]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
gdb: Add support for dumping to verilog hex format.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 2 goodbye
2795 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2796 * 1 hello
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @quotation
2848 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2849 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2850 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2851 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2852 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2853 like this:
2854
2855 @smallexample
2856 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2857 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2858 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2859 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2860 @end smallexample
2861 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2862 @c doesn't support threads"?
2863 @end quotation
2864
2865 @cindex focus of debugging
2866 @cindex current thread
2867 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2868 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2869 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2870 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2871 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2872
2873 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2874 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2875 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2876 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2877 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2878 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2879 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2880 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2881 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2882 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2883
2884 @smallexample
2885 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2890 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2891 further qualifier.
2892
2893 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2894 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2895 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2896 @c program?
2897 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2898 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2899 @c threads ab initio?
2900
2901 @cindex thread number
2902 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2903 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2904 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2905
2906 @table @code
2907 @kindex info threads
2908 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2909 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2910 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2911 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2912 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2913
2914 @enumerate
2915 @item
2916 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2917
2918 @item
2919 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2920
2921 @item
2922 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2923 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2924 program itself.
2925
2926 @item
2927 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2928 @end enumerate
2929
2930 @noindent
2931 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2932 indicates the current thread.
2933
2934 For example,
2935 @end table
2936 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2937
2938 @smallexample
2939 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2940 Id Target Id Frame
2941 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2942 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2943 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2944 at threadtest.c:68
2945 @end smallexample
2946
2947 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2948 Solaris-specific command:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item maint info sol-threads
2952 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2953 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2954 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2959 @item thread @var{threadno}
2960 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2961 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2962 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2963 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2964 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2968 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2969 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2970 8 printf ("hello\n");
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @noindent
2974 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2975 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2976 threads.
2977
2978 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2979 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2980 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2981 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2982 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2983 information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 @kindex thread apply
2986 @cindex apply command to several threads
2987 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2988 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2989 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2990 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2991 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2992 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2993 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2994 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2995 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2996 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2997
2998
2999 @kindex thread name
3000 @cindex name a thread
3001 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3002 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3003 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3004 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3005
3006 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3007 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3008 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3009 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3010 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3011
3012 @kindex thread find
3013 @cindex search for a thread
3014 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3015 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3016 matches the supplied regular expression.
3017
3018 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3019 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3020 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3021 is the LWP id.
3022
3023 @smallexample
3024 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3025 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3026 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3027 Id Target Id Frame
3028 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 @kindex set print thread-events
3032 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3033 @item set print thread-events
3034 @itemx set print thread-events on
3035 @itemx set print thread-events off
3036 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3037 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3038 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3039 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3040 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3041
3042 @kindex show print thread-events
3043 @item show print thread-events
3044 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3045 have started and exited.
3046 @end table
3047
3048 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3049 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3050 programs with multiple threads.
3051
3052 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3053 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3054
3055 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3056 @table @code
3057 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3058 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3059 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3061 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3062 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3063 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3064 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3065 macro.
3066
3067 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3068 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3069 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3070 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3071 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3072 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3073
3074 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3075 refers to the default system directories that are
3076 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3077 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3078 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3079
3080 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3081 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3082 was loaded in the inferior process.
3083
3084 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3085 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3086 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3087 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3088 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3089 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3090 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3091
3092 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3093 only on some platforms.
3094
3095 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3096 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3097 Display current libthread_db search path.
3098
3099 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3100 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3101 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3102 @item set debug libthread-db
3103 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3104 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3105 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3106 @end table
3107
3108 @node Forks
3109 @section Debugging Forks
3110
3111 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3112 @cindex multiple processes
3113 @cindex processes, multiple
3114 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3115 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3116 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3117 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3118 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3119 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3120 will cause it to terminate.
3121
3122 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3123 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3124 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3125 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3126 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3127 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3128 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3129 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3130 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3131 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3132
3133 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3134 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3135 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3136 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3137
3138 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3139 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3140
3141 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3142 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3146 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3147 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3148 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3149 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @item parent
3153 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3154 unimpeded. This is the default.
3155
3156 @item child
3157 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3158 unimpeded.
3159
3160 @end table
3161
3162 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3163 @item show follow-fork-mode
3164 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3165 @end table
3166
3167 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3168 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3169 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3170
3171 @table @code
3172 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3173 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3174 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3175 retain debugger control over them both.
3176
3177 @table @code
3178 @item on
3179 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3180 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3181 independently. This is the default.
3182
3183 @item off
3184 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3185 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3186 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3187 is held suspended.
3188
3189 @end table
3190
3191 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3192 @item show detach-on-fork
3193 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3194 @end table
3195
3196 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3197 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3198 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3199 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3200 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3201 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3202
3203 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3204 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3205 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3206 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3207 and Programs}.
3208
3209 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3210 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3211 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3212 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3213 the child process's @code{main}.
3214
3215 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3216 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3217
3218 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3219 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3220 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3221 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3222 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3223 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3224 command.
3225
3226 @table @code
3227 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3228 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3229
3230 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3231 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3232
3233 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3234
3235 @table @code
3236 @item new
3237 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3238 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3239 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3240 original inferior.
3241
3242 For example:
3243
3244 @smallexample
3245 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3246 (gdb) info inferior
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog1
3249 (@value{GDBP}) run
3250 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3251 Program exited normally.
3252 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3253 Id Description Executable
3254 * 2 <null> prog2
3255 1 <null> prog1
3256 @end smallexample
3257
3258 @item same
3259 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3260 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3261 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3262 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3263 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3264
3265 For example:
3266
3267 @smallexample
3268 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3269 Id Description Executable
3270 * 1 <null> prog1
3271 (@value{GDBP}) run
3272 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3273 Program exited normally.
3274 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3275 Id Description Executable
3276 * 1 <null> prog2
3277 @end smallexample
3278
3279 @end table
3280 @end table
3281
3282 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3283 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3284 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3285
3286 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3287 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3288
3289 @cindex checkpoint
3290 @cindex restart
3291 @cindex bookmark
3292 @cindex snapshot of a process
3293 @cindex rewind program state
3294
3295 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3296 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3297 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3298 later.
3299
3300 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3301 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3302 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3303 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3304 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3305
3306 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3307 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3308 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3309 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3310 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3311 start again from there.
3312
3313 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3314 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3315
3316 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3317
3318 @table @code
3319 @kindex checkpoint
3320 @item checkpoint
3321 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3322 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3323 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3324
3325 @kindex info checkpoints
3326 @item info checkpoints
3327 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3328 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3329 listed:
3330
3331 @table @code
3332 @item Checkpoint ID
3333 @item Process ID
3334 @item Code Address
3335 @item Source line, or label
3336 @end table
3337
3338 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3339 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3340 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3341 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3342 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3343 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3344 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3345
3346 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3347 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3348 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3349 the debugger.
3350
3351 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3352 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3353 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3354
3355 @end table
3356
3357 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3358 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3359 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3360 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3361 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3362 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3363 previously read data can be read again.
3364
3365 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3366 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3367 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3368 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3369 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3370 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3371
3372 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3373 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3374 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3375 different execution path this time.
3376
3377 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3378 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3379 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3380 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3381 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3382 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3383 potentially pose a problem.
3384
3385 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3386
3387 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3388 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3389 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3390 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3391 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3392 next.
3393
3394 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3395 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3396 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3397 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3398 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3399
3400 @node Stopping
3401 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3402
3403 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3404 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3405 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3406
3407 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3408 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3409 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3410 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3411 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3412 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3413 explicitly request this information at any time.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex info program
3417 @item info program
3418 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3419 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3420 @end table
3421
3422 @menu
3423 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3424 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3425 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3426 Skipping over functions and files
3427 * Signals:: Signals
3428 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3429 @end menu
3430
3431 @node Breakpoints
3432 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3433
3434 @cindex breakpoints
3435 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3436 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3437 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3438 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3439 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3440 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3441 program.
3442
3443 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3444 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3445 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3446 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3447 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3448 call).
3449
3450 @cindex watchpoints
3451 @cindex data breakpoints
3452 @cindex memory tracing
3453 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3454 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3455 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3456 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3457 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3458 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3459 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3460 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3461 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3462 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3463 same commands.
3464
3465 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3466 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3467 Automatic Display}.
3468
3469 @cindex catchpoints
3470 @cindex breakpoint on events
3471 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3472 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3473 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3474 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3475 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3476 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3477 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3478
3479 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3480 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3481 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3482 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3483 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3484 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3485 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3486 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3487 enable it again.
3488
3489 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3490 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3491 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3492 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3493 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3494 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3495 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3496
3497 @menu
3498 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3499 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3500 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3501 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3502 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3503 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3504 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3505 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3506 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3507 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3508 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3509 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3510 @end menu
3511
3512 @node Set Breaks
3513 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3514
3515 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3516 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3517 @c
3518 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3519
3520 @kindex break
3521 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3522 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3523 @cindex latest breakpoint
3524 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3525 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3526 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3527 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3528 convenience variables.
3529
3530 @table @code
3531 @item break @var{location}
3532 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3533 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3534 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3535 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3536 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3537
3538 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3539 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3540 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3541 that situation.
3542
3543 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3544 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3545 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3546
3547 @item break
3548 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3549 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3550 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3551 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3552 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3553 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3554 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3555 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3556 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3557 inside loops.
3558
3559 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3560 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3561 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3562 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3563 existed when your program stopped.
3564
3565 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3566 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3567 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3568 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3569 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3570 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3571 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3572
3573 @kindex tbreak
3574 @item tbreak @var{args}
3575 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3576 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3577 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3578 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3579
3580 @kindex hbreak
3581 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3582 @item hbreak @var{args}
3583 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3584 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3585 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3586 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3587 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3588 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3589 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3590 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3591 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3592 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3593 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3594 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3595 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3596 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3597 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3598 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3599 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3600 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3601
3602 @kindex thbreak
3603 @item thbreak @var{args}
3604 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3605 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3606 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3607 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3608 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3609 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3610 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3611 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3612
3613 @kindex rbreak
3614 @cindex regular expression
3615 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3616 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3617 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3618 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3619 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3620 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3621 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3622 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3623 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3624
3625 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3626 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3627 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3628 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3629 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3630 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3631
3632 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3633 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3634 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3635 classes.
3636
3637 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3638 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3639 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3640
3641 @smallexample
3642 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3643 @end smallexample
3644
3645 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3646 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3647 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3648 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3649 every function in a given file:
3650
3651 @smallexample
3652 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3653 @end smallexample
3654
3655 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3656 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3657
3658 @kindex info breakpoints
3659 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3660 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3661 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3662 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3663 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3664 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3665 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3666
3667 @table @emph
3668 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3669 @item Type
3670 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3671 @item Disposition
3672 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3673 @item Enabled or Disabled
3674 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3675 that are not enabled.
3676 @item Address
3677 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3678 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3679 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3680 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3681 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3682 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3683 @item What
3684 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3685 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3686 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3687 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3688 @end table
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3692 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3693 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3694 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3695 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3696 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3697
3698 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3699 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3700 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3701 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3702
3703 @noindent
3704 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3705 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3706 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3707 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3708 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3709
3710 @noindent
3711 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3712 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3713 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3714 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3715 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3716 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3717
3718 @noindent
3719 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3720 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3721
3722 @end table
3723
3724 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3725 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3726 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3727 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3728
3729 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3730 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3731 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3732 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3733
3734 @itemize @bullet
3735 @item
3736 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3737
3738 @item
3739 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3740 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3741
3742 @item
3743 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3744 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3745
3746 @item
3747 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3748 several places where that function is inlined.
3749 @end itemize
3750
3751 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3752 the relevant locations.
3753
3754 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3755 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3756 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3757 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3758 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3759 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3760 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3761
3762 For example:
3763
3764 @smallexample
3765 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3766 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3767 stop only if i==1
3768 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3769 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3770 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3771 @end smallexample
3772
3773 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3774 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3775 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3776 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3777 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3778 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3779 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3780 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3781 that belong to that breakpoint.
3782
3783 @cindex pending breakpoints
3784 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3785 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3786 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3787 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3788 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3789 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3790 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3791 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3792 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3793 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3794 is not yet resolved.
3795
3796 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3797 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3798 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3799 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3800 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3801 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3802
3803 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3804 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3805 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3806 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3807
3808 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3809 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3810 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3811
3812 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3813 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3814 address specification to an address:
3815
3816 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3817 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3818 @table @code
3819 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3820 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3821 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3822
3823 @item set breakpoint pending on
3824 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3825 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3826
3827 @item set breakpoint pending off
3828 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3829 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3830 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3831
3832 @item show breakpoint pending
3833 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3834 @end table
3835
3836 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3837 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3838 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3839
3840 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3841 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3842 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3843 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3844 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3845 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3846 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3847 breakpoints.
3848
3849 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3850
3851 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3852 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3853 @table @code
3854 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3855 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3856 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3857 breakpoint must be used.
3858
3859 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3860 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3861 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3862 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3863 @end table
3864
3865 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3866 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3867 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3868 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3869 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3870 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3871 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3872 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3873 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3874
3875 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3876 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3877 @table @code
3878 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3879 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3880 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3881 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3882
3883 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3884 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3885 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3886 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3887 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3888 @end table
3889
3890 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3891 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3892 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3893
3894 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3895 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3896
3897 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3898
3899 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3900 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3901 @table @code
3902 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3903 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3904 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3905 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3906 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3907
3908 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3909 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3910 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3911 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3912 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3913 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3914 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3915 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3916 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3917 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3918 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3919 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3920 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3921
3922 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3923 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3924 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3925 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3926 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3927 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3928 @end table
3929
3930
3931 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3932 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3933 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3934 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3935 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3936 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3937 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3938 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3939
3940
3941 @node Set Watchpoints
3942 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3943
3944 @cindex setting watchpoints
3945 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3946 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3947 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3948 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3949 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3950
3951 @itemize @bullet
3952 @item
3953 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3954
3955 @item
3956 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3957 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3958 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3959
3960 @item
3961 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3962 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3963 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3964 @end itemize
3965
3966 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3967 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3968 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3969 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3970 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3971 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3972 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3973 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3974 the expression changes.
3975
3976 @cindex software watchpoints
3977 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3978 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3979 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3980 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3981 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3982 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3983 culprit.)
3984
3985 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3986 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3987 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3988
3989 @table @code
3990 @kindex watch
3991 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3992 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3993 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3994 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3995 to watch the value of a single variable:
3996
3997 @smallexample
3998 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3999 @end smallexample
4000
4001 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4002 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4003 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4004 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4005 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4006 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4007
4008 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4009 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4010 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4011 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4012 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4013 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4014 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4015 error.
4016
4017 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4018 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4019 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4020 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4021 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4022 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4023 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4024 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4025 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4026 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4027 Examples:
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4031 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 @kindex rwatch
4035 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4036 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4037 by the program.
4038
4039 @kindex awatch
4040 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4041 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4042 or written into by the program.
4043
4044 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4045 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4046 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4047 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4048 @end table
4049
4050 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4051 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4052 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4053 a never-changing value:
4054
4055 @smallexample
4056 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4057 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4058 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4059 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4060 @end smallexample
4061
4062 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4063 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4064 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4065 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4066 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4067 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4068
4069 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4070 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4071 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4072 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4073 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4074 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4075 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4076 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4077
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4080 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4081 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4082
4083 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4084 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4085 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4086 @end table
4087
4088 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4089 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4090 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4091
4092 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4093
4094 @smallexample
4095 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4096 @end smallexample
4097
4098 @noindent
4099 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4100
4101 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4102 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4103 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4104 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4105 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4106 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4107 will print a message like this:
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4114 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4115 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4116 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4117 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4118 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4119 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4120 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4121
4122 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4123 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4124 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4125 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4126 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4127 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4128
4129 @smallexample
4130 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4131 @end smallexample
4132
4133 @noindent
4134 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4135
4136 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4137 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4138 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4139 expression with separately allocated resources.
4140
4141 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4142 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4143 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4144
4145 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4146 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4147 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4148 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4149 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4150 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4151 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4152 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4153 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4154
4155 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4156 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4157 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4158 watched expression from every thread.
4159
4160 @quotation
4161 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4162 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4163 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4164 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4165 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4166 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4167 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4168 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4169 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4170 @end quotation
4171
4172 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4173
4174 @node Set Catchpoints
4175 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4176 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4177 @cindex exception handlers
4178 @cindex event handling
4179
4180 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4181 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4182 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4183
4184 @table @code
4185 @kindex catch
4186 @item catch @var{event}
4187 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4188
4189 @table @code
4190 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4191 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4192 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4193 @kindex catch throw
4194 @kindex catch rethrow
4195 @kindex catch catch
4196 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4197 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4198
4199 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4200 regular expression will be caught.
4201
4202 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4203 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4204 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4205 exception being thrown.
4206
4207 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4208 @value{GDBN}:
4209
4210 @itemize @bullet
4211 @item
4212 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4213 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4214 supported.
4215
4216 @item
4217 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4218 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4219 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4220 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4221 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4222 built.
4223
4224 @item
4225 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4226 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4227
4228 @item
4229 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4230 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4231 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4232 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4233
4234 @item
4235 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4236 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4237 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4238 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4239 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4240 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4241 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4242 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4243 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4244
4245 @item
4246 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4247
4248 @item
4249 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4250 @end itemize
4251
4252 @item exception
4253 @kindex catch exception
4254 @cindex Ada exception catching
4255 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4256 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4257 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4258 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4259 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4260
4261 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4262 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4263 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4264 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4265 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4266 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4267 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4268 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4269
4270 @item exception unhandled
4271 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4272 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4273
4274 @item assert
4275 @kindex catch assert
4276 A failed Ada assertion.
4277
4278 @item exec
4279 @kindex catch exec
4280 @cindex break on fork/exec
4281 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4282 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4283
4284 @item syscall
4285 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4286 @kindex catch syscall
4287 @cindex break on a system call.
4288 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4289 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4290 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4291 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4292 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4293 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4294 will be caught.
4295
4296 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4297 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4298 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4299 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4300
4301 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4302 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4303 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4304 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4305
4306 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4307 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4308 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4309 available choices.
4310
4311 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4312 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4313 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4314 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4315 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4316 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4317 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4318 behind the OS upgrades).
4319
4320 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4321 arguments to it:
4322
4323 @smallexample
4324 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4325 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4326 (@value{GDBP}) r
4327 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4328
4329 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4330 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4331 (@value{GDBP}) c
4332 Continuing.
4333
4334 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4335 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4336 (@value{GDBP})
4337 @end smallexample
4338
4339 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4343 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4344 (@value{GDBP}) r
4345 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4346
4347 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4348 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4349 (@value{GDBP}) c
4350 Continuing.
4351
4352 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4353 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4354 (@value{GDBP})
4355 @end smallexample
4356
4357 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4358 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4359 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4360
4361 @smallexample
4362 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4363 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4364 (@value{GDBP}) r
4365 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4366
4367 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4368 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4369 (@value{GDBP}) c
4370 Continuing.
4371
4372 Program exited normally.
4373 (@value{GDBP})
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4377 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4378 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4379 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4380
4381 @smallexample
4382 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4383 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4384 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4385 (@value{GDBP})
4386 @end smallexample
4387
4388 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4389 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4390 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4391 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4392 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4393 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4394
4395 @smallexample
4396 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4397 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4398 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4399 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4400 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4401 (@value{GDBP})
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4405
4406 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4407 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4408
4409 @smallexample
4410 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4411 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4412 @end smallexample
4413
4414 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4415
4416 @item fork
4417 @kindex catch fork
4418 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4419 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4420
4421 @item vfork
4422 @kindex catch vfork
4423 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4424 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4425
4426 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4427 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4428 @kindex catch load
4429 @kindex catch unload
4430 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4431 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4432 matches one of the affected libraries.
4433
4434 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4435 @kindex catch signal
4436 The delivery of a signal.
4437
4438 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4439 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4440 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4441
4442 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4443 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4444 signal names.
4445
4446 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4447 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4448 will be caught.
4449
4450 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4451 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4452 catchpoint.
4453
4454 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4455 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4456 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4457 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4458 commands.
4459
4460 @end table
4461
4462 @item tcatch @var{event}
4463 @kindex tcatch
4464 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4465 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4466
4467 @end table
4468
4469 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4470
4471
4472 @node Delete Breaks
4473 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4474
4475 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4476 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4477 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4478 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4479 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4480 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4481
4482 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4483 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4484 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4485 their breakpoint numbers.
4486
4487 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4488 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4489 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4490
4491 @table @code
4492 @kindex clear
4493 @item clear
4494 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4495 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4496 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4497 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4498
4499 @item clear @var{location}
4500 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4501 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4502 most useful ones are listed below:
4503
4504 @table @code
4505 @item clear @var{function}
4506 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4507 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4508
4509 @item clear @var{linenum}
4510 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4511 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4512 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4513 @end table
4514
4515 @cindex delete breakpoints
4516 @kindex delete
4517 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4518 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4519 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4520 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4521 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4522 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4523 @end table
4524
4525 @node Disabling
4526 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4527
4528 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4529 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4530 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4531 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4532 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4533
4534 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4535 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4536 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4537 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4538 do not know which numbers to use.
4539
4540 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4541 affects all of its locations.
4542
4543 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4544 different states of enablement:
4545
4546 @itemize @bullet
4547 @item
4548 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4549 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4550 @item
4551 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4552 @item
4553 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4554 disabled.
4555 @item
4556 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4557 N times, then becomes disabled.
4558 @item
4559 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4560 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4561 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4562 @end itemize
4563
4564 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4565 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4566
4567 @table @code
4568 @kindex disable
4569 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4570 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4571 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4572 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4573 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4574 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4575 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4576
4577 @kindex enable
4578 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4579 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4580 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4581
4582 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4583 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4584 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4585
4586 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4587 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4588 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4589 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4590 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4591 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4592 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4593
4594 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4595 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4596 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4597 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4598 @end table
4599
4600 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4601 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4602 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4603 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4604 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4605 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4606 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4607 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4608 Stepping}.)
4609
4610 @node Conditions
4611 @subsection Break Conditions
4612 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4613 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4614
4615 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4616 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4617 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4618 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4619 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4620 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4621 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4622 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4623
4624 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4625 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4626 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4627 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4628 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4629
4630 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4631 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4632 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4633 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4634 one.
4635
4636 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4637 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4638 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4639 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4640 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4641 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4642 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4643 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4644 conditions for the
4645 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4646 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4647
4648 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4649 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4650 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4651 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4652 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4653 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4654
4655 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4656 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4657 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4658 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4659 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4660
4661 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4662 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4663 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4664 with the @code{condition} command.
4665
4666 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4667 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4668 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4669 catchpoint.
4670
4671 @table @code
4672 @kindex condition
4673 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4674 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4675 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4676 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4677 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4678 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4679 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4680 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4681 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4682 prints an error message:
4683
4684 @smallexample
4685 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4686 @end smallexample
4687
4688 @noindent
4689 @value{GDBN} does
4690 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4691 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4692 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4693
4694 @item condition @var{bnum}
4695 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4696 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4697 @end table
4698
4699 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4700 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4701 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4702 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4703 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4704 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4705 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4706 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4707 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4708 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4709 your program reaches it.
4710
4711 @table @code
4712 @kindex ignore
4713 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4714 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4715 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4716 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4717 takes no action.
4718
4719 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4720 a count of zero.
4721
4722 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4723 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4724 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4725 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4726
4727 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4728 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4729 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4730
4731 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4732 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4733 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4734 Variables}.
4735 @end table
4736
4737 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4738
4739
4740 @node Break Commands
4741 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4742
4743 @cindex breakpoint commands
4744 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4745 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4746 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4747 enable other breakpoints.
4748
4749 @table @code
4750 @kindex commands
4751 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4752 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4753 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4754 @itemx end
4755 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4756 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4757 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4758
4759 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4760 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4761
4762 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4763 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4764 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4765 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4766 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4767 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4768 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4769 Expressions}).
4770 @end table
4771
4772 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4773 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4774
4775 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4776 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4777 that resumes execution.
4778
4779 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4780 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4781 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4782 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4783 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4784
4785 @kindex silent
4786 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4787 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4788 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4789 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4790 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4791 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4792
4793 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4794 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4795 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4796
4797 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4798 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4799
4800 @smallexample
4801 break foo if x>0
4802 commands
4803 silent
4804 printf "x is %d\n",x
4805 cont
4806 end
4807 @end smallexample
4808
4809 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4810 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4811 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4812 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4813 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4814 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4815 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4816
4817 @smallexample
4818 break 403
4819 commands
4820 silent
4821 set x = y + 4
4822 cont
4823 end
4824 @end smallexample
4825
4826 @node Dynamic Printf
4827 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4828
4829 @cindex dynamic printf
4830 @cindex dprintf
4831 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4832 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4833 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4834 having to recompile it.
4835
4836 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4837 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4838 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4839 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4840 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4841 redirects to files and so forth.
4842
4843 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4844 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4845 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4846 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4847 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4848 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4849 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4850
4851 @table @code
4852 @kindex dprintf
4853 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4854 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4855 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4856 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4857
4858 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4859 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4860 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4861 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4862 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4863 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4864
4865 @item gdb
4866 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4867 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4868
4869 @item call
4870 @kindex dprintf-style call
4871 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4872 @code{printf}).
4873
4874 @item agent
4875 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4876 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4877 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4878 support running commands on the target.
4879
4880 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4881 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4882 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4883 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4884 command.
4885
4886 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4887 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4888 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4889 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4890 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4891 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4892
4893 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4894 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4895 you could do the following:
4896
4897 @example
4898 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4899 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4900 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4901 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4902 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4903 (gdb) info break
4904 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4905 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4906 continue
4907 (gdb)
4908 @end example
4909
4910 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4911 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4912 the variable settings.
4913
4914 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4915 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4916 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4917 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4918 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4919 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4920
4921 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4922 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4923 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4924
4925 @end table
4926
4927 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4928 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4929 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4930 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4931 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4932 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4933
4934 @node Save Breakpoints
4935 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4936
4937 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4938 breakpoints}} command.
4939
4940 @table @code
4941 @kindex save breakpoints
4942 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4943 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4944 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4945 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4946 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4947 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4948 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4949 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4950 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4951 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4952 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4953 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4954 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4955 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4956 that can no longer be recreated.
4957 @end table
4958
4959 @node Static Probe Points
4960 @subsection Static Probe Points
4961
4962 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4963 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4964 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4965 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4966 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4967
4968 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4969 ELF-compatible systems:
4970
4971 @itemize @bullet
4972
4973 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4974 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4975 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4976 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4977 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4978 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4979 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4980 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4981
4982 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4983 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4984 C@t{++} languages.
4985 @end itemize
4986
4987 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4988 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4989 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4990 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4991 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4992 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4993 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4994 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4995 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4996
4997 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4998 probes}, with optional arguments:
4999
5000 @table @code
5001 @kindex info probes
5002 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5003 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5004 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5005 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5006
5007 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5008 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5009 probes from all providers are listed.
5010
5011 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5012 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5013 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5014
5015 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5016 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5017 given, all object files are considered.
5018
5019 @item info probes all
5020 List the available static probes, from all types.
5021 @end table
5022
5023 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5024 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5025 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5026 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5027 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5028
5029 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5030 commands, with optional arguments:
5031
5032 @table @code
5033 @kindex enable probes
5034 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5035 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5036 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5037 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5038
5039 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5040 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5041 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5042
5043 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5044 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5045 given, all object files are considered.
5046
5047 @kindex disable probes
5048 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5049 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5050 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5051 @end table
5052
5053 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5054 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5055 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5056 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5057 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5058 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5059 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5060 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5061 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5062 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5063 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5064 at the current probe point.
5065
5066 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5067 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5068 an error message.
5069
5070
5071 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5072 @node Error in Breakpoints
5073 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5074
5075 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5076 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5077
5078 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5079 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5080 @smallexample
5081 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5082 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5083 @end smallexample
5084
5085 @noindent
5086 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5087 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5088 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5089
5090 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5091 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5092
5093 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5094 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5095 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5096
5097 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5098 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5099 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5100 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5101
5102 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5103 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5104 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5105 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5106 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5107 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5108 first in the bundle.
5109
5110 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5111 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5112 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5113 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5114 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5115 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5116 is hit.
5117
5118 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5119 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5123 @end smallexample
5124
5125 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5126 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5127 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5128 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5129 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5130 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5131 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5132 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5133
5134 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5135 adjusted breakpoints:
5136
5137 @smallexample
5138 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5139 to 0x00010410.
5140 @end smallexample
5141
5142 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5143 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5144 frequently than expected.
5145
5146 @node Continuing and Stepping
5147 @section Continuing and Stepping
5148
5149 @cindex stepping
5150 @cindex continuing
5151 @cindex resuming execution
5152 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5153 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5154 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5155 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5156 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5157 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5158 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5159 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5160 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5161 handlers}).)
5162
5163 @table @code
5164 @kindex continue
5165 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5166 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5167 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5168 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5169 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5170 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5171 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5172 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5173 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5174 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5175
5176 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5177 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5178 @code{continue} is ignored.
5179
5180 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5181 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5182 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5183 @code{continue}.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5187 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5188 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5189 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5190
5191 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5192 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5193 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5194 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5195 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5196 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5197
5198 @table @code
5199 @kindex step
5200 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5201 @item step
5202 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5203 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5204 abbreviated @code{s}.
5205
5206 @quotation
5207 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5208 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5209 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5210 @c distinction here.
5211 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5212 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5213 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5214 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5215 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5216 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5217 below.
5218 @end quotation
5219
5220 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5221 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5222 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5223 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5224 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5225 called within the line.
5226
5227 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5228 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5229 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5230 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5231 was any debugging information about the routine.
5232
5233 @item step @var{count}
5234 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5235 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5236 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5237
5238 @kindex next
5239 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5240 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5241 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5242 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5243 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5244 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5245 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5246 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5247
5248 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5249
5250
5251 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5252 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5253 @c
5254 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5255 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5256 @c function are executed without stopping.
5257
5258 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5259 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5260 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5261
5262 @kindex set step-mode
5263 @item set step-mode
5264 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5265 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5266 @itemx set step-mode on
5267 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5268 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5269 information rather than stepping over it.
5270
5271 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5272 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5273 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5274
5275 @item set step-mode off
5276 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5277 debug information. This is the default.
5278
5279 @item show step-mode
5280 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5281 source line debug information.
5282
5283 @kindex finish
5284 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5285 @item finish
5286 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5287 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5288 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5289
5290 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5291 ,Returning from a Function}).
5292
5293 @kindex until
5294 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5295 @cindex run until specified location
5296 @item until
5297 @itemx u
5298 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5299 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5300 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5301 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5302 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5303 than the address of the jump.
5304
5305 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5306 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5307 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5308 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5309 through the next iteration.
5310
5311 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5312 stack frame.
5313
5314 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5315 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5316 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5317 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5318 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5319
5320 @smallexample
5321 (@value{GDBP}) f
5322 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5323 206 expand_input();
5324 (@value{GDBP}) until
5325 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5326 @end smallexample
5327
5328 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5329 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5330 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5331 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5332 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5333 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5334 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5335
5336 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5337 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5338 argument.
5339
5340 @item until @var{location}
5341 @itemx u @var{location}
5342 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5343 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5344 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5345 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5346 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5347 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5348 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5349 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5350 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5351 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5352 invocations have returned.
5353
5354 @smallexample
5355 94 int factorial (int value)
5356 95 @{
5357 96 if (value > 1) @{
5358 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5359 98 @}
5360 99 return (value);
5361 100 @}
5362 @end smallexample
5363
5364
5365 @kindex advance @var{location}
5366 @item advance @var{location}
5367 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5368 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5369 @ref{Specify Location}.
5370 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5371 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5372 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5373 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5374
5375
5376 @kindex stepi
5377 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5378 @item stepi
5379 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5380 @itemx si
5381 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5382
5383 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5384 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5385 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5386 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5387
5388 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5389
5390 @need 750
5391 @kindex nexti
5392 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5393 @item nexti
5394 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5395 @itemx ni
5396 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5397 proceed until the function returns.
5398
5399 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5400
5401 @end table
5402
5403 @anchor{range stepping}
5404 @cindex range stepping
5405 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5406 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5407 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5408 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5409 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5410 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5411 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5412 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5413 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5414 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5415 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5416 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5417 if necessary:
5418
5419 @table @code
5420 @kindex set range-stepping
5421 @kindex show range-stepping
5422 @item set range-stepping
5423 @itemx show range-stepping
5424 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5425
5426 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5427 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5428 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5429 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5430 default is @code{on}.
5431
5432 @end table
5433
5434 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5435 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5436 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5437
5438 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5439 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5440 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5441
5442 For example, consider the following C function:
5443
5444 @smallexample
5445 101 int func()
5446 102 @{
5447 103 foo(boring());
5448 104 bar(boring());
5449 105 @}
5450 @end smallexample
5451
5452 @noindent
5453 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5454 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5455 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5456 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5457
5458 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5459 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5460 is called from many places.
5461
5462 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5463 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5464 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5465 @code{foo}.
5466
5467 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5468 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5469
5470 @table @code
5471 @kindex skip function
5472 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5473 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5474 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5475 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5476 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5477
5478 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5479 will be skipped.
5480
5481 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5482 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5483
5484 @kindex skip file
5485 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5486 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5487 will be skipped over when stepping.
5488
5489 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5490 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5491 @end table
5492
5493 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5494 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex info skip
5498 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5499 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5500 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5501 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5502
5503 @table @emph
5504 @item Identifier
5505 A number identifying this skip.
5506 @item Type
5507 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5508 @item Enabled or Disabled
5509 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5510 @item Address
5511 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5512 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5513 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5514 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5515 address here.
5516 @item What
5517 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5518 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5519 where it is defined.
5520 @end table
5521
5522 @kindex skip delete
5523 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5524 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5525 skips.
5526
5527 @kindex skip enable
5528 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5529 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5530 skips.
5531
5532 @kindex skip disable
5533 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5534 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5535 skips.
5536
5537 @end table
5538
5539 @node Signals
5540 @section Signals
5541 @cindex signals
5542
5543 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5544 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5545 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5546 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5547 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5548 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5549 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5550 requested an alarm).
5551
5552 @cindex fatal signals
5553 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5554 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5555 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5556 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5557 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5558 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5559
5560 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5561 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5562 signal.
5563
5564 @cindex handling signals
5565 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5566 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5567 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5568 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5569 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5570
5571 @table @code
5572 @kindex info signals
5573 @kindex info handle
5574 @item info signals
5575 @itemx info handle
5576 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5577 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5578 the defined types of signals.
5579
5580 @item info signals @var{sig}
5581 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5582
5583 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5584
5585 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5586 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5587 for details about this command.
5588
5589 @kindex handle
5590 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5591 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5592 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5593 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5594 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5595 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5596 say what change to make.
5597 @end table
5598
5599 @c @group
5600 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5601 Their full names are:
5602
5603 @table @code
5604 @item nostop
5605 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5606 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5607
5608 @item stop
5609 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5610 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5611
5612 @item print
5613 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5614
5615 @item noprint
5616 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5617 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5618
5619 @item pass
5620 @itemx noignore
5621 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5622 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5623 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5624
5625 @item nopass
5626 @itemx ignore
5627 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5628 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5629 @end table
5630 @c @end group
5631
5632 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5633 program until you
5634 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5635 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5636 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5637 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5638 program sees that signal when you continue.
5639
5640 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5641 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5642 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5643 erroneous signals.
5644
5645 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5646 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5647 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5648 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5649 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5650 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5651 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5652 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5653 Program a Signal}.
5654
5655 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5656 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5657
5658 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5659 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5660 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5661 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5662 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5663 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5664 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5665 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5666 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5667 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5668 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5669 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5670 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5671
5672 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5673
5674 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5675 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5676 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5677 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5678
5679 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5680 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5681 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5682 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5683
5684 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5685 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5686
5687 @smallexample
5688 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5689 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5690 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5691 (@value{GDBP}) c
5692 Continuing.
5693
5694 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5695 main () sigusr1.c:28
5696 28 p = 0;
5697 (@value{GDBP}) si
5698 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5699 9 @{
5700 @end smallexample
5701
5702 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5703 program to receive the signal first:
5704
5705 @smallexample
5706 (@value{GDBP}) n
5707 28 p = 0;
5708 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5709 (@value{GDBP}) si
5710 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5711 9 @{
5712 (@value{GDBP})
5713 @end smallexample
5714
5715 @cindex extra signal information
5716 @anchor{extra signal information}
5717
5718 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5719 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5720 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5721 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5722 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5723 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5724 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5725 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5726 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5727 system header.
5728
5729 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5730 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5731
5732 @smallexample
5733 @group
5734 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5735 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5736 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5737 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5738 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5739 type = struct @{
5740 int si_signo;
5741 int si_errno;
5742 int si_code;
5743 union @{
5744 int _pad[28];
5745 struct @{...@} _kill;
5746 struct @{...@} _timer;
5747 struct @{...@} _rt;
5748 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5749 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5750 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5751 @} _sifields;
5752 @}
5753 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5754 type = struct @{
5755 void *si_addr;
5756 @}
5757 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5758 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5759 @end group
5760 @end smallexample
5761
5762 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5763
5764 @node Thread Stops
5765 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5766
5767 @cindex stopped threads
5768 @cindex threads, stopped
5769
5770 @cindex continuing threads
5771 @cindex threads, continuing
5772
5773 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5774 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5775 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5776 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5777 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5778 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5779 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5780 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5781 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5782
5783 @menu
5784 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5785 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5786 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5787 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5788 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5789 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5790 @end menu
5791
5792 @node All-Stop Mode
5793 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5794
5795 @cindex all-stop mode
5796
5797 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5798 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5799 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5800 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5801 underfoot.
5802
5803 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5804 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5805 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5806
5807 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5808 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5809 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5810 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5811 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5812 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5813 stops.
5814
5815 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5816 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5817 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5818 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5819
5820 @cindex automatic thread selection
5821 @cindex switching threads automatically
5822 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5823 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5824 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5825 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5826 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5827 thread.
5828
5829 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5830 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5831
5832 @table @code
5833 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5834 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5835 @cindex lock scheduler
5836 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5837 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5838 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5839 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5840 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5841 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5842 Other threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5843 completely free to run when you use commands
5844 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5845 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5846 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5847
5848 @item show scheduler-locking
5849 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5850 @end table
5851
5852 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5853 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5854 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5855 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5856 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5857 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5858 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5859 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5860 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5861 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5862 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5863 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5864 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5865 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5866
5867 @table @code
5868 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5869 @item set schedule-multiple
5870 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5871 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5872 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5873 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5874 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5875 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5876
5877 @item show schedule-multiple
5878 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5879 multiple processes.
5880 @end table
5881
5882 @node Non-Stop Mode
5883 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5884
5885 @cindex non-stop mode
5886
5887 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5888 @c with more details.
5889
5890 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5891 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5892 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5893 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5894 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5895 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5896
5897 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5898 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5899 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5900 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5901 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5902 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5903 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5904 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5905 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5906 independently and simultaneously.
5907
5908 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5909 or attach to your program:
5910
5911 @smallexample
5912 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5913 set pagination off
5914
5915 # Finally, turn it on!
5916 set non-stop on
5917 @end smallexample
5918
5919 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5920
5921 @table @code
5922 @kindex set non-stop
5923 @item set non-stop on
5924 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5925 @item set non-stop off
5926 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5927 @kindex show non-stop
5928 @item show non-stop
5929 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5930 @end table
5931
5932 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5933 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5934 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5935 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5936 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5937 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5938 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5939 default.
5940
5941 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5942 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5943 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5944
5945 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5946 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5947 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5948 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5949 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5950
5951 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5952 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5953 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5954 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5955 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5956
5957 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5958
5959 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5960 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5961 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5962 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5963 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5964 previously current thread.
5965
5966 @node Background Execution
5967 @subsection Background Execution
5968
5969 @cindex foreground execution
5970 @cindex background execution
5971 @cindex asynchronous execution
5972 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5973
5974 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5975 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5976 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5977 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5978 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5979 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5980
5981 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5982 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5983
5984 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5985 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5986 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5987 are:
5988
5989 @table @code
5990 @kindex run&
5991 @item run
5992 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5993
5994 @item attach
5995 @kindex attach&
5996 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5997
5998 @item step
5999 @kindex step&
6000 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6001
6002 @item stepi
6003 @kindex stepi&
6004 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6005
6006 @item next
6007 @kindex next&
6008 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6009
6010 @item nexti
6011 @kindex nexti&
6012 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6013
6014 @item continue
6015 @kindex continue&
6016 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6017
6018 @item finish
6019 @kindex finish&
6020 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6021
6022 @item until
6023 @kindex until&
6024 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6025
6026 @end table
6027
6028 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6029 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6030 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6031 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6032 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6033 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6034
6035 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6036 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6037
6038 @table @code
6039 @kindex interrupt
6040 @item interrupt
6041 @itemx interrupt -a
6042
6043 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6044 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6045 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6046 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6047 @end table
6048
6049 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6050 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6051
6052 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6053 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6054 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6055
6056 @table @code
6057 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6058 @cindex thread breakpoints
6059 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6060 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
6061 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6062 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6063 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6064 specify some source line.
6065
6066 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6067 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6068 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6069 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6070 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6071
6072 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6073 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6074 program.
6075
6076 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6077 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6078 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 @end table
6085
6086 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6087 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6088 thread list. For example:
6089
6090 @smallexample
6091 (@value{GDBP}) c
6092 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6096 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6097 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6098 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6099 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6100 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6101 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6102 command.
6103
6104 @node Interrupted System Calls
6105 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6106
6107 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6108 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6109 @cindex premature return from system calls
6110 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6111 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6112 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6113 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6114 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6115 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6116 stop execution.
6117
6118 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6119 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6120 style anyways.
6121
6122 For example, do not write code like this:
6123
6124 @smallexample
6125 sleep (10);
6126 @end smallexample
6127
6128 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6129 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6130
6131 Instead, write this:
6132
6133 @smallexample
6134 int unslept = 10;
6135 while (unslept > 0)
6136 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6137 @end smallexample
6138
6139 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6140 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6141 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6142 @value{GDBN}.
6143
6144 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6145 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6146 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6147 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6148
6149 @node Observer Mode
6150 @subsection Observer Mode
6151
6152 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6153 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6154 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6155 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6156 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6157
6158 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6159 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6160 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6161 mode.
6162
6163 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6164 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6165 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6166 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6167 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6168
6169 @table @code
6170
6171 @kindex observer
6172 @item set observer on
6173 @itemx set observer off
6174 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6175 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6176 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6177 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6178
6179 @item show observer
6180 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6181
6182 @kindex may-write-registers
6183 @item set may-write-registers on
6184 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6185 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6186 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6187 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6188
6189 @item show may-write-registers
6190 Show the current permission to write registers.
6191
6192 @kindex may-write-memory
6193 @item set may-write-memory on
6194 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6195 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6196 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6197 defaults to @code{on}.
6198
6199 @item show may-write-memory
6200 Show the current permission to write memory.
6201
6202 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6203 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6204 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6205 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6206 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6207 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6208
6209 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6210 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6211
6212 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6213 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6214 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6215 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6216 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6217 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6218 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6219
6220 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6221 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6222
6223 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6224 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6225 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6226 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6227 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6228 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6229 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6230
6231 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6232 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6233
6234 @kindex may-interrupt
6235 @item set may-interrupt on
6236 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6237 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6238 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6239 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6240 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6241
6242 @item show may-interrupt
6243 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6244
6245 @end table
6246
6247 @node Reverse Execution
6248 @chapter Running programs backward
6249 @cindex reverse execution
6250 @cindex running programs backward
6251
6252 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6253 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6254 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6255 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6256
6257 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6258 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6259 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6260 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6261 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6262 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6263
6264 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6265 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6266 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6267 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6268 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6269 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6270 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6271 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6272 prior values@footnote{
6273 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6274 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6275 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6276
6277 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6278 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6279 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6280 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6281 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6282 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6283 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6284 }.
6285
6286 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6287 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @kindex reverse-continue
6291 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6292 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6293 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6294 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6295 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6296 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6297 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6298
6299 @kindex reverse-step
6300 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6301 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6302 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6303 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6304
6305 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6306 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6307 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6308 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6309 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6310 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6311
6312 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6313 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6314
6315 @kindex reverse-stepi
6316 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6317 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6318 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6319 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6320 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6321 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6322 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6323
6324 @kindex reverse-next
6325 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6326 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6327 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6328 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6329 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6330 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6331 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6332 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6333 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6334 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6335
6336 @kindex reverse-nexti
6337 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6338 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6339 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6340 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6341 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6342 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6343 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6344 frame) is reached.
6345
6346 @kindex reverse-finish
6347 @item reverse-finish
6348 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6349 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6350 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6351 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6352
6353 @kindex set exec-direction
6354 @item set exec-direction
6355 Set the direction of target execution.
6356 @item set exec-direction reverse
6357 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6358 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6359 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6360 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6361 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6362 @item set exec-direction forward
6363 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6364 This is the default.
6365 @end table
6366
6367
6368 @node Process Record and Replay
6369 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6370 @cindex process record and replay
6371 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6372
6373 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6374 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6375 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6376
6377 @cindex replay mode
6378 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6379 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6380 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6381 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6382 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6383 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6384 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6385 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6386 execution log.
6387
6388 @cindex record mode
6389 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6390 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6391 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6392 for future replay.
6393
6394 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6395 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6396 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6397 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6398 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6399 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6400
6401 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6402 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6403 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6404 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6405
6406 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6407 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6408
6409 @table @code
6410 @kindex target record
6411 @kindex target record-full
6412 @kindex target record-btrace
6413 @kindex record
6414 @kindex record full
6415 @kindex record btrace
6416 @kindex record btrace bts
6417 @kindex record bts
6418 @kindex rec
6419 @kindex rec full
6420 @kindex rec btrace
6421 @kindex rec btrace bts
6422 @kindex rec bts
6423 @item record @var{method}
6424 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6425 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6426 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6427 recording methods are available:
6428
6429 @table @code
6430 @item full
6431 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6432 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6433 execution.
6434
6435 @item btrace @var{format}
6436 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6437 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6438 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6439 reverse execution.
6440
6441 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6442 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6443 formats are available:
6444
6445 @table @code
6446 @item bts
6447 @cindex branch trace store
6448 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6449 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6450 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6451 @end table
6452
6453 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6454 @end table
6455
6456 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6457 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6458 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6459 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6460
6461 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6462 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6463
6464 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6465 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6466 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6467 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6468 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6469
6470 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6471 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6472 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6473 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6474 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6475 does not support these two modes.
6476
6477 @kindex record stop
6478 @kindex rec s
6479 @item record stop
6480 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6481 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6482 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6483
6484 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6485 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6486 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6487 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6488 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6489
6490 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6491 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6492 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6493 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6494 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6495
6496 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6497 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6498
6499 @kindex record goto
6500 @item record goto
6501 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6502 ways to specify the location to go to:
6503
6504 @table @code
6505 @item record goto begin
6506 @itemx record goto start
6507 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6508
6509 @item record goto end
6510 Go to the end of the execution log.
6511
6512 @item record goto @var{n}
6513 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6514 @end table
6515
6516 @kindex record save
6517 @item record save @var{filename}
6518 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6519 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6520 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6521
6522 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6523
6524 @kindex record restore
6525 @item record restore @var{filename}
6526 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6527 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6528
6529 @kindex set record full
6530 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6531 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6532 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6533 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6534
6535 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6536 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6537 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6538 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6539 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6540 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6541 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6542 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6543
6544 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6545 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6546 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6547
6548 @kindex show record full
6549 @item show record full insn-number-max
6550 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6551 recording method.
6552
6553 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6554 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6555 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6556 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6557 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6558 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6559 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6560 oldest one to be deleted.
6561
6562 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6563 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6564
6565 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6566 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6567
6568 @item set record full memory-query
6569 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6570 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6571 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6572 case.
6573
6574 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6575 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6576 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6577 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6578 results.
6579
6580 @item show record full memory-query
6581 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6582
6583 @kindex set record btrace
6584 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6585 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6586 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6587 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6588 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6589 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6590 You can use the following command for that:
6591
6592 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6593 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6594 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6595 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6596 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6597 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6598 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6599 position.
6600
6601 @kindex show record btrace
6602 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6603 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6604
6605 @kindex set record btrace bts
6606 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6607 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6608 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6609 format. Default is 64KB.
6610
6611 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6612 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6613 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6614 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6615 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6616 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6617 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6618
6619 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6620 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6621
6622 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6623 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6624
6625 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6626 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6627 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6628
6629 @kindex info record
6630 @item info record
6631 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6632 method:
6633
6634 @table @code
6635 @item full
6636 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6637 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6638
6639 @itemize @bullet
6640 @item
6641 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6642 @item
6643 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6644 @item
6645 Highest recorded instruction number.
6646 @item
6647 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6648 @item
6649 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6650 @item
6651 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6652 @end itemize
6653
6654 @item btrace
6655 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6656
6657 @itemize @bullet
6658 @item
6659 Recording format.
6660 @item
6661 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6662 @item
6663 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6664 instructions.
6665 @item
6666 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6667 @end itemize
6668
6669 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6670 @itemize @bullet
6671 @item
6672 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6673 @end itemize
6674 @end table
6675
6676 @kindex record delete
6677 @kindex rec del
6678 @item record delete
6679 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6680 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6681 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6682 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6683
6684 @kindex record instruction-history
6685 @kindex rec instruction-history
6686 @item record instruction-history
6687 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6688 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6689 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6690 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6691 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6692
6693 @table @code
6694 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6695 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6696 @var{insn}.
6697
6698 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6699 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6700 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6701 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6702 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6703 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6704
6705 @item record instruction-history
6706 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6707
6708 @item record instruction-history -
6709 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6710
6711 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6712 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6713 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6714 number @var{end} is included.
6715 @end table
6716
6717 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6718
6719 @kindex set record
6720 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6721 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6722 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6723 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6724 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6725
6726 @kindex show record
6727 @item show record instruction-history-size
6728 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6729 instruction-history} command.
6730
6731 @kindex record function-call-history
6732 @kindex rec function-call-history
6733 @item record function-call-history
6734 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6735 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6736 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6737 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6738 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6739 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6740 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6741 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6742 given together.
6743
6744 @smallexample
6745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6746 1 void foo (void)
6747 2 @{
6748 3 @}
6749 4
6750 5 void bar (void)
6751 6 @{
6752 7 ...
6753 8 foo ();
6754 9 ...
6755 10 @}
6756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6757 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6758 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6759 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6760 @end smallexample
6761
6762 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6763 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6764 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6765 to print:
6766
6767 @table @code
6768 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6769 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6770
6771 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6772 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6773 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6774 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6775 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6776
6777 @item record function-call-history
6778 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6779
6780 @item record function-call-history -
6781 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6782
6783 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6784 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6785 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6786 @end table
6787
6788 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6789
6790 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6791 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6792 Define how many lines to print in the
6793 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6794 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6795
6796 @item show record function-call-history-size
6797 Show how many lines to print in the
6798 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6799 @end table
6800
6801
6802 @node Stack
6803 @chapter Examining the Stack
6804
6805 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6806 stopped and how it got there.
6807
6808 @cindex call stack
6809 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6810 is generated.
6811 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6812 the arguments of the call,
6813 and the local variables of the function being called.
6814 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6815 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6816 stack}.
6817
6818 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6819 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6820
6821 @cindex selected frame
6822 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6823 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6824 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6825 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6826 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6827 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6828
6829 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6830 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6831 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6832
6833 @menu
6834 * Frames:: Stack frames
6835 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6836 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6837 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6838 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6839
6840 @end menu
6841
6842 @node Frames
6843 @section Stack Frames
6844
6845 @cindex frame, definition
6846 @cindex stack frame
6847 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6848 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6849 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6850 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6851 which the function is executing.
6852
6853 @cindex initial frame
6854 @cindex outermost frame
6855 @cindex innermost frame
6856 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6857 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6858 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6859 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6860 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6861 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6862 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6863 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6864
6865 @cindex frame pointer
6866 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6867 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6868 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6869 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6870 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6871 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6872
6873 @cindex frame number
6874 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6875 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6876 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6877 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6878 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6879
6880 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6881 @c underflow problems.
6882 @cindex frameless execution
6883 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6884 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6885 @smallexample
6886 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6887 @end smallexample
6888 generates functions without a frame.)
6889 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6890 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6891 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6892 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6893 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6894 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6895 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6896
6897 @table @code
6898 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6899 @cindex current stack frame
6900 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6901 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6902 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6903 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6904 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6905
6906 @kindex select-frame
6907 @cindex selecting frame silently
6908 @item select-frame
6909 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6910 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6911 @code{frame}.
6912 @end table
6913
6914 @node Backtrace
6915 @section Backtraces
6916
6917 @cindex traceback
6918 @cindex call stack traces
6919 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6920 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6921 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6922 stack.
6923
6924 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6925 @table @code
6926 @kindex backtrace
6927 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6928 @item backtrace
6929 @itemx bt
6930 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6931 frames in the stack.
6932
6933 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6934 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6935
6936 @item backtrace @var{n}
6937 @itemx bt @var{n}
6938 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6939
6940 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6941 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6942 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6943
6944 @item backtrace full
6945 @itemx bt full
6946 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6947 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6948 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6949 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6950
6951 @item backtrace no-filters
6952 @itemx bt no-filters
6953 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6954 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6955 @itemx bt no-filters full
6956 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6957 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6958 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6959 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6960 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6961 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6962 support.
6963 @end table
6964
6965 @kindex where
6966 @kindex info stack
6967 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6968 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6969
6970 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6971 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6972 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6973 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6974 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6975 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6976 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6977 multi-threaded program.
6978
6979 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6980 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6981 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6982 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6983 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6984 line number.
6985
6986 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6987 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6988
6989 @smallexample
6990 @group
6991 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6992 at builtin.c:993
6993 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6994 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6995 at macro.c:71
6996 (More stack frames follow...)
6997 @end group
6998 @end smallexample
6999
7000 @noindent
7001 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7002 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7003 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7004
7005 @noindent
7006 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7007 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7008 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7009 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7010 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7011
7012 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7013 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7014 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7015 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7016 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7017 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7018 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7019 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7020 such a backtrace might look like:
7021
7022 @smallexample
7023 @group
7024 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7025 at builtin.c:993
7026 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7027 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7028 at macro.c:71
7029 (More stack frames follow...)
7030 @end group
7031 @end smallexample
7032
7033 @noindent
7034 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7035 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7036
7037 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7038 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7039 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7040
7041 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7042 @cindex program entry point
7043 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7044 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7045 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7046 @code{main}@footnote{
7047 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7048 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7049 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7050 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7051 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7052 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7053
7054 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7055 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7056
7057 @table @code
7058 @item set backtrace past-main
7059 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7060 @kindex set backtrace
7061 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7062
7063 @item set backtrace past-main off
7064 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7065 default.
7066
7067 @item show backtrace past-main
7068 @kindex show backtrace
7069 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7070
7071 @item set backtrace past-entry
7072 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7073 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7074 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7075 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7076
7077 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7078 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7079 application. This is the default.
7080
7081 @item show backtrace past-entry
7082 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7083
7084 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7085 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7086 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7087 @cindex backtrace limit
7088 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7089 or zero means unlimited levels.
7090
7091 @item show backtrace limit
7092 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7093 @end table
7094
7095 You can control how file names are displayed.
7096
7097 @table @code
7098 @item set filename-display
7099 @itemx set filename-display relative
7100 @cindex filename-display
7101 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7102
7103 @item set filename-display basename
7104 Display only basename of a filename.
7105
7106 @item set filename-display absolute
7107 Display an absolute filename.
7108
7109 @item show filename-display
7110 Show the current way to display filenames.
7111 @end table
7112
7113 @node Frame Filter Management
7114 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7115 @cindex managing frame filters
7116
7117 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7118 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7119
7120 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7121 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7122
7123 @table @code
7124 @kindex info frame-filter
7125 @item info frame-filter
7126 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7127 their name, priority and enabled status.
7128
7129 @kindex disable frame-filter
7130 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7131 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7132 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7133 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7134 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7135 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7136 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7137 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7138 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7139 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7140 may be enabled again later.
7141
7142 @kindex enable frame-filter
7143 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7144 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7145 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7146 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7147 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7148 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7149 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7150 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7151 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7152
7153 Example:
7154
7155 @smallexample
7156 (gdb) info frame-filter
7157
7158 global frame-filters:
7159 Priority Enabled Name
7160 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7161 100 Yes Reverse
7162
7163 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7164 Priority Enabled Name
7165 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7166
7167 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7168 Priority Enabled Name
7169 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7170
7171 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7172 (gdb) info frame-filter
7173
7174 global frame-filters:
7175 Priority Enabled Name
7176 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7177 100 Yes Reverse
7178
7179 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7180 Priority Enabled Name
7181 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7182
7183 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7184 Priority Enabled Name
7185 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7186
7187 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7188 (gdb) info frame-filter
7189
7190 global frame-filters:
7191 Priority Enabled Name
7192 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7193 100 Yes Reverse
7194
7195 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7196 Priority Enabled Name
7197 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7198
7199 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7200 Priority Enabled Name
7201 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7202 @end smallexample
7203
7204 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7205 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7206 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7207 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7208 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7209 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7210 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7211
7212 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7213 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7214 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7215 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7216 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7217 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7218 dictionary resides.
7219
7220 Example:
7221
7222 @smallexample
7223 (gdb) info frame-filter
7224
7225 global frame-filters:
7226 Priority Enabled Name
7227 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7228 100 Yes Reverse
7229
7230 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7231 Priority Enabled Name
7232 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7233
7234 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7235 Priority Enabled Name
7236 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7237
7238 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7239 (gdb) info frame-filter
7240
7241 global frame-filters:
7242 Priority Enabled Name
7243 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7244 50 Yes Reverse
7245
7246 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7247 Priority Enabled Name
7248 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7249
7250 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7251 Priority Enabled Name
7252 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7253 @end smallexample
7254 @end table
7255
7256 @node Selection
7257 @section Selecting a Frame
7258
7259 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7260 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7261 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7262 of the stack frame just selected.
7263
7264 @table @code
7265 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7266 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7267 @item frame @var{n}
7268 @itemx f @var{n}
7269 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7270 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7271 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7272 @code{main}.
7273
7274 @item frame @var{addr}
7275 @itemx f @var{addr}
7276 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7277 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7278 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7279 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7280 switches between them.
7281
7282 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7283 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7284
7285 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7286 pointer and a program counter.
7287
7288 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7289 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7290
7291 @kindex up
7292 @item up @var{n}
7293 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7294 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7295 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7296
7297 @kindex down
7298 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7299 @item down @var{n}
7300 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7301 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7302 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7303 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7304 @end table
7305
7306 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7307 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7308 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7309 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7310
7311 @need 1000
7312 For example:
7313
7314 @smallexample
7315 @group
7316 (@value{GDBP}) up
7317 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7318 at env.c:10
7319 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7320 @end group
7321 @end smallexample
7322
7323 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7324 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7325 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7326 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7327 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7328 for details.
7329
7330 @table @code
7331 @kindex down-silently
7332 @kindex up-silently
7333 @item up-silently @var{n}
7334 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7335 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7336 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7337 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7338 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7339 distracting.
7340 @end table
7341
7342 @node Frame Info
7343 @section Information About a Frame
7344
7345 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7346 stack frame.
7347
7348 @table @code
7349 @item frame
7350 @itemx f
7351 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7352 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7353 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7354 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7355 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7356
7357 @kindex info frame
7358 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7359 @item info frame
7360 @itemx info f
7361 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7362 including:
7363
7364 @itemize @bullet
7365 @item
7366 the address of the frame
7367 @item
7368 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7369 @item
7370 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7371 @item
7372 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7373 @item
7374 the address of the frame's arguments
7375 @item
7376 the address of the frame's local variables
7377 @item
7378 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7379 @item
7380 which registers were saved in the frame
7381 @end itemize
7382
7383 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7384 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7385 the usual conventions.
7386
7387 @item info frame @var{addr}
7388 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7389 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7390 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7391 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7392 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7393 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7394
7395 @kindex info args
7396 @item info args
7397 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7398
7399 @item info locals
7400 @kindex info locals
7401 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7402 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7403 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7404
7405 @end table
7406
7407
7408 @node Source
7409 @chapter Examining Source Files
7410
7411 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7412 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7413 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7414 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7415 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7416 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7417 source files by explicit command.
7418
7419 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7420 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7421 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7422
7423 @menu
7424 * List:: Printing source lines
7425 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7426 * Edit:: Editing source files
7427 * Search:: Searching source files
7428 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7429 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7430 @end menu
7431
7432 @node List
7433 @section Printing Source Lines
7434
7435 @kindex list
7436 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7437 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7438 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7439 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7440 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7441
7442 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7443
7444 @table @code
7445 @item list @var{linenum}
7446 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7447 current source file.
7448
7449 @item list @var{function}
7450 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7451 @var{function}.
7452
7453 @item list
7454 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7455 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7456 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7457 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7458 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7459
7460 @item list -
7461 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7462 @end table
7463
7464 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7465 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7466 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7467
7468 @table @code
7469 @kindex set listsize
7470 @item set listsize @var{count}
7471 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7472 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7473 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7474 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7475
7476 @kindex show listsize
7477 @item show listsize
7478 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7479 @end table
7480
7481 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7482 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7483 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7484 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7485 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7486
7487 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7488 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7489 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7490 to specify some source line.
7491
7492 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7493
7494 @table @code
7495 @item list @var{linespec}
7496 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7497
7498 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7499 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7500 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7501 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7502 the same source file as the first linespec.
7503
7504 @item list ,@var{last}
7505 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7506
7507 @item list @var{first},
7508 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7509
7510 @item list +
7511 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7512
7513 @item list -
7514 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7515
7516 @item list
7517 As described in the preceding table.
7518 @end table
7519
7520 @node Specify Location
7521 @section Specifying a Location
7522 @cindex specifying location
7523 @cindex linespec
7524
7525 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7526 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7527 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7528 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7529
7530 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7531 @value{GDBN} understands:
7532
7533 @table @code
7534 @item @var{linenum}
7535 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7536
7537 @item -@var{offset}
7538 @itemx +@var{offset}
7539 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7540 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7541 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7542 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7543 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7544 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7545 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7546 linespec.
7547
7548 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7549 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7550 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7551 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7552 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7553 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7554 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7555
7556 @item @var{function}
7557 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7558 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7559
7560 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7561 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7562
7563 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7564 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7565 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7566 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7567 functions in different source files.
7568
7569 @item @var{label}
7570 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7571 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7572 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7573 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7574 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7575
7576 @item *@var{address}
7577 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7578 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7579 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7580 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7581 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7582 source files.
7583
7584 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7585 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7586 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7587 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7588 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7589 of @var{address}:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item @var{expression}
7593 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7594
7595 @item @var{funcaddr}
7596 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7597 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7598 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7599 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7600 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7601 (although the Pascal form also works).
7602
7603 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7604 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7605
7606 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7607 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7608 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7609 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7610 functions with identical names in different source files.
7611 @end table
7612
7613 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7614 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7615 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7616 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7617 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7618 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7619
7620 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7621 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7622 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7623 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7624 each one of those probes.
7625
7626 @end table
7627
7628
7629 @node Edit
7630 @section Editing Source Files
7631 @cindex editing source files
7632
7633 @kindex edit
7634 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7635 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7636 The editing program of your choice
7637 is invoked with the current line set to
7638 the active line in the program.
7639 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7640 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7641
7642 @table @code
7643 @item edit @var{location}
7644 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7645 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7646 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7647 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7648 command most commonly used:
7649
7650 @table @code
7651 @item edit @var{number}
7652 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7653
7654 @item edit @var{function}
7655 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7656 @end table
7657
7658 @end table
7659
7660 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7661 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7662 @footnote{
7663 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7664 following command-line syntax:
7665 @smallexample
7666 ex +@var{number} file
7667 @end smallexample
7668 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7669 the file where to start editing.}.
7670 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7671 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7672 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7673 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7674 @smallexample
7675 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7676 export EDITOR
7677 gdb @dots{}
7678 @end smallexample
7679 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7680 @smallexample
7681 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7682 gdb @dots{}
7683 @end smallexample
7684
7685 @node Search
7686 @section Searching Source Files
7687 @cindex searching source files
7688
7689 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7690 regular expression.
7691
7692 @table @code
7693 @kindex search
7694 @kindex forward-search
7695 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7696 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7697 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7698 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7699 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7700 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7701 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7702 @code{fo}.
7703
7704 @kindex reverse-search
7705 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7706 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7707 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7708 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7709 this command as @code{rev}.
7710 @end table
7711
7712 @node Source Path
7713 @section Specifying Source Directories
7714
7715 @cindex source path
7716 @cindex directories for source files
7717 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7718 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7719 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7720 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7721 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7722 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7723 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7724
7725 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7726 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7727 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7728 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7729 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7730 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7731 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7732 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7733 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7734 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7735 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7736
7737 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7738 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7739 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7740 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7741 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7742 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7743
7744 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7745 source files.
7746
7747 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7748 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7749 each line is in the file.
7750
7751 @kindex directory
7752 @kindex dir
7753 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7754 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7755 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7756
7757 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7758 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7759
7760 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7761 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7762 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7763 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7764 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7765 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7766 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7767 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7768 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7769 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7770 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7771 name to look up the sources.
7772
7773 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7774 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7775 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7776 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7777 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7778 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7779 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7780 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7781
7782 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7783 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7784 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7785 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7786 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7787 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7788 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7789
7790 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7791 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7792 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7793 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7794 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7795 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7796 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7797 command.
7798
7799 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7800 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7801 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7802 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7803 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7804 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7805 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7806
7807 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7808 @cindex default source path substitution
7809 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7810 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7811 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7812 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7813 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7814 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7815 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7816 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7817 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7818 together.
7819
7820 @table @code
7821 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7822 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7823 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7824 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7825 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7826 part of absolute file names) or
7827 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7828 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7829
7830 @kindex cdir
7831 @kindex cwd
7832 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7833 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7834 @cindex compilation directory
7835 @cindex current directory
7836 @cindex working directory
7837 @cindex directory, current
7838 @cindex directory, compilation
7839 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7840 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7841 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7842 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7843 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7844 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7845
7846 @item directory
7847 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7848
7849 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7850 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7851
7852 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7853 @kindex set directories
7854 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7855 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7856
7857 @item show directories
7858 @kindex show directories
7859 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7860
7861 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7862 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7863 @kindex set substitute-path
7864 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7865 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7866 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7867
7868 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7869 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7870
7871 @smallexample
7872 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7873 @end smallexample
7874
7875 @noindent
7876 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7877 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7878 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7879
7880 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7881 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7882 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7883 the substitution.
7884
7885 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7886
7887 @smallexample
7888 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7889 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7890 @end smallexample
7891
7892 @noindent
7893 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7894 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7895 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7896 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7897
7898
7899 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7900 @kindex unset substitute-path
7901 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7902 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7903 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7904
7905 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7906
7907 @item show substitute-path [path]
7908 @kindex show substitute-path
7909 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7910 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7911
7912 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7913 rules.
7914
7915 @end table
7916
7917 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7918 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7919 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7920
7921 @enumerate
7922 @item
7923 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7924
7925 @item
7926 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7927 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7928 directories in one command.
7929 @end enumerate
7930
7931 @node Machine Code
7932 @section Source and Machine Code
7933 @cindex source line and its code address
7934
7935 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7936 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7937 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7938 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7939 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7940 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7941 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7942 well as hex.
7943
7944 @table @code
7945 @kindex info line
7946 @item info line @var{linespec}
7947 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7948 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7949 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7950 @end table
7951
7952 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7953 the object code for the first line of function
7954 @code{m4_changequote}:
7955
7956 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7957 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7958 @smallexample
7959 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7960 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7961 @end smallexample
7962
7963 @noindent
7964 @cindex code address and its source line
7965 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7966 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7967 @smallexample
7968 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7969 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7973 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7974 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7975 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7976 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7977 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7978 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7979 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7980 Variables}).
7981
7982 @table @code
7983 @kindex disassemble
7984 @cindex assembly instructions
7985 @cindex instructions, assembly
7986 @cindex machine instructions
7987 @cindex listing machine instructions
7988 @item disassemble
7989 @itemx disassemble /m
7990 @itemx disassemble /r
7991 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7992 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7993 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7994 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7995 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7996 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7997 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7998 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7999 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8000 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8001
8002 @table @code
8003 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8004 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8005 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8006 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8007 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8008 @end table
8009
8010 @noindent
8011 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8012 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8013
8014 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8015 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8016
8017 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8018 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8019 @end table
8020
8021 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8022 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8023
8024 @smallexample
8025 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8026 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8027 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8028 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8029 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8030 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8031 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8032 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8033 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8034 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8035 End of assembler dump.
8036 @end smallexample
8037
8038 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
8039 program is stopped just after function prologue:
8040
8041 @smallexample
8042 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8043 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8044 5 @{
8045 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8046 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8047 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8048 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8049 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8050
8051 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8052 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8053 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8054
8055 7 return 0;
8056 8 @}
8057 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8058 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8059 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8060
8061 End of assembler dump.
8062 @end smallexample
8063
8064 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8065
8066 @smallexample
8067 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8068 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8069 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8070 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8071 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8072 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8073 End of assembler dump.
8074 @end smallexample
8075
8076 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8077 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8078 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8079 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8080
8081 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8082 mnemonics or other syntax.
8083
8084 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8085 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8086 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8087 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8088 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8089
8090 @table @code
8091 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8092 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8093 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8094 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8095 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8096 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8097
8098 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8099 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8100 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8101 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8102
8103 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8104 @item show disassembly-flavor
8105 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8106 @end table
8107
8108 @table @code
8109 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8110 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8111 @item set disassemble-next-line
8112 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8113 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8114 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8115 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8116 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8117 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8118 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8119 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8120 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8121 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8122 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8123 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8124 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8125 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8126 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8127 instruction.
8128 @end table
8129
8130
8131 @node Data
8132 @chapter Examining Data
8133
8134 @cindex printing data
8135 @cindex examining data
8136 @kindex print
8137 @kindex inspect
8138 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8139 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8140 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8141 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8142 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8143 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8144
8145 @table @code
8146 @item print @var{expr}
8147 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8148 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8149 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8150 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8151 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8152 Formats}.
8153
8154 @item print
8155 @itemx print /@var{f}
8156 @cindex reprint the last value
8157 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8158 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8159 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8160 @end table
8161
8162 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8163 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8164 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8165
8166 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8167 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8168 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8169 Table}.
8170
8171 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8172 @kindex explore
8173 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8174 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8175 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8176 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8177 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8178 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8179 embedded in the higher level data types.
8180
8181 @table @code
8182 @item explore @var{arg}
8183 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8184 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8185 @end table
8186
8187 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8188 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8189 C program as
8190
8191 @smallexample
8192 struct SimpleStruct
8193 @{
8194 int i;
8195 double d;
8196 @};
8197
8198 struct ComplexStruct
8199 @{
8200 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8201 int arr[10];
8202 @};
8203 @end smallexample
8204
8205 @noindent
8206 followed by variable declarations as
8207
8208 @smallexample
8209 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8210 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8211 @end smallexample
8212
8213 @noindent
8214 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8215 @code{explore} command as follows.
8216
8217 @smallexample
8218 (gdb) explore cs
8219 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8220 the following fields:
8221
8222 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8223 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8224
8225 Enter the field number of choice:
8226 @end smallexample
8227
8228 @noindent
8229 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8230 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8231 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8232 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8233 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8234 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8235 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8236 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8237
8238 @smallexample
8239 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8240 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8241 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8242 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8243
8244 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8245 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8246
8247 Press enter to return to parent value:
8248 @end smallexample
8249
8250 @noindent
8251 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8252 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8253 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8254 to explore.
8255
8256 @smallexample
8257 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8258 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8259
8260 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8261
8262 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8263
8264 Press enter to return to parent value:
8265 @end smallexample
8266
8267 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8268 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8269 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8270 level data structure).
8271
8272 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8273 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8274 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8275 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8276 same example as above, your can explore the type
8277 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8278 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8279
8280 @smallexample
8281 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8282 @end smallexample
8283
8284 @noindent
8285 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8286 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8287 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8288 example.
8289
8290 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8291 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8292 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8293 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8294 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8295
8296 @table @code
8297 @item explore value @var{expr}
8298 @cindex explore value
8299 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8300 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8301 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8302 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8303 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8304
8305 @item explore type @var{arg}
8306 @cindex explore type
8307 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8308 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8309 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8310 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8311 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8312 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8313 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8314 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8315 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8316 @end table
8317
8318 @menu
8319 * Expressions:: Expressions
8320 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8321 * Variables:: Program variables
8322 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8323 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8324 * Memory:: Examining memory
8325 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8326 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8327 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8328 * Value History:: Value history
8329 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8330 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8331 * Registers:: Registers
8332 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8333 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8334 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8335 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8336 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8337 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8338 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8339 character set than GDB does
8340 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8341 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8342 @end menu
8343
8344 @node Expressions
8345 @section Expressions
8346
8347 @cindex expressions
8348 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8349 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8350 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8351 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8352 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8353 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8354 @ref{Compilation}.
8355
8356 @cindex arrays in expressions
8357 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8358 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8359 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8360 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8361 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8362 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8363
8364 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8365 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8366 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8367 languages.
8368
8369 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8370 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8371
8372 @cindex casts, in expressions
8373 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8374 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8375 at that address in memory.
8376 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8377
8378 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8379 to programming languages:
8380
8381 @table @code
8382 @item @@
8383 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8384 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8385
8386 @item ::
8387 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8388 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8389
8390 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8391 @cindex type casting memory
8392 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8393 @cindex casts, to view memory
8394 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8395 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8396 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8397 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8398 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8399 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8400 @end table
8401
8402 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8403 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8404 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8405
8406 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8407 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8408 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8409 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8410 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8411 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8412 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8413
8414 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8415 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8416 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8417 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8418 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8419 as well.
8420
8421 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8422 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8423 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8424 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8425 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8426 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8427 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8428 choices.
8429
8430 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8431 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8432 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8433
8434 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8435 @smallexample
8436 @group
8437 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8438 [0] cancel
8439 [1] all
8440 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8441 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8442 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8443 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8444 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8445 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8446 > 2 4 6
8447 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8448 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8449 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8450 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8451 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8452 breakpoints.
8453 (@value{GDBP})
8454 @end group
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 @table @code
8458 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8459 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8460 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8461
8462 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8463 is ambiguous.
8464
8465 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8466 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8467 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8468 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8469 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8470 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8471 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8472 in the use of the menu.
8473
8474 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8475 when an ambiguity is detected.
8476
8477 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8478 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8479
8480 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8481 @item show multiple-symbols
8482 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8483 @end table
8484
8485 @node Variables
8486 @section Program Variables
8487
8488 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8489 in your program.
8490
8491 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8492 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8493
8494 @itemize @bullet
8495 @item
8496 global (or file-static)
8497 @end itemize
8498
8499 @noindent or
8500
8501 @itemize @bullet
8502 @item
8503 visible according to the scope rules of the
8504 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8505 @end itemize
8506
8507 @noindent This means that in the function
8508
8509 @smallexample
8510 foo (a)
8511 int a;
8512 @{
8513 bar (a);
8514 @{
8515 int b = test ();
8516 bar (b);
8517 @}
8518 @}
8519 @end smallexample
8520
8521 @noindent
8522 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8523 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8524 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8525 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8526
8527 @cindex variable name conflict
8528 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8529 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8530 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8531 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8532 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8533 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8534 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8535
8536 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8537 @ifnotinfo
8538 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8539 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8540 @end ifnotinfo
8541 @smallexample
8542 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8543 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8544 @end smallexample
8545
8546 @noindent
8547 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8548 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8549 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8550 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8551
8552 @smallexample
8553 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8554 @end smallexample
8555
8556 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8557 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8558 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8559 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8560 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8561
8562 @smallexample
8563 void
8564 foo (int a)
8565 @{
8566 if (a < 10)
8567 bar (a);
8568 else
8569 process (a); /* Stop here */
8570 @}
8571
8572 int
8573 bar (int a)
8574 @{
8575 foo (a + 5);
8576 @}
8577 @end smallexample
8578
8579 @noindent
8580 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8581 here is what you might see
8582 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8583
8584 @smallexample
8585 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8586 $1 = 10
8587 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8588 $2 = 5
8589 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8590 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8591 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8592 $3 = 5
8593 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8594 $4 = 0
8595 @end smallexample
8596
8597 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8598 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8599 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8600 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8601 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8602
8603 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8604 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8605 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8606 @code{some_global}.
8607
8608 @smallexample
8609 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8610 $1 = 23
8611 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8612 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8613 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8614 $2 = 27
8615 @end smallexample
8616
8617 @cindex wrong values
8618 @cindex variable values, wrong
8619 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8620 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8621 @quotation
8622 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8623 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8624 scope, and just before exit.
8625 @end quotation
8626 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8627 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8628 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8629 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8630 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8631 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8632 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8633 variable definitions may be gone.
8634
8635 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8636 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8637 when compiling.
8638
8639 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8640 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8641 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8642 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8643 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8644 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8645 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8646
8647 @smallexample
8648 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8649 @end smallexample
8650
8651 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8652 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8653 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8654 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8655 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8656
8657 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8658 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8659 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8660 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8661
8662 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8663 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8664 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8665 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8666 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8667
8668 @smallexample
8669 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8670 29 i++;
8671 (gdb) next
8672 30 e (i);
8673 (gdb) print i
8674 $1 = 31
8675 (gdb) print i@@entry
8676 $2 = 30
8677 @end smallexample
8678
8679 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8680 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8681 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8682 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8683 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8684 For program code
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 char var0[] = "A";
8688 signed char var1[] = "A";
8689 @end smallexample
8690
8691 You get during debugging
8692 @smallexample
8693 (gdb) print var0
8694 $1 = "A"
8695 (gdb) print var1
8696 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8697 @end smallexample
8698
8699 @node Arrays
8700 @section Artificial Arrays
8701
8702 @cindex artificial array
8703 @cindex arrays
8704 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8705 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8706 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8707 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8708 program.
8709
8710 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8711 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8712 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8713 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8714 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8715 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8716 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8717 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8718 example. If a program says
8719
8720 @smallexample
8721 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8722 @end smallexample
8723
8724 @noindent
8725 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8726
8727 @smallexample
8728 p *array@@len
8729 @end smallexample
8730
8731 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8732 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8733 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8734 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8735 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8736
8737 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8738 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8739 The value need not be in memory:
8740 @smallexample
8741 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8742 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8743 @end smallexample
8744
8745 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8746 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8747 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8748 @smallexample
8749 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8750 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8751 @end smallexample
8752
8753 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8754 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8755 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8756 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8757 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8758 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8759 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8760 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8761 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8762 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8763
8764 @smallexample
8765 set $i = 0
8766 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8767 @key{RET}
8768 @key{RET}
8769 @dots{}
8770 @end smallexample
8771
8772 @node Output Formats
8773 @section Output Formats
8774
8775 @cindex formatted output
8776 @cindex output formats
8777 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8778 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8779 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8780 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8781 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8782
8783 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8784 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8785 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8786 letters supported are:
8787
8788 @table @code
8789 @item x
8790 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8791 hexadecimal.
8792
8793 @item d
8794 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8795
8796 @item u
8797 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8798
8799 @item o
8800 Print as integer in octal.
8801
8802 @item t
8803 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8804 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8805 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8806 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8807
8808 @item a
8809 @cindex unknown address, locating
8810 @cindex locate address
8811 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8812 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8813 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8814
8815 @smallexample
8816 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8817 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8818 @end smallexample
8819
8820 @noindent
8821 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8822 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8823
8824 @item c
8825 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8826 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8827 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8828 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8829
8830 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8831 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8832 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8833 data.
8834
8835 @item f
8836 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8837 using typical floating point syntax.
8838
8839 @item s
8840 @cindex printing strings
8841 @cindex printing byte arrays
8842 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8843 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8844 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8845 natural types.
8846
8847 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8848 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8849 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8850 array.
8851
8852 @item z
8853 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8854 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8855 to the size of the integer type.
8856
8857 @item r
8858 @cindex raw printing
8859 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8860 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8861 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8862 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8863 pretty-printer which might exist.
8864 @end table
8865
8866 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8867
8868 @smallexample
8869 p/x $pc
8870 @end smallexample
8871
8872 @noindent
8873 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8874 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8875
8876 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8877 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8878 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8879
8880 @node Memory
8881 @section Examining Memory
8882
8883 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8884 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8885
8886 @cindex examining memory
8887 @table @code
8888 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8889 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8890 @itemx x @var{addr}
8891 @itemx x
8892 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8893 @end table
8894
8895 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8896 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8897 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8898 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8899 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8900
8901 @table @r
8902 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8903 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8904 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8905 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8906 @c 4.1.2.
8907
8908 @item @var{f}, the display format
8909 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8910 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8911 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8912 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8913 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8914
8915 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8916 The unit size is any of
8917
8918 @table @code
8919 @item b
8920 Bytes.
8921 @item h
8922 Halfwords (two bytes).
8923 @item w
8924 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8925 @item g
8926 Giant words (eight bytes).
8927 @end table
8928
8929 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8930 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8931 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8932 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8933 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8934 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8935 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8936 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8937 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8938 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8939 be altered.
8940
8941 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8942 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8943 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8944 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8945 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8946 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8947 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8948 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8949 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8950 a value from memory).
8951 @end table
8952
8953 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8954 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8955 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8956 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8957 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8958
8959 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8960 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8961 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8962 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8963 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8964
8965 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8966 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8967 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8968 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8969 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8970 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8971 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8972 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8973 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8974
8975 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8976 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8977 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8978 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8979 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8980 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8981 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8982
8983 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8984 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8985
8986 @smallexample
8987 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8988 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8989 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8990 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8991 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8992 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8993 @end smallexample
8994
8995 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8996 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8997 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8998 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8999 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9000 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9001 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9002 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9003 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9004
9005 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9006 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9007 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9008
9009 @cindex remote memory comparison
9010 @cindex target memory comparison
9011 @cindex verify remote memory image
9012 @cindex verify target memory image
9013 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9014 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9015 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9016 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9017 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9018 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9019
9020 @table @code
9021 @kindex compare-sections
9022 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9023 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9024 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9025 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9026 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9027 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9028
9029 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9030 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9031 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9032 @end table
9033
9034 @node Auto Display
9035 @section Automatic Display
9036 @cindex automatic display
9037 @cindex display of expressions
9038
9039 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9040 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9041 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9042 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9043 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9044 The automatic display looks like this:
9045
9046 @smallexample
9047 2: foo = 38
9048 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9049 @end smallexample
9050
9051 @noindent
9052 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9053 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9054 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9055 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9056 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9057 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9058
9059 @table @code
9060 @kindex display
9061 @item display @var{expr}
9062 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9063 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9064
9065 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9066
9067 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9068 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9069 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9070 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9071 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9072
9073 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9074 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9075 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9076 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9077 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9078 @end table
9079
9080 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9081 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9082 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9083
9084 @table @code
9085 @kindex delete display
9086 @kindex undisplay
9087 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9088 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9089 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9090 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9091 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9092 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9093 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9094
9095 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9096 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9097
9098 @kindex disable display
9099 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9100 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9101 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9102 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9103 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9104 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9105 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9106 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9107
9108 @kindex enable display
9109 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9110 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9111 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9112 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9113 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9114 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9115 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9116
9117 @item display
9118 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9119 done when your program stops.
9120
9121 @kindex info display
9122 @item info display
9123 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9124 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9125 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9126 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9127 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9128 @end table
9129
9130 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9131 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9132 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9133 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9134 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9135 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9136 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9137 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9138 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9139 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9140 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9141
9142 @node Print Settings
9143 @section Print Settings
9144
9145 @cindex format options
9146 @cindex print settings
9147 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9148 and symbols are printed.
9149
9150 @noindent
9151 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9152
9153 @table @code
9154 @kindex set print
9155 @item set print address
9156 @itemx set print address on
9157 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9158 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9159 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9160 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9161 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9162 @code{set print address on}:
9163
9164 @smallexample
9165 @group
9166 (@value{GDBP}) f
9167 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9168 at input.c:530
9169 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9170 @end group
9171 @end smallexample
9172
9173 @item set print address off
9174 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9175 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9176
9177 @smallexample
9178 @group
9179 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9180 (@value{GDBP}) f
9181 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9182 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9183 @end group
9184 @end smallexample
9185
9186 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9187 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9188 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9189 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9190
9191 @kindex show print
9192 @item show print address
9193 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9194 @end table
9195
9196 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9197 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9198 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9199 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9200 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9201 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9202 it prints a symbolic address:
9203
9204 @table @code
9205 @item set print symbol-filename on
9206 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9207 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9208 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9209 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9210
9211 @item set print symbol-filename off
9212 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9213 default.
9214
9215 @item show print symbol-filename
9216 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9217 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9218 @end table
9219
9220 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9221 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9222 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9223
9224 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9225 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9226
9227 @table @code
9228 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9229 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9230 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9231 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9232 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9233 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9234 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9235 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9236
9237 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9238 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9239 symbolic address.
9240 @end table
9241
9242 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9243 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9244 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9245 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9246 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9247 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9248 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9249 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9250
9251 @smallexample
9252 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9253 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9254 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9255 @end smallexample
9256
9257 @quotation
9258 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9259 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9260 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9261 @end quotation
9262
9263 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9264 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9265
9266 @table @code
9267 @item set print symbol on
9268 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9269 one exists.
9270
9271 @item set print symbol off
9272 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9273 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9274 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9275
9276 @item show print symbol
9277 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9278 address.
9279 @end table
9280
9281 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9282
9283 @table @code
9284 @item set print array
9285 @itemx set print array on
9286 @cindex pretty print arrays
9287 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9288 but uses more space. The default is off.
9289
9290 @item set print array off
9291 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9292
9293 @item show print array
9294 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9295 arrays.
9296
9297 @cindex print array indexes
9298 @item set print array-indexes
9299 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9300 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9301 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9302 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9303
9304 @item set print array-indexes off
9305 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9306
9307 @item show print array-indexes
9308 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9309 arrays.
9310
9311 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9312 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9313 @cindex number of array elements to print
9314 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9315 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9316 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9317 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9318 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9319 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9320 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9321 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9322
9323 @item show print elements
9324 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9325 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9326
9327 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9328 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9329 @cindex printing frame argument values
9330 @cindex print all frame argument values
9331 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9332 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9333 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9334 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9335 values are:
9336
9337 @table @code
9338 @item all
9339 The values of all arguments are printed.
9340
9341 @item scalars
9342 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9343 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9344 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9345 only scalar arguments are shown:
9346
9347 @smallexample
9348 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9349 at frame-args.c:23
9350 @end smallexample
9351
9352 @item none
9353 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9354 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9355
9356 @smallexample
9357 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9358 at frame-args.c:23
9359 @end smallexample
9360 @end table
9361
9362 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9363 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9364 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9365 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9366 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9367 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9368 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9369 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9370 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9371 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9372
9373 @item show print frame-arguments
9374 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9375
9376 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9377 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9378
9379 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9380 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9381 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9382 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9383 This is the default.
9384
9385 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9386 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9387
9388 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9389 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9390 @kindex set print entry-values
9391 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9392 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9393 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9394 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9395 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9396
9397 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9398 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9399 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9400 @code{no} setting.
9401
9402 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9403 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9404 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9405 this information.
9406
9407 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9408
9409 @table @code
9410 @item no
9411 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9412 point.
9413 @smallexample
9414 #0 equal (val=5)
9415 #0 different (val=6)
9416 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9417 #0 born (val=10)
9418 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9419 @end smallexample
9420
9421 @item only
9422 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9423 values are never printed.
9424 @smallexample
9425 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9426 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9427 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9428 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9429 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9430 @end smallexample
9431
9432 @item preferred
9433 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9434 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9435 value for such parameter.
9436 @smallexample
9437 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9438 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9439 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9440 #0 born (val=10)
9441 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9442 @end smallexample
9443
9444 @item if-needed
9445 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9446 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9447 parameter.
9448 @smallexample
9449 #0 equal (val=5)
9450 #0 different (val=6)
9451 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9452 #0 born (val=10)
9453 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9454 @end smallexample
9455
9456 @item both
9457 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9458 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9459 optimizations.
9460 @smallexample
9461 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9462 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9463 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9464 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9465 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9466 @end smallexample
9467
9468 @item compact
9469 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9470 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9471 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9472 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9473 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9474 @smallexample
9475 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9476 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9477 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9478 #0 born (val=10)
9479 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @item default
9483 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9484 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9485 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9486 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9487 @smallexample
9488 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9489 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9490 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9491 #0 born (val=10)
9492 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9493 @end smallexample
9494 @end table
9495
9496 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9497 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9498
9499 @item show print entry-values
9500 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9501 entry.
9502
9503 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9504 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9505 @cindex repeated array elements
9506 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9507 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9508 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9509 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9510 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9511 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9512 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9513 is 10.
9514
9515 @item show print repeats
9516 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9517 elements.
9518
9519 @item set print null-stop
9520 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9521 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9522 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9523 contain only short strings.
9524 The default is off.
9525
9526 @item show print null-stop
9527 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9528 @sc{null} character.
9529
9530 @item set print pretty on
9531 @cindex print structures in indented form
9532 @cindex indentation in structure display
9533 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9534 per line, like this:
9535
9536 @smallexample
9537 @group
9538 $1 = @{
9539 next = 0x0,
9540 flags = @{
9541 sweet = 1,
9542 sour = 1
9543 @},
9544 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9545 @}
9546 @end group
9547 @end smallexample
9548
9549 @item set print pretty off
9550 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9551
9552 @smallexample
9553 @group
9554 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9555 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9556 @end group
9557 @end smallexample
9558
9559 @noindent
9560 This is the default format.
9561
9562 @item show print pretty
9563 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9564
9565 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9566 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9567 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9568 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9569 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9570 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9571 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9572 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9573
9574 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9575 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9576 international character sets, and is the default.
9577
9578 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9579 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9580
9581 @item set print union on
9582 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9583 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9584 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9585
9586 @item set print union off
9587 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9588 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9589 instead.
9590
9591 @item show print union
9592 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9593 structures and other unions.
9594
9595 For example, given the declarations
9596
9597 @smallexample
9598 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9599 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9600 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9601 Bug_forms;
9602
9603 struct thing @{
9604 Species it;
9605 union @{
9606 Tree_forms tree;
9607 Bug_forms bug;
9608 @} form;
9609 @};
9610
9611 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9612 @end smallexample
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9616
9617 @smallexample
9618 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @noindent
9622 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9623
9624 @smallexample
9625 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9626 @end smallexample
9627
9628 @noindent
9629 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9630 and in Pascal.
9631 @end table
9632
9633 @need 1000
9634 @noindent
9635 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9636
9637 @table @code
9638 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9639 @item set print demangle
9640 @itemx set print demangle on
9641 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9642 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9643 linkage. The default is on.
9644
9645 @item show print demangle
9646 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9647
9648 @item set print asm-demangle
9649 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9650 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9651 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9652 The default is off.
9653
9654 @item show print asm-demangle
9655 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9656 or demangled form.
9657
9658 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9659 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9660 @kindex set demangle-style
9661 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9662 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9663 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9664
9665 @table @code
9666 @item auto
9667 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9668 This is the default.
9669
9670 @item gnu
9671 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9672
9673 @item hp
9674 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9675
9676 @item lucid
9677 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9678
9679 @item arm
9680 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9681 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9682 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9683 require further enhancement to permit that.
9684
9685 @end table
9686 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9687
9688 @item show demangle-style
9689 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9690
9691 @item set print object
9692 @itemx set print object on
9693 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9694 @cindex display derived types
9695 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9696 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9697 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9698 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9699 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9700 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9701 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9702
9703 @item set print object off
9704 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9705 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9706
9707 @item show print object
9708 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9709
9710 @item set print static-members
9711 @itemx set print static-members on
9712 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9713 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9714
9715 @item set print static-members off
9716 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9717
9718 @item show print static-members
9719 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9720
9721 @item set print pascal_static-members
9722 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9723 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9724 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9725 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9726
9727 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9728 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9729
9730 @item show print pascal_static-members
9731 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9732
9733 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9734 @item set print vtbl
9735 @itemx set print vtbl on
9736 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9737 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9738 @cindex VTBL display
9739 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9740 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9741 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9742
9743 @item set print vtbl off
9744 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9745
9746 @item show print vtbl
9747 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9748 @end table
9749
9750 @node Pretty Printing
9751 @section Pretty Printing
9752
9753 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9754 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9755 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9756
9757 @menu
9758 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9759 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9760 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9761 @end menu
9762
9763 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9764 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9765
9766 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9767 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9768 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9769
9770 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9771 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9772 pretty-printers with their names.
9773 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9774 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9775 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9776 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9777
9778 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9779 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9780 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9781 do anything special.
9782
9783 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9784
9785 @itemize @bullet
9786 @item
9787 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9788 all inferiors.
9789
9790 @item
9791 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9792 when debugging that program.
9793 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9794
9795 @item
9796 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9797 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9798 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9799 @end itemize
9800
9801 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9802 pretty-printers are selected,
9803
9804 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9805 for new types.
9806
9807 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9808 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9809
9810 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9811
9812 @smallexample
9813 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9814 $1 = @{
9815 static npos = 4294967295,
9816 _M_dataplus = @{
9817 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9818 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9819 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9820 @},
9821 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9822 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9823 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9824 @}
9825 @}
9826 @end smallexample
9827
9828 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9829
9830 @smallexample
9831 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9832 $2 = "abcd"
9833 @end smallexample
9834
9835 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9836 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9837 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9838
9839 @table @code
9840 @kindex info pretty-printer
9841 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9842 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9843 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9844
9845 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9846 whose pretty-printers to list.
9847 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9848 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9849 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9850 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9851 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9852
9853 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9854 to list.
9855
9856 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9857 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9858 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9859 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9860
9861 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9862 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9863 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9864 @end table
9865
9866 Example:
9867
9868 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9869 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9870 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9871 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9872
9873 @smallexample
9874 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9875 library1.so:
9876 foo
9877 library2.so:
9878 bar
9879 bar1
9880 bar2
9881 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9882 library2.so:
9883 bar
9884 bar1
9885 bar2
9886 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9887 1 printer disabled
9888 2 of 3 printers enabled
9889 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9890 library1.so:
9891 foo [disabled]
9892 library2.so:
9893 bar
9894 bar1
9895 bar2
9896 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9897 1 printer disabled
9898 1 of 3 printers enabled
9899 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9900 library1.so:
9901 foo [disabled]
9902 library2.so:
9903 bar
9904 bar1 [disabled]
9905 bar2
9906 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9907 1 printer disabled
9908 0 of 3 printers enabled
9909 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9910 library1.so:
9911 foo [disabled]
9912 library2.so:
9913 bar [disabled]
9914 bar1 [disabled]
9915 bar2
9916 @end smallexample
9917
9918 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9919 as can each individual subprinter.
9920
9921 @node Value History
9922 @section Value History
9923
9924 @cindex value history
9925 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9926 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9927 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9928 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9929 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9930 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9931 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9932 symbol table.
9933
9934 @cindex @code{$}
9935 @cindex @code{$$}
9936 @cindex history number
9937 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9938 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9939 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9940 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9941 history number.
9942
9943 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9944 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9945 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9946 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9947 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9948 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9949 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9950
9951 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9952 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9953
9954 @smallexample
9955 p *$
9956 @end smallexample
9957
9958 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9959 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9960
9961 @smallexample
9962 p *$.next
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9967 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9968
9969 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9970 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9971
9972 @smallexample
9973 print x
9974 set x=5
9975 @end smallexample
9976
9977 @noindent
9978 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9979 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9980
9981 @table @code
9982 @kindex show values
9983 @item show values
9984 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9985 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9986 values} does not change the history.
9987
9988 @item show values @var{n}
9989 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9990
9991 @item show values +
9992 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9993 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9994 @end table
9995
9996 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9997 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9998
9999 @node Convenience Vars
10000 @section Convenience Variables
10001
10002 @cindex convenience variables
10003 @cindex user-defined variables
10004 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10005 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10006 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10007 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10008 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10009
10010 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10011 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10012 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10013 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10014 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10015
10016 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10017 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10018 For example:
10019
10020 @smallexample
10021 set $foo = *object_ptr
10022 @end smallexample
10023
10024 @noindent
10025 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10026 @code{object_ptr}.
10027
10028 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10029 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10030 value with another assignment at any time.
10031
10032 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10033 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10034 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10035 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10036
10037 @table @code
10038 @kindex show convenience
10039 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10040 @item show convenience
10041 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10042 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10043 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10044
10045 @kindex init-if-undefined
10046 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10047 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10048 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10049 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10050 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10051 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10052 override default values used in a command script.
10053
10054 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10055 any side-effects do not occur.
10056 @end table
10057
10058 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10059 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10060 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10061
10062 @smallexample
10063 set $i = 0
10064 print bar[$i++]->contents
10065 @end smallexample
10066
10067 @noindent
10068 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10069
10070 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10071 values likely to be useful.
10072
10073 @table @code
10074 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10075 @item $_
10076 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10077 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10078 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10079 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10080 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10081 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10082 to the type of @code{$__}.
10083
10084 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10085 @item $__
10086 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10087 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10088 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10089
10090 @item $_exitcode
10091 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10092 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10093 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10094 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10095
10096 @item $_exitsignal
10097 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10098 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10099 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10100 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10101
10102 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10103 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10104 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10105 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10106 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10107
10108 @smallexample
10109 #include <signal.h>
10110
10111 int
10112 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10113 @{
10114 raise (SIGALRM);
10115 return 0;
10116 @}
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10120 or signalled would be:
10121
10122 @smallexample
10123 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10124 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10125 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10126 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10127 >echo The program has exited\n
10128 >else
10129 >echo The program has signalled\n
10130 >end
10131 >end
10132 (@value{GDBP}) run
10133 Starting program:
10134
10135 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10136 The program no longer exists.
10137 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10138 The program has signalled
10139 @end smallexample
10140
10141 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10142 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10143 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10144 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10145
10146 @smallexample
10147 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10148 The program has exited
10149 @end smallexample
10150
10151 @item $_exception
10152 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10153 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10154
10155 @item $_probe_argc
10156 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10157 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10158
10159 @item $_sdata
10160 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10161 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10162 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10163 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10164 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10165
10166 @item $_siginfo
10167 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10168 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10169 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10170 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10171 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10172
10173 @item $_tlb
10174 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10175 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10176 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10177 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10178 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10179 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10180
10181 @end table
10182
10183 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10184 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10185 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10186
10187 @node Convenience Funs
10188 @section Convenience Functions
10189
10190 @cindex convenience functions
10191 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10192 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10193 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10194 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10195 @value{GDBN}.
10196
10197 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10198 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10199
10200 @table @code
10201
10202 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10203 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10204 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10205 returns zero.
10206
10207 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10208 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10209 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10210 it is @code{void}:
10211
10212 @smallexample
10213 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10214 $1 = void
10215 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10216 $2 = 1
10217 (@value{GDBP}) run
10218 Starting program: ./a.out
10219 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10220 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10221 $3 = 0
10222 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10223 $4 = 0
10224 @end smallexample
10225
10226 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10227 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10228 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10229 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10230 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10231 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10232 anymore.
10233
10234 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10235 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10236
10237 @smallexample
10238 void
10239 foo (void)
10240 @{
10241 @}
10242 @end smallexample
10243
10244 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10245
10246 @smallexample
10247 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10248 $1 = void
10249 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10250 $2 = 1
10251 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10252 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10253 $3 = void
10254 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10255 $4 = 1
10256 @end smallexample
10257
10258 @end table
10259
10260 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10261 @code{Python} support.
10262
10263 @table @code
10264
10265 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10266 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10267 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10268 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10269 Otherwise it returns zero.
10270
10271 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10272 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10273 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10274 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10275 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10276 regular expression support.
10277
10278 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10279 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10280 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10281 Otherwise it returns zero.
10282
10283 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10284 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10285 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10286
10287 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10288 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10289 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10290 Otherwise it returns zero.
10291
10292 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10293 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10294 The default is 1.
10295
10296 Example:
10297
10298 @smallexample
10299 (gdb) backtrace
10300 #0 bottom_func ()
10301 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10302 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10303 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10304 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10305 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10306 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10307 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10308 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10309 $1 = 1
10310 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10311 $1 = 1
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10315 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10316 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10317 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10318
10319 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10320 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10321 The default is 1.
10322
10323 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10324 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10325 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10326 Otherwise it returns zero.
10327
10328 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10329 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10330 The default is 1.
10331
10332 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10333 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10334 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10335 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10336
10337 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10338 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10339 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10340 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10341
10342 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10343 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10344 The default is 1.
10345
10346 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10347 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10348 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10349 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10350
10351 @end table
10352
10353 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10354 convenience functions.
10355
10356 @table @code
10357 @item help function
10358 @kindex help function
10359 @cindex show all convenience functions
10360 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10361 @end table
10362
10363 @node Registers
10364 @section Registers
10365
10366 @cindex registers
10367 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10368 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10369 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10370 your machine.
10371
10372 @table @code
10373 @kindex info registers
10374 @item info registers
10375 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10376 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10377
10378 @kindex info all-registers
10379 @cindex floating point registers
10380 @item info all-registers
10381 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10382 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10383
10384 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10385 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10386 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10387 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10388 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10389 @end table
10390
10391 @anchor{standard registers}
10392 @cindex stack pointer register
10393 @cindex program counter register
10394 @cindex process status register
10395 @cindex frame pointer register
10396 @cindex standard registers
10397 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10398 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10399 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10400 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10401 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10402 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10403 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10404 you could print the program counter in hex with
10405
10406 @smallexample
10407 p/x $pc
10408 @end smallexample
10409
10410 @noindent
10411 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10412
10413 @smallexample
10414 x/i $pc
10415 @end smallexample
10416
10417 @noindent
10418 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10419 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10420 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10421 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10422 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10423 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10424 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10425
10426 @smallexample
10427 set $sp += 4
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10431 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10432 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10433 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10434 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10435 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10436 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10437
10438 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10439 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10440 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10441 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10442 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10443 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10444 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10445
10446 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10447 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10448 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10449 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10450 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10451 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10452 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10453 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10454 prints the data in both formats.
10455
10456 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10457 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10458 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10459 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10460 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10461 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10462 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10463
10464 @smallexample
10465 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10466 $1 = @{
10467 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10468 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10469 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10470 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10471 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10472 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10473 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10474 @}
10475 @end smallexample
10476
10477 @noindent
10478 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10479 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10480 value to a @code{struct} member:
10481
10482 @smallexample
10483 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10484 @end smallexample
10485
10486 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10487 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10488 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10489 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10490 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10491 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10492
10493 @cindex caller-saved registers
10494 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10495 @cindex volatile registers
10496 @cindex <not saved> values
10497 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10498 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10499 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10500 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10501 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10502 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10503 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10504 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10505 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10506 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10507 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10508 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10509 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10510 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10511 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10512 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10513 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10514 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10515 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10516 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10517 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10518 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10519 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10520
10521 @node Floating Point Hardware
10522 @section Floating Point Hardware
10523 @cindex floating point
10524
10525 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10526 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10527
10528 @table @code
10529 @kindex info float
10530 @item info float
10531 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10532 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10533 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10534 the ARM and x86 machines.
10535 @end table
10536
10537 @node Vector Unit
10538 @section Vector Unit
10539 @cindex vector unit
10540
10541 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10542 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10543
10544 @table @code
10545 @kindex info vector
10546 @item info vector
10547 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10548 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10549 @end table
10550
10551 @node OS Information
10552 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10553 @cindex OS information
10554
10555 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10556 you debug your program.
10557
10558 @cindex auxiliary vector
10559 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10560 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10561 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10562 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10563 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10564 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10565 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10566 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10567 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10568 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10569 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10570 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10571
10572 @table @code
10573 @kindex info auxv
10574 @item info auxv
10575 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10576 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10577 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10578 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10579 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10580 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10581 an unrecognized tag.
10582 @end table
10583
10584 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10585 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10586 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10587 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10588 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10589 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10590 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10591
10592 @table @code
10593 @kindex info os
10594 @item info os @var{infotype}
10595
10596 Display OS information of the requested type.
10597
10598 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10599
10600 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10601 @table @code
10602 @kindex info os cpus
10603 @item cpus
10604 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10605 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10606 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10607 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10608 kernel initialization.
10609
10610 @kindex info os files
10611 @item files
10612 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10613 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10614 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10615 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10616
10617 @kindex info os modules
10618 @item modules
10619 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10620 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10621 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10622 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10623 in memory.
10624
10625 @kindex info os msg
10626 @item msg
10627 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10628 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10629 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10630 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10631 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10632 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10633 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10634 the message queue was last changed.
10635
10636 @kindex info os processes
10637 @item processes
10638 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10639 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10640 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10641 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10642 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10643 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10644
10645 @kindex info os procgroups
10646 @item procgroups
10647 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10648 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10649 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10650 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10651 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10652 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10653 and the process group leader is listed first.
10654
10655 @kindex info os semaphores
10656 @item semaphores
10657 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10658 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10659 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10660 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10661 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10662
10663 @kindex info os shm
10664 @item shm
10665 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10666 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10667 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10668 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10669 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10670 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10671 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10672
10673 @kindex info os sockets
10674 @item sockets
10675 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10676 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10677 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10678 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10679 connection.
10680
10681 @kindex info os threads
10682 @item threads
10683 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10684 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10685 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10686 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10687 process is not listed.
10688 @end table
10689
10690 @item info os
10691 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10692 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10693 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10694 types, this command will report an error.
10695 @end table
10696
10697 @node Memory Region Attributes
10698 @section Memory Region Attributes
10699 @cindex memory region attributes
10700
10701 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10702 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10703 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10704 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10705 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10706 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10707 user can override the fetched regions.
10708
10709 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10710 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10711 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10712 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10713 all memory.
10714
10715 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10716 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10717
10718 @table @code
10719 @kindex mem
10720 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10721 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10722 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10723 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10724 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10725 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10726
10727 @item mem auto
10728 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10729 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10730
10731 @kindex delete mem
10732 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10733 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10734 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10735
10736 @kindex disable mem
10737 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10738 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10739 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10740 It may be enabled again later.
10741
10742 @kindex enable mem
10743 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10744 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10745
10746 @kindex info mem
10747 @item info mem
10748 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10749 for each region:
10750
10751 @table @emph
10752 @item Memory Region Number
10753 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10754 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10755 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10756
10757 @item Lo Address
10758 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10759
10760 @item Hi Address
10761 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10762
10763 @item Attributes
10764 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10765 @end table
10766 @end table
10767
10768
10769 @subsection Attributes
10770
10771 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10772 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10773 write accesses to a memory region.
10774
10775 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10776 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10777 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10778
10779 @table @code
10780 @item ro
10781 Memory is read only.
10782 @item wo
10783 Memory is write only.
10784 @item rw
10785 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10786 @end table
10787
10788 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10789 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10790 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10791 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10792 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10793
10794 @table @code
10795 @item 8
10796 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10797 @item 16
10798 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10799 @item 32
10800 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10801 @item 64
10802 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10803 @end table
10804
10805 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10806 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10807 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10808 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10809 @c
10810 @c @table @code
10811 @c @item hwbreak
10812 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10813 @c @item swbreak (default)
10814 @c @end table
10815
10816 @subsubsection Data Cache
10817 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10818 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10819 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10820 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10821 registers.
10822
10823 @table @code
10824 @item cache
10825 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10826 @item nocache
10827 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10828 @end table
10829
10830 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10831 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10832 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10833 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10834 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10835
10836 @table @code
10837 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10838 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10839 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10840 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10841 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10842 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10843 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10844 The default value is @code{on}.
10845 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10846 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10847 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10848 @end table
10849
10850
10851 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10852 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10853 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10854 @c
10855 @c @table @code
10856 @c @item verify
10857 @c @item noverify (default)
10858 @c @end table
10859
10860 @node Dump/Restore Files
10861 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10862 @cindex dump/restore files
10863 @cindex append data to a file
10864 @cindex dump data to a file
10865 @cindex restore data from a file
10866
10867 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10868 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10869 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10870 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10871 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
10872 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
10873 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
10874
10875 @table @code
10876
10877 @kindex dump
10878 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10879 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10880 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10881 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10882
10883 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10884 @table @code
10885 @item binary
10886 Raw binary form.
10887 @item ihex
10888 Intel hex format.
10889 @item srec
10890 Motorola S-record format.
10891 @item tekhex
10892 Tektronix Hex format.
10893 @item verilog
10894 Verilog Hex format.
10895 @end table
10896
10897 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10898 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10899 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10900 form.
10901
10902 @kindex append
10903 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10904 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10905 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10906 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10907 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10908
10909 @kindex restore
10910 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10911 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10912 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10913 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10914 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10915
10916 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10917 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10918 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10919 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10920 from that location.
10921
10922 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10923 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10924 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10925 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10926
10927 @end table
10928
10929 @node Core File Generation
10930 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10931 @cindex dump core from inferior
10932
10933 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10934 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10935 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10936 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10937 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10938 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10939 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10940
10941 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10942 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10943 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10944
10945 @table @code
10946 @kindex gcore
10947 @kindex generate-core-file
10948 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10949 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10950 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10951 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10952 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10953 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10954
10955 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10956 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10957
10958 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
10959 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
10960 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
10961
10962 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
10963 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
10964 @item set use-coredump-filter on
10965 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
10966 Enable or disable the use of the file
10967 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
10968 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
10969 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
10970 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
10971
10972 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
10973 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
10974 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
10975 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
10976 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
10977 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
10978 about the bits that can be set in the
10979 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
10980 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
10981
10982 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
10983 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
10984 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
10985 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
10986 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
10987 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
10988 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
10989 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
10990 @end table
10991
10992 @node Character Sets
10993 @section Character Sets
10994 @cindex character sets
10995 @cindex charset
10996 @cindex translating between character sets
10997 @cindex host character set
10998 @cindex target character set
10999
11000 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11001 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11002 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11003 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11004 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11005 @dfn{target character set}.
11006
11007 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11008 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11009 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11010 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11011 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11012 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11013 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11014 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11015 character and string literals in expressions.
11016
11017 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11018 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11019 target-charset} command, described below.
11020
11021 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11022 support:
11023
11024 @table @code
11025 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11026 @kindex set target-charset
11027 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11028 list of supported target character sets, type
11029 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11030
11031 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11032 @kindex set host-charset
11033 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11034
11035 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11036 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11037 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11038 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11039 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11040
11041 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11042 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11043 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11044
11045 @item set charset @var{charset}
11046 @kindex set charset
11047 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11048 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11049 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11050 for both host and target.
11051
11052 @item show charset
11053 @kindex show charset
11054 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11055
11056 @item show host-charset
11057 @kindex show host-charset
11058 Show the name of the current host character set.
11059
11060 @item show target-charset
11061 @kindex show target-charset
11062 Show the name of the current target character set.
11063
11064 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11065 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11066 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11067 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11068 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11069 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11070
11071 @item show target-wide-charset
11072 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11073 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11074 @end table
11075
11076 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11077 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11078 @file{charset-test.c}:
11079
11080 @smallexample
11081 #include <stdio.h>
11082
11083 char ascii_hello[]
11084 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11085 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11086 char ibm1047_hello[]
11087 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11088 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11089
11090 main ()
11091 @{
11092 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11093 @}
11094 @end smallexample
11095
11096 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11097 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11098 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11099
11100 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11101
11102 @smallexample
11103 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11104 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11105 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11106 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11107 @dots{}
11108 (@value{GDBP})
11109 @end smallexample
11110
11111 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11112 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11113 strings:
11114
11115 @smallexample
11116 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11117 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11118 (@value{GDBP})
11119 @end smallexample
11120
11121 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11122 initial character set:
11123 @smallexample
11124 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11125 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11126 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11127 (@value{GDBP})
11128 @end smallexample
11129
11130 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11131 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11132 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11133 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11134 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11135
11136 @smallexample
11137 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11138 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11139 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11140 $2 = 72 'H'
11141 (@value{GDBP})
11142 @end smallexample
11143
11144 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11145 literals you use in expressions:
11146
11147 @smallexample
11148 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11149 $3 = 43 '+'
11150 (@value{GDBP})
11151 @end smallexample
11152
11153 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11154 character.
11155
11156 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11157 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11158 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11159
11160 @smallexample
11161 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11162 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11163 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11164 $5 = 200 '\310'
11165 (@value{GDBP})
11166 @end smallexample
11167
11168 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11169 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11170
11171 @smallexample
11172 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11173 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11174 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11178 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11179 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11180 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11181 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11182
11183 @smallexample
11184 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11185 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11186 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11187 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11188 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11189 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11190 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11191 $7 = 72 '\110'
11192 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11193 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11194 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11195 $9 = 200 'H'
11196 (@value{GDBP})
11197 @end smallexample
11198
11199 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11200 string literals you use in expressions:
11201
11202 @smallexample
11203 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11204 $10 = 78 '+'
11205 (@value{GDBP})
11206 @end smallexample
11207
11208 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11209 character.
11210
11211 @node Caching Target Data
11212 @section Caching Data of Targets
11213 @cindex caching data of targets
11214
11215 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11216 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11217 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11218 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11219 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11220 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11221 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11222 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11223 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11224 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11225 is executing.
11226 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11227 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11228 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11229 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11230 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11231 in the code segment.
11232 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11233 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11234
11235 @table @code
11236 @kindex set remotecache
11237 @item set remotecache on
11238 @itemx set remotecache off
11239 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11240 with old scripts.
11241
11242 @kindex show remotecache
11243 @item show remotecache
11244 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11245
11246 @kindex set stack-cache
11247 @item set stack-cache on
11248 @itemx set stack-cache off
11249 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11250 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11251
11252 @kindex show stack-cache
11253 @item show stack-cache
11254 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11255
11256 @kindex set code-cache
11257 @item set code-cache on
11258 @itemx set code-cache off
11259 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11260 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11261 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11262
11263 @kindex show code-cache
11264 @item show code-cache
11265 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11266 accesses.
11267
11268 @kindex info dcache
11269 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11270 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11271 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11272 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11273 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11274 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11275
11276 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11277 printed in hex.
11278
11279 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11280 @cindex dcache size
11281 @kindex set dcache size
11282 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11283
11284 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11285 @cindex dcache line-size
11286 @kindex set dcache line-size
11287 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11288 Must be a power of 2.
11289
11290 @item show dcache size
11291 @kindex show dcache size
11292 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11293
11294 @item show dcache line-size
11295 @kindex show dcache line-size
11296 Show default size of dcache lines.
11297
11298 @end table
11299
11300 @node Searching Memory
11301 @section Search Memory
11302 @cindex searching memory
11303
11304 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11305 @code{find} command.
11306
11307 @table @code
11308 @kindex find
11309 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11310 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11311 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11312 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11313 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11314 @end table
11315
11316 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11317 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11318
11319 @table @r
11320 @item @var{s}, search query size
11321 The size of each search query value.
11322
11323 @table @code
11324 @item b
11325 bytes
11326 @item h
11327 halfwords (two bytes)
11328 @item w
11329 words (four bytes)
11330 @item g
11331 giant words (eight bytes)
11332 @end table
11333
11334 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11335 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11336 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11337
11338 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11339 value's type in the current language.
11340 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11341 pattern as a mixture of types.
11342 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11343 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11344 which is typically four bytes.
11345
11346 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11347 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11348 @end table
11349
11350 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11351 (@code{"}).
11352 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11353 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11354
11355 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11356 number of matches found.
11357
11358 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11359 @samp{$_}.
11360 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11361
11362 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11363
11364 @smallexample
11365 void
11366 hello ()
11367 @{
11368 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11369 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11370 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11371 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11372 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11373 @}
11374 @end smallexample
11375
11376 @noindent
11377 you get during debugging:
11378
11379 @smallexample
11380 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11381 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11382 1 pattern found
11383 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11384 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11385 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11386 2 patterns found
11387 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11388 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11389 1 pattern found
11390 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11391 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11392 1 pattern found
11393 (gdb) print $numfound
11394 $1 = 1
11395 (gdb) print $_
11396 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11397 @end smallexample
11398
11399 @node Optimized Code
11400 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11401 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11402 @cindex debugging optimized code
11403
11404 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11405 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11406 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11407 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11408 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11409 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11410 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11411
11412 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11413 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11414 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11415 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11416
11417 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11418 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11419 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11420 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11421 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11422 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11423
11424 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11425 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11426 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11427 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11428 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11429
11430 @menu
11431 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11432 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11433 @end menu
11434
11435 @node Inline Functions
11436 @section Inline Functions
11437 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11438
11439 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11440 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11441 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11442 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11443 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11444 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11445 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11446 @code{info frame} command.
11447
11448 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11449 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11450 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11451 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11452 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11453 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11454 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11455 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11456 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11457 local variables in the caller.
11458
11459 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11460 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11461 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11462 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11463 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11464 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11465 instructions are executed.
11466
11467 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11468 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11469 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11470 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11471
11472 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11473 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11474
11475 @itemize @bullet
11476 @item
11477 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11478 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11479 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11480 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11481 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11482 or inside the inlined function instead.
11483
11484 @item
11485 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11486 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11487 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11488 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11489
11490 @end itemize
11491
11492 @node Tail Call Frames
11493 @section Tail Call Frames
11494 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11495
11496 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11497 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11498 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11499 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11500 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11501
11502 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11503 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11504 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11505 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11506 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11507 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11508 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11509
11510 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11511 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11512 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11513 this information.
11514
11515 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11516 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11517
11518 @smallexample
11519 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11520 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11521 (gdb) info frame
11522 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11523 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11524 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11525 source language c++.
11526 Arglist at unknown address.
11527 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11528 @end smallexample
11529
11530 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11531 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11532 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11533 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11534 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11535 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11536
11537 @table @code
11538 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11539 @item set debug entry-values
11540 @kindex set debug entry-values
11541 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11542 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11543 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11544 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11545 result.
11546
11547 @item show debug entry-values
11548 @kindex show debug entry-values
11549 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11550 values at function entry and tail calls.
11551 @end table
11552
11553 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11554 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11555 reference by variable @code{x}):
11556
11557 @smallexample
11558 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11559 void (*x) (void) = c;
11560 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11561 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11562 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11563
11564 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11565 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11566 a () at t.c:3
11567 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11568 (gdb) bt
11569 #0 a () at t.c:3
11570 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11571 @end smallexample
11572
11573 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11574
11575 @smallexample
11576 int i;
11577 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11578 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11579 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11580 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11581 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11582 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11583 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11584 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11585
11586 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11587 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11588 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11589 (gdb) bt
11590 #0 f () at t.c:2
11591 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11592 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11593 @end smallexample
11594
11595 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11596 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11597
11598 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11599 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11600 @set ARROW @click{}
11601 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11602 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11603 @end ifset
11604 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11605 @set ARROW ->
11606 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11607 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11608 @end ifclear
11609
11610 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11611 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11612 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11613
11614 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11615 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11616 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11617 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11618 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11619 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11620
11621 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11622 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11623 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11624 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11625 omitted.
11626
11627 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11628 entry may fail:
11629
11630 @smallexample
11631 int v;
11632 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11633 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11634 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11635 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11636 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11637 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11638
11639 (gdb) bt
11640 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11641 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11642 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11643 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11644 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11645 @end smallexample
11646
11647 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11648 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11649 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11650 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11651 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11652
11653 @node Macros
11654 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11655
11656 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11657 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11658 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11659 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11660 where it was defined.
11661
11662 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11663 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11664 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11665 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11666
11667 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11668 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11669 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11670 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11671 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11672 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11673 see @ref{List}.
11674
11675 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11676 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11677 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11678
11679 @table @code
11680
11681 @kindex macro expand
11682 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11683 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11684 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11685 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11686 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11687 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11688 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11689 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11690 it can be any string of tokens.
11691
11692 @kindex macro exp1
11693 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11694 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11695 @cindex expand macro once
11696 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11697 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11698 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11699 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11700 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11701 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11702 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11703 can be any string of tokens.
11704
11705 @kindex info macro
11706 @cindex macro definition, showing
11707 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11708 @cindex macros, from debug info
11709 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11710 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11711 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11712 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11713 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11714 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11715
11716 @kindex info macros
11717 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11718 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11719 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11720 command-line where those definitions were established.
11721
11722 @kindex macro define
11723 @cindex user-defined macros
11724 @cindex defining macros interactively
11725 @cindex macros, user-defined
11726 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11727 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11728 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11729 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11730 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11731 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11732 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11733 @var{arglist}.
11734
11735 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11736 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11737 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11738 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11739 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11740
11741 @kindex macro undef
11742 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11743 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11744 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11745 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11746 in the program being debugged.
11747
11748 @kindex macro list
11749 @item macro list
11750 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11751 @end table
11752
11753 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11754 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11755 show our source files:
11756
11757 @smallexample
11758 $ cat sample.c
11759 #include <stdio.h>
11760 #include "sample.h"
11761
11762 #define M 42
11763 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11764
11765 main ()
11766 @{
11767 #define N 28
11768 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11769 #undef N
11770 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11771 #define N 1729
11772 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11773 @}
11774 $ cat sample.h
11775 #define Q <
11776 $
11777 @end smallexample
11778
11779 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11780 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11781 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11782 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11783 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11784 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11785 information.
11786
11787 @smallexample
11788 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11789 $
11790 @end smallexample
11791
11792 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11793
11794 @smallexample
11795 $ gdb -nw sample
11796 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11797 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11798 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11799 (@value{GDBP})
11800 @end smallexample
11801
11802 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11803 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11804 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11805
11806 @smallexample
11807 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11808 3
11809 4 #define M 42
11810 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11811 6
11812 7 main ()
11813 8 @{
11814 9 #define N 28
11815 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11816 11 #undef N
11817 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11818 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11819 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11820 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11821 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11822 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11823 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11824 #define Q <
11825 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11826 expands to: (42 + 1)
11827 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11828 expands to: once (M + 1)
11829 (@value{GDBP})
11830 @end smallexample
11831
11832 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11833 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11834 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11835 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11836
11837 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11838 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11839
11840 @smallexample
11841 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11842 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11843 (@value{GDBP}) run
11844 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11845
11846 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11847 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11848 (@value{GDBP})
11849 @end smallexample
11850
11851 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11852
11853 @smallexample
11854 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11855 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11856 #define N 28
11857 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11858 expands to: 28 < 42
11859 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11860 $1 = 1
11861 (@value{GDBP})
11862 @end smallexample
11863
11864 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11865 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11866 thereof) in force at each point:
11867
11868 @smallexample
11869 (@value{GDBP}) next
11870 Hello, world!
11871 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11872 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11873 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11874 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11875 (@value{GDBP}) next
11876 We're so creative.
11877 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11878 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11879 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11880 #define N 1729
11881 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11882 expands to: 1729 < 42
11883 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11884 $2 = 0
11885 (@value{GDBP})
11886 @end smallexample
11887
11888 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11889 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11890 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11891 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11892
11893 @smallexample
11894 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11895 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11896 -D__STDC__=1
11897 (@value{GDBP})
11898 @end smallexample
11899
11900
11901 @node Tracepoints
11902 @chapter Tracepoints
11903 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11904 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11905
11906 @cindex tracepoints
11907 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11908 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11909 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11910 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11911 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11912 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11913 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11914
11915 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11916 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11917 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11918 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11919 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11920 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11921 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11922 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11923 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11924 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11925 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11926
11927 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11928 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11929 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11930 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11931 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11932 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11933 Packets}.
11934
11935 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11936 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11937 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11938
11939 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11940
11941 @menu
11942 * Set Tracepoints::
11943 * Analyze Collected Data::
11944 * Tracepoint Variables::
11945 * Trace Files::
11946 @end menu
11947
11948 @node Set Tracepoints
11949 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11950
11951 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11952 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11953 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11954 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11955 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11956 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11957 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11958
11959 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11960 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11961 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11962 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11963 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11964 tracepoint was hit.
11965
11966 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11967 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11968 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11969 either.
11970
11971 @cindex fast tracepoints
11972 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11973 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11974 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11975
11976 @cindex static tracepoints
11977 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11978 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11979 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11980 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11981 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11982 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11983 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11984 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11985 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11986 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11987 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11988 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11989 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11990 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11991 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11992 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11993 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11994 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11995 static tracepoint marker.
11996
11997 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11998 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11999
12000 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12001 conditions and actions.
12002
12003 @menu
12004 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12005 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12006 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12007 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12008 * Trace State Variables::
12009 * Tracepoint Actions::
12010 * Listing Tracepoints::
12011 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12012 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12013 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12014 @end menu
12015
12016 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12017 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12018
12019 @table @code
12020 @cindex set tracepoint
12021 @kindex trace
12022 @item trace @var{location}
12023 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12024 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
12025 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
12026 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
12027 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
12028 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
12029 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12030 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12031 in tracing}).
12032 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12033 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12034 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12035 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12036 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12037 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12038 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12039 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12040 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12041 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12042 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12043 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12044
12045 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12046
12047 @smallexample
12048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12049
12050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12051
12052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12053
12054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12055
12056 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12057 @end smallexample
12058
12059 @noindent
12060 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12061
12062 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12063 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12064 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12065 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12066 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12067 information on tracepoint conditions.
12068
12069 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12070 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12071 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12072 @kindex ftrace
12073 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12074 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12075 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12076 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12077 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12078 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12079 message.
12080
12081 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12082 @code{trace}.
12083
12084 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12085 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12086 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12087 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12088 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12089 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12090 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12091 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12092
12093 @example
12094 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12095 @end example
12096
12097 @noindent
12098 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12099 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12100
12101 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12102 @cindex set static tracepoint
12103 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12104 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12105 @kindex strace
12106 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12107 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12108 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12109 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12110 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12111
12112 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12113 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12114 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12115 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12116 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12117 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12118 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12119 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12120 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12121 tracing engine:
12122
12123 @smallexample
12124 main ()
12125 @{
12126 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12127 @}
12128 @end smallexample
12129
12130 @noindent
12131 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12132 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12133
12134 @smallexample
12135 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12136 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12137 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12138 Data: "str %s"
12139 [etc...]
12140 @end smallexample
12141
12142 @noindent
12143 so you may probe the marker above with:
12144
12145 @smallexample
12146 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12147 @end smallexample
12148
12149 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12150 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12151 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12152 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12153 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12154 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12155 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12156 the @samp{Data:} field.
12157
12158 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12159 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12160 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12161
12162 @vindex $tpnum
12163 @cindex last tracepoint number
12164 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12165 @cindex tracepoint number
12166 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12167 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12168
12169 @kindex delete tracepoint
12170 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12171 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12172 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12173 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12174 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12175
12176 Examples:
12177
12178 @smallexample
12179 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12180
12181 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12182 @end smallexample
12183
12184 @noindent
12185 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12186 @end table
12187
12188 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12189 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12190
12191 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12192
12193 @table @code
12194 @kindex disable tracepoint
12195 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12196 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12197 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12198 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12199 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12200 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12201 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12202 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12203 next trace experiment.
12204
12205 @kindex enable tracepoint
12206 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12207 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12208 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12209 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12210 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12211 next time a trace experiment is run.
12212 @end table
12213
12214 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12215 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12216
12217 @table @code
12218 @kindex passcount
12219 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12220 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12221 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12222 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12223 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12224 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12225 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12226 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12227 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12228 user.
12229
12230 Examples:
12231
12232 @smallexample
12233 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12234 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12235
12236 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12237 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12240 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12241 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12242 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12243 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12244 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12245 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12246 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12247 @end smallexample
12248 @end table
12249
12250 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12251 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12252 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12253 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12254
12255 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12256 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12257 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12258 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12259 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12260 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12261 is true.
12262
12263 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12264 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12265 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12266 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12267 just as with breakpoints.
12268
12269 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12270 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12271 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12272 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12273 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12274 accesses, and so forth.
12275
12276 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12277 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12278 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12279 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12280 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12281 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12282 search through.
12283
12284 @smallexample
12285 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12286 @end smallexample
12287
12288 @node Trace State Variables
12289 @subsection Trace State Variables
12290 @cindex trace state variables
12291
12292 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12293 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12294 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12295 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12296 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12297 integers.
12298
12299 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12300 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12301 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12302 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12303
12304 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12305 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12306 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12307 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12308 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12309 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12310 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12311 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12312 variable with the same name.
12313
12314 @table @code
12315
12316 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12317 @kindex tvariable
12318 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12319 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12320 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12321 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12322 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12323 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12324 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12325 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12326 value. The default initial value is 0.
12327
12328 @item info tvariables
12329 @kindex info tvariables
12330 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12331 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12332 currently running.
12333
12334 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12335 @kindex delete tvariable
12336 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12337 are specified.
12338
12339 @end table
12340
12341 @node Tracepoint Actions
12342 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12343
12344 @table @code
12345 @kindex actions
12346 @cindex tracepoint actions
12347 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12348 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12349 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12350 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12351 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12352 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12353 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12354 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12355 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12356 @code{while-stepping}.
12357
12358 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12359 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12360 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12361
12362 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12363 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12364 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12365
12366 @smallexample
12367 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12368
12369 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12370
12371 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12372 @end smallexample
12373
12374 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12375 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12376 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12377 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12378 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12379 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12380 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12381 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12382
12383 @smallexample
12384 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12385 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12386 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12387 > collect bar,baz
12388 > collect $regs
12389 > while-stepping 12
12390 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12391 > end
12392 end
12393 @end smallexample
12394
12395 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12396 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12397 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12398 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12399 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12400 special arguments are supported:
12401
12402 @table @code
12403 @item $regs
12404 Collect all registers.
12405
12406 @item $args
12407 Collect all function arguments.
12408
12409 @item $locals
12410 Collect all local variables.
12411
12412 @item $_ret
12413 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12414 of a backtrace.
12415
12416 @item $_probe_argc
12417 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12418 tracepoint is located.
12419 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12420
12421 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12422 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12423 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12424 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12425
12426 @item $_sdata
12427 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12428 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12429 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12430 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12431 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12432 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12433 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12434 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12435 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12436
12437 @smallexample
12438 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12439 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12440 @end smallexample
12441
12442 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12443 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12444 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12445 @value{GDBN}.
12446 @end table
12447
12448 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12449 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12450 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12451
12452 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12453 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12454 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12455 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12456 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12457 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12458 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12459 @samp{mystr}.
12460
12461 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12462 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12463
12464 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12465 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12466 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12467 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12468 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12469 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12470 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12471 action were used.
12472
12473 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12474 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12475 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12476 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12477 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12478 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12479
12480 @smallexample
12481 > while-stepping 12
12482 > collect $regs, myglobal
12483 > end
12484 >
12485 @end smallexample
12486
12487 @noindent
12488 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12489 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12490 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12491 @code{stepping}.
12492
12493 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12494 @kindex set default-collect
12495 @cindex default collection action
12496 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12497 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12498 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12499 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12500 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12501 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12502
12503 @item show default-collect
12504 @kindex show default-collect
12505 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12506 tracepoint hit.
12507
12508 @end table
12509
12510 @node Listing Tracepoints
12511 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12512
12513 @table @code
12514 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12515 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12516 @cindex information about tracepoints
12517 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12518 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12519 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12520 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12521 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12522 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12523
12524 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12525 tracing:
12526
12527 @itemize @bullet
12528 @item
12529 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12530
12531 @item
12532 the state about installed on target of each location
12533 @end itemize
12534
12535 @smallexample
12536 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12537 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12538 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12539 while-stepping 20
12540 collect globfoo, $regs
12541 end
12542 collect globfoo2
12543 end
12544 pass count 1200
12545 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12546 collect $eip
12547 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12548 installed on target
12549 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12550 installed on target
12551 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12552 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12553 not installed on target
12554 (@value{GDBP})
12555 @end smallexample
12556
12557 @noindent
12558 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12559 @end table
12560
12561 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12562 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12563
12564 @table @code
12565 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12566 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12567 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12568 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12569 program.
12570
12571 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12572
12573 @table @emph
12574 @item Count
12575 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12576 stable identifier.
12577 @item ID
12578 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12579 @item Enabled or Disabled
12580 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12581 that are not enabled.
12582 @item Address
12583 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12584 @item What
12585 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12586 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12587 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12588 will be left blank.
12589 @end table
12590
12591 @noindent
12592 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12593
12594 @table @emph
12595 @item Data
12596 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12597 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12598 marker call.
12599 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12600 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12601 @end table
12602
12603 @smallexample
12604 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12605 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12606 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12607 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12608 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12609 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12610 Data: str %s
12611 (@value{GDBP})
12612 @end smallexample
12613 @end table
12614
12615 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12616 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12617
12618 @table @code
12619 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12620 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12621 @cindex collected data discarded
12622 @item tstart
12623 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12624 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12625 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12626 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12627 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12628 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12629 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12630 information, and so forth.
12631
12632 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12633 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12634 @item tstop
12635 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12636 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12637 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12638 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12639 needs to be stopped quickly.
12640
12641 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12642 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12643 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12644
12645 @kindex tstatus
12646 @cindex status of trace data collection
12647 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12648 @item tstatus
12649 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12650 collection.
12651 @end table
12652
12653 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12654
12655 @smallexample
12656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12658 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12659 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12660 > while-stepping 11
12661 > collect $regs
12662 > end
12663 > end
12664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12665 [time passes @dots{}]
12666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12667 @end smallexample
12668
12669 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12670 @cindex disconnected tracing
12671 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12672 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12673 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12674 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12675 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12676 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12677 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12678 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12679
12680 @table @code
12681 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12682 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12683 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12684 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12685 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12686 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12687 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12688 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12689
12690 @item show disconnected-tracing
12691 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12692 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12693
12694 @end table
12695
12696 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12697 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12698 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12699 it will continue after reconnection.
12700
12701 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12702 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12703 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12704 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12705 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12706 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12707 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12708 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12709 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12710 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12711
12712 @cindex circular trace buffer
12713 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12714 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12715 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12716 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12717 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12718 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12719 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12720 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12721 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12722 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12723 the next run.
12724
12725 @table @code
12726 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12727 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12728 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12729 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12730 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12731 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12732 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12733
12734 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12735 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12736 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12737 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12738 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12739 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12740
12741 @end table
12742
12743 @table @code
12744 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12745 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12746 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12747 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12748 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12749 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12750 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12751 likes. This is also the default.
12752
12753 @item show trace-buffer-size
12754 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12755 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12756 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12757 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12758 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12759 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12760 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12761 @end table
12762
12763 @table @code
12764 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12765 @kindex set trace-user
12766
12767 @item show trace-user
12768 @kindex show trace-user
12769
12770 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12771 @kindex set trace-notes
12772 Set the trace run's notes.
12773
12774 @item show trace-notes
12775 @kindex show trace-notes
12776 Show the trace run's notes.
12777
12778 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12779 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12780 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12781 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12782 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12783
12784 @item show trace-stop-notes
12785 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12786 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12787
12788 @end table
12789
12790 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12791 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12792
12793 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12794 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12795 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12796 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12797 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12798 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12799 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12800 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12801 mentioned here.
12802
12803 @itemize @bullet
12804
12805 @item
12806 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12807 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12808 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12809 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12810 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12811 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12812 cannot be collected either.
12813
12814 @item
12815 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12816 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12817 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12818 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12819 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12820 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12821 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12822 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12823 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12824 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12825
12826 @item
12827 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12828 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12829 in a misleading way.
12830
12831 @item
12832 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12833 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12834 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12835 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12836 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12837 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12838 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12839 by @code{ptr}.
12840
12841 @item
12842 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12843 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12844 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12845 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12846 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12847 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12848 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12849 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12850 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12851 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12852 invalid address.
12853
12854 @item
12855 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12856 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12857 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12858 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12859 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12860 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12861 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12862 it to zero.
12863
12864 @end itemize
12865
12866 @node Analyze Collected Data
12867 @section Using the Collected Data
12868
12869 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12870 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12871 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12872 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12873 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12874 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12875 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12876 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12877 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12878 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12879 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12880 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12881 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12882 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12883 the buffer will fail.
12884
12885 @menu
12886 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12887 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12888 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12889 @end menu
12890
12891 @node tfind
12892 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12893
12894 @kindex tfind
12895 @cindex select trace snapshot
12896 @cindex find trace snapshot
12897 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12898 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12899 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12900 snapshot is selected.
12901
12902 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12903
12904 @table @code
12905 @item tfind start
12906 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12907 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12908
12909 @item tfind none
12910 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12911
12912 @item tfind end
12913 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12914
12915 @item tfind
12916 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12917
12918 @item tfind -
12919 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12920 retracing earlier steps.
12921
12922 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12923 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12924 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12925 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12926 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12927
12928 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12929 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12930 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12931 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12932 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12933
12934 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12935 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12936 addresses (exclusive).
12937
12938 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12939 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12940 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12941
12942 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12943 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12944 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12945 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12946 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12947 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12948 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12949 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12950 @end table
12951
12952 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12953 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12954 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12955 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12956 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12957 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12958 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12959 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12960 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12961 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12962 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12963 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12964 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12965 tracepoint as the current one.
12966
12967 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12968 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12969 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12970 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12971 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12972
12973 @smallexample
12974 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12975 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12976 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12977 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12978 > tfind
12979 > end
12980
12981 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12982 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12983 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12984 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12985 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12986 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12987 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12988 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12989 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12990 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12991 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12992 @end smallexample
12993
12994 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12995 the buffer:
12996
12997 @smallexample
12998 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12999 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13000 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13001 > tfind line
13002 > end
13003
13004 Frame 0, X = 1
13005 Frame 7, X = 2
13006 Frame 13, X = 255
13007 @end smallexample
13008
13009 @node tdump
13010 @subsection @code{tdump}
13011 @kindex tdump
13012 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13013 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13014
13015 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13016 the current trace snapshot.
13017
13018 @smallexample
13019 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13020 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13021 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13022 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13023 > end
13024
13025 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13026
13027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13028 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13029 at gdb_test.c:444
13030 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13031
13032 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13033 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13034 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13035 d1 0x18 24
13036 d2 0x80 128
13037 d3 0x33 51
13038 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13039 d5 0x22 34
13040 d6 0xe0 224
13041 d7 0x380035 3670069
13042 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13043 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13044 a2 0x100 256
13045 a3 0x322000 3284992
13046 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13047 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13048 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13049 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13050 ps 0x0 0
13051 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13052 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13053 fpstatus 0x0 0
13054 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13055 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13056 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13057 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13058 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13059 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13060 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13061 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13062 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13063
13064 (@value{GDBP})
13065 @end smallexample
13066
13067 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13068 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13069 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13070 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13071
13072 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13073 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13074 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13075 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13076 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13077 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13078 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13079 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13080 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13081 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13082
13083 @node save tracepoints
13084 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13085 @kindex save tracepoints
13086 @kindex save-tracepoints
13087 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13088
13089 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13090 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13091 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13092 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13093 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13094 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13095
13096 @node Tracepoint Variables
13097 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13098 @cindex tracepoint variables
13099 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13100
13101 @table @code
13102 @vindex $trace_frame
13103 @item (int) $trace_frame
13104 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13105 snapshot is selected.
13106
13107 @vindex $tracepoint
13108 @item (int) $tracepoint
13109 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13110
13111 @vindex $trace_line
13112 @item (int) $trace_line
13113 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13114
13115 @vindex $trace_file
13116 @item (char []) $trace_file
13117 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13118
13119 @vindex $trace_func
13120 @item (char []) $trace_func
13121 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13122 @end table
13123
13124 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13125 use @code{output} instead.
13126
13127 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13128 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13129 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13130 which are managed by the target.
13131
13132 @smallexample
13133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13134
13135 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13136 > output $trace_file
13137 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13138 > tfind
13139 > end
13140 @end smallexample
13141
13142 @node Trace Files
13143 @section Using Trace Files
13144 @cindex trace files
13145
13146 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13147 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13148 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13149 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13150 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13151
13152 @table @code
13153
13154 @kindex tsave
13155 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13156 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13157 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13158 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13159 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13160 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13161 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13162 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13163 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13164 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13165 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13166 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13167 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13168 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13169 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13170
13171 @kindex target tfile
13172 @kindex tfile
13173 @kindex target ctf
13174 @kindex ctf
13175 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13176 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13177 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13178 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13179 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13180 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13181 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13182 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13183 the host.
13184
13185 @smallexample
13186 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13187 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13188 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13189 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13190 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13191 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13192 i = 0
13193 a = 0
13194 b = 1 '\001'
13195 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13196 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13197 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13198 $1 = 1
13199 @end smallexample
13200
13201 @end table
13202
13203 @node Overlays
13204 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13205 @cindex overlays
13206
13207 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13208 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13209 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13210 use overlays.
13211
13212 @menu
13213 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13214 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13215 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13216 mapped by asking the inferior.
13217 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13218 @end menu
13219
13220 @node How Overlays Work
13221 @section How Overlays Work
13222 @cindex mapped overlays
13223 @cindex unmapped overlays
13224 @cindex load address, overlay's
13225 @cindex mapped address
13226 @cindex overlay area
13227
13228 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13229 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13230 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13231 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13232 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13233
13234 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13235 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13236 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13237 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13238 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13239 largest overlay as well.
13240
13241 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13242 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13243 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13244 there.
13245
13246 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13247 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13248 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13249
13250 @smallexample
13251 @group
13252 Data Instruction Larger
13253 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13254 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13255 | | | | | |
13256 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13257 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13258 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13259 | and heap | | | | | |
13260 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13261 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13262 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13263 | | | | | |
13264 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13265 address | | | | | |
13266 | overlay | <-' | | |
13267 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13268 | | <---. | | load address
13269 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13270 | | | |
13271 +-----------+ | |
13272 +-----------+
13273 | |
13274 +-----------+
13275
13276 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13277 @end group
13278 @end smallexample
13279
13280 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13281 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13282 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13283 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13284 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13285 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13286 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13287 program and the overlay area.
13288
13289 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13290 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13291 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13292 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13293 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13294 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13295 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13296
13297 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13298 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13299 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13300
13301 @itemize @bullet
13302
13303 @item
13304 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13305 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13306 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13307 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13308
13309 @item
13310 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13311 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13312 your program's performance.
13313
13314 @item
13315 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13316 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13317 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13318 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13319 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13320 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13321 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13322
13323 @item
13324 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13325 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13326 instruction and data spaces.
13327
13328 @end itemize
13329
13330 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13331 improved in many ways:
13332
13333 @itemize @bullet
13334
13335 @item
13336 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13337 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13338 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13339 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13340 area in the usual way.
13341
13342 @item
13343 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13344 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13345
13346 @item
13347 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13348 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13349 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13350 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13351 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13352 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13353 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13354
13355 @end itemize
13356
13357
13358 @node Overlay Commands
13359 @section Overlay Commands
13360
13361 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13362 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13363 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13364 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13365 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13366 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13367
13368 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13369 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13370
13371 @table @code
13372 @item overlay off
13373 @kindex overlay
13374 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13375 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13376 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13377 overlay support is disabled.
13378
13379 @item overlay manual
13380 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13381 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13382 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13383 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13384 commands described below.
13385
13386 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13387 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13388 @cindex map an overlay
13389 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13390 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13391 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13392 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13393 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13394 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13395
13396 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13397 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13398 @cindex unmap an overlay
13399 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13400 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13401 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13402 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13403
13404 @item overlay auto
13405 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13406 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13407 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13408 Overlay Debugging}.
13409
13410 @item overlay load-target
13411 @itemx overlay load
13412 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13413 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13414 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13415 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13416 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13417 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13418
13419 @item overlay list-overlays
13420 @itemx overlay list
13421 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13422 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13423 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13424
13425 @end table
13426
13427 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13428 of the function the address falls in:
13429
13430 @smallexample
13431 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13432 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13433 @end smallexample
13434 @noindent
13435 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13436 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13437 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13438 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13439
13440 @smallexample
13441 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13442 No sections are mapped.
13443 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13444 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13445 @end smallexample
13446 @noindent
13447 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13448 name normally:
13449
13450 @smallexample
13451 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13452 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13453 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13454 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13455 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13456 @end smallexample
13457
13458 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13459 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13460 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13461 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13462 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13463
13464 @itemize @bullet
13465 @item
13466 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13467 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13468 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13469 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13470 @item
13471 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13472 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13473 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13474 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13475 breakpoints properly.
13476 @end itemize
13477
13478
13479 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13480 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13481 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13482
13483 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13484 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13485 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13486 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13487 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13488 current state of the overlays.
13489
13490 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13491 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13492
13493 @table @asis
13494
13495 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13496 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13497
13498 @smallexample
13499 struct
13500 @{
13501 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13502 unsigned long vma;
13503
13504 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13505 unsigned long size;
13506
13507 /* The overlay's load address. */
13508 unsigned long lma;
13509
13510 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13511 zero otherwise. */
13512 unsigned long mapped;
13513 @}
13514 @end smallexample
13515
13516 @item @code{_novlys}:
13517 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13518 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13519
13520 @end table
13521
13522 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13523 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13524 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13525 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13526 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13527 currently mapped.
13528
13529 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13530 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13531 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13532 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13533 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13534 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13535 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13536 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13537 are not being executed.
13538
13539 @node Overlay Sample Program
13540 @section Overlay Sample Program
13541 @cindex overlay example program
13542
13543 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13544 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13545 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13546 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13547 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13548 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13549 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13550
13551 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13552 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13553 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13554 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13555
13556 @table @file
13557 @item overlays.c
13558 The main program file.
13559 @item ovlymgr.c
13560 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13561 @item foo.c
13562 @itemx bar.c
13563 @itemx baz.c
13564 @itemx grbx.c
13565 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13566 @item d10v.ld
13567 @itemx m32r.ld
13568 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13569 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13570 @end table
13571
13572 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13573 cross-compiler like this:
13574
13575 @smallexample
13576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13577 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13578 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13579 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13580 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13581 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13582 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13583 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13584 @end smallexample
13585
13586 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13587 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13588 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13589
13590
13591 @node Languages
13592 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13593 @cindex languages
13594
13595 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13596 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13597 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13598 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13599 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13600 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13601
13602 @cindex working language
13603 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13604 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13605 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13606 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13607 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13608 language}.
13609
13610 @menu
13611 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13612 * Show:: Displaying the language
13613 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13614 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13615 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13616 @end menu
13617
13618 @node Setting
13619 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13620
13621 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13622 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13623 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13624 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13625 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13626 are printed, etc.
13627
13628 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13629 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13630 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13631 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13632 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13633 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13634 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13635 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13636 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13637 Displaying the Language}.
13638
13639 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13640 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13641 another language. In that case, make the
13642 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13643 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13644 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13645
13646 @menu
13647 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13648 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13649 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13650 @end menu
13651
13652 @node Filenames
13653 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13654
13655 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13656 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13657
13658 @table @file
13659 @item .ada
13660 @itemx .ads
13661 @itemx .adb
13662 @itemx .a
13663 Ada source file.
13664
13665 @item .c
13666 C source file
13667
13668 @item .C
13669 @itemx .cc
13670 @itemx .cp
13671 @itemx .cpp
13672 @itemx .cxx
13673 @itemx .c++
13674 C@t{++} source file
13675
13676 @item .d
13677 D source file
13678
13679 @item .m
13680 Objective-C source file
13681
13682 @item .f
13683 @itemx .F
13684 Fortran source file
13685
13686 @item .mod
13687 Modula-2 source file
13688
13689 @item .s
13690 @itemx .S
13691 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13692 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13693 @end table
13694
13695 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13696 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13697
13698 @node Manually
13699 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13700
13701 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13702 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13703 your program.
13704
13705 @kindex set language
13706 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13707 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13708 a language, such as
13709 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13710 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13711
13712 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13713 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13714 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13715 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13716 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13717 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13718 command such as:
13719
13720 @smallexample
13721 print a = b + c
13722 @end smallexample
13723
13724 @noindent
13725 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13726 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13727 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13728 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13729
13730 @node Automatically
13731 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13732
13733 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13734 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13735 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13736 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13737 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13738 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13739 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13740 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13741 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13742
13743 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13744 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13745 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13746 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13747 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13748
13749 @node Show
13750 @section Displaying the Language
13751
13752 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13753 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13754
13755 @table @code
13756 @item show language
13757 @anchor{show language}
13758 @kindex show language
13759 Display the current working language. This is the
13760 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13761 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13762
13763 @item info frame
13764 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13765 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13766 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13767 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13768 information listed here.
13769
13770 @item info source
13771 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13772 Display the source language of this source file.
13773 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13774 information listed here.
13775 @end table
13776
13777 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13778 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13779 with a language explicitly:
13780
13781 @table @code
13782 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13783 @kindex set extension-language
13784 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13785 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13786
13787 @item info extensions
13788 @kindex info extensions
13789 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13790 @end table
13791
13792 @node Checks
13793 @section Type and Range Checking
13794
13795 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13796 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13797 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13798 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13799 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13800 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13801 errors when your program is running.
13802
13803 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13804 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13805 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13806 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13807
13808 @menu
13809 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13810 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13811 @end menu
13812
13813 @cindex type checking
13814 @cindex checks, type
13815 @node Type Checking
13816 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13817
13818 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13819 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13820 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13821 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13822
13823 @smallexample
13824 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13825
13826 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13827 $1 = 2
13828 @exdent but
13829 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13830 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13831 @end smallexample
13832
13833 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13834 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13835
13836 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13837 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13838 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13839 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13840 expressions like the second example above.
13841
13842 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13843 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13844 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13845 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13846 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13847 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13848
13849 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13850
13851 @kindex set check type
13852 @kindex show check type
13853 @table @code
13854 @item set check type on
13855 @itemx set check type off
13856 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13857 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13858 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13859
13860 @item show check type
13861 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13862 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13863 @end table
13864
13865 @cindex range checking
13866 @cindex checks, range
13867 @node Range Checking
13868 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13869
13870 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13871 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13872 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13873 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13874 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13875
13876 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13877 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13878 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13879 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13880
13881 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13882 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13883 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13884 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13885 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13886 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13887
13888 @smallexample
13889 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13890 @end smallexample
13891
13892 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13893 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13894 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13895
13896 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13897
13898 @kindex set check range
13899 @kindex show check range
13900 @table @code
13901 @item set check range auto
13902 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13903 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13904 each language.
13905
13906 @item set check range on
13907 @itemx set check range off
13908 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13909 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13910 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13911 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13912
13913 @item set check range warn
13914 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13915 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13916 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13917 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13918 systems).
13919
13920 @item show range
13921 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13922 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13923 @end table
13924
13925 @node Supported Languages
13926 @section Supported Languages
13927
13928 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13929 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13930 @c This is false ...
13931 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13932 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13933 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13934 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13935 language.
13936
13937 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13938 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13939 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13940 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13941 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13942 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13943 language reference or tutorial.
13944
13945 @menu
13946 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13947 * D:: D
13948 * Go:: Go
13949 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13950 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13951 * Fortran:: Fortran
13952 * Pascal:: Pascal
13953 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13954 * Ada:: Ada
13955 @end menu
13956
13957 @node C
13958 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13959
13960 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13961 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13962
13963 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13964 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13965 together.
13966
13967 @cindex C@t{++}
13968 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13969 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13970 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13971 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13972 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13973 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13974 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13975
13976 @menu
13977 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13978 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13979 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13980 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13981 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13982 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13983 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13984 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13985 @end menu
13986
13987 @node C Operators
13988 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13989
13990 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13991
13992 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13993 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13994 often defined on groups of types.
13995
13996 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13997
13998 @itemize @bullet
13999
14000 @item
14001 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14002 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14003
14004 @item
14005 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14006 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14007
14008 @item
14009 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14010
14011 @item
14012 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14013
14014 @end itemize
14015
14016 @noindent
14017 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14018 in order of increasing precedence:
14019
14020 @table @code
14021 @item ,
14022 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14023 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14024 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14025
14026 @item =
14027 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14028 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14029
14030 @item @var{op}=
14031 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14032 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14033 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14034 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14035 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14036
14037 @item ?:
14038 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14039 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14040 should be of an integral type.
14041
14042 @item ||
14043 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14044
14045 @item &&
14046 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14047
14048 @item |
14049 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14050
14051 @item ^
14052 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14053
14054 @item &
14055 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14056
14057 @item ==@r{, }!=
14058 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14059 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14060
14061 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14062 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14063 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14064 and non-zero for true.
14065
14066 @item <<@r{, }>>
14067 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14068
14069 @item @@
14070 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14071
14072 @item +@r{, }-
14073 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14074 pointer types.
14075
14076 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14077 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14078 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14079 integral types.
14080
14081 @item ++@r{, }--
14082 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14083 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14084 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14085 operation takes place.
14086
14087 @item *
14088 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14089 @code{++}.
14090
14091 @item &
14092 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14093
14094 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14095 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14096 to examine the address
14097 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14098 stored.
14099
14100 @item -
14101 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14102 precedence as @code{++}.
14103
14104 @item !
14105 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14106 @code{++}.
14107
14108 @item ~
14109 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14110 @code{++}.
14111
14112
14113 @item .@r{, }->
14114 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14115 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14116 pointer based on the stored type information.
14117 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14118
14119 @item .*@r{, }->*
14120 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14121
14122 @item []
14123 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14124 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14125
14126 @item ()
14127 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14128
14129 @item ::
14130 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14131 and @code{class} types.
14132
14133 @item ::
14134 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14135 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14136 above.
14137 @end table
14138
14139 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14140 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14141 predefined meaning.
14142
14143 @node C Constants
14144 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14145
14146 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14147
14148 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14149 following ways:
14150
14151 @itemize @bullet
14152 @item
14153 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14154 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14155 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14156 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14157 @code{long} value.
14158
14159 @item
14160 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14161 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14162 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14163 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14164 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14165 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14166 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14167 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14168 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14169 constant.
14170
14171 @item
14172 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14173 integral equivalents.
14174
14175 @item
14176 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14177 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14178 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14179 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14180 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14181 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14182 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14183 @samp{\n} for newline.
14184
14185 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14186 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14187 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14188 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14189
14190 @item
14191 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14192 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14193 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14194 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14195 characters.
14196
14197 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14198 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14199 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14200
14201 @item
14202 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14203 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14204
14205 @item
14206 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14207 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14208 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14209 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14210 @end itemize
14211
14212 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14213 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14214
14215 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14216 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14217
14218 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14219 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14220 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14221 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14222 @quotation
14223 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14224 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14225 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14226 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14227 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14228 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14229 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14230 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14231 @end quotation
14232
14233 @enumerate
14234
14235 @cindex member functions
14236 @item
14237 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14238
14239 @smallexample
14240 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14241 @end smallexample
14242
14243 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14244 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14245 @item
14246 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14247 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14248 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14249 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14250 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14251
14252 @cindex call overloaded functions
14253 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14254 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14255 @item
14256 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14257 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14258 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14259 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14260 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14261 default arguments.
14262
14263 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14264 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14265 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14266 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14267 number of function arguments.
14268
14269 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14270 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14271 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14272
14273 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14274 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14275 @smallexample
14276 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14277 @end smallexample
14278
14279 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14280 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14281
14282 @cindex reference declarations
14283 @item
14284 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14285 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14286 dereferenced.
14287
14288 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14289 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14290 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14291 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14292 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14293
14294 @item
14295 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14296 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14297 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14298 necessary, for example in an expression like
14299 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14300 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14301 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14302
14303 @item
14304 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14305 specification.
14306 @end enumerate
14307
14308 @node C Defaults
14309 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14310
14311 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14312
14313 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14314 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14315 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14316 selects the working language.
14317
14318 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14319 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14320 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14321 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14322 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14323 for further details.
14324
14325 @node C Checks
14326 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14327
14328 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14329
14330 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14331 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14332 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14333 constants to pointers.
14334
14335 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14336 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14337 that is not itself an array.
14338
14339 @node Debugging C
14340 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14341
14342 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14343 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14344 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14345 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14346
14347 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14348 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14349 ,Expressions}.
14350
14351 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14352 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14353
14354 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14355
14356 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14357 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14358
14359 @table @code
14360 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14361 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14362 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14363 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14364 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14365 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14366
14367 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14368 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14369 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14370 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14371 classes.
14372 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14373
14374 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14375 @item catch throw
14376 @itemx catch rethrow
14377 @itemx catch catch
14378 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14379 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14380
14381 @cindex inheritance
14382 @item ptype @var{typename}
14383 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14384 @var{typename}.
14385 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14386
14387 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14388 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14389 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14390 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14391 multiple inheritance is in use.
14392
14393 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14394 @item demangle @var{name}
14395 Demangle @var{name}.
14396 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14397
14398 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14399 @item set print demangle
14400 @itemx show print demangle
14401 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14402 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14403 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14404 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14405 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14406
14407 @item set print object
14408 @itemx show print object
14409 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14410 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14411
14412 @item set print vtbl
14413 @itemx show print vtbl
14414 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14415 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14416 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14417 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14418
14419 @kindex set overload-resolution
14420 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14421 @item set overload-resolution on
14422 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14423 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14424 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14425 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14426 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14427 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14428
14429 @item set overload-resolution off
14430 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14431 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14432 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14433 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14434 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14435 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14436 argument types.
14437
14438 @kindex show overload-resolution
14439 @item show overload-resolution
14440 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14441
14442 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14443 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14444 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14445 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14446 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14447 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14448 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14449 @end table
14450
14451 @node Decimal Floating Point
14452 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14453 @cindex decimal floating point format
14454
14455 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14456 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14457 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14458 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14459
14460 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14461 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14462 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14463 configured target.
14464
14465 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14466 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14467 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14468
14469 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14470 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14471 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14472
14473 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14474 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14475 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14476
14477 @node D
14478 @subsection D
14479
14480 @cindex D
14481 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14482 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14483 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14484
14485 @node Go
14486 @subsection Go
14487
14488 @cindex Go (programming language)
14489 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14490 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14491
14492 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14493
14494 @table @code
14495 @cindex current Go package
14496 @item The current Go package
14497 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14498 specifying global variables and functions.
14499
14500 For example, given the program:
14501
14502 @example
14503 package main
14504 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14505 func main () @{
14506 // ...
14507 @}
14508 @end example
14509
14510 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14511
14512 @example
14513 (gdb) p myglob
14514 (gdb) p main.myglob
14515 @end example
14516
14517 @cindex builtin Go types
14518 @item Builtin Go types
14519 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14520 as a string.
14521
14522 @cindex builtin Go functions
14523 @item Builtin Go functions
14524 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14525 function and handles it internally.
14526
14527 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14528 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14529 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14530 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14531 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14532 @end table
14533
14534 @node Objective-C
14535 @subsection Objective-C
14536
14537 @cindex Objective-C
14538 This section provides information about some commands and command
14539 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14540 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14541 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14542
14543 @menu
14544 * Method Names in Commands::
14545 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14546 @end menu
14547
14548 @node Method Names in Commands
14549 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14550
14551 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14552 names as line specifications:
14553
14554 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14555 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14556 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14557 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14558 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14559 @itemize
14560 @item @code{clear}
14561 @item @code{break}
14562 @item @code{info line}
14563 @item @code{jump}
14564 @item @code{list}
14565 @end itemize
14566
14567 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14568
14569 @smallexample
14570 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14571 @end smallexample
14572
14573 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14574 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14575 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14576 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14577 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14578 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14579 debugged, enter:
14580
14581 @smallexample
14582 break -[Fruit create]
14583 @end smallexample
14584
14585 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14586 enter:
14587
14588 @smallexample
14589 list +[NSText initialize]
14590 @end smallexample
14591
14592 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14593 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14594 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14595 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14596
14597 @smallexample
14598 break create
14599 @end smallexample
14600
14601 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14602 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14603 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14604 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14605 none apply.
14606
14607 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14608 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14609
14610 @smallexample
14611 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14612 @end smallexample
14613
14614 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14615 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14616 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14617 @kindex print-object
14618 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14619
14620 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14621
14622 @smallexample
14623 print -[@var{object} hash]
14624 @end smallexample
14625
14626 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14627 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14628 @noindent
14629 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14630 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14631 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14632 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14633 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14634 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14635
14636 @node OpenCL C
14637 @subsection OpenCL C
14638
14639 @cindex OpenCL C
14640 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14641
14642 @menu
14643 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14644 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14645 * OpenCL C Operators::
14646 @end menu
14647
14648 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14649 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14650
14651 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14652 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14653 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14654 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14655 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14656
14657 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14658 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14659
14660 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14661 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14662 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14663 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14664
14665 @node OpenCL C Operators
14666 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14667
14668 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14669 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14670 vector data types.
14671
14672 @node Fortran
14673 @subsection Fortran
14674 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14675
14676 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14677 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14678
14679 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14680 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14681 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14682 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14683 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14684 underscore.
14685
14686 @menu
14687 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14688 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14689 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14690 @end menu
14691
14692 @node Fortran Operators
14693 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14694
14695 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14696
14697 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14698 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14699 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14700
14701 @table @code
14702 @item **
14703 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14704 of the second one.
14705
14706 @item :
14707 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14708 represent a section of array.
14709
14710 @item %
14711 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14712 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14713 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14714 union type.
14715 @end table
14716
14717 @node Fortran Defaults
14718 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14719
14720 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14721
14722 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14723 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14724 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14725 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14726
14727 @node Special Fortran Commands
14728 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14729
14730 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14731
14732 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14733 such as displaying common blocks.
14734
14735 @table @code
14736 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14737 @kindex info common
14738 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14739 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14740 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14741 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14742 printed.
14743 @end table
14744
14745 @node Pascal
14746 @subsection Pascal
14747
14748 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14749 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14750 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14751 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14752 syntax.
14753
14754 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14755 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14756 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14757
14758 @node Modula-2
14759 @subsection Modula-2
14760
14761 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14762
14763 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14764 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14765 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14766 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14767 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14768 table.
14769
14770 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14771 @menu
14772 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14773 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14774 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14775 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14776 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14777 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14778 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14779 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14780 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14781 @end menu
14782
14783 @node M2 Operators
14784 @subsubsection Operators
14785 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14786
14787 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14788 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14789 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14790 following definitions hold:
14791
14792 @itemize @bullet
14793
14794 @item
14795 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14796 their subranges.
14797
14798 @item
14799 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14800
14801 @item
14802 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14803
14804 @item
14805 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14806 @var{type}}.
14807
14808 @item
14809 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14810
14811 @item
14812 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14813
14814 @item
14815 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14816 @end itemize
14817
14818 @noindent
14819 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14820 increasing precedence:
14821
14822 @table @code
14823 @item ,
14824 Function argument or array index separator.
14825
14826 @item :=
14827 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14828 @var{value}.
14829
14830 @item <@r{, }>
14831 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14832 types.
14833
14834 @item <=@r{, }>=
14835 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14836 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14837 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14838
14839 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14840 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14841 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14842 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14843 comment character.
14844
14845 @item IN
14846 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14847 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14848
14849 @item OR
14850 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14851
14852 @item AND@r{, }&
14853 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14854
14855 @item @@
14856 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14857
14858 @item +@r{, }-
14859 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14860 and difference on set types.
14861
14862 @item *
14863 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14864 on set types.
14865
14866 @item /
14867 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14868 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14869
14870 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14871 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14872 precedence as @code{*}.
14873
14874 @item -
14875 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14876
14877 @item ^
14878 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14879
14880 @item NOT
14881 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14882 @code{^}.
14883
14884 @item .
14885 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14886 precedence as @code{^}.
14887
14888 @item []
14889 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14890
14891 @item ()
14892 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14893 as @code{^}.
14894
14895 @item ::@r{, }.
14896 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14897 @end table
14898
14899 @quotation
14900 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14901 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14902 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14903 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14904 @end quotation
14905
14906
14907 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14908 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14909 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14910
14911 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14912 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14913
14914 @table @var
14915
14916 @item a
14917 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14918
14919 @item c
14920 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14921
14922 @item i
14923 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14924
14925 @item m
14926 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14927 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14928 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14929
14930 @item n
14931 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14932
14933 @item r
14934 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14935
14936 @item t
14937 represents a type.
14938
14939 @item v
14940 represents a variable.
14941
14942 @item x
14943 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14944 explanation of the function for details.
14945 @end table
14946
14947 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14948
14949 @table @code
14950 @item ABS(@var{n})
14951 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14952
14953 @item CAP(@var{c})
14954 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14955 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14956
14957 @item CHR(@var{i})
14958 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14959
14960 @item DEC(@var{v})
14961 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14962
14963 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14964 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14965 new value.
14966
14967 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14968 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14969 set.
14970
14971 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14972 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14973
14974 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14975 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14976
14977 @item INC(@var{v})
14978 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14979
14980 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14981 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14982 new value.
14983
14984 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14985 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14986 there. Returns the new set.
14987
14988 @item MAX(@var{t})
14989 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14990
14991 @item MIN(@var{t})
14992 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14993
14994 @item ODD(@var{i})
14995 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14996
14997 @item ORD(@var{x})
14998 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14999 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15000 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15001 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15002
15003 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15004 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15005 variable or a type.
15006
15007 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15008 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15009
15010 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15011 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15012 variable or a type.
15013
15014 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15015 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15016 @end table
15017
15018 @quotation
15019 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15020 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15021 an error.
15022 @end quotation
15023
15024 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15025 @node M2 Constants
15026 @subsubsection Constants
15027
15028 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15029 ways:
15030
15031 @itemize @bullet
15032
15033 @item
15034 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15035 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15036 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15037 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15038
15039 @item
15040 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15041 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15042 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15043 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15044 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15045 digits.
15046
15047 @item
15048 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15049 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15050 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15051 followed by a @samp{C}.
15052
15053 @item
15054 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15055 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15056 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15057 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15058 sequences.
15059
15060 @item
15061 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15062
15063 @item
15064 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15065 @code{FALSE}.
15066
15067 @item
15068 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15069
15070 @item
15071 Set constants are not yet supported.
15072 @end itemize
15073
15074 @node M2 Types
15075 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15076 @cindex Modula-2 types
15077
15078 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15079 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15080 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15081 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15082 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15083 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15084
15085 The first example contains the following section of code:
15086
15087 @smallexample
15088 VAR
15089 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15090 r: [20..40] ;
15091 @end smallexample
15092
15093 @noindent
15094 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15095 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15096
15097 @smallexample
15098 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15099 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15100 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15101 SET OF CHAR
15102 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15103 21
15104 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15105 [20..40]
15106 @end smallexample
15107
15108 @noindent
15109 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15110
15111 @smallexample
15112 VAR
15113 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15114 @end smallexample
15115
15116 @noindent
15117 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15118
15119 @smallexample
15120 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15121 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15122 @end smallexample
15123
15124 @noindent
15125 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15126 expressions using the debugger.
15127
15128 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15129 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15130
15131 @smallexample
15132 VAR
15133 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15134 @end smallexample
15135
15136 @smallexample
15137 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15138 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15139 @end smallexample
15140
15141 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15142 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15143 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15144 above.
15145
15146 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15147
15148 @smallexample
15149 TYPE
15150 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15151 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15152 VAR
15153 s: t ;
15154 BEGIN
15155 s := blue ;
15156 @end smallexample
15157
15158 @noindent
15159 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15160 and value of a variable.
15161
15162 @smallexample
15163 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15164 $1 = blue
15165 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15166 type = [blue..yellow]
15167 @end smallexample
15168
15169 @noindent
15170 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15171 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15172 their @code{C} counterparts.
15173
15174 @smallexample
15175 VAR
15176 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15177 BEGIN
15178 s[1] := 1 ;
15179 @end smallexample
15180
15181 @smallexample
15182 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15183 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15184 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15185 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15186 @end smallexample
15187
15188 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15189 pointer types as shown in this example:
15190
15191 @smallexample
15192 VAR
15193 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15194 BEGIN
15195 NEW(s) ;
15196 s^[1] := 1 ;
15197 @end smallexample
15198
15199 @noindent
15200 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15201
15202 @smallexample
15203 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15204 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15205 @end smallexample
15206
15207 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15208 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15209 types:
15210
15211 @smallexample
15212 TYPE
15213 foo = RECORD
15214 f1: CARDINAL ;
15215 f2: CHAR ;
15216 f3: myarray ;
15217 END ;
15218
15219 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15220 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15221 VAR
15222 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15223 @end smallexample
15224
15225 @noindent
15226 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15227 below.
15228
15229 @smallexample
15230 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15231 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15232 f1 : CARDINAL;
15233 f2 : CHAR;
15234 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15235 END
15236 @end smallexample
15237
15238 @node M2 Defaults
15239 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15240 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15241
15242 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15243 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15244 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15245 selected the working language.
15246
15247 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15248 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15249 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15250 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15251
15252 @node Deviations
15253 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15254 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15255
15256 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15257 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15258
15259 @itemize @bullet
15260 @item
15261 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15262 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15263 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15264 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15265 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15266 returned a pointer.)
15267
15268 @item
15269 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15270 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15271 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15272 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15273
15274 @item
15275 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15276 argument.
15277
15278 @item
15279 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15280 @end itemize
15281
15282 @node M2 Checks
15283 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15284 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15285
15286 @quotation
15287 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15288 range checking.
15289 @end quotation
15290 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15291
15292 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15293
15294 @itemize @bullet
15295 @item
15296 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15297 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15298
15299 @item
15300 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15301 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15302 @end itemize
15303
15304 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15305 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15306
15307 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15308 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15309
15310 @node M2 Scope
15311 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15312 @cindex scope
15313 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15314 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15315 @ifinfo
15316 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15317 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15318 @end ifinfo
15319 @ifnotinfo
15320 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15321 @end ifnotinfo
15322
15323 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15324 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15325 similar syntax:
15326
15327 @smallexample
15328
15329 @var{module} . @var{id}
15330 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15331 @end smallexample
15332
15333 @noindent
15334 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15335 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15336 identifier within your program, except another module.
15337
15338 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15339 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15340 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15341 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15342
15343 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15344 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15345 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15346 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15347 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15348 @var{module}.
15349
15350 @node GDB/M2
15351 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15352
15353 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15354 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15355 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15356 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15357 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15358 analogue in Modula-2.
15359
15360 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15361 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15362 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15363 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15364 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15365 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15366
15367 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15368 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15369 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15370
15371 @node Ada
15372 @subsection Ada
15373 @cindex Ada
15374
15375 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15376 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15377 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15378 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15379 to be difficult.
15380
15381
15382 @cindex expressions in Ada
15383 @menu
15384 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15385 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15386 in @value{GDBN}.
15387 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15388 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15389 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15390 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15391 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15392 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15393 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15394 Profile
15395 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15396 @end menu
15397
15398 @node Ada Mode Intro
15399 @subsubsection Introduction
15400 @cindex Ada mode, general
15401
15402 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15403 syntax, with some extensions.
15404 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15405
15406 @itemize @bullet
15407 @item
15408 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15409 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15410 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15411 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15412
15413 @item
15414 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15415 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15416
15417 @item
15418 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15419 @end itemize
15420
15421 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15422 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15423 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15424 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15425 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15426
15427 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15428 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15429 was translated from an Ada source file.
15430
15431 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15432 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15433 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15434 middle (to allow based literals).
15435
15436 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15437 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15438 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15439 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15440 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15441 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15442
15443 @node Omissions from Ada
15444 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15445 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15446
15447 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15448
15449 @itemize @bullet
15450 @item
15451 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15452
15453 @itemize @minus
15454 @item
15455 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15456 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15457
15458 @item
15459 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15460
15461 @item
15462 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15463
15464 @item
15465 @t{'Tag}.
15466
15467 @item
15468 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15469 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15470
15471 @item
15472 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15473 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15474
15475 @item
15476 @t{'Address}.
15477 @end itemize
15478
15479 @item
15480 The names in
15481 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15482 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15483 not currently available.
15484
15485 @item
15486 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15487 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15488 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15489 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15490 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15491 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15492 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15493 indeterminate values.
15494
15495 @item
15496 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15497 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15498 are not implemented.
15499
15500 @item
15501 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15502 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15503 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15504 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15505 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15506
15507 @smallexample
15508 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15509 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15510 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15511 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15512 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15513 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15514 @end smallexample
15515
15516 Changing a
15517 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15518 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15519 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15520 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15521 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15522 declared to have a type such as:
15523
15524 @smallexample
15525 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15526 Id : Integer;
15527 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15528 end record;
15529 @end smallexample
15530
15531 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15532 assignments:
15533
15534 @smallexample
15535 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15536 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15537 @end smallexample
15538
15539 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15540 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15541 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15542 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15543 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15544 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15545 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15546 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15547
15548 @item
15549 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15550
15551 @item
15552 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15553 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15554 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15555 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15556 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15557 the proper resolution.
15558
15559 @item
15560 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15561
15562 @item
15563 Entry calls are not implemented.
15564
15565 @item
15566 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15567 formats are not supported.
15568
15569 @item
15570 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15571
15572 @item
15573 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15574 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15575 context.
15576 Should your program
15577 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15578 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15579 @end itemize
15580
15581 @node Additions to Ada
15582 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15583 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15584
15585 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15586 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15587
15588 @itemize @bullet
15589 @item
15590 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15591 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15592 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15593 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15594 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15595 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15596 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15597 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15598
15599 @item
15600 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15601 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15602 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15603
15604 @item
15605 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15606 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15607
15608 @item
15609 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15610 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15611 @end itemize
15612
15613 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15614 additions specific to Ada:
15615
15616 @itemize @bullet
15617 @item
15618 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15619 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15620
15621 @smallexample
15622 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15623 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15624 @end smallexample
15625
15626 @item
15627 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15628 the value of its right-hand operand.
15629 This allows, for example,
15630 complex conditional breaks:
15631
15632 @smallexample
15633 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15634 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15635 @end smallexample
15636
15637 @item
15638 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15639 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15640 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15641 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15642 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15643 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15644 in strings. For example,
15645 @smallexample
15646 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15647 @end smallexample
15648 @noindent
15649 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15650 after each period.
15651
15652 @item
15653 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15654 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15655 to write
15656
15657 @smallexample
15658 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15659 @end smallexample
15660
15661 @item
15662 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15663 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15664 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15665 of 3 might print as
15666
15667 @smallexample
15668 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15669 @end smallexample
15670
15671 @noindent
15672 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15673 clause.
15674
15675 @item
15676 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15677 multi-character subsequence of
15678 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15679 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15680 in place of @t{a'length}.
15681
15682 @item
15683 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15684 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15685 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15686 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15687 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15688 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15689 For example,
15690 @smallexample
15691 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15692 @end smallexample
15693
15694 @item
15695 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15696 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15697 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15698 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15699 object.
15700
15701 @end itemize
15702
15703 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15704 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15705
15706 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15707 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15708 before reaching the main procedure.
15709 As defined in the Ada Reference
15710 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15711 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15712 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15713 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15714
15715 @node Ada Exceptions
15716 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15717
15718 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15719
15720 @table @code
15721 @kindex info exceptions
15722 @item info exceptions
15723 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15724 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15725 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15726 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15727 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15728 @end table
15729
15730 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15731 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15732 argument.
15733
15734 @smallexample
15735 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15736 All defined Ada exceptions:
15737 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15738 program_error: 0x613d20
15739 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15740 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15741 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15742 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15743 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15744 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15745 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15746 @end smallexample
15747
15748 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15749 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15750
15751 @node Ada Tasks
15752 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15753 @cindex Ada, tasking
15754
15755 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15756 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15757
15758 @table @code
15759 @kindex info tasks
15760 @item info tasks
15761 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15762
15763
15764 @smallexample
15765 @iftex
15766 @leftskip=0.5cm
15767 @end iftex
15768 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15769 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15770 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15771 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15772 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15773 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15774
15775 @end smallexample
15776
15777 @noindent
15778 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15779 task currently being inspected.
15780
15781 @table @asis
15782 @item ID
15783 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15784
15785 @item TID
15786 The Ada task ID.
15787
15788 @item P-ID
15789 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15790
15791 @item Pri
15792 The base priority of the task.
15793
15794 @item State
15795 Current state of the task.
15796
15797 @table @code
15798 @item Unactivated
15799 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15800 executing.
15801
15802 @item Runnable
15803 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15804 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15805
15806 @item Terminated
15807 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15808 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15809 terminated themselves.
15810
15811 @item Child Activation Wait
15812 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15813
15814 @item Accept Statement
15815 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15816
15817 @item Waiting on entry call
15818 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15819
15820 @item Async Select Wait
15821 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15822 select statement.
15823
15824 @item Delay Sleep
15825 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15826 alternative open.
15827
15828 @item Child Termination Wait
15829 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15830 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15831 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15832
15833 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15834 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15835 finish terminating.
15836
15837 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15838 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15839 @end table
15840
15841 @item Name
15842 Name of the task in the program.
15843
15844 @end table
15845
15846 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15847 @item info task @var{taskno}
15848 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15849 the following example:
15850 @smallexample
15851 @iftex
15852 @leftskip=0.5cm
15853 @end iftex
15854 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15855 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15856 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15857 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15858 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15859 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15860 Name: task_1
15861 Thread: 0x807f378
15862 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15863 Base Priority: 15
15864 State: Runnable
15865 @end smallexample
15866
15867 @item task
15868 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15869 @cindex current Ada task ID
15870 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15871
15872 @smallexample
15873 @iftex
15874 @leftskip=0.5cm
15875 @end iftex
15876 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15877 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15878 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15879 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15880 (@value{GDBP}) task
15881 [Current task is 2]
15882 @end smallexample
15883
15884 @item task @var{taskno}
15885 @cindex Ada task switching
15886 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15887 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15888 from the current task to the given task.
15889
15890 @smallexample
15891 @iftex
15892 @leftskip=0.5cm
15893 @end iftex
15894 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15895 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15896 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15897 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15898 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15899 [Switching to task 1]
15900 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15901 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15902 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15903 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15904 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15905 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15906 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15907 @end smallexample
15908
15909 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15910 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15911 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15912 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15913 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15914 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15915 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15916 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15917 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15918
15919 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15920 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15921 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15922 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15923 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15924
15925 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15926 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15927 program.
15928
15929 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15930 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15931 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15932
15933 For example,
15934
15935 @smallexample
15936 @iftex
15937 @leftskip=0.5cm
15938 @end iftex
15939 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15940 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15941 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15942 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15943 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15944 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15945 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15946 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15947 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15948 Continuing.
15949 task # 1 running
15950 task # 2 running
15951
15952 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15953 15 flush;
15954 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15955 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15956 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15957 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15958 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15959 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15960 @end smallexample
15961 @end table
15962
15963 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15964 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15965 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15966
15967 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15968 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15969 the platform being used.
15970 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15971 switching is not supported.
15972
15973 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
15974 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15975 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15976 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15977 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15978 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15979
15980 @node Ravenscar Profile
15981 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15982 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15983
15984 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15985 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15986 requirements.
15987
15988 @table @code
15989 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15990 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15991 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15992 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15993 Profile. This is the default.
15994
15995 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15996 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15997 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15998 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15999 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16000 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16001 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16002
16003 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16004 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16005 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16006 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16007
16008 @end table
16009
16010 @node Ada Glitches
16011 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16012 @cindex Ada, problems
16013
16014 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16015 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16016 @value{GDBN},
16017 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16018 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16019
16020 @itemize @bullet
16021 @item
16022 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16023 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16024
16025 @item
16026 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16027 argument lists are treated as positional).
16028
16029 @item
16030 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16031
16032 @item
16033 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16034 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16035 the host machine.
16036
16037 @item
16038 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16039 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16040 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16041 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16042 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16043 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16044 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16045 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16046 you can usually resolve the confusion
16047 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16048 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16049 @end itemize
16050
16051 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16052 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16053 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16054 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16055 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16056 enabled.
16057
16058 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16059 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16060 @table @code
16061
16062 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16063 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16064 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16065 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16066 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16067 This is the default.
16068
16069 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16070 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16071 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16072 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16073 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16074 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16075 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16076
16077 @end table
16078
16079 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16080 @cindex GNAT encoding
16081 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16082 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16083 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16084 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16085 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16086 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16087
16088 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16089 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16090 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16091 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16092 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16093 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16094 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16095 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16096
16097 @table @code
16098
16099 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16100 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16101 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16102 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16103
16104 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16105 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16106 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16107
16108 @end table
16109
16110 @node Unsupported Languages
16111 @section Unsupported Languages
16112
16113 @cindex unsupported languages
16114 @cindex minimal language
16115 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16116 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16117 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16118 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16119 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16120 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16121
16122 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16123 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16124 language.
16125
16126 @node Symbols
16127 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16128
16129 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16130 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16131 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16132 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16133 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16134 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16135 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16136
16137 @cindex symbol names
16138 @cindex names of symbols
16139 @cindex quoting names
16140 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16141 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16142 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16143 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16144 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16145 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16146 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16147 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16148
16149 @smallexample
16150 p 'foo.c'::x
16151 @end smallexample
16152
16153 @noindent
16154 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16155
16156 @table @code
16157 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16158 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16159 @kindex set case-sensitive
16160 @item set case-sensitive on
16161 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16162 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16163 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16164 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16165 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16166 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16167 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16168 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16169 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16170 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16171 case-insensitive matches.
16172
16173 @kindex show case-sensitive
16174 @item show case-sensitive
16175 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16176 lookups.
16177
16178 @kindex set print type methods
16179 @item set print type methods
16180 @itemx set print type methods on
16181 @itemx set print type methods off
16182 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16183 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16184 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16185 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16186 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16187 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16188
16189 @kindex show print type methods
16190 @item show print type methods
16191 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16192 classes.
16193
16194 @kindex set print type typedefs
16195 @item set print type typedefs
16196 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16197 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16198
16199 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16200 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16201 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16202 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16203 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16204 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16205 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16206 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16207 types.
16208
16209 @kindex show print type typedefs
16210 @item show print type typedefs
16211 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16212 printing classes.
16213
16214 @kindex info address
16215 @cindex address of a symbol
16216 @item info address @var{symbol}
16217 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16218 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16219 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16220 is always stored.
16221
16222 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16223 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16224 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16225
16226 @kindex info symbol
16227 @cindex symbol from address
16228 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16229 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16230 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16231 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16232 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16233
16234 @smallexample
16235 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16236 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16237 @end smallexample
16238
16239 @noindent
16240 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16241 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16242
16243 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16244 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16245
16246 @smallexample
16247 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16248 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16249 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16250 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16251 @end smallexample
16252
16253 @kindex demangle
16254 @cindex demangle
16255 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16256 Demangle @var{name}.
16257 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16258 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16259
16260 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16261 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16262
16263 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16264 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16265
16266 @kindex whatis
16267 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16268 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16269 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16270 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16271
16272 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16273 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16274 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16275
16276 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16277 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16278 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16279 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16280 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16281 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16282 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16283 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16284 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16285
16286 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16287 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16288 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16289 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16290 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16291 unroll it.
16292
16293 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16294 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16295 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16296
16297 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16298 Available flags are:
16299
16300 @table @code
16301 @item r
16302 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16303 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16304 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16305
16306 @item m
16307 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16308
16309 @item M
16310 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16311 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16312
16313 @item t
16314 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16315 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16316 names are substituted when printing other types.
16317
16318 @item T
16319 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16320 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16321 @end table
16322
16323 @kindex ptype
16324 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16325 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16326 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16327 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16328
16329 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16330 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16331 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16332 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16333 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16334 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16335 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16336 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16337
16338 For example, for this variable declaration:
16339
16340 @smallexample
16341 typedef double real_t;
16342 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16343 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16344 complex_t var;
16345 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16346 @end smallexample
16347
16348 @noindent
16349 the two commands give this output:
16350
16351 @smallexample
16352 @group
16353 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16354 type = complex_t
16355 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16356 type = struct complex @{
16357 real_t real;
16358 double imag;
16359 @}
16360 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16361 type = struct complex
16362 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16363 type = struct complex
16364 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16365 type = struct complex @{
16366 real_t real;
16367 double imag;
16368 @}
16369 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16370 type = real_t *
16371 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16372 type = double *
16373 @end group
16374 @end smallexample
16375
16376 @noindent
16377 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16378 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16379
16380 @cindex incomplete type
16381 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16382 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16383 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16384 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16385 given these declarations:
16386
16387 @smallexample
16388 struct foo;
16389 struct foo *fooptr;
16390 @end smallexample
16391
16392 @noindent
16393 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16394
16395 @smallexample
16396 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16397 $1 = <incomplete type>
16398 @end smallexample
16399
16400 @noindent
16401 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16402 completely specified.
16403
16404 @kindex info types
16405 @item info types @var{regexp}
16406 @itemx info types
16407 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16408 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16409 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16410 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16411 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16412 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16413 name is @code{value}.
16414
16415 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16416 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16417 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16418
16419 @kindex info type-printers
16420 @item info type-printers
16421 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16422 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16423 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16424 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16425 type printers.
16426
16427 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16428
16429 @kindex enable type-printer
16430 @kindex disable type-printer
16431 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16432 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16433 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16434
16435 @kindex info scope
16436 @cindex local variables
16437 @item info scope @var{location}
16438 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16439 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16440 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16441 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16442 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16443
16444 @smallexample
16445 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16446 Scope for command_line_handler:
16447 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16448 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16449 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16450 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16451 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16452 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16453 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16454 @end smallexample
16455
16456 @noindent
16457 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16458 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16459 collect}.
16460
16461 @kindex info source
16462 @item info source
16463 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16464 the function containing the current point of execution:
16465 @itemize @bullet
16466 @item
16467 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16468 @item
16469 the directory it was compiled in,
16470 @item
16471 its length, in lines,
16472 @item
16473 which programming language it is written in,
16474 @item
16475 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16476 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16477 @item
16478 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16479 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16480 @item
16481 whether the debugging information includes information about
16482 preprocessor macros.
16483 @end itemize
16484
16485
16486 @kindex info sources
16487 @item info sources
16488 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16489 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16490 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16491
16492 @kindex info functions
16493 @item info functions
16494 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16495
16496 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16497 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16498 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16499 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16500 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16501 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16502 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16503 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16504
16505 @kindex info variables
16506 @item info variables
16507 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16508 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16509
16510 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16511 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16512 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16513 @var{regexp}.
16514
16515 @kindex info classes
16516 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16517 @item info classes
16518 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16519 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16520 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16521 expression.
16522
16523 @kindex info selectors
16524 @item info selectors
16525 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16526 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16527 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16528 expression.
16529
16530 @ignore
16531 This was never implemented.
16532 @kindex info methods
16533 @item info methods
16534 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16535 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16536 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16537 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16538 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16539 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16540 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16541 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16542 @end ignore
16543
16544 @cindex opaque data types
16545 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16546 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16547 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16548 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16549 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16550 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16551 another source file. The default is on.
16552
16553 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16554 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16555
16556 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16557 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16558 is printed as follows:
16559 @smallexample
16560 @{<no data fields>@}
16561 @end smallexample
16562
16563 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16564 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16565 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16566
16567 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16568 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16569 @item set print symbol-loading
16570 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16571 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16572 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16573 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16574 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16575 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16576 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16577 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16578 can be annoying.
16579 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16580 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16581 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16582 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16583
16584 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16585 @item show print symbol-loading
16586 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16587 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16588
16589 @kindex maint print symbols
16590 @cindex symbol dump
16591 @kindex maint print psymbols
16592 @cindex partial symbol dump
16593 @kindex maint print msymbols
16594 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16595 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16596 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16597 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16598 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16599 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16600 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16601 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16602 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16603 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16604 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16605 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16606 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16607 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16608 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16609 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16610 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16611 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16612
16613 @kindex maint info symtabs
16614 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16615 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16616 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16617 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16618 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16619 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16620 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16621
16622 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16623 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16624 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16625 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16626 structure in more detail. For example:
16627
16628 @smallexample
16629 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16630 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16631 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16632 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16633 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16634 readin no
16635 fullname (null)
16636 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16637 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16638 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16639 dependencies (none)
16640 @}
16641 @}
16642 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16643 (@value{GDBP})
16644 @end smallexample
16645 @noindent
16646 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16647 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16648 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16649 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16650 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16651
16652 @smallexample
16653 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16654 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16655 line 1574.
16656 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16657 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16658 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16659 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16660 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16661 dirname (null)
16662 fullname (null)
16663 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16664 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16665 debugformat DWARF 2
16666 @}
16667 @}
16668 (@value{GDBP})
16669 @end smallexample
16670
16671 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16672 @cindex symbol cache size
16673 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16674 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16675 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16676 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16677 with different sizes.
16678
16679 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16680 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16681 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16682
16683 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16684 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16685 @item maint print symbol-cache
16686 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16687 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16688
16689 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16690 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16691 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16692 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16693 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16694
16695 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16696 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16697 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16698 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16699 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16700 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16701
16702 @end table
16703
16704 @node Altering
16705 @chapter Altering Execution
16706
16707 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16708 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16709 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16710 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16711 program.
16712
16713 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16714 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16715 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16716
16717 @menu
16718 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16719 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16720 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16721 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16722 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16723 * Patching:: Patching your program
16724 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16725 @end menu
16726
16727 @node Assignment
16728 @section Assignment to Variables
16729
16730 @cindex assignment
16731 @cindex setting variables
16732 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16733 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16734
16735 @smallexample
16736 print x=4
16737 @end smallexample
16738
16739 @noindent
16740 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16741 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16742 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16743 information on operators in supported languages.
16744
16745 @kindex set variable
16746 @cindex variables, setting
16747 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16748 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16749 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16750 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16751 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16752
16753 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16754 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16755 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16756 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16757 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16758 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16759 command @code{set width}:
16760
16761 @smallexample
16762 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16763 type = double
16764 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16765 $4 = 13
16766 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16767 Invalid syntax in expression.
16768 @end smallexample
16769
16770 @noindent
16771 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16772 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16773
16774 @smallexample
16775 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16776 @end smallexample
16777
16778 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16779 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16780 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16781 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16782 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16783 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16784
16785 @smallexample
16786 @group
16787 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16788 type = double
16789 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16790 $1 = 1
16791 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16792 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16793 $2 = 1
16794 (@value{GDBP}) r
16795 The program being debugged has been started already.
16796 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16797 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16798 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16799 Invalid bfd target.
16800 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16801 The current BFD target is "=4".
16802 @end group
16803 @end smallexample
16804
16805 @noindent
16806 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16807 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16808 @code{g}, use
16809
16810 @smallexample
16811 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16812 @end smallexample
16813
16814 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16815 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16816 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16817 same length or shorter.
16818 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16819 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16820
16821 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16822 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16823 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16824 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16825 and representation in memory), and
16826
16827 @smallexample
16828 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16829 @end smallexample
16830
16831 @noindent
16832 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16833
16834 @node Jumping
16835 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16836
16837 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16838 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16839 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16840
16841 @table @code
16842 @kindex jump
16843 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16844 @item jump @var{linespec}
16845 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16846 @itemx jump @var{location}
16847 @itemx j @var{location}
16848 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16849 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16850 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16851 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16852 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16853 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16854
16855 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16856 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16857 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16858 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16859 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16860 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16861 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16862 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16863 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16864 @end table
16865
16866 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16867 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16868 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16869 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16870 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16871 example,
16872
16873 @smallexample
16874 set $pc = 0x485
16875 @end smallexample
16876
16877 @noindent
16878 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16879 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16880 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16881
16882 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16883 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16884 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16885 detail.
16886
16887 @c @group
16888 @node Signaling
16889 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16890 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16891
16892 @table @code
16893 @kindex signal
16894 @item signal @var{signal}
16895 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16896 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16897 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16898 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16899
16900 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16901 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16902 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16903 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16904 signal.
16905
16906 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16907 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16908 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16909 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16910 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16911 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16912 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16913 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16914
16915 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16916 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16917 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16918 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16919 passes the signal directly to your program.
16920
16921 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16922 after executing the command.
16923
16924 @kindex queue-signal
16925 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16926 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16927 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16928 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16929 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16930 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16931 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16932 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16933 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16934
16935 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16936 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16937 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16938 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16939 @code{continue} command.
16940
16941 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16942 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16943 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16944 (@pxref{Signals}).
16945 @end table
16946 @c @end group
16947
16948 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
16949 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
16950
16951 @node Returning
16952 @section Returning from a Function
16953
16954 @table @code
16955 @cindex returning from a function
16956 @kindex return
16957 @item return
16958 @itemx return @var{expression}
16959 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16960 command. If you give an
16961 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16962 value.
16963 @end table
16964
16965 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16966 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16967 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16968 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16969
16970 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16971 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16972 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16973 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16974 of functions.
16975
16976 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16977 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16978 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16979 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16980 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16981
16982 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16983 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16984 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16985 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16986 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16987 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16988 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16989 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16990 assignment into the right register(s).
16991
16992 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16993 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16994 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16995 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16996 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16997 into a @code{long long int}:
16998
16999 @smallexample
17000 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17001 29 return 31;
17002 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17003 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17004 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17005 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17006 (@value{GDBP})
17007 @end smallexample
17008
17009 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17010 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17011 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17012 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17013 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17014 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17015 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17016 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17017
17018 @smallexample
17019 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17020 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17021 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17022 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17023 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17024 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17025 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17026 (@value{GDBP})
17027 @end smallexample
17028
17029 @node Calling
17030 @section Calling Program Functions
17031
17032 @table @code
17033 @cindex calling functions
17034 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17035 @item print @var{expr}
17036 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17037 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17038 debugged.
17039
17040 @kindex call
17041 @item call @var{expr}
17042 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17043 returned values.
17044
17045 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17046 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17047 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17048 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17049 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17050 value history.
17051 @end table
17052
17053 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17054 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17055 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17056 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17057
17058 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17059 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17060 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17061 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17062 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17063 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17064 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17065 in that case is controlled by the
17066 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17067
17068 @table @code
17069 @item set unwindonsignal
17070 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17071 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17072 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17073 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17074 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17075 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17076 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17077 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17078 received.
17079
17080 @item show unwindonsignal
17081 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17082 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17083 @value{GDBN}.
17084
17085 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17086 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17087 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17088 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17089 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17090 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17091 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17092 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17093 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17094 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17095
17096 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17097 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17098 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17099 @value{GDBN}.
17100
17101 @end table
17102
17103 @cindex weak alias functions
17104 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17105 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17106 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17107 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17108 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17109 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17110 function instead.
17111
17112 @node Patching
17113 @section Patching Programs
17114
17115 @cindex patching binaries
17116 @cindex writing into executables
17117 @cindex writing into corefiles
17118
17119 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17120 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17121 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17122 patching your program's binary.
17123
17124 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17125 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17126 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17127 repairs.
17128
17129 @table @code
17130 @kindex set write
17131 @item set write on
17132 @itemx set write off
17133 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17134 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17135 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17136
17137 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17138 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17139 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17140
17141 @item show write
17142 @kindex show write
17143 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17144 as well as reading.
17145 @end table
17146
17147 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17148 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17149 @cindex injecting code
17150 @cindex writing into executables
17151 @cindex compiling code
17152
17153 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17154 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17155 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17156 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17157
17158 @table @code
17159 @kindex compile code
17160 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17161 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17162 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17163 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17164 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17165 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17166 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17167 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17168 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17169 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17170 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17171 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17172
17173 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17174 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17175 E.g.:
17176
17177 @smallexample
17178 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17179 @end smallexample
17180
17181 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17182 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17183 from actual source code. E.g.:
17184
17185 @smallexample
17186 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17187 @end smallexample
17188
17189 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17190 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17191 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17192 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17193 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17194 editor.
17195
17196 @smallexample
17197 compile code
17198 >printf ("hello\n");
17199 >printf ("world\n");
17200 >end
17201 @end smallexample
17202
17203 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17204 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17205 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17206 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17207 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17208 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17209 inferior symbols otherwise.
17210
17211 @kindex compile file
17212 @item compile file @var{filename}
17213 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17214 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17215
17216 @smallexample
17217 compile file /home/user/example.c
17218 @end smallexample
17219 @end table
17220
17221 @noindent
17222 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17223
17224 @table @code
17225 @anchor{set debug compile}
17226 @item set debug compile
17227 @cindex compile command debugging info
17228 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17229 injecting the code. The default is off.
17230
17231 @item show debug compile
17232 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17233 compiling and injecting the code.
17234 @end table
17235
17236 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17237
17238 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17239 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17240 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17241 injecting process.
17242
17243 @noindent
17244 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17245
17246 @table @asis
17247 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17248 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17249 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17250 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17251
17252 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17253 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17254 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17255 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17256 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17257 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17258 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17259 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17260
17261 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17262 @end table
17263
17264 @noindent
17265 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17266
17267 @table @code
17268 @item set compile-args
17269 @cindex compile command options override
17270 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17271 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17272 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17273 compilation.
17274
17275 @item show compile-args
17276 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17277 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17278 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17279 @end table
17280
17281 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17282
17283 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17284 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17285 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17286
17287 @table @asis
17288 @item C code examples and caveats
17289 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17290 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17291 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17292 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17293 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17294
17295 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17296 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17297 much like any other normal debugging session.
17298
17299 @smallexample
17300 void function1 (void)
17301 @{
17302 int i = 42;
17303 printf ("function 1\n");
17304 @}
17305
17306 void function2 (void)
17307 @{
17308 int j = 12;
17309 function1 ();
17310 @}
17311
17312 int main(void)
17313 @{
17314 int k = 6;
17315 int *p;
17316 function2 ();
17317 return 0;
17318 @}
17319 @end smallexample
17320
17321 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17322 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17323 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17324
17325 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17326 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17327 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17328 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17329 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17330
17331 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17332 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17333 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17334 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17335 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17336 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17337 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17338 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17339 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17340 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17341
17342 @smallexample
17343 compile code k = 3;
17344 @end smallexample
17345
17346 @noindent
17347 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17348 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17349 @code{compile} command changes it.
17350
17351 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17352 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17353 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17354 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17355 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17356
17357 @smallexample
17358 compile code j = 3;
17359 @end smallexample
17360
17361 @noindent
17362 will result in a compilation error message.
17363
17364 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17365 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17366 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17367
17368 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17369 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17370 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17371 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17372
17373 @smallexample
17374 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17375 @end smallexample
17376
17377 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17378 command has completed:
17379
17380 @smallexample
17381 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17382 @end smallexample
17383
17384 @noindent
17385 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17386 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17387 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17388 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17389 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17390
17391 @smallexample
17392 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17393 @end smallexample
17394
17395 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17396 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17397 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17398 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17399 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17400 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17401 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17402 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17403
17404 @smallexample
17405 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17406 @end smallexample
17407
17408 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17409 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17410 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17411 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17412 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17413 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17414 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17415
17416 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17417 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17418 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17419 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17420 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17421 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17422
17423 @smallexample
17424 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17425 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17426 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17427 Compilation failed.
17428 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17429 42
17430 @end smallexample
17431
17432 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17433 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17434 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17435 will print to the console.
17436 @end table
17437
17438 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17439
17440 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17441 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17442 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17443 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17444 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17445 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17446 target architecture and operating system.
17447
17448 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17449 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17450 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17451 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17452 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17453 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17454 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17455
17456 @node GDB Files
17457 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17458
17459 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17460 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17461 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17462 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17463
17464 @menu
17465 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17466 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17467 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17468 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17469 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17470 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17471 @end menu
17472
17473 @node Files
17474 @section Commands to Specify Files
17475
17476 @cindex symbol table
17477 @cindex core dump file
17478
17479 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17480 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17481 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17482 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17483
17484 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17485 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17486 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17487 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17488 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17489 new files are useful.
17490
17491 @table @code
17492 @cindex executable file
17493 @kindex file
17494 @item file @var{filename}
17495 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17496 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17497 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17498 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17499 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17500 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17501 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17502 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17503
17504 @cindex unlinked object files
17505 @cindex patching object files
17506 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17507 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17508 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17509 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17510 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17511 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17512 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17513 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17514
17515 @item file
17516 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17517 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17518
17519 @kindex exec-file
17520 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17521 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17522 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17523 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17524 discard information on the executable file.
17525
17526 @kindex symbol-file
17527 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17528 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17529 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17530 table and program to run from the same file.
17531
17532 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17533 program's symbol table.
17534
17535 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17536 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17537 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17538 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17539 @value{GDBN}.
17540
17541 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17542 executing it once.
17543
17544 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17545 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17546 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17547 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17548 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17549 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17550 optimized code.
17551
17552 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17553 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17554 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17555 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17556 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17557
17558 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17559 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17560 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17561 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17562 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17563 Warnings and Messages}.)
17564
17565 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17566 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17567 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17568 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17569 in stabs format.
17570
17571 @kindex readnow
17572 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17573 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17574 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17575 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17576 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17577 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17578 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17579 entire symbol table available.
17580
17581 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17582 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17583 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17584 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17585 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17586 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17587 @c files.
17588
17589 @kindex core-file
17590 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17591 @itemx core
17592 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17593 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17594 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17595 executable file itself for other parts.
17596
17597 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17598 to be used.
17599
17600 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17601 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17602 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17603 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17604 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17605
17606 @kindex add-symbol-file
17607 @cindex dynamic linking
17608 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17609 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17610 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17611 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17612 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17613 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17614 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17615 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17616 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17617 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17618 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17619 @var{address} as an expression.
17620
17621 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17622 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17623 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17624 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17625
17626 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17627
17628 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17629 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17630 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17631 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17632 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17633 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17634 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17635 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17636 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17637
17638 @itemize @bullet
17639 @item
17640 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17641 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17642 @item
17643 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17644 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17645 @item
17646 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17647 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17648 @end itemize
17649
17650 @noindent
17651 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17652 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17653 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17654 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17655 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17656 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17657 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17658 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17659 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17660 way.
17661
17662 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17663
17664 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17665 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17666 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17667 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17668 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17669 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17670
17671 @smallexample
17672 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17673 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17674 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17675 (y or n) y
17676 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17677 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17678 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17679 (gdb)
17680 @end smallexample
17681
17682
17683 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17684
17685 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17686 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17687 @cindex load symbols from memory
17688 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17689 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17690 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17691 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17692 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17693 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17694 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17695 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17696 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17697
17698 @kindex section
17699 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17700 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17701 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17702 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17703 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17704 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17705 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17706 their addresses.
17707
17708 @kindex info files
17709 @kindex info target
17710 @item info files
17711 @itemx info target
17712 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17713 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17714 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17715 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17716 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17717 current ones.
17718
17719 @kindex maint info sections
17720 @item maint info sections
17721 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17722 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17723 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17724 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17725 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17726 may be arbitrarily combined):
17727
17728 @table @code
17729 @item ALLOBJ
17730 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17731 @item @var{sections}
17732 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17733 @item @var{section-flags}
17734 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17735 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17736 @table @code
17737 @item ALLOC
17738 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17739 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17740 @item LOAD
17741 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17742 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17743 @item RELOC
17744 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17745 @item READONLY
17746 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17747 @item CODE
17748 Section contains executable code only.
17749 @item DATA
17750 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17751 @item ROM
17752 Section will reside in ROM.
17753 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17754 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17755 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17756 Section is not empty.
17757 @item NEVER_LOAD
17758 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17759 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17760 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17761 COFF shared library information.
17762 @item IS_COMMON
17763 Section contains common symbols.
17764 @end table
17765 @end table
17766 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17767 @cindex read-only sections
17768 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17769 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17770 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17771 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17772 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17773 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17774 enhancement to debugging performance.
17775
17776 The default is off.
17777
17778 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17779 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17780 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17781 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17782
17783 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17784 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17785 @end table
17786
17787 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17788 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17789 name and remembers it that way.
17790
17791 @cindex shared libraries
17792 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17793 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17794 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17795
17796 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17797 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17798
17799 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17800 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17801 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17802 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17803 debugging a core file).
17804
17805 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17806 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17807
17808 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17809 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17810 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17811
17812 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17813 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17814 particularly large or there are many of them.
17815
17816 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17817 commands:
17818
17819 @table @code
17820 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17821 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17822 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17823 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17824 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17825 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17826 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17827 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17828
17829 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17830 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17831 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17832 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17833 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17834 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17835 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17836 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17837 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17838
17839 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17840 @item show auto-solib-add
17841 Display the current autoloading mode.
17842 @end table
17843
17844 @cindex load shared library
17845 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17846 command:
17847
17848 @table @code
17849 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17850 @kindex info share
17851 @item info share @var{regex}
17852 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17853 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17854 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17855 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17856
17857 @kindex sharedlibrary
17858 @kindex share
17859 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17860 @itemx share @var{regex}
17861 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17862 Unix regular expression.
17863 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17864 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17865 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17866 loaded.
17867
17868 @item nosharedlibrary
17869 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17870 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17871 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17872 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17873 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17874 discarded.
17875 @end table
17876
17877 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17878 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17879 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17880 Catchpoints}).
17881
17882 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17883 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17884 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17885 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17886
17887 @table @code
17888 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17889 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17890 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17891 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17892 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17893 shared library.
17894
17895 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17896 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17897 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17898 library events happen.
17899 @end table
17900
17901 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17902 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17903 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17904 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17905 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17906 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17907 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17908 not.
17909
17910 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17911 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17912 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17913 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17914 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17915
17916 @table @code
17917 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
17918 @cindex system root, alternate
17919 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17920 @kindex set sysroot
17921 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17922 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17923 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17924 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17925 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
17926 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
17927 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
17928 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
17929 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
17930 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
17931 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
17932 @var{path}.
17933
17934 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
17935 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
17936 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
17937 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
17938 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
17939 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
17940 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
17941 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
17942 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
17943 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
17944 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
17945 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
17946 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
17947 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
17948
17949 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17950 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17951 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17952 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17953 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17954
17955 @smallexample
17956 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17957 @end smallexample
17958
17959 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17960 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17961 system:
17962
17963 @smallexample
17964 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17965 @end smallexample
17966
17967 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17968 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17969 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17970 colons:
17971
17972 @smallexample
17973 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17974 @end smallexample
17975
17976 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17977 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17978 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17979 @samp{z}):
17980
17981 @smallexample
17982 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17983 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17984 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17985 @end smallexample
17986
17987 @noindent
17988 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17989 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17990 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17991
17992 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
17993 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17994
17995 @smallexample
17996 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17997 @end smallexample
17998
17999 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18000 if you don't want or need to.
18001
18002 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18003 sysroot}.
18004
18005 @cindex default system root
18006 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18007 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18008 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18009 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18010 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18011 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18012 location.
18013
18014 @kindex show sysroot
18015 @item show sysroot
18016 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18017
18018 @kindex set solib-search-path
18019 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18020 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18021 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18022 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18023 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18024 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18025 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18026 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18027 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18028 of shared library symbols.
18029
18030 @kindex show solib-search-path
18031 @item show solib-search-path
18032 Display the current shared library search path.
18033
18034 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18035 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18036 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18037 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18038 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18039
18040 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18041 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18042 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18043 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18044 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18045 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18046 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18047 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18048 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18049 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18050 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18051 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18052 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18053 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18054 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18055 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18056 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18057 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18058 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18059 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18060 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18061 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18062
18063 @table @code
18064 @item unix
18065 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18066 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18067 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18068 the forward slash.
18069
18070 @item dos-based
18071 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18072 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18073 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18074 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18075 considered directory separators.
18076
18077 @item auto
18078 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18079 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18080 This is the default.
18081 @end table
18082 @end table
18083
18084 @cindex file name canonicalization
18085 @cindex base name differences
18086 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18087 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18088 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18089 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18090 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18091 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18092 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18093 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18094 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18095 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18096 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18097 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18098 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18099 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18100 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18101
18102 @table @code
18103 @item set basenames-may-differ
18104 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18105 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18106
18107 @item show basenames-may-differ
18108 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18109 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18110 @end table
18111
18112 @node Separate Debug Files
18113 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18114 @cindex separate debugging information files
18115 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18116 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18117 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18118 @cindex global debugging information directories
18119 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18120 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18121
18122 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18123 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18124 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18125 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18126 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18127 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18128 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18129
18130 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18131 file:
18132
18133 @itemize @bullet
18134 @item
18135 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18136 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18137 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18138 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18139 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18140 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18141 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18142 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18143
18144 @item
18145 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18146 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18147 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
18148 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18149 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18150 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18151 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18152 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18153 below.
18154 @end itemize
18155
18156 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18157 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18158
18159 @itemize @bullet
18160 @item
18161 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18162 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18163 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18164 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18165 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18166
18167 @item
18168 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18169 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18170 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18171 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18172 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18173 hex characters, not 10.)
18174 @end itemize
18175
18176 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18177 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18178 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18179 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18180 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18181 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18182
18183 @itemize @minus
18184 @item
18185 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18186 @item
18187 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18188 @item
18189 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18190 @item
18191 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18192 @end itemize
18193
18194 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18195 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18196 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18197 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18198 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18199
18200 @table @code
18201
18202 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18203 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18204 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18205 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18206 concatenating them by a path separator.
18207
18208 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18209 @item show debug-file-directory
18210 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18211 information files.
18212
18213 @end table
18214
18215 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18216 @cindex debug link sections
18217 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18218 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18219
18220 @itemize
18221 @item
18222 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18223 a zero byte,
18224 @item
18225 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18226 boundary within the section, and
18227 @item
18228 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18229 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18230 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18231 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18232 @end itemize
18233
18234 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18235 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18236 described above.
18237
18238 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18239 @cindex build ID sections
18240 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18241 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18242 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18243 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18244 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18245 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18246 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18247 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18248 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18249
18250 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18251 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18252 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18253 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18254 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18255 in an ordinary executable.
18256
18257 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18258 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18259 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18260 following commands:
18261
18262 @smallexample
18263 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18264 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18265 @end smallexample
18266
18267 @noindent
18268 These commands remove the debugging
18269 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18270 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18271 two files:
18272
18273 @itemize @bullet
18274 @item
18275 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18276 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18277
18278 @smallexample
18279 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18280 @end smallexample
18281
18282 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18283 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18284 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18285 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18286
18287 @item
18288 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18289 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18290 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18291 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18292 @end itemize
18293
18294 @noindent
18295
18296 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18297 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18298 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18299
18300 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18301 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18302 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18303 @c different ways!
18304 @ifhtml
18305 @display
18306 @html
18307 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18308 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18309 @end html
18310 @end display
18311 @end ifhtml
18312 @ifnothtml
18313 @display
18314 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18315 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18316 @end display
18317 @end ifnothtml
18318
18319 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18320 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18321 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18322 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18323 CRC.
18324
18325 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18326 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18327 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18328 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18329 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18330
18331 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18332 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18333 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18334 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18335 @code{0xffffffff}.
18336
18337 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18338 @smallexample
18339 unsigned long
18340 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18341 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18342 @{
18343 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18344 @{
18345 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18346 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18347 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18348 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18349 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18350 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18351 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18352 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18353 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18354 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18355 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18356 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18357 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18358 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18359 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18360 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18361 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18362 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18363 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18364 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18365 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18366 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18367 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18368 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18369 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18370 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18371 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18372 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18373 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18374 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18375 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18376 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18377 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18378 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18379 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18380 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18381 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18382 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18383 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18384 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18385 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18386 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18387 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18388 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18389 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18390 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18391 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18392 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18393 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18394 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18395 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18396 0x2d02ef8d
18397 @};
18398 unsigned char *end;
18399
18400 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18401 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18402 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18403 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18404 @}
18405 @end smallexample
18406
18407 @noindent
18408 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18409
18410 @node MiniDebugInfo
18411 @section Debugging information in a special section
18412 @cindex separate debug sections
18413 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18414
18415 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18416 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18417 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18418 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18419
18420 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18421 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18422 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18423 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18424 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18425 debugging information might be included in the section.
18426
18427 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18428 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18429 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18430
18431 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18432 standard utilities:
18433
18434 @smallexample
18435 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18436 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18437 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18438 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18439
18440 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18441 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18442 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18443 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18444 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18445 | sort > funcsyms
18446
18447 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18448 # table.
18449 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18450
18451 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18452 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18453
18454 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18455 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18456 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18457 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18458
18459 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18460 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18461
18462 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18463 # original binary.
18464 xz mini_debuginfo
18465 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18466 @end smallexample
18467
18468 @node Index Files
18469 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18470 @cindex index files
18471 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18472
18473 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18474 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18475 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18476 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18477 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18478 startup.
18479
18480 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18481 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18482 using @command{objcopy}.
18483
18484 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18485
18486 @table @code
18487 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18488 @kindex save gdb-index
18489 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18490 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18491 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18492 @var{directory}.
18493 @end table
18494
18495 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18496 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18497
18498 @smallexample
18499 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18500 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18501 @end smallexample
18502
18503 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18504 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18505 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18506 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18507 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18508 The default is @code{off}.
18509 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18510 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18511
18512 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18513 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18514
18515 @smallexample
18516 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18517 @end smallexample
18518
18519 Instead you must do, for example,
18520
18521 @smallexample
18522 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18523 @end smallexample
18524
18525 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18526 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18527 currently work for programs using Ada.
18528
18529 @node Symbol Errors
18530 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18531
18532 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18533 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18534 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18535 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18536 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18537 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18538 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18539 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18540 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18541 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18542 Messages}).
18543
18544 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18545
18546 @table @code
18547 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18548
18549 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18550 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18551 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18552 in its outer scope blocks.
18553
18554 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18555 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18556 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18557 function.
18558
18559 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18560
18561 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18562 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18563 do so.
18564
18565 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18566 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18567 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18568 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18569 Messages}.)
18570
18571 @item bad block start address patched
18572
18573 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18574 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18575 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18576
18577 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18578 starting on the previous source line.
18579
18580 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18581
18582 @cindex foo
18583 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18584 larger than the size of the string table.
18585
18586 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18587 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18588 with this name.
18589
18590 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18591
18592 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18593 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18594 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18595
18596 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18597 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18598 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18599 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18600 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18601 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18602
18603 @item stub type has NULL name
18604
18605 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18606
18607 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18608 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18609 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18610 it.
18611
18612 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18613
18614 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18615
18616 @end table
18617
18618 @node Data Files
18619 @section GDB Data Files
18620
18621 @cindex prefix for data files
18622 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18623 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18624
18625 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18626 is currently using.
18627
18628 @table @code
18629 @kindex set data-directory
18630 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18631 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18632 to @var{directory}.
18633
18634 @kindex show data-directory
18635 @item show data-directory
18636 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18637 @end table
18638
18639 @cindex default data directory
18640 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18641 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18642 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18643 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18644 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18645 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18646 location.
18647
18648 The data directory may also be specified with the
18649 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18650 @xref{Mode Options}.
18651
18652 @node Targets
18653 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18654
18655 @cindex debugging target
18656 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18657
18658 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18659 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18660 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18661 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18662 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18663 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18664 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18665 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18666
18667 @cindex target architecture
18668 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18669 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18670 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18671 command.
18672
18673 @table @code
18674 @kindex set architecture
18675 @kindex show architecture
18676 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18677 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18678 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18679 supported architectures.
18680
18681 @item show architecture
18682 Show the current target architecture.
18683
18684 @item set processor
18685 @itemx processor
18686 @kindex set processor
18687 @kindex show processor
18688 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18689 and @code{show architecture}.
18690 @end table
18691
18692 @menu
18693 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18694 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18695 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18696 @end menu
18697
18698 @node Active Targets
18699 @section Active Targets
18700
18701 @cindex stacking targets
18702 @cindex active targets
18703 @cindex multiple targets
18704
18705 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18706 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18707 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18708 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18709 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18710 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18711 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18712 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18713 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18714
18715 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18716 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18717 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18718 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18719
18720 @node Target Commands
18721 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18722
18723 @table @code
18724 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18725 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18726 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18727 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18728 protocol of the target machine.
18729
18730 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18731 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18732 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18733
18734 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18735 after executing the command.
18736
18737 @kindex help target
18738 @item help target
18739 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18740 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18741 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18742
18743 @item help target @var{name}
18744 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18745 select it.
18746
18747 @kindex set gnutarget
18748 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18749 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18750 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18751 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18752 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18753 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18754
18755 @quotation
18756 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18757 you must know the actual BFD name.
18758 @end quotation
18759
18760 @noindent
18761 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18762
18763 @kindex show gnutarget
18764 @item show gnutarget
18765 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18766 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18767 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18768 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18769 @end table
18770
18771 @cindex common targets
18772 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18773 configuration):
18774
18775 @table @code
18776 @kindex target
18777 @item target exec @var{program}
18778 @cindex executable file target
18779 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18780 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18781
18782 @item target core @var{filename}
18783 @cindex core dump file target
18784 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18785 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18786
18787 @item target remote @var{medium}
18788 @cindex remote target
18789 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18790 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18791 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18792
18793 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18794 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18795
18796 @smallexample
18797 target remote /dev/ttya
18798 @end smallexample
18799
18800 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18801 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18802 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18803 clobbered by the download.
18804
18805 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18806 @cindex built-in simulator target
18807 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18808 In general,
18809 @smallexample
18810 target sim
18811 load
18812 run
18813 @end smallexample
18814 @noindent
18815 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18816 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18817 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18818 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18819 Processors}.
18820
18821 @item target native
18822 @cindex native target
18823 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18824 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18825 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18826 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18827
18828 @end table
18829
18830 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18831 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18832
18833 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18834 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18835 various aspects of this process.
18836
18837 @table @code
18838
18839 @item set hash
18840 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18841 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18842 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18843 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18844 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18845 monitor.
18846
18847 @item show hash
18848 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18849 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18850
18851 @item set debug monitor
18852 @kindex set debug monitor
18853 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18854 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18855 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18856
18857 @item show debug monitor
18858 @kindex show debug monitor
18859 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18860 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18861 @end table
18862
18863 @table @code
18864
18865 @kindex load @var{filename}
18866 @item load @var{filename}
18867 @anchor{load}
18868 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18869 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18870 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18871 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18872 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18873 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18874
18875 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18876 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18877 target is @dots{}}''
18878
18879 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18880 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18881 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18882 specifies a fixed address.
18883 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18884
18885 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18886 load programs into flash memory.
18887
18888 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18889 @end table
18890
18891 @node Byte Order
18892 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18893
18894 @cindex choosing target byte order
18895 @cindex target byte order
18896
18897 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18898 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18899 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18900 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18901 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18902 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18903
18904 @table @code
18905 @kindex set endian
18906 @item set endian big
18907 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18908
18909 @item set endian little
18910 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18911
18912 @item set endian auto
18913 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18914 executable.
18915
18916 @item show endian
18917 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18918
18919 @end table
18920
18921 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18922 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18923 target system.
18924
18925
18926 @node Remote Debugging
18927 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18928 @cindex remote debugging
18929
18930 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18931 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18932 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18933 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18934 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18935
18936 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18937 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18938 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18939 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18940 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18941 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18942
18943 Other remote targets may be available in your
18944 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18945
18946 @menu
18947 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18948 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18949 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18950 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18951 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18952 @end menu
18953
18954 @node Connecting
18955 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18956
18957 @value{GDBN} needs an unstripped copy of your program to access symbol
18958 and debugging information. Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer
18959 executable filename read}, and @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow
18960 @value{GDBN} to access program files over the same connection used to
18961 communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a target, if the remote
18962 program is unstripped, the only command you need is @code{target
18963 remote}. Otherwise, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
18964 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
18965 @code{file} command.
18966
18967 @cindex @code{target remote}
18968 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18969 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18970 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18971 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18972 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18973 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18974
18975 @table @code
18976
18977 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18978 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18979 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18980 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18981
18982 @smallexample
18983 target remote /dev/ttyb
18984 @end smallexample
18985
18986 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18987 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18988 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18989 @code{target} command.
18990
18991 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18992 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18993 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18994 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18995 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18996 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18997 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18998 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18999 target.
19000
19001 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19002 @code{manyfarms}:
19003
19004 @smallexample
19005 target remote manyfarms:2828
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19009 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19010 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19011 port 1234 on your local machine:
19012
19013 @smallexample
19014 target remote :1234
19015 @end smallexample
19016 @noindent
19017
19018 Note that the colon is still required here.
19019
19020 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19021 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19022 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19023 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19024
19025 @smallexample
19026 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19027 @end smallexample
19028
19029 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19030 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19031 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19032 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19033
19034 @item target remote | @var{command}
19035 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19036 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19037 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19038 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19039 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19040 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19041 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19042 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19043
19044 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19045 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19046 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19047
19048 @end table
19049
19050 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
19051 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
19052 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
19053 need to use @kbd{run}.
19054
19055 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19056 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19057 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19058 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19059 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19060 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19061 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19065 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19066 @end smallexample
19067
19068 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
19069 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
19070 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
19071 goes back to waiting.
19072
19073 @table @code
19074 @kindex detach (remote)
19075 @item detach
19076 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19077 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19078 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19079 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19080 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
19081
19082 @kindex disconnect
19083 @item disconnect
19084 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
19085 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19086 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19087 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19088 another target.
19089
19090 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19091 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19092 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19093 @kindex monitor
19094 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19095 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19096 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19097 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19098 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19099 and implement.
19100 @end table
19101
19102 @node File Transfer
19103 @section Sending files to a remote system
19104 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19105 @cindex file transfer
19106 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19107
19108 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19109 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19110 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19111 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19112 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19113 the only way to upload or download files.
19114
19115 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19116
19117 @table @code
19118 @kindex remote put
19119 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19120 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19121 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19122
19123 @kindex remote get
19124 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19125 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19126 on the host system.
19127
19128 @kindex remote delete
19129 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19130 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19131
19132 @end table
19133
19134 @node Server
19135 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19136
19137 @kindex gdbserver
19138 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19139 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19140 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19141 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
19142
19143 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19144 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19145 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19146 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19147 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19148 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19149 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19150 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19151 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19152 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19153 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19154 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19155 choice for debugging.
19156
19157 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19158 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19159 protocol.
19160
19161 @quotation
19162 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19163 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19164 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19165 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19166 @code{gdbserver}.
19167 @end quotation
19168
19169 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19170 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19171 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19172
19173 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19174 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19175 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19176 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19177 system does all the symbol handling.
19178
19179 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19180 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19181 syntax is:
19182
19183 @smallexample
19184 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19185 @end smallexample
19186
19187 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19188 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19189 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19190 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19191 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19192 @file{/dev/com1}:
19193
19194 @smallexample
19195 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19196 @end smallexample
19197
19198 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19199 with it.
19200
19201 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19202
19203 @smallexample
19204 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19205 @end smallexample
19206
19207 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19208 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19209 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19210 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19211 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19212 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19213 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19214 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19215 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19216 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19217 @code{target remote} command.
19218
19219 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19220 with ssh:
19221
19222 @smallexample
19223 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19224 @end smallexample
19225
19226 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19227 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19228 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19229 You could elide it if you want to.
19230
19231 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19232 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19233 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19234 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19235
19236 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19237 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19238 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19239
19240 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19241 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19242
19243 @smallexample
19244 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19245 @end smallexample
19246
19247 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19248 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19249
19250 @pindex pidof
19251 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19252 @code{pidof} utility:
19253
19254 @smallexample
19255 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19256 @end smallexample
19257
19258 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19259 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19260 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19261
19262 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19263 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19264 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19265
19266 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19267 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19268 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19269 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19270
19271 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19272 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19273 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19274 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19275 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19276 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19277 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19278 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19279 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19280
19281 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19282 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19283 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19284 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19285 the program you want to debug.
19286
19287 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19288 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19289 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19290 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19291 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19292 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19293
19294 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19295
19296 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19297
19298 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19299 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19300 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19301 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19302 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19303 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19304 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19305 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19306
19307 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19308 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19309 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19310
19311 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19312 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19313 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19314 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19315 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19316 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19317 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19318 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19319 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19320 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19321 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19322 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19323
19324 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19325 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19326
19327 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19328 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19329 status information about the debugging process.
19330 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19331 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19332 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19333 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19334
19335 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19336 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19337 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19338 Possible options are:
19339
19340 @table @code
19341 @item none
19342 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19343 @item all
19344 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19345 @item timestamps
19346 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19347 @end table
19348
19349 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19350 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19351
19352 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19353 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19354 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19355 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19356 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19357
19358 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19359 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19360 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19361 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19362
19363 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19364 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19365 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19366 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19367
19368 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19369 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19370 environment:
19371
19372 @smallexample
19373 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19374 @end smallexample
19375
19376 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19377
19378 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19379
19380 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19381 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19382 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19383 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19384
19385 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19386 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19387 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19388 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19389 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19390 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19391 programs.
19392
19393 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19394 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19395 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19396 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19397 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19398 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19399 already on the target.
19400
19401 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19402 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19403 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19404
19405 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19406 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19407 Here are the available commands.
19408
19409 @table @code
19410 @item monitor help
19411 List the available monitor commands.
19412
19413 @item monitor set debug 0
19414 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19415 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19416
19417 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19418 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19419 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19420 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19421
19422 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19423 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19424 Possible options are:
19425
19426 @table @code
19427 @item none
19428 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19429 @item all
19430 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19431 @item timestamps
19432 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19433 @end table
19434
19435 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19436 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19437
19438 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19439 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19440 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19441 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19442 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19443 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19444
19445 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19446 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19447
19448 @item monitor exit
19449 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19450 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19451 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19452 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19453 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19454
19455 @end table
19456
19457 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19458 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19459
19460 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19461 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19462
19463 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19464 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19465 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19466 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19467 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19468 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19469 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19470 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19471 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19472 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19473 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19474 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19475
19476 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19477
19478 @table @code
19479 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19480
19481 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19482 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19483 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19484
19485 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19486
19487 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19488 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19489 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19490 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19491 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19492 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19493
19494 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19495
19496 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19497 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19498 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19499 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19500 command for that. For example:
19501
19502 @smallexample
19503 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19504 @end smallexample
19505
19506 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19507 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19508 @end table
19509
19510 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19511 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19512 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19513 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19514 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19515 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19516 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19517 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19518 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19519 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19520
19521 @smallexample
19522 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19523 @end smallexample
19524
19525 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19526
19527 @smallexample
19528 $ gdb myprogram
19529 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19530 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19531 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19532 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19533 @end smallexample
19534
19535 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19536 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19537 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19538 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19539 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19540 tracing.
19541
19542 @node Remote Configuration
19543 @section Remote Configuration
19544
19545 @kindex set remote
19546 @kindex show remote
19547 This section documents the configuration options available when
19548 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19549 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19550 system-call-allowed}.
19551
19552 @table @code
19553 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19554 @cindex address size for remote targets
19555 @cindex bits in remote address
19556 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19557 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19558 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19559 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19560
19561 @item show remoteaddresssize
19562 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19563
19564 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19565 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19566 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19567 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19568 remote targets.
19569
19570 @item show serial baud
19571 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19572
19573 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19574 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19575 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19576
19577 @item show serial parity
19578 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19579
19580 @item set remotebreak
19581 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19582 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19583 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19584 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19585 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19586 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19587 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19588 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19589
19590 @item show remotebreak
19591 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19592 interrupt the remote program.
19593
19594 @item set remoteflow on
19595 @itemx set remoteflow off
19596 @kindex set remoteflow
19597 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19598 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19599
19600 @item show remoteflow
19601 @kindex show remoteflow
19602 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19603
19604 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19605 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19606 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19607 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19608 @code{ascii}.
19609
19610 @item show remotelogbase
19611 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19612 protocol.
19613
19614 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19615 @cindex record serial communications on file
19616 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19617 default is not to record at all.
19618
19619 @item show remotelogfile.
19620 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19621 serial communications.
19622
19623 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19624 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19625 @cindex remote timeout
19626 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19627 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19628
19629 @item show remotetimeout
19630 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19631 responses.
19632
19633 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19634 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19635 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19636 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19637 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19638 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19639 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19640 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19641
19642 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19643 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19644 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19645 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19646 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19647 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19648 as unlimited.
19649
19650 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19651 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19652 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19653
19654 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19655 @itemx show remote exec-file
19656 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19657 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19658 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19659 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19660 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19661 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19662
19663 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19664 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19665 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19666 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19667 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19668 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19669 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19670 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19671 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19672 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19673
19674 @item show interrupt-sequence
19675 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19676 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19677 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19678 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19679
19680 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19681 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19682 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19683 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19684 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19685 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19686
19687 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19688 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19689 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19690
19691 @kindex set tcp
19692 @kindex show tcp
19693 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19694 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19695 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19696 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19697 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19698 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19699 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19700 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19701 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19702
19703 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19704 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19705
19706 @item show tcp auto-retry
19707 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19708
19709 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19710 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19711 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19712 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19713 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19714 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19715 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19716 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19717 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19718 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19719 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19720
19721 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19722 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19723 @end table
19724
19725 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19726 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19727 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19728 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19729 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19730 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19731 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19732 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19733 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19734
19735 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19736 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19737 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19738 @value{GDBN} developers.
19739
19740 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19741 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19742 are:
19743
19744 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19745 @item Command Name
19746 @tab Remote Packet
19747 @tab Related Features
19748
19749 @item @code{fetch-register}
19750 @tab @code{p}
19751 @tab @code{info registers}
19752
19753 @item @code{set-register}
19754 @tab @code{P}
19755 @tab @code{set}
19756
19757 @item @code{binary-download}
19758 @tab @code{X}
19759 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19760
19761 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19762 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19763 @tab @code{info auxv}
19764
19765 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19766 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19767 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19768
19769 @item @code{attach}
19770 @tab @code{vAttach}
19771 @tab @code{attach}
19772
19773 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19774 @tab @code{vCont}
19775 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19776
19777 @item @code{run}
19778 @tab @code{vRun}
19779 @tab @code{run}
19780
19781 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19782 @tab @code{Z0}
19783 @tab @code{break}
19784
19785 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19786 @tab @code{Z1}
19787 @tab @code{hbreak}
19788
19789 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19790 @tab @code{Z2}
19791 @tab @code{watch}
19792
19793 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19794 @tab @code{Z3}
19795 @tab @code{rwatch}
19796
19797 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19798 @tab @code{Z4}
19799 @tab @code{awatch}
19800
19801 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
19802 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
19803 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
19804
19805 @item @code{target-features}
19806 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19807 @tab @code{set architecture}
19808
19809 @item @code{library-info}
19810 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19811 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19812
19813 @item @code{memory-map}
19814 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19815 @tab @code{info mem}
19816
19817 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19818 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19819 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19820
19821 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19822 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19823 @tab @code{info spu}
19824
19825 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19826 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19827 @tab @code{info spu}
19828
19829 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19830 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19831 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19832
19833 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19834 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19835 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19836
19837 @item @code{threads}
19838 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19839 @tab @code{info threads}
19840
19841 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19842 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19843 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19844
19845 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19846 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19847 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19848
19849 @item @code{search-memory}
19850 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19851 @tab @code{find}
19852
19853 @item @code{supported-packets}
19854 @tab @code{qSupported}
19855 @tab Remote communications parameters
19856
19857 @item @code{pass-signals}
19858 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19859 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19860
19861 @item @code{program-signals}
19862 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19863 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19864
19865 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19866 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19867 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19868
19869 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19870 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19871 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19872
19873 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19874 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19875 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19876
19877 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19878 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19879 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19880
19881 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19882 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19883 @tab @code{remote delete}
19884
19885 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19886 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19887 @tab Host I/O
19888
19889 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
19890 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
19891 @tab Host I/O
19892
19893 @item @code{noack-packet}
19894 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19895 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19896
19897 @item @code{osdata}
19898 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19899 @tab @code{info os}
19900
19901 @item @code{query-attached}
19902 @tab @code{qAttached}
19903 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19904
19905 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19906 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19907 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19908
19909 @item @code{trace-status}
19910 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19911 @tab @code{tstatus}
19912
19913 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19914 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19915 @tab Traceframe info
19916
19917 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19918 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19919 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19920
19921 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19922 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19923 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19924
19925 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19926 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19927 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19928
19929 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
19930 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
19931 @tab @code{break}
19932
19933 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
19934 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
19935 @tab @code{hbreak}
19936
19937 @end multitable
19938
19939 @node Remote Stub
19940 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19941
19942 @cindex debugging stub, example
19943 @cindex remote stub, example
19944 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19945 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19946 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19947 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19948 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19949 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19950 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19951 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19952
19953 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19954 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19955 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19956 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19957 program, you need:
19958
19959 @enumerate
19960 @item
19961 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19962 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19963 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19964
19965 @item
19966 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19967 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19968
19969 @item
19970 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19971 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19972 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19973 documentation.
19974 @end enumerate
19975
19976 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19977 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19978 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19979
19980 @table @emph
19981 @item On the host,
19982 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19983 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19984 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19985
19986 @item On the target,
19987 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19988 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19989 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19990
19991 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19992 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19993 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19994 @end table
19995
19996 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19997 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19998 @sc{sparc} boards.
19999
20000 @cindex remote serial stub list
20001 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20002
20003 @table @code
20004
20005 @item i386-stub.c
20006 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20007 @cindex Intel
20008 @cindex i386
20009 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20010
20011 @item m68k-stub.c
20012 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20013 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20014 @cindex m680x0
20015 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20016
20017 @item sh-stub.c
20018 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20019 @cindex Renesas
20020 @cindex SH
20021 For Renesas SH architectures.
20022
20023 @item sparc-stub.c
20024 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20025 @cindex Sparc
20026 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20027
20028 @item sparcl-stub.c
20029 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20030 @cindex Fujitsu
20031 @cindex SparcLite
20032 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20033
20034 @end table
20035
20036 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20037 recently added stubs.
20038
20039 @menu
20040 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20041 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20042 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20043 @end menu
20044
20045 @node Stub Contents
20046 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20047
20048 @cindex remote serial stub
20049 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20050 subroutines:
20051
20052 @table @code
20053 @item set_debug_traps
20054 @findex set_debug_traps
20055 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20056 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20057 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20058 program's startup code.
20059
20060 @item handle_exception
20061 @findex handle_exception
20062 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20063 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20064 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20065 run when a trap is triggered.
20066
20067 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20068 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20069 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20070 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20071 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20072 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20073 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20074 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20075 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20076 machine.
20077
20078 @item breakpoint
20079 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20080 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20081 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20082 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20083 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20084 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20085 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20086 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20087 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20088 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20089 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20090
20091 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20092 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20093 start of your debugging session.
20094 @end table
20095
20096 @node Bootstrapping
20097 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20098
20099 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20100 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20101 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20102 debugging target machine.
20103
20104 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20105 serial port.
20106
20107 @table @code
20108 @item int getDebugChar()
20109 @findex getDebugChar
20110 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20111 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20112 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20113
20114 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20115 @findex putDebugChar
20116 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20117 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20118 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20119 @end table
20120
20121 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20122 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20123 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20124 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20125 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20126 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20127 remote system to stop.
20128
20129 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20130 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20131 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20132 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20133
20134 Other routines you need to supply are:
20135
20136 @table @code
20137 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20138 @findex exceptionHandler
20139 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20140 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20141 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20142 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20143 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20144 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20145 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20146 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20147 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20148 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20149 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20150 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20151 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20152
20153 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20154 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20155 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20156 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20157 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20158
20159 @item void flush_i_cache()
20160 @findex flush_i_cache
20161 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20162 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20163 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20164
20165 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20166 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20167 @end table
20168
20169 @noindent
20170 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20171
20172 @table @code
20173 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20174 @findex memset
20175 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20176 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20177 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20178 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20179 @end table
20180
20181 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20182 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20183 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20184 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20185
20186
20187 @node Debug Session
20188 @subsection Putting it All Together
20189
20190 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20191 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20192 steps.
20193
20194 @enumerate
20195 @item
20196 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20197 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20198 @display
20199 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20200 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20201 @end display
20202
20203 @item
20204 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20205 procedure is called:
20206
20207 @smallexample
20208 set_debug_traps();
20209 breakpoint();
20210 @end smallexample
20211
20212 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20213 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20214 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20215 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20216 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20217 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20218 progress.
20219
20220 @item
20221 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20222 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20223
20224 @smallexample
20225 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20226 @end smallexample
20227
20228 @noindent
20229 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20230 function in your program, that function is called when
20231 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20232 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20233 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20234
20235 @item
20236 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20237 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20238
20239 @item
20240 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20241 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20242
20243 @item
20244 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20245 @c document that. FIXME.
20246 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20247 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20248
20249 @item
20250 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20251 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20252
20253 @end enumerate
20254
20255 @node Configurations
20256 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20257
20258 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20259 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20260 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20261
20262 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20263 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20264 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20265 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20266 are quite different from each other.
20267
20268 @menu
20269 * Native::
20270 * Embedded OS::
20271 * Embedded Processors::
20272 * Architectures::
20273 @end menu
20274
20275 @node Native
20276 @section Native
20277
20278 This section describes details specific to particular native
20279 configurations.
20280
20281 @menu
20282 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20283 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20284 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20285 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20286 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20287 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20288 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20289 @end menu
20290
20291 @node HP-UX
20292 @subsection HP-UX
20293
20294 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20295 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20296 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20297
20298
20299 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20300 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20301
20302 @cindex libkvm
20303 @cindex kernel memory image
20304 @cindex kernel crash dump
20305
20306 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20307 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20308 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20309 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20310 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20311 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20312 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20313 @code{kvm} target:
20314
20315 @smallexample
20316 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20317 @end smallexample
20318
20319 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20320 argument:
20321
20322 @smallexample
20323 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20324 @end smallexample
20325
20326 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20327 available:
20328
20329 @table @code
20330 @kindex kvm
20331 @item kvm pcb
20332 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20333
20334 @item kvm proc
20335 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20336 modern FreeBSD systems.
20337 @end table
20338
20339 @node SVR4 Process Information
20340 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20341 @cindex /proc
20342 @cindex examine process image
20343 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20344
20345 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20346 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20347 process using file-system subroutines.
20348
20349 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20350 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20351 information about the process running your program, or about any
20352 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20353 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20354
20355 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20356 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20357
20358 @table @code
20359 @kindex info proc
20360 @cindex process ID
20361 @item info proc
20362 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20363 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20364 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20365 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20366 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20367 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20368 executable file's absolute file name.
20369
20370 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20371 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20372 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20373 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20374 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20375 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20376
20377 @item info proc cmdline
20378 @cindex info proc cmdline
20379 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20380 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20381
20382 @item info proc cwd
20383 @cindex info proc cwd
20384 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20385 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20386
20387 @item info proc exe
20388 @cindex info proc exe
20389 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20390 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20391
20392 @item info proc mappings
20393 @cindex memory address space mappings
20394 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20395 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20396 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20397 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20398 memory access rights to that range.
20399
20400 @item info proc stat
20401 @itemx info proc status
20402 @cindex process detailed status information
20403 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20404 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20405 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20406 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20407 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20408 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20409 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20410
20411 @item info proc all
20412 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20413 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20414
20415 @ignore
20416 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20417 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20418 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20419 @kindex info proc times
20420 @item info proc times
20421 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20422 its children.
20423
20424 @kindex info proc id
20425 @item info proc id
20426 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20427 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20428 @end ignore
20429
20430 @item set procfs-trace
20431 @kindex set procfs-trace
20432 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20433 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20434
20435 @item show procfs-trace
20436 @kindex show procfs-trace
20437 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20438
20439 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20440 @kindex set procfs-file
20441 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20442 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20443 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20444 standard output.
20445
20446 @item show procfs-file
20447 @kindex show procfs-file
20448 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20449
20450 @item proc-trace-entry
20451 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20452 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20453 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20454 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20455 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20456 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20457 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20458 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20459 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20460
20461 @item info pidlist
20462 @kindex info pidlist
20463 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20464 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20465 processes and all the threads within each process.
20466
20467 @item info meminfo
20468 @kindex info meminfo
20469 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20470 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20471 @end table
20472
20473 @node DJGPP Native
20474 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20475 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20476 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20477 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20478
20479 @cindex DPMI
20480 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20481 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20482 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20483 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20484
20485 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20486 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20487 subsection describes those commands.
20488
20489 @table @code
20490 @kindex info dos
20491 @item info dos
20492 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20493 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20494
20495 @kindex sysinfo
20496 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20497 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20498 @item info dos sysinfo
20499 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20500 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20501 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20502
20503 @cindex GDT
20504 @cindex LDT
20505 @cindex IDT
20506 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20507 @cindex descriptor tables display
20508 @item info dos gdt
20509 @itemx info dos ldt
20510 @itemx info dos idt
20511 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20512 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20513 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20514 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20515 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20516 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20517 rights.
20518
20519 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20520 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20521 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20522 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20523 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20524
20525 @cindex garbled pointers
20526 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20527 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20528 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20529 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20530 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20531 debugged program's data segment:
20532
20533 @smallexample
20534 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20535 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20536 @end smallexample
20537
20538 @noindent
20539 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20540 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20541
20542 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20543 @item info dos pde
20544 @itemx info dos pte
20545 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20546 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20547 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20548 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20549 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20550 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20551 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20552 that is currently in use.
20553
20554 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20555 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20556 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20557 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20558 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20559 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20560 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20561
20562 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20563 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20564 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20565 controller.
20566
20567 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20568
20569 @cindex physical address from linear address
20570 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20571 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20572 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20573 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20574 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20575 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20576 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20577
20578 @smallexample
20579 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20580 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20581 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20582 @end smallexample
20583
20584 @noindent
20585 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20586 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20587 attributes of that page.
20588
20589 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20590 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20591 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20592 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20593 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20594 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20595
20596 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20597 transfer buffer:
20598
20599 @smallexample
20600 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20601 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20602 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20603 @end smallexample
20604
20605 @noindent
20606 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20607 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20608 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20609 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20610 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20611
20612 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20613 @end table
20614
20615 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20616 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20617 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20618 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20619
20620 @table @code
20621 @kindex set com1base
20622 @kindex set com1irq
20623 @kindex set com2base
20624 @kindex set com2irq
20625 @kindex set com3base
20626 @kindex set com3irq
20627 @kindex set com4base
20628 @kindex set com4irq
20629 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20630 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20631 port.
20632
20633 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20634 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20635 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20636
20637 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20638 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20639 other 3 COM ports.
20640
20641 @kindex show com1base
20642 @kindex show com1irq
20643 @kindex show com2base
20644 @kindex show com2irq
20645 @kindex show com3base
20646 @kindex show com3irq
20647 @kindex show com4base
20648 @kindex show com4irq
20649 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20650 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20651 lines used by the COM ports.
20652
20653 @item info serial
20654 @kindex info serial
20655 @cindex DOS serial port status
20656 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20657 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20658 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20659 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20660 @end table
20661
20662
20663 @node Cygwin Native
20664 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20665 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20666 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20667 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20668
20669 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20670 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20671
20672 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20673 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20674 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20675 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20676 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20677 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20678 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20679 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20680
20681 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20682 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20683 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20684
20685 @table @code
20686 @kindex info w32
20687 @item info w32
20688 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20689 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20690
20691 @item info w32 selector
20692 This command displays information returned by
20693 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20694 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20695 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20696 Without argument, this command displays information
20697 about the six segment registers.
20698
20699 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20700 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20701 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20702 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20703
20704 @kindex info dll
20705 @item info dll
20706 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20707
20708 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20709 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20710 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20711 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20712 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20713 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20714 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20715 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20716 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20717 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20718 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20719
20720 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20721 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20722 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20723 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20724
20725 @kindex set new-console
20726 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20727 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20728 be started in a new console on next start.
20729 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20730 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20731
20732 @kindex show new-console
20733 @item show new-console
20734 Displays whether a new console is used
20735 when the debuggee is started.
20736
20737 @kindex set new-group
20738 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20739 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20740 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20741 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20742 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20743
20744 @kindex show new-group
20745 @item show new-group
20746 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20747
20748 @kindex set debugevents
20749 @item set debugevents
20750 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20751 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20752 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20753 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20754 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20755
20756 @kindex set debugexec
20757 @item set debugexec
20758 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20759 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20760
20761 @kindex set debugexceptions
20762 @item set debugexceptions
20763 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20764 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20765
20766 @kindex set debugmemory
20767 @item set debugmemory
20768 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20769 and writes by the debugger.
20770
20771 @kindex set shell
20772 @item set shell
20773 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20774 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20775
20776 @kindex show shell
20777 @item show shell
20778 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20779
20780 @end table
20781
20782 @menu
20783 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20784 @end menu
20785
20786 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20787 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20788 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20789 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20790
20791 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20792 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20793 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20794 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20795 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20796 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20797 ``minimal symbols''.
20798
20799 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20800 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20801 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20802 program run once to completion.
20803
20804 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20805
20806 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20807 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20808 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20809 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20810 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20811 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20812 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20813 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20814 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20815
20816 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20817 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20818 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20819 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20820 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20821 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20822
20823 @smallexample
20824 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20825 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20826
20827 Non-debugging symbols:
20828 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20829 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20830 @end smallexample
20831
20832 @smallexample
20833 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20834 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20835
20836 Non-debugging symbols:
20837 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20838 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20839 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20840 [etc...]
20841 @end smallexample
20842
20843 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20844
20845 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20846 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20847 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20848 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20849 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20850 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20851 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20852
20853 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20854 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20855 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20856 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20857 problem:
20858
20859 @smallexample
20860 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20861 $1 = 268572168
20862 @end smallexample
20863
20864 @smallexample
20865 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20866 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20867 @end smallexample
20868
20869 And two possible solutions:
20870
20871 @smallexample
20872 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20873 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20874 @end smallexample
20875
20876 @smallexample
20877 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20878 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20879 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20880 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20881 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20882 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20886 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20887 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20888 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20889 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20890
20891 @smallexample
20892 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20893 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20894 @end smallexample
20895
20896 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20897 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20898 safe.
20899
20900 @node Hurd Native
20901 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20902 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20903
20904 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20905 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20906
20907 @table @code
20908 @item set signals
20909 @itemx set sigs
20910 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20911 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20912 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20913 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20914 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20915 @code{signals}.
20916
20917 @item show signals
20918 @itemx show sigs
20919 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20920 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20921 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20922
20923 @item set signal-thread
20924 @itemx set sigthread
20925 @kindex set signal-thread
20926 @kindex set sigthread
20927 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20928 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20929 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20930 signal-thread}.
20931
20932 @item show signal-thread
20933 @itemx show sigthread
20934 @kindex show signal-thread
20935 @kindex show sigthread
20936 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20937 delivered a signal.
20938
20939 @item set stopped
20940 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20941 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20942 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20943 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20944
20945 @item show stopped
20946 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20947 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20948 stopped.
20949
20950 @item set exceptions
20951 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20952 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20953 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20954 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20955 trapping on.
20956
20957 @item show exceptions
20958 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20959 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20960
20961 @item set task pause
20962 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20963 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20964 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20965 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20966 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20967 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20968 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20969 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20970 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20971
20972 @item show task pause
20973 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20974 Show the current state of task suspension.
20975
20976 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20977 @cindex task suspend count
20978 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20979 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20980 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20981
20982 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20983 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20984
20985 @item set task exception-port
20986 @itemx set task excp
20987 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20988 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20989 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20990 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20991
20992 @item set noninvasive
20993 @cindex noninvasive task options
20994 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20995 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20996 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20997 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20998
20999 @item info send-rights
21000 @itemx info receive-rights
21001 @itemx info port-rights
21002 @itemx info port-sets
21003 @itemx info dead-names
21004 @itemx info ports
21005 @itemx info psets
21006 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21007 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21008 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21009 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21010 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21011 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21012 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21013 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21014 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21015
21016 @item set thread pause
21017 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21018 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21019 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21020 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21021 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21022 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21023 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21024 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21025 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21026 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21027 only the current thread.
21028
21029 @item show thread pause
21030 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21031 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21032
21033 @item set thread run
21034 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21035
21036 @item show thread run
21037 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21038
21039 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21040 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21041 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21042 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21043 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21044 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21045 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21046
21047 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21048 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21049 detaching.
21050
21051 @item set thread exception-port
21052 @itemx set thread excp
21053 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21054 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21055 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21056
21057 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21058 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21059 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21060 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21061
21062 @item set thread default
21063 @itemx show thread default
21064 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21065 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21066 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21067 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21068 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21069 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21070 the non-default commands.
21071 @end table
21072
21073 @node Darwin
21074 @subsection Darwin
21075 @cindex Darwin
21076
21077 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21078
21079 @table @code
21080 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21081 @kindex set debug darwin
21082 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21083 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21084
21085 @item show debug darwin
21086 @kindex show debug darwin
21087 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21088
21089 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21090 @kindex set debug mach-o
21091 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21092 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21093 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21094 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21095 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21096 usage.
21097
21098 @item show debug mach-o
21099 @kindex show debug mach-o
21100 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21101
21102 @item set mach-exceptions on
21103 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21104 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21105 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21106 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21107 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21108 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21109
21110 @item show mach-exceptions
21111 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21112 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21113 @end table
21114
21115
21116 @node Embedded OS
21117 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21118
21119 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21120 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21121 architectures.
21122
21123 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21124 various real-time operating systems.
21125
21126 @node Embedded Processors
21127 @section Embedded Processors
21128
21129 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21130 configurations.
21131
21132 @cindex send command to simulator
21133 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21134 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21135
21136 @table @code
21137 @item sim @var{command}
21138 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21139 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21140 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21141 acceptable commands.
21142 @end table
21143
21144
21145 @menu
21146 * ARM:: ARM RDI
21147 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
21148 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21149 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21150 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21151 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21152 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
21153 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
21154 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
21155 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
21156 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21157 * CRIS:: CRIS
21158 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21159 @end menu
21160
21161 @node ARM
21162 @subsection ARM
21163 @cindex ARM RDI
21164
21165 @table @code
21166 @kindex target rdi
21167 @item target rdi @var{dev}
21168 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
21169 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
21170 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
21171
21172 @kindex target rdp
21173 @item target rdp @var{dev}
21174 ARM Demon monitor.
21175
21176 @end table
21177
21178 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21179
21180 @table @code
21181 @item set arm disassembler
21182 @kindex set arm
21183 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21184 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21185
21186 @item show arm disassembler
21187 @kindex show arm
21188 Show the current disassembly style.
21189
21190 @item set arm apcs32
21191 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21192 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21193
21194 @item show arm apcs32
21195 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21196
21197 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21198 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21199 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21200
21201 @table @code
21202 @item auto
21203 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21204 @item softfpa
21205 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21206 processors.
21207 @item fpa
21208 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21209 @item softvfp
21210 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21211 @item vfp
21212 VFP co-processor.
21213 @end table
21214
21215 @item show arm fpu
21216 Show the current type of the FPU.
21217
21218 @item set arm abi
21219 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21220
21221 @item show arm abi
21222 Show the currently used ABI.
21223
21224 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21225 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21226 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21227 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21228 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21229 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21230 register).
21231
21232 @item show arm fallback-mode
21233 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21234
21235 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21236 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21237 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21238 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21239 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21240
21241 @item show arm force-mode
21242 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21243
21244 @item set debug arm
21245 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21246 target support subsystem.
21247
21248 @item show debug arm
21249 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21250 @end table
21251
21252 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21253 using the RDI interface:
21254
21255 @table @code
21256 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21257 @kindex rdilogfile
21258 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21259 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21260 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21261 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21262 @file{rdi.log}.
21263
21264 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21265 @kindex rdilogenable
21266 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21267 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21268 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21269 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21270 are logged to a file.
21271
21272 @item set rdiromatzero
21273 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21274 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21275 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21276 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21277 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21278 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21279
21280 @item show rdiromatzero
21281 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21282 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21283
21284 @item set rdiheartbeat
21285 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21286 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21287 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21288 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21289 well as the Angel monitor.
21290
21291 @item show rdiheartbeat
21292 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21293 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21294 @end table
21295
21296 @table @code
21297 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21298 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21299
21300 @table @code
21301 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21302 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21303 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21304 The default value is @code{all}.
21305
21306 @table @code
21307 @item none
21308 @item demon
21309 @item angel
21310 @item redboot
21311 @item all
21312 @end table
21313 @end table
21314 @end table
21315
21316 @node M32R/D
21317 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21318
21319 @table @code
21320 @kindex target m32r
21321 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21322 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21323
21324 @kindex target m32rsdi
21325 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21326 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21327 @end table
21328
21329 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21330
21331 @table @code
21332 @item set download-path @var{path}
21333 @kindex set download-path
21334 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21335 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21336
21337 @item show download-path
21338 @kindex show download-path
21339 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21340
21341 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21342 @kindex set board-address
21343 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21344 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21345
21346 @item show board-address
21347 @kindex show board-address
21348 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21349
21350 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21351 @kindex set server-address
21352 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21353 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21354 host machine.
21355
21356 @item show server-address
21357 @kindex show server-address
21358 Display the IP address of the download server.
21359
21360 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21361 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21362 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21363 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21364 executable file is uploaded.
21365
21366 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21367 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21368 Test the @code{upload} command.
21369 @end table
21370
21371 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21372
21373 @table @code
21374 @item sdireset
21375 @kindex sdireset
21376 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21377 This command resets the SDI connection.
21378
21379 @item sdistatus
21380 @kindex sdistatus
21381 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21382
21383 @item debug_chaos
21384 @kindex debug_chaos
21385 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21386 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21387
21388 @item use_debug_dma
21389 @kindex use_debug_dma
21390 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21391
21392 @item use_mon_code
21393 @kindex use_mon_code
21394 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21395
21396 @item use_ib_break
21397 @kindex use_ib_break
21398 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21399
21400 @item use_dbt_break
21401 @kindex use_dbt_break
21402 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21403 @end table
21404
21405 @node M68K
21406 @subsection M68k
21407
21408 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21409 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21410
21411 @table @code
21412
21413 @kindex target dbug
21414 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21415 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21416
21417 @end table
21418
21419 @node MicroBlaze
21420 @subsection MicroBlaze
21421 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21422 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21423
21424 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21425 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21426 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21427 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21428 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21429 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21430 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21431 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21432 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21433 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21434 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21435
21436 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21437
21438 @table @code
21439 @item target remote :1234
21440 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21441 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21442
21443 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21444 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21445 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21446
21447 @item load
21448 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21449
21450 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21451 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21452
21453 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21454 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21455 @end table
21456
21457 @node MIPS Embedded
21458 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21459
21460 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21461 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21462 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21463 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21464
21465 @need 1000
21466 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21467
21468 @table @code
21469 @item target mips @var{port}
21470 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21471 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21472 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21473 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21474 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21475 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21476 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21477
21478 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21479 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21480 debugger:
21481
21482 @smallexample
21483 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21484 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21485 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21486 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21487 (@value{GDBP}) run
21488 @end smallexample
21489
21490 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21491 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21492 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21493 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21494 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21495
21496 @item target pmon @var{port}
21497 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21498 PMON ROM monitor.
21499
21500 @item target ddb @var{port}
21501 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21502 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21503
21504 @item target lsi @var{port}
21505 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21506 LSI variant of PMON.
21507
21508 @kindex target r3900
21509 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21510 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21511
21512 @kindex target array
21513 @item target array @var{dev}
21514 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21515
21516 @end table
21517
21518
21519 @noindent
21520 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21521
21522 @table @code
21523 @item set mipsfpu double
21524 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21525 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21526 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21527 @itemx show mipsfpu
21528 @kindex set mipsfpu
21529 @kindex show mipsfpu
21530 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21531 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21532 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21533 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21534 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21535 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21536 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21537 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21538 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21539 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21540 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21541 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21542 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21543
21544 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21545 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21546 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21547
21548 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21549 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21550
21551 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21552 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21553 @itemx show timeout
21554 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21555 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21556 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21557 @kindex set timeout
21558 @kindex show timeout
21559 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21560 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21561 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21562 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21563 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21564 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21565 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21566 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21567 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21568 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21569
21570 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21571 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21572 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21573 to run before stopping.
21574
21575 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21576 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21577 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21578 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21579 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21580 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21581
21582 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21583 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21584 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21585 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21586
21587 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21588 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21589 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21590 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21591 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21592 @table @asis
21593 @item pmon target
21594 @samp{PMON}
21595 @item ddb target
21596 @samp{NEC010}
21597 @item lsi target
21598 @samp{PMON>}
21599 @end table
21600
21601 @item show monitor-prompt
21602 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21603 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21604 remote monitor.
21605
21606 @item set monitor-warnings
21607 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21608 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21609 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21610 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21611 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21612
21613 @item show monitor-warnings
21614 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21615 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21616
21617 @item pmon @var{command}
21618 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21619 @cindex send PMON command
21620 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21621 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21622 @end table
21623
21624 @node PowerPC Embedded
21625 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21626
21627 @cindex DVC register
21628 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21629 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21630
21631 @smallexample
21632 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21633 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21634 @end smallexample
21635
21636 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21637 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21638 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21639 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21640 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21641 or newer.
21642
21643 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21644 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21645 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21646 watching variables of scalar types.
21647
21648 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21649 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21650
21651 @smallexample
21652 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21653 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21654 @end smallexample
21655
21656 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21657 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21658
21659 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21660 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21661 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21662 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21663 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21664 use the @code{break-range} command.
21665
21666 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21667
21668 @table @code
21669 @kindex break-range
21670 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21671 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21672 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21673 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21674 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21675 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21676 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21677 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21678 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21679
21680 @kindex set powerpc
21681 @item set powerpc soft-float
21682 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21683 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21684 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21685 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21686
21687 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21688 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21689 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21690 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21691 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21692 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21693 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21694 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21695
21696 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21697 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21698 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21699 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21700 address of its first byte.
21701
21702 @kindex target dink32
21703 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21704 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21705
21706 @kindex target ppcbug
21707 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21708 @kindex target ppcbug1
21709 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21710 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21711
21712 @kindex target sds
21713 @item target sds @var{dev}
21714 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21715 @end table
21716
21717 @cindex SDS protocol
21718 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21719 by @value{GDBN}:
21720
21721 @table @code
21722 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21723 @kindex set sdstimeout
21724 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21725 default is 2 seconds.
21726
21727 @item show sdstimeout
21728 @kindex show sdstimeout
21729 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21730
21731 @item sds @var{command}
21732 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21733 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21734 @end table
21735
21736
21737 @node PA
21738 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21739
21740 @table @code
21741
21742 @kindex target op50n
21743 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21744 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21745
21746 @kindex target w89k
21747 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21748 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21749
21750 @end table
21751
21752 @node Sparclet
21753 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21754
21755 @cindex Sparclet
21756
21757 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21758 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21759 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21760 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21761 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21762
21763 @table @code
21764 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21765 @kindex remotetimeout
21766 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21767 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21768 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21769 @end table
21770
21771 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21772 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21773 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21774 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21775 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21776
21777 @smallexample
21778 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21779 @end smallexample
21780
21781 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21782
21783 @smallexample
21784 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21785 @end smallexample
21786
21787 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21788 Once you have set
21789 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21790 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21791 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21792
21793 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21794
21795 @smallexample
21796 (gdbslet)
21797 @end smallexample
21798
21799 @menu
21800 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21801 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21802 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21803 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21804 @end menu
21805
21806 @node Sparclet File
21807 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21808
21809 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21810
21811 @smallexample
21812 (gdbslet) file prog
21813 @end smallexample
21814
21815 @need 1000
21816 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21817 @value{GDBN} locates
21818 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21819 path.
21820 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21821 files will be searched as well.
21822 @value{GDBN} locates
21823 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21824 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21825 If it fails
21826 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21827
21828 @smallexample
21829 prog: No such file or directory.
21830 @end smallexample
21831
21832 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21833 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21834 @code{target} command again.
21835
21836 @node Sparclet Connection
21837 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21838
21839 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21840 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21841
21842 @smallexample
21843 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21844 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21845 main () at ../prog.c:3
21846 @end smallexample
21847
21848 @need 750
21849 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21850
21851 @smallexample
21852 Connected to ttya.
21853 @end smallexample
21854
21855 @node Sparclet Download
21856 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21857
21858 @cindex download to Sparclet
21859 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21860 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21861 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21862 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21863 command.
21864 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21865 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21866 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21867 of each of the file's sections.
21868 For instance, if the program
21869 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21870 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21871
21872 @smallexample
21873 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21874 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21875 @end smallexample
21876
21877 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21878 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21879 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21880
21881 @node Sparclet Execution
21882 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21883
21884 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21885 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21886 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21887 manual for the list of commands.
21888
21889 @smallexample
21890 (gdbslet) b main
21891 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21892 (gdbslet) run
21893 Starting program: prog
21894 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21895 3 char *symarg = 0;
21896 (gdbslet) step
21897 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21898 (gdbslet)
21899 @end smallexample
21900
21901 @node Sparclite
21902 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21903
21904 @table @code
21905
21906 @kindex target sparclite
21907 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21908 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21909 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21910 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21911 remote protocol.
21912
21913 @end table
21914
21915 @node Z8000
21916 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21917
21918 @cindex Z8000
21919 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21920 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21921
21922 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21923 a Z8000 simulator.
21924
21925 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21926 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21927 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21928 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21929
21930 @table @code
21931 @item target sim @var{args}
21932 @kindex sim
21933 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21934 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21935 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21936 @end table
21937
21938 @noindent
21939 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21940 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21941 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21942 to run your program, and so on.
21943
21944 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21945 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21946 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21947
21948 @table @code
21949
21950 @item cycles
21951 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21952
21953 @item insts
21954 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21955
21956 @item time
21957 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21958
21959 @end table
21960
21961 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21962 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21963 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21964 simulated clock ticks.
21965
21966 @node AVR
21967 @subsection Atmel AVR
21968 @cindex AVR
21969
21970 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21971 following AVR-specific commands:
21972
21973 @table @code
21974 @item info io_registers
21975 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21976 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21977 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21978 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21979 @end table
21980
21981 @node CRIS
21982 @subsection CRIS
21983 @cindex CRIS
21984
21985 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21986 following CRIS-specific commands:
21987
21988 @table @code
21989 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21990 @cindex CRIS version
21991 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21992 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21993 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21994
21995 @item show cris-version
21996 Show the current CRIS version.
21997
21998 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21999 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22000 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22001 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22002 @code{R59}.
22003
22004 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22005 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22006
22007 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22008 @cindex CRIS mode
22009 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22010 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22011 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22012
22013 @item show cris-mode
22014 Show the current CRIS mode.
22015 @end table
22016
22017 @node Super-H
22018 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22019 @cindex Super-H
22020
22021 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22022 commands:
22023
22024 @table @code
22025 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22026 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22027 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22028 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22029 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22030 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22031 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22032 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22033 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22034 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22035 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22036 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22037
22038 @item show sh calling-convention
22039 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22040 Show the current calling convention setting.
22041
22042 @end table
22043
22044
22045 @node Architectures
22046 @section Architectures
22047
22048 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22049 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22050
22051 @menu
22052 * AArch64::
22053 * i386::
22054 * Alpha::
22055 * MIPS::
22056 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22057 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22058 * PowerPC::
22059 * Nios II::
22060 @end menu
22061
22062 @node AArch64
22063 @subsection AArch64
22064 @cindex AArch64 support
22065
22066 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22067 following special commands:
22068
22069 @table @code
22070 @item set debug aarch64
22071 @kindex set debug aarch64
22072 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22073 messages are to be displayed.
22074
22075 @item show debug aarch64
22076 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22077
22078 @end table
22079
22080 @node i386
22081 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22082
22083 @table @code
22084 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22085 @kindex set struct-convention
22086 @cindex struct return convention
22087 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22088 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22089 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22090 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22091 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22092 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22093 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22094 be returned in a register.
22095
22096 @item show struct-convention
22097 @kindex show struct-convention
22098 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22099 from functions.
22100 @end table
22101
22102 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22103 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22104
22105 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22106 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22107 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22108 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22109 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22110 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22111 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22112
22113 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22114 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22115 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22116 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22117 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22118 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22119
22120 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22121 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22122 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22123
22124 @smallexample
22125 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22126 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22127 @end smallexample
22128
22129 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22130 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22131 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22132 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22133 the pointer.
22134
22135 @node Alpha
22136 @subsection Alpha
22137
22138 See the following section.
22139
22140 @node MIPS
22141 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22142
22143 @cindex stack on Alpha
22144 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22145 @cindex Alpha stack
22146 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22147 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22148 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22149 find the beginning of a function.
22150
22151 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22152 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22153 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22154 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22155 commands:
22156
22157 @table @code
22158 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22159 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22160 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22161 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22162 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22163 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22164 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22165 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22166
22167 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22168 Display the current limit.
22169 @end table
22170
22171 @noindent
22172 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22173 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22174
22175 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22176 programs:
22177
22178 @table @code
22179 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22180 @kindex set mips abi
22181 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22182 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22183 values of @var{arg} are:
22184
22185 @table @samp
22186 @item auto
22187 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22188 default).
22189 @item o32
22190 @item o64
22191 @item n32
22192 @item n64
22193 @item eabi32
22194 @item eabi64
22195 @end table
22196
22197 @item show mips abi
22198 @kindex show mips abi
22199 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22200
22201 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22202 @kindex set mips compression
22203 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22204 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22205 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22206 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22207 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22208 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22209 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22210 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22211 provided by the executable.
22212
22213 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22214 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22215 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22216 identified as such.
22217
22218 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22219 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22220 implicitly from an executable.
22221
22222 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22223 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22224 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22225 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22226 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22227
22228 @item show mips compression
22229 @kindex show mips compression
22230 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22231 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22232
22233 @item set mipsfpu
22234 @itemx show mipsfpu
22235 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22236
22237 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22238 @kindex set mips mask-address
22239 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22240 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22241 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22242 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22243 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22244
22245 @item show mips mask-address
22246 @kindex show mips mask-address
22247 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22248 not.
22249
22250 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22251 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22252 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22253 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22254 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22255 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22256
22257 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22258 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22259 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22260
22261 @item set debug mips
22262 @kindex set debug mips
22263 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22264 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22265
22266 @item show debug mips
22267 @kindex show debug mips
22268 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22269 @end table
22270
22271
22272 @node HPPA
22273 @subsection HPPA
22274 @cindex HPPA support
22275
22276 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22277 following special commands:
22278
22279 @table @code
22280 @item set debug hppa
22281 @kindex set debug hppa
22282 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22283 messages are to be displayed.
22284
22285 @item show debug hppa
22286 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22287
22288 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22289 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22290 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22291 given @var{address}.
22292
22293 @end table
22294
22295
22296 @node SPU
22297 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22298 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22299 @cindex SPU
22300
22301 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22302 it provides the following special commands:
22303
22304 @table @code
22305 @item info spu event
22306 @kindex info spu
22307 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22308 and pending event status.
22309
22310 @item info spu signal
22311 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22312 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22313 notification channels.
22314
22315 @item info spu mailbox
22316 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22317 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22318 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22319
22320 @item info spu dma
22321 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22322 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22323 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22324
22325 @item info spu proxydma
22326 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22327 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22328 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22329
22330 @end table
22331
22332 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22333 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22334 special commands:
22335
22336 @table @code
22337 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22338 @kindex set spu
22339 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22340 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22341 function. The default is @code{off}.
22342
22343 @item show spu stop-on-load
22344 @kindex show spu
22345 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22346
22347 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22348 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22349 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22350 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22351 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22352 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22353
22354 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22355 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22356
22357 @end table
22358
22359 @node PowerPC
22360 @subsection PowerPC
22361 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22362
22363 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22364 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22365 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22366 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22367 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22368
22369 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22370 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22371 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22372
22373 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22374 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22375
22376 @node Nios II
22377 @subsection Nios II
22378 @cindex Nios II architecture
22379
22380 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22381 it provides the following special commands:
22382
22383 @table @code
22384
22385 @item set debug nios2
22386 @kindex set debug nios2
22387 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22388 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22389
22390 @item show debug nios2
22391 @kindex show debug nios2
22392 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22393 @end table
22394
22395 @node Controlling GDB
22396 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22397
22398 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22399 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22400 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22401 described here.
22402
22403 @menu
22404 * Prompt:: Prompt
22405 * Editing:: Command editing
22406 * Command History:: Command history
22407 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22408 * Numbers:: Numbers
22409 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22410 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22411 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22412 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22413 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22414 @end menu
22415
22416 @node Prompt
22417 @section Prompt
22418
22419 @cindex prompt
22420
22421 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22422 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22423 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22424 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22425 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22426 which one you are talking to.
22427
22428 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22429 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22430 or a prompt that does not.
22431
22432 @table @code
22433 @kindex set prompt
22434 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22435 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22436
22437 @kindex show prompt
22438 @item show prompt
22439 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22440 @end table
22441
22442 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22443 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22444 are:
22445
22446 @table @code
22447 @kindex set extended-prompt
22448 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22449 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22450 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22451 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22452 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22453 is displayed.
22454
22455 For example:
22456
22457 @smallexample
22458 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22459 @end smallexample
22460
22461 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22462 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22463
22464 @kindex show extended-prompt
22465 @item show extended-prompt
22466 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22467 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22468 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22469 @end table
22470
22471 @node Editing
22472 @section Command Editing
22473 @cindex readline
22474 @cindex command line editing
22475
22476 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22477 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22478 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22479 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22480 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22481 debugging sessions.
22482
22483 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22484 command @code{set}.
22485
22486 @table @code
22487 @kindex set editing
22488 @cindex editing
22489 @item set editing
22490 @itemx set editing on
22491 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22492
22493 @item set editing off
22494 Disable command line editing.
22495
22496 @kindex show editing
22497 @item show editing
22498 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22499 @end table
22500
22501 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22502 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22503 @end ifset
22504 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22505 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22506 @end ifclear
22507 for more details about the Readline
22508 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22509 encouraged to read that chapter.
22510
22511 @node Command History
22512 @section Command History
22513 @cindex command history
22514
22515 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22516 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22517 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22518 history facility.
22519
22520 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22521 package, to provide the history facility.
22522 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22523 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22524 @end ifset
22525 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22526 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22527 @end ifclear
22528 for the detailed description of the History library.
22529
22530 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22531 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22532 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22533 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22534 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22535 pressed on a line by itself.
22536
22537 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22538 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22539 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22540 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22541
22542 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22543 history.
22544
22545 @table @code
22546 @cindex history substitution
22547 @cindex history file
22548 @kindex set history filename
22549 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22550 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22551 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22552 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22553 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22554 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22555 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22556 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22557 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22558 is not set.
22559
22560 @cindex save command history
22561 @kindex set history save
22562 @item set history save
22563 @itemx set history save on
22564 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22565 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22566
22567 @item set history save off
22568 Stop recording command history in a file.
22569
22570 @cindex history size
22571 @kindex set history size
22572 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22573 @item set history size @var{size}
22574 @itemx set history size unlimited
22575 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22576 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22577 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22578 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22579 history list is unlimited.
22580 @end table
22581
22582 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22583 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22584 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22585 @end ifset
22586 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22587 @xref{Event Designators},
22588 @end ifclear
22589 for more details.
22590
22591 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22592 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22593 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22594 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22595 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22596 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22597 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22598 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22599
22600 The commands to control history expansion are:
22601
22602 @table @code
22603 @item set history expansion on
22604 @itemx set history expansion
22605 @kindex set history expansion
22606 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22607
22608 @item set history expansion off
22609 Disable history expansion.
22610
22611 @c @group
22612 @kindex show history
22613 @item show history
22614 @itemx show history filename
22615 @itemx show history save
22616 @itemx show history size
22617 @itemx show history expansion
22618 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22619 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22620 @c @end group
22621 @end table
22622
22623 @table @code
22624 @kindex show commands
22625 @cindex show last commands
22626 @cindex display command history
22627 @item show commands
22628 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22629
22630 @item show commands @var{n}
22631 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22632
22633 @item show commands +
22634 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22635 @end table
22636
22637 @node Screen Size
22638 @section Screen Size
22639 @cindex size of screen
22640 @cindex screen size
22641 @cindex pagination
22642 @cindex page size
22643 @cindex pauses in output
22644
22645 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22646 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22647 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22648 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22649 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22650 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22651 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22652 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22653
22654 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22655 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22656 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22657 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22658 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22659 width} commands:
22660
22661 @table @code
22662 @kindex set height
22663 @kindex set width
22664 @kindex show width
22665 @kindex show height
22666 @item set height @var{lpp}
22667 @itemx set height unlimited
22668 @itemx show height
22669 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22670 @itemx set width unlimited
22671 @itemx show width
22672 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22673 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22674 commands display the current settings.
22675
22676 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22677 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22678 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22679 buffer.
22680
22681 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22682 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22683
22684 @item set pagination on
22685 @itemx set pagination off
22686 @kindex set pagination
22687 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22688 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22689 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22690 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22691
22692 @item show pagination
22693 @kindex show pagination
22694 Show the current pagination mode.
22695 @end table
22696
22697 @node Numbers
22698 @section Numbers
22699 @cindex number representation
22700 @cindex entering numbers
22701
22702 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22703 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22704 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22705 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22706 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22707 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22708 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22709 both input and output with the commands described below.
22710
22711 @table @code
22712 @kindex set input-radix
22713 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22714 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22715 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22716 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22717 example, any of
22718
22719 @smallexample
22720 set input-radix 012
22721 set input-radix 10.
22722 set input-radix 0xa
22723 @end smallexample
22724
22725 @noindent
22726 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22727 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22728 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22729 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22730 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22731 change the radix.
22732
22733 @kindex set output-radix
22734 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22735 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22736 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22737 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22738
22739 @kindex show input-radix
22740 @item show input-radix
22741 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22742
22743 @kindex show output-radix
22744 @item show output-radix
22745 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22746
22747 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22748 @itemx show radix
22749 @kindex set radix
22750 @kindex show radix
22751 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22752 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22753 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22754 default value of 10.
22755
22756 @end table
22757
22758 @node ABI
22759 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22760
22761 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22762 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22763 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22764 current ABI.
22765
22766 @cindex OS ABI
22767 @kindex set osabi
22768 @kindex show osabi
22769 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22770
22771 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22772 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22773 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22774 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22775 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22776 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22777 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22778 platform provides.
22779
22780 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22781 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22782 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22783 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22784
22785 @table @code
22786 @item show osabi
22787 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22788
22789 @item set osabi
22790 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22791
22792 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22793 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22794 @end table
22795
22796 @cindex float promotion
22797
22798 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22799 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22800 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22801 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22802 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22803 @code{double} and then passed.
22804
22805 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22806 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22807 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22808
22809 @table @code
22810 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22811 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22812 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22813 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22814 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22815
22816 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22817 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22818 functions.
22819
22820 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22821 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22822 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22823 @end table
22824
22825 @kindex set cp-abi
22826 @kindex show cp-abi
22827 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22828 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22829 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22830 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22831 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22832 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22833 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22834 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22835 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22836 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22837 ``auto''.
22838
22839 @table @code
22840 @item show cp-abi
22841 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22842
22843 @item set cp-abi
22844 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22845
22846 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22847 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22848 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22849 @end table
22850
22851 @node Auto-loading
22852 @section Automatically loading associated files
22853 @cindex auto-loading
22854
22855 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22856 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22857 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22858 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22859 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22860 sources).
22861
22862 @menu
22863 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22864 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22865
22866 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22867 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22868 @end menu
22869
22870 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22871 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22872 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22873
22874 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22875 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22876 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22877
22878 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22879 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22880
22881 @table @code
22882 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22883 @kindex set auto-load off
22884 @item set auto-load off
22885 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22886 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22887 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22888 @smallexample
22889 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22890 @end smallexample
22891
22892 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22893 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22894 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22895 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22896 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22897 @code{set auto-load no}.
22898
22899 @anchor{show auto-load}
22900 @kindex show auto-load
22901 @item show auto-load
22902 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22903 or disabled.
22904
22905 @smallexample
22906 (gdb) show auto-load
22907 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22908 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22909 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22910 is on.
22911 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22912 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22913 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22914 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22915 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22916 @end smallexample
22917
22918 @anchor{info auto-load}
22919 @kindex info auto-load
22920 @item info auto-load
22921 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22922 not.
22923
22924 @smallexample
22925 (gdb) info auto-load
22926 gdb-scripts:
22927 Loaded Script
22928 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22929 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22930 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22931 loaded.
22932 python-scripts:
22933 Loaded Script
22934 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22935 @end smallexample
22936 @end table
22937
22938 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22939
22940 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22941 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22942 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22943 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22944 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22945 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22946 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22947 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22948 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22949 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22950 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22951 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22952 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22953 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22954 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22955 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22956 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22957 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22958 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22959 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22960 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22961 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22962 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22963 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22964 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22965 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22966 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22967 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22968 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22969 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
22970 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
22971 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22972 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22973 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22974 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22975 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22976 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22977 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22978 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22979 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22980 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22981 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22982 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22983 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22984 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22985 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22986 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22987 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22988 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22989 @end multitable
22990
22991 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22992 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22993 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22994
22995 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22996 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22997 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22998
22999 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23000 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23001
23002 @table @code
23003 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23004 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23005 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23006 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23007 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23008
23009 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23010 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23011 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23012 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23013 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23014
23015 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23016 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23017 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23018 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23019 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23020 @end table
23021
23022 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23023 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23024 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23025
23026 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23027
23028 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23029 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23030
23031 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23032 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23033 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23034 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23035 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23036 library.
23037
23038 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23039 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23040
23041 @table @code
23042 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23043 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23044 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23045 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23046
23047 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23048 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23049 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23050 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23051 enabled or disabled.
23052
23053 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23054 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23055 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23056 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23057 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23058 @end table
23059
23060 @node Auto-loading safe path
23061 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23062 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23063
23064 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23065 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23066 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23067 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23068 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23069
23070 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23071 get loaded:
23072
23073 @smallexample
23074 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23075 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23076 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23077 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23078 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23079 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23080 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23081 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23082 @end smallexample
23083
23084 @noindent
23085 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23086 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23087
23088 @smallexample
23089 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23090 @end smallexample
23091
23092 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23093
23094 @table @code
23095 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23096 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23097 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23098 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23099 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23100 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23101 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23102 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23103 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23104 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23105
23106 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23107 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23108 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23109
23110 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23111 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23112 @item show auto-load safe-path
23113 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23114 scripts.
23115
23116 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23117 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23118 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23119 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23120 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23121 by the host platform path separator in use.
23122 @end table
23123
23124 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23125 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23126 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23127 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23128 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23129
23130 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23131 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23132 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23133 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23134 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23135 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23136 init file in the current directory
23137 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23138
23139 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23140 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23141
23142 @table @asis
23143 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23144 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23145 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23146 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23147
23148 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23149 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23150 @value{GDBN} session.
23151
23152 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23153 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23154 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23155 from trusted sources.
23156
23157 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23158 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23159 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23160 trusted sources.
23161 @end table
23162
23163 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23164 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23165
23166 @table @asis
23167 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23168 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23169
23170 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23171 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23172 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23173 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23174 @end table
23175
23176 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23177 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23178 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23179 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23180 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23181 recommended to be entered.
23182
23183 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23184 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23185 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23186
23187 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23188 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23189 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23190 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23191 be printed.
23192
23193 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23194 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23195 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23196
23197 @smallexample
23198 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23199 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23200 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23201 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23202 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23203 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23204 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23205 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23206 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23207 @end smallexample
23208
23209 @table @code
23210 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23211 @kindex set debug auto-load
23212 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23213 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23214
23215 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23216 @kindex show debug auto-load
23217 @item show debug auto-load
23218 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23219 on or off.
23220 @end table
23221
23222 @node Messages/Warnings
23223 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23224
23225 @cindex verbose operation
23226 @cindex optional warnings
23227 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23228 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23229 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23230 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23231
23232 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23233 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23234 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23235
23236 @table @code
23237 @kindex set verbose
23238 @item set verbose on
23239 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23240
23241 @item set verbose off
23242 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23243
23244 @kindex show verbose
23245 @item show verbose
23246 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23247 @end table
23248
23249 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23250 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23251 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23252 Symbol Files}).
23253
23254 @table @code
23255
23256 @kindex set complaints
23257 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23258 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23259 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23260 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23261 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23262
23263 @kindex show complaints
23264 @item show complaints
23265 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23266
23267 @end table
23268
23269 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23270 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23271 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23272 you try to run a program which is already running:
23273
23274 @smallexample
23275 (@value{GDBP}) run
23276 The program being debugged has been started already.
23277 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23278 @end smallexample
23279
23280 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23281 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23282
23283 @table @code
23284
23285 @kindex set confirm
23286 @cindex flinching
23287 @cindex confirmation
23288 @cindex stupid questions
23289 @item set confirm off
23290 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23291 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23292 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23293
23294 @item set confirm on
23295 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23296
23297 @kindex show confirm
23298 @item show confirm
23299 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23300
23301 @end table
23302
23303 @cindex command tracing
23304 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23305 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23306 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23307 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23308
23309 @table @code
23310 @kindex set trace-commands
23311 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23312 @item set trace-commands on
23313 Enable command tracing.
23314 @item set trace-commands off
23315 Disable command tracing.
23316 @item show trace-commands
23317 Display the current state of command tracing.
23318 @end table
23319
23320 @node Debugging Output
23321 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23322 @cindex optional debugging messages
23323
23324 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23325 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23326 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23327 section documents those commands.
23328
23329 @table @code
23330 @kindex set exec-done-display
23331 @item set exec-done-display
23332 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23333 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23334 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23335 @kindex show exec-done-display
23336 @item show exec-done-display
23337 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23338 notification.
23339 @kindex set debug
23340 @cindex ARM AArch64
23341 @item set debug aarch64
23342 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23343 The default is off.
23344 @kindex show debug
23345 @item show debug aarch64
23346 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23347 ARM AArch64.
23348 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23349 @cindex architecture debugging info
23350 @item set debug arch
23351 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23352 @item show debug arch
23353 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23354 @item set debug aix-solib
23355 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23356 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23357 support module. The default is off.
23358 @item show debug aix-thread
23359 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23360 @item set debug aix-thread
23361 @cindex AIX threads
23362 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23363 module.
23364 @item show debug aix-thread
23365 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23366 @item set debug check-physname
23367 @cindex physname
23368 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23369 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23370 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23371 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23372 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23373 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23374 @item show debug check-physname
23375 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23376 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23377 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23378 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23379 exported symbols. The default is off.
23380 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23381 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23382 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23383 @item set debug dwarf2-die
23384 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
23385 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
23386 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23387 A value of zero turns off the display.
23388 @item show debug dwarf2-die
23389 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
23390 @item set debug dwarf2-read
23391 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
23392 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23393 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23394 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23395 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23396 @item show debug dwarf2-read
23397 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
23398 @item set debug displaced
23399 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23400 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23401 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23402 @item show debug displaced
23403 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23404 related to displaced stepping.
23405 @item set debug event
23406 @cindex event debugging info
23407 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23408 default is off.
23409 @item show debug event
23410 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23411 info.
23412 @item set debug expression
23413 @cindex expression debugging info
23414 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23415 expression parsing. The default is off.
23416 @item show debug expression
23417 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23418 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23419 @item set debug frame
23420 @cindex frame debugging info
23421 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23422 default is off.
23423 @item show debug frame
23424 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23425 info.
23426 @item set debug gnu-nat
23427 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23428 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23429 @item show debug gnu-nat
23430 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23431 @item set debug infrun
23432 @cindex inferior debugging info
23433 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23434 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23435 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23436 @item show debug infrun
23437 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23438 @item set debug jit
23439 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23440 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23441 @item show debug jit
23442 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23443 @item set debug lin-lwp
23444 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23445 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23446 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23447 @item show debug lin-lwp
23448 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23449 @item set debug mach-o
23450 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23451 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23452 processing. The default is off.
23453 @item show debug mach-o
23454 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23455 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23456 @item set debug notification
23457 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23458 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23459 The default is off.
23460 @item show debug notification
23461 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23462 @item set debug observer
23463 @cindex observer debugging info
23464 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23465 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23466 @item show debug observer
23467 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23468 @item set debug overload
23469 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23470 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23471 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23472 is off.
23473 @item show debug overload
23474 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23475 debugging info.
23476 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23477 @cindex debug expression parser
23478 @item set debug parser
23479 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23480 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23481 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23482 details. The default is off.
23483 @item show debug parser
23484 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23485 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23486 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23487 @cindex debug remote protocol
23488 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23489 @cindex display remote packets
23490 @item set debug remote
23491 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23492 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23493 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23494 @item show debug remote
23495 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23496 @item set debug serial
23497 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23498 default is off.
23499 @item show debug serial
23500 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23501 info.
23502 @item set debug solib-frv
23503 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23504 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23505 @item show debug solib-frv
23506 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23507 messages.
23508 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23509 @cindex symbol lookup
23510 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23511 The default is 0 (off).
23512 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23513 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23514 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23515 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23516 @item set debug symfile
23517 @cindex symbol file functions
23518 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23519 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23520 @item show debug symfile
23521 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23522 @item set debug symtab-create
23523 @cindex symbol table creation
23524 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23525 The default is 0 (off).
23526 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23527 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23528 @item show debug symtab-create
23529 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23530 @item set debug target
23531 @cindex target debugging info
23532 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23533 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23534 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23535 value of large memory transfers.
23536 @item show debug target
23537 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23538 info.
23539 @item set debug timestamp
23540 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23541 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23542 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23543 message.
23544 @item show debug timestamp
23545 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23546 debugging info.
23547 @item set debug varobj
23548 @cindex variable object debugging info
23549 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23550 info. The default is off.
23551 @item show debug varobj
23552 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23553 debugging info.
23554 @item set debug xml
23555 @cindex XML parser debugging
23556 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23557 @item show debug xml
23558 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23559 @end table
23560
23561 @node Other Misc Settings
23562 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23563 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23564
23565 @table @code
23566 @kindex set interactive-mode
23567 @item set interactive-mode
23568 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23569 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23570 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23571 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23572 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23573 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23574 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23575 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23576
23577 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23578 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23579 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23580 inside a cygwin window.
23581
23582 @kindex show interactive-mode
23583 @item show interactive-mode
23584 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23585 @end table
23586
23587 @node Extending GDB
23588 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23589 @cindex extending GDB
23590
23591 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23592 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23593 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23594 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23595 being debugged.
23596
23597 @menu
23598 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23599 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23600 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23601 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23602 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23603 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23604 @end menu
23605
23606 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23607 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23608 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23609 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23610 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23611 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23612
23613 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23614 setting:
23615
23616 @table @code
23617 @kindex set script-extension
23618 @kindex show script-extension
23619 @item set script-extension off
23620 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23621
23622 @item set script-extension soft
23623 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23624 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23625 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23626 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23627
23628 @item set script-extension strict
23629 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23630 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23631 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23632
23633 @item show script-extension
23634 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23635
23636 @end table
23637
23638 @node Sequences
23639 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23640
23641 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23642 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23643 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23644 files.
23645
23646 @menu
23647 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23648 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23649 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23650 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23651 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23652 @end menu
23653
23654 @node Define
23655 @subsection User-defined Commands
23656
23657 @cindex user-defined command
23658 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23659 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23660 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23661 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23662 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23663 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23664
23665 @smallexample
23666 define adder
23667 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23668 end
23669 @end smallexample
23670
23671 @noindent
23672 To execute the command use:
23673
23674 @smallexample
23675 adder 1 2 3
23676 @end smallexample
23677
23678 @noindent
23679 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23680 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23681 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23682 functions calls.
23683
23684 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23685 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23686 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23687 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23688
23689 @smallexample
23690 define adder
23691 if $argc == 2
23692 print $arg0 + $arg1
23693 end
23694 if $argc == 3
23695 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23696 end
23697 end
23698 @end smallexample
23699
23700 @table @code
23701
23702 @kindex define
23703 @item define @var{commandname}
23704 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23705 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23706 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23707 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23708 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23709 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23710
23711 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23712 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23713 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23714
23715 @kindex document
23716 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23717 @item document @var{commandname}
23718 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23719 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23720 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23721 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23722 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23723 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23724
23725 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23726 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23727 does not change the documentation.
23728
23729 @kindex dont-repeat
23730 @cindex don't repeat command
23731 @item dont-repeat
23732 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23733 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23734 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23735
23736 @kindex help user-defined
23737 @item help user-defined
23738 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23739 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23740 included (if any).
23741
23742 @kindex show user
23743 @item show user
23744 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23745 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23746 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23747 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23748 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23749
23750 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23751 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23752 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23753 @item show max-user-call-depth
23754 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23755 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23756 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23757 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23758 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23759 @end table
23760
23761 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23762 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23763
23764 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23765 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23766 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23767
23768 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23769 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23770 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23771 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23772
23773 @node Hooks
23774 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23775 @cindex command hooks
23776 @cindex hooks, for commands
23777 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23778
23779 @kindex hook
23780 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23781 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23782 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23783 before that command.
23784
23785 @cindex hooks, post-command
23786 @kindex hookpost
23787 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23788 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23789 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23790 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23791 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23792
23793 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23794 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23795
23796 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23797 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23798
23799 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23800 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23801 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23802 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23803 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23804
23805 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23806 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23807 you could define:
23808
23809 @smallexample
23810 define hook-stop
23811 handle SIGALRM nopass
23812 end
23813
23814 define hook-run
23815 handle SIGALRM pass
23816 end
23817
23818 define hook-continue
23819 handle SIGALRM pass
23820 end
23821 @end smallexample
23822
23823 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23824 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23825 you could define:
23826
23827 @smallexample
23828 define hook-echo
23829 echo <<<---
23830 end
23831
23832 define hookpost-echo
23833 echo --->>>\n
23834 end
23835
23836 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23837 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23838 (@value{GDBP})
23839
23840 @end smallexample
23841
23842 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23843 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23844 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23845 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23846 @c or not?
23847 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23848 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23849 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23850
23851 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23852 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23853 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23854
23855 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23856 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23857
23858 @node Command Files
23859 @subsection Command Files
23860
23861 @cindex command files
23862 @cindex scripting commands
23863 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23864 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23865 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23866 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23867 terminal.
23868
23869 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23870 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23871 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23872 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23873 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23874
23875 @table @code
23876 @kindex source
23877 @cindex execute commands from a file
23878 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23879 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23880 @end table
23881
23882 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23883 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23884 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23885 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23886 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23887
23888 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23889 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23890 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23891 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23892 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23893 is not relevant to scripts.
23894
23895 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23896 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23897 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23898 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23899 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23900 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23901 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23902 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23903 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23904 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23905 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23906 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23907 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23908 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23909
23910 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23911 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23912 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23913
23914 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23915 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23916 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23917 when called from command files.
23918
23919 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23920 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23921 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23922 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23923 the next command.
23924
23925 @smallexample
23926 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23927 @end smallexample
23928
23929 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23930 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23931 would be directed to @file{log}.
23932
23933 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23934 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23935 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23936 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23937 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23938 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23939 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23940 conditionally, etc.
23941
23942 @table @code
23943 @kindex if
23944 @kindex else
23945 @item if
23946 @itemx else
23947 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23948 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23949 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23950 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23951 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23952 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23953 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23954
23955 @kindex while
23956 @item while
23957 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23958 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23959 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23960 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23961 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23962 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23963
23964 @kindex loop_break
23965 @item loop_break
23966 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23967 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23968 line.
23969
23970 @kindex loop_continue
23971 @item loop_continue
23972 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23973 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23974 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23975 the controlling expression.
23976
23977 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23978 @item end
23979 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23980 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23981 @end table
23982
23983
23984 @node Output
23985 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23986
23987 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23988 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23989 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23990 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23991 want.
23992
23993 @table @code
23994 @kindex echo
23995 @item echo @var{text}
23996 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23997 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23998 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23999 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24000 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24001 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24002 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24003 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24004 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24005 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24006 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24007
24008 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24009 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24010
24011 @smallexample
24012 echo This is some text\n\
24013 which is continued\n\
24014 onto several lines.\n
24015 @end smallexample
24016
24017 produces the same output as
24018
24019 @smallexample
24020 echo This is some text\n
24021 echo which is continued\n
24022 echo onto several lines.\n
24023 @end smallexample
24024
24025 @kindex output
24026 @item output @var{expression}
24027 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24028 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24029 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24030 on expressions.
24031
24032 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24033 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24034 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24035 Formats}, for more information.
24036
24037 @kindex printf
24038 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24039 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24040 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24041 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24042 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24043 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24044 executing the code below:
24045
24046 @smallexample
24047 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24048 @end smallexample
24049
24050 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24051 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24052 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24053 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24054 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24055 printed.
24056
24057 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24058
24059 @smallexample
24060 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24061 @end smallexample
24062
24063 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24064 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24065 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24066
24067 @itemize @bullet
24068 @item
24069 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24070
24071 @item
24072 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24073 width.
24074
24075 @item
24076 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24077 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24078
24079 @item
24080 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24081 supported.
24082
24083 @item
24084 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24085
24086 @item
24087 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24088 @end itemize
24089
24090 @noindent
24091 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24092 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24093 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24094 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24095
24096 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24097 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24098 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24099 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24100 supported.
24101
24102 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24103 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24104 together with a floating point specifier.
24105 letters:
24106
24107 @itemize @bullet
24108 @item
24109 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24110
24111 @item
24112 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24113
24114 @item
24115 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24116 @end itemize
24117
24118 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24119 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24120 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24121
24122 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24123 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24124
24125 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24126 @smallexample
24127 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24128 @end smallexample
24129
24130 @kindex eval
24131 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24132 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24133 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24134
24135 @end table
24136
24137 @node Auto-loading sequences
24138 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24139 @cindex native script auto-loading
24140
24141 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24142 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24143 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24144 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24145
24146 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24147 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24148
24149 @table @code
24150 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24151 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24152 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24153 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24154
24155 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24156 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24157 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24158 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24159 disabled.
24160
24161 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24162 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24163 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24164 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24165 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24166 auto-loaded.
24167 @end table
24168
24169 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24170 matching names are printed.
24171
24172 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24173 @include python.texi
24174
24175 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24176 @include guile.texi
24177
24178 @node Auto-loading extensions
24179 @section Auto-loading extensions
24180 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24181
24182 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24183 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24184 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24185 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24186 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24187
24188 @menu
24189 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24190 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24191 * Which flavor to choose?::
24192 @end menu
24193
24194 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24195 debugging commands and features.
24196
24197 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24198 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24199 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24200 for more information.
24201 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24202 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24203
24204 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24205 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24206
24207 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24208 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24209 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24210 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24211 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24212
24213 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24214 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24215 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24216 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24217
24218 @table @code
24219 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24220 GDB's own command language
24221 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24222 Python
24223 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24224 Guile
24225 @end table
24226
24227 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24228 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24229 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24230 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24231 script in the specified extension language.
24232
24233 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24234 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24235
24236 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24237 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24238
24239 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24240 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24241 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24242 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24243 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24244 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24245
24246 @table @code
24247 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24248 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24249 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24250 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24251 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24252 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24253
24254 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24255 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24256
24257 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24258 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24259 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24260 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24261
24262 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24263 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24264 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24265 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24266 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24267 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24268 platform.
24269
24270 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24271 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24272 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24273
24274 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24275 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24276 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24277 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24278
24279 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24280 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24281 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24282 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24283 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24284 @end table
24285
24286 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24287 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24288 @var{objfile} is opened.
24289 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24290 is evaluated more than once.
24291
24292 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24293 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24294 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24295
24296 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24297 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24298 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24299 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24300 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24301 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24302 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24303
24304 The following entries are supported:
24305
24306 @table @code
24307 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24308 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24309 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24310 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24311 @end table
24312
24313 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24314
24315 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24316 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24317 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24318 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24319 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24320
24321 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24322 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24323
24324 @example
24325 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24326 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24327 asm("\
24328 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24329 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24330 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24331 .popsection \n\
24332 ");
24333 @end example
24334
24335 @noindent
24336 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24337 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24338
24339 @example
24340 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24341 @end example
24342
24343 The script name may include directories if desired.
24344
24345 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24346 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24347
24348 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24349 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24350 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24351 will remove duplicates.
24352
24353 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24354
24355 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24356 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24357 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24358 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24359 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24360 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24361 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24362 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24363 on its name.
24364
24365 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24366 testsuite.
24367
24368 @example
24369 #include "symcat.h"
24370 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24371 asm(
24372 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24373 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24374 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24375 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24376 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24377 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24378 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24379 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24380 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24381 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24382 ".byte 0\n"
24383 ".popsection\n"
24384 );
24385 @end example
24386
24387 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24388 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24389 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24390 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24391
24392 @node Which flavor to choose?
24393 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24394
24395 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24396 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24397
24398 @noindent
24399 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24400
24401 @itemize @bullet
24402 @item
24403 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24404
24405 @item
24406 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24407
24408 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24409 in the source search path.
24410 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24411 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24412
24413 @item
24414 Doesn't require source code additions.
24415 @end itemize
24416
24417 @noindent
24418 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24419
24420 @itemize @bullet
24421 @item
24422 Works with static linking.
24423
24424 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24425 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24426 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24427 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24428 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24429
24430 @item
24431 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24432
24433 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24434 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24435
24436 @item
24437 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24438
24439 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24440 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24441 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24442 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24443 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24444 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24445 @end itemize
24446
24447 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24448 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24449
24450 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24451 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24452 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24453
24454 @subsection Python comes first
24455
24456 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24457 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24458 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24459 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24460 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24461 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24462 pretty-printed form of a value).
24463 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24464 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24465 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24466
24467 @node Aliases
24468 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24469 @cindex aliases for commands
24470
24471 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24472 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24473 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24474 that involves less typing.
24475
24476 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24477 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24478 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24479
24480 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24481 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24482 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24483
24484 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24485
24486 @table @code
24487
24488 @kindex alias
24489 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24490
24491 @end table
24492
24493 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24494 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24495 underscores.
24496
24497 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24498 that is being aliased.
24499
24500 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24501 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24502 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24503
24504 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24505 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24506
24507 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24508 of a command so that there is less to type.
24509 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24510 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24511 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24512 The following will accomplish this.
24513
24514 @smallexample
24515 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24516 @end smallexample
24517
24518 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24519 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24520 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24521 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24522
24523 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24524 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24525 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24526 of a command.
24527
24528 @smallexample
24529 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24530 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24531 (gdb) set p elms 20
24532 (gdb) show p elms
24533 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24534 @end smallexample
24535
24536 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24537 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24538 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24539
24540 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24541 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24542
24543 @smallexample
24544 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24545 @end smallexample
24546
24547 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24548 alias for a more complex command.
24549 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24550
24551 @smallexample
24552 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24553 (gdb) spe 20
24554 @end smallexample
24555
24556 @node Interpreters
24557 @chapter Command Interpreters
24558 @cindex command interpreters
24559
24560 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24561 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24562 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24563
24564 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24565 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24566 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24567 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24568
24569 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24570 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24571 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24572 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24573
24574 @table @code
24575 @item console
24576 @cindex console interpreter
24577 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24578 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24579 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24580
24581 @item mi
24582 @cindex mi interpreter
24583 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24584 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24585 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24586 Interface}.
24587
24588 @item mi2
24589 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24590 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24591
24592 @item mi1
24593 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24594 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24595
24596 @end table
24597
24598 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24599 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24600 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24601 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24602 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24603 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24604 the IDE inoperable!
24605
24606 @kindex interpreter-exec
24607 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24608 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24609 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24610 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24611
24612 @smallexample
24613 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24614 @end smallexample
24615
24616 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24617 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24618
24619 @node TUI
24620 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24621 @cindex TUI
24622 @cindex Text User Interface
24623
24624 @menu
24625 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24626 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24627 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24628 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24629 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24630 @end menu
24631
24632 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24633 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24634 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24635 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24636 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24637 is available.
24638
24639 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24640 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24641 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24642 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24643 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24644
24645 @node TUI Overview
24646 @section TUI Overview
24647
24648 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24649
24650 @table @emph
24651 @item command
24652 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24653 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24654 managed using readline.
24655
24656 @item source
24657 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24658 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24659
24660 @item assembly
24661 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24662
24663 @item register
24664 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24665 when their values change.
24666 @end table
24667
24668 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24669 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24670 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24671 indicates the breakpoint type:
24672
24673 @table @code
24674 @item B
24675 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24676
24677 @item b
24678 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24679
24680 @item H
24681 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24682
24683 @item h
24684 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24685 @end table
24686
24687 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24688
24689 @table @code
24690 @item +
24691 Breakpoint is enabled.
24692
24693 @item -
24694 Breakpoint is disabled.
24695 @end table
24696
24697 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24698 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24699 changes.
24700
24701 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24702 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24703 layouts:
24704
24705 @itemize @bullet
24706 @item
24707 source only,
24708
24709 @item
24710 assembly only,
24711
24712 @item
24713 source and assembly,
24714
24715 @item
24716 source and registers, or
24717
24718 @item
24719 assembly and registers.
24720 @end itemize
24721
24722 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24723
24724 @table @emph
24725 @item target
24726 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24727 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24728
24729 @item process
24730 Gives the current process or thread number.
24731 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24732
24733 @item function
24734 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24735 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24736 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24737 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24738
24739 @item line
24740 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24741 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24742
24743 @item pc
24744 Indicates the current program counter address.
24745 @end table
24746
24747 @node TUI Keys
24748 @section TUI Key Bindings
24749 @cindex TUI key bindings
24750
24751 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24752 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24753 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24754 @end ifset
24755 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24756 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24757 @end ifclear
24758 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24759 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24760
24761 @table @kbd
24762 @kindex C-x C-a
24763 @item C-x C-a
24764 @kindex C-x a
24765 @itemx C-x a
24766 @kindex C-x A
24767 @itemx C-x A
24768 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24769 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24770 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24771 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24772 The screen is then refreshed.
24773
24774 @kindex C-x 1
24775 @item C-x 1
24776 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24777 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24778 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24779
24780 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24781
24782 @kindex C-x 2
24783 @item C-x 2
24784 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24785 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24786 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24787 previous layout and the new one.
24788
24789 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24790
24791 @kindex C-x o
24792 @item C-x o
24793 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24794 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24795 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24796
24797 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24798
24799 @kindex C-x s
24800 @item C-x s
24801 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24802 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24803 @end table
24804
24805 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24806
24807 @table @asis
24808 @kindex PgUp
24809 @item @key{PgUp}
24810 Scroll the active window one page up.
24811
24812 @kindex PgDn
24813 @item @key{PgDn}
24814 Scroll the active window one page down.
24815
24816 @kindex Up
24817 @item @key{Up}
24818 Scroll the active window one line up.
24819
24820 @kindex Down
24821 @item @key{Down}
24822 Scroll the active window one line down.
24823
24824 @kindex Left
24825 @item @key{Left}
24826 Scroll the active window one column left.
24827
24828 @kindex Right
24829 @item @key{Right}
24830 Scroll the active window one column right.
24831
24832 @kindex C-L
24833 @item @kbd{C-L}
24834 Refresh the screen.
24835 @end table
24836
24837 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24838 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24839 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24840 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24841 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24842
24843 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24844 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24845 @cindex TUI single key mode
24846
24847 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24848 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24849 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24850
24851 @table @kbd
24852 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24853 @item c
24854 continue
24855
24856 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24857 @item d
24858 down
24859
24860 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24861 @item f
24862 finish
24863
24864 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24865 @item n
24866 next
24867
24868 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24869 @item q
24870 exit the SingleKey mode.
24871
24872 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24873 @item r
24874 run
24875
24876 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24877 @item s
24878 step
24879
24880 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24881 @item u
24882 up
24883
24884 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24885 @item v
24886 info locals
24887
24888 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24889 @item w
24890 where
24891 @end table
24892
24893 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24894 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24895 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24896 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24897 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24898 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24899
24900
24901 @node TUI Commands
24902 @section TUI-specific Commands
24903 @cindex TUI commands
24904
24905 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24906 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24907 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24908 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24909
24910 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24911 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24912 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24913 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24914 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24915
24916 @table @code
24917 @item info win
24918 @kindex info win
24919 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24920
24921 @item layout next
24922 @kindex layout
24923 Display the next layout.
24924
24925 @item layout prev
24926 Display the previous layout.
24927
24928 @item layout src
24929 Display the source window only.
24930
24931 @item layout asm
24932 Display the assembly window only.
24933
24934 @item layout split
24935 Display the source and assembly window.
24936
24937 @item layout regs
24938 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24939
24940 @item focus next
24941 @kindex focus
24942 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24943
24944 @item focus prev
24945 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24946
24947 @item focus src
24948 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24949
24950 @item focus asm
24951 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24952
24953 @item focus regs
24954 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24955
24956 @item focus cmd
24957 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24958
24959 @item refresh
24960 @kindex refresh
24961 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24962
24963 @item tui reg float
24964 @kindex tui reg
24965 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24966
24967 @item tui reg general
24968 Show the general registers in the register window.
24969
24970 @item tui reg next
24971 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24972 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24973 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24974 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24975
24976 @item tui reg system
24977 Show the system registers in the register window.
24978
24979 @item update
24980 @kindex update
24981 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24982
24983 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24984 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24985 @kindex winheight
24986 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24987 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24988 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
24989 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
24990 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
24991
24992 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24993 @kindex tabset
24994 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
24995 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
24996 assembly windows.
24997 @end table
24998
24999 @node TUI Configuration
25000 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25001 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25002
25003 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25004
25005 @table @code
25006 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25007 @kindex set tui border-kind
25008 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25009 The possible values are the following:
25010 @table @code
25011 @item space
25012 Use a space character to draw the border.
25013
25014 @item ascii
25015 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25016
25017 @item acs
25018 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25019 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25020 @end table
25021
25022 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25023 @kindex set tui border-mode
25024 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25025 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25026 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25027 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25028 @table @code
25029 @item normal
25030 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25031
25032 @item standout
25033 Use standout mode.
25034
25035 @item reverse
25036 Use reverse video mode.
25037
25038 @item half
25039 Use half bright mode.
25040
25041 @item half-standout
25042 Use half bright and standout mode.
25043
25044 @item bold
25045 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25046
25047 @item bold-standout
25048 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25049 @end table
25050 @end table
25051
25052 @node Emacs
25053 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25054
25055 @cindex Emacs
25056 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25057 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25058 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25059 @value{GDBN}.
25060
25061 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25062 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25063 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25064 created Emacs buffer.
25065 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25066
25067 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25068 things:
25069
25070 @itemize @bullet
25071 @item
25072 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25073 the GUD buffer.
25074
25075 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25076 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25077
25078 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25079 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25080 in this way.
25081
25082 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25083 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25084 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25085 stop.
25086
25087 @item
25088 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25089
25090 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25091 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25092 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25093 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25094 and the source.
25095
25096 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25097 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25098 @end itemize
25099
25100 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25101 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25102 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25103 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25104
25105 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25106 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25107 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25108 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25109 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25110 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25111 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25112 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25113 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25114
25115 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25116 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25117 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25118 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25119
25120 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25121 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25122 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25123 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25124 one you want.
25125
25126 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25127 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25128
25129 @table @kbd
25130 @item C-h m
25131 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25132
25133 @item C-c C-s
25134 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25135 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25136
25137 @item C-c C-n
25138 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25139 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25140 to show the current file and location.
25141
25142 @item C-c C-i
25143 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25144 display window accordingly.
25145
25146 @item C-c C-f
25147 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25148 @code{finish} command.
25149
25150 @item C-c C-r
25151 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25152 command.
25153
25154 @item C-c <
25155 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25156 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25157 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25158
25159 @item C-c >
25160 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25161 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25162 @end table
25163
25164 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25165 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25166
25167 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25168 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25169 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25170 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25171 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25172 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25173 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25174
25175 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25176 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25177 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25178 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25179 frame.
25180
25181 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25182 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25183 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25184 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25185 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25186 to correspond properly with the code.
25187
25188 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25189 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25190 Emacs Manual}).
25191
25192 @node GDB/MI
25193 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25194
25195 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25196
25197 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25198 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25199 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25200 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25201 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25202 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25203
25204 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25205 in the form of a reference manual.
25206
25207 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25208 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25209 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25210
25211 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25212
25213 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25214 This chapter uses the following notation:
25215
25216 @itemize @bullet
25217 @item
25218 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25219
25220 @item
25221 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25222 it may or may not be given.
25223
25224 @item
25225 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25226 may repeat zero or more times.
25227
25228 @item
25229 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25230 may repeat one or more times.
25231
25232 @item
25233 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25234 @end itemize
25235
25236 @ignore
25237 @heading Dependencies
25238 @end ignore
25239
25240 @menu
25241 * GDB/MI General Design::
25242 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25243 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25244 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25245 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25246 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25247 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25248 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25249 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25250 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25251 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25252 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25253 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25254 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25255 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25256 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25257 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25258 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25259 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25260 @ignore
25261 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25262 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25263 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25264 @end ignore
25265 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25266 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25267 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25268 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25269 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25270 @end menu
25271
25272 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25273 @node GDB/MI General Design
25274 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25275 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25276
25277 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25278 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25279 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25280 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25281 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25282 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25283 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25284 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25285 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25286 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25287
25288 The important examples of notifications are:
25289 @itemize @bullet
25290
25291 @item
25292 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25293 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25294 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25295 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25296 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25297 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25298 command itself was successfully executed.
25299
25300 @item
25301 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25302 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25303 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25304 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25305 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25306 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25307
25308 @item
25309 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25310 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25311 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25312 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25313 orthogonal frontend design.
25314
25315 @end itemize
25316
25317 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25318 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25319 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25320 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25321 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25322 the user interface.
25323
25324
25325 @menu
25326 * Context management::
25327 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25328 * Thread groups::
25329 @end menu
25330
25331 @node Context management
25332 @subsection Context management
25333
25334 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25335
25336 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25337 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25338 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25339 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25340 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25341 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25342 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25343 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25344 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25345
25346 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25347 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25348 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25349 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25350 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25351 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25352 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25353 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25354 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25355 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25356 for thread and frame to operate on.
25357
25358 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25359 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25360 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25361 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25362 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25363 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25364 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25365 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25366 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25367 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25368
25369 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25370 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25371 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25372 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25373 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25374 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25375 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25376 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25377 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25378 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25379 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25380 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25381 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25382 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25383 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25384 @samp{--frame} options.
25385
25386 @subsubsection Language
25387
25388 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25389 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25390 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25391 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25392 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25393 For instance:
25394
25395 @smallexample
25396 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25397 ^done,value="4"
25398 (gdb)
25399 @end smallexample
25400
25401 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25402 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25403 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25404
25405 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25406 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25407
25408 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25409 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25410 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25411 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25412 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25413 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25414 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25415 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25416 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25417
25418 @table @code
25419 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25420 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25421 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25422
25423 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25424 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25425 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25426
25427 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25428 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25429 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25430 MI commands even while the target is running.
25431
25432 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25433 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25434 @end table
25435
25436 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25437 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25438 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25439 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25440 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25441 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25442
25443 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25444 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25445 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25446 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25447 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25448 are running.
25449
25450 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25451 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25452 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25453 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25454 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25455 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25456 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25457 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25458 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25459 @samp{--thread} option).
25460
25461 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25462 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25463 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25464 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25465
25466 @node Thread groups
25467 @subsection Thread groups
25468 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25469 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25470 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25471 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25472 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25473
25474 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25475 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25476 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25477 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25478 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25479 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25480 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25481 into processes.
25482
25483 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25484 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25485 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25486 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25487 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25488 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25489 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25490 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25491 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25492 the members of specific thread group.
25493
25494 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25495 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25496 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25497 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25498 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25499 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25500 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25501 after attaching to that thread group.
25502
25503 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25504 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25505 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25506 such thread groups.
25507
25508 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25509 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25510 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25511
25512 @menu
25513 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25514 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25515 @end menu
25516
25517 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25518 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25519
25520 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25521 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25522 @table @code
25523 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25524 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25525
25526 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25527 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25528 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25529
25530 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25531 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25532 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25533
25534 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25535 "any sequence of digits"
25536
25537 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25538 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25539
25540 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25541 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25542
25543 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25544 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25545
25546 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25547 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25548 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25549
25550 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25551 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25552
25553 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25554 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25555 @end table
25556
25557 @noindent
25558 Notes:
25559
25560 @itemize @bullet
25561 @item
25562 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25563 output is described below.
25564
25565 @item
25566 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25567 finishes.
25568
25569 @item
25570 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25571 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25572 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25573 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25574 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25575 @end itemize
25576
25577 Pragmatics:
25578
25579 @itemize @bullet
25580 @item
25581 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25582
25583 @item
25584 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25585 @end itemize
25586
25587 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25588 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25589
25590 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25591 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25592 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25593 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25594 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25595 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25596
25597 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25598 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25599 @var{token}.
25600
25601 @table @code
25602 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25603 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25604
25605 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25606 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25607
25608 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25609 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25610
25611 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25612 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25613
25614 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25615 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25616
25617 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25618 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25619
25620 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25621 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25622
25623 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25624 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25625
25626 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25627 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25628
25629 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25630 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25631 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25632
25633 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25634 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25635
25636 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25637 @code{ @var{string} }
25638
25639 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25640 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25641
25642 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25643 @code{@var{c-string}}
25644
25645 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25646 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25647
25648 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25649 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25650 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25651
25652 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25653 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25654
25655 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25656 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25657
25658 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25659 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25660
25661 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25662 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25663
25664 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25665 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25666
25667 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25668 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25669 @end table
25670
25671 @noindent
25672 Notes:
25673
25674 @itemize @bullet
25675 @item
25676 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25677
25678 @item
25679 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25680 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25681 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25682 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25683 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25684 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25685 prior command.
25686
25687 @item
25688 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25689 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25690 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25691 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25692
25693 @item
25694 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25695 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25696 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25697 @samp{*}.
25698
25699 @item
25700 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25701 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25702 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25703 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25704
25705 @item
25706 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25707 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25708 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25709 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25710
25711 @item
25712 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25713 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25714 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25715
25716 @item
25717 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25718 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25719 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25720 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25721
25722 @item
25723 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25724 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25725 @var{values}.
25726
25727
25728 @end itemize
25729
25730 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25731 details about the various output records.
25732
25733 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25734 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25735 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25736
25737 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25738 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25739
25740 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25741 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25742 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25743 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25744 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25745 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25746
25747 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25748 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25749 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25750
25751 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25752 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25753 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25754 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25755
25756 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25757 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25758
25759 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25760 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25761 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25762 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25763 might change.
25764
25765 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25766 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25767 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25768 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25769
25770 @itemize @bullet
25771 @item
25772 New MI commands may be added.
25773
25774 @item
25775 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25776
25777 @item
25778 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25779 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25780
25781 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25782 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25783
25784 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25785 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25786 @end itemize
25787
25788 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25789 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25790 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25791 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25792 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25793
25794 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25795 @c version?
25796
25797 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25798 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25799 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25800 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25801 @cindex mailing lists
25802
25803 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25804 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25805 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25806
25807 @menu
25808 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25809 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25810 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25811 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25812 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25813 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25814 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25815 @end menu
25816
25817 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25818 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25819
25820 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25821 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25822 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25823 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25824
25825 @table @code
25826 @findex ^done
25827 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25828 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25829 values.
25830
25831 @item "^running"
25832 @findex ^running
25833 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25834 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25835 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25836 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25837 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25838 which threads are resumed.
25839
25840 @item "^connected"
25841 @findex ^connected
25842 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25843
25844 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25845 @findex ^error
25846 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25847 the corresponding error message.
25848
25849 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25850 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25851 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25852
25853 @table @samp
25854 @item "undefined-command"
25855 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25856 @end table
25857
25858 @item "^exit"
25859 @findex ^exit
25860 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25861
25862 @end table
25863
25864 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25865 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25866
25867 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25868 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25869 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25870 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25871 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25872
25873 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25874 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25875 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25876 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25877 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25878
25879 @table @code
25880 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25881 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25882 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25883
25884 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25885 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25886 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25887 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25888
25889 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25890 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25891 internals.
25892 @end table
25893
25894 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25895 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25896
25897 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25898 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25899 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25900 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25901 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25902 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25903
25904 The following is the list of possible async records:
25905
25906 @table @code
25907
25908 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25909 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25910 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25911 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25912 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25913 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25914 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25915 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25916 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25917 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25918
25919 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25920 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25921 following values:
25922
25923 @table @code
25924 @item breakpoint-hit
25925 A breakpoint was reached.
25926 @item watchpoint-trigger
25927 A watchpoint was triggered.
25928 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25929 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25930 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25931 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25932 @item function-finished
25933 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25934 @item location-reached
25935 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25936 @item watchpoint-scope
25937 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25938 @item end-stepping-range
25939 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25940 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25941 @item exited-signalled
25942 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25943 @item exited
25944 The inferior exited.
25945 @item exited-normally
25946 The inferior exited normally.
25947 @item signal-received
25948 A signal was received by the inferior.
25949 @item solib-event
25950 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25951 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25952 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25953 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25954 @item fork
25955 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25956 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25957 @item vfork
25958 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25959 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25960 @item syscall-entry
25961 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25962 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25963 @item syscall-return
25964 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25965 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25966 @item exec
25967 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25968 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25969 @end table
25970
25971 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25972 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25973 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25974 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25975 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25976 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25977 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25978 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25979 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25980 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25981 if such information is not available.
25982
25983 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25984 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25985 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25986 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25987 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25988 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25989 cannot be used in any way.
25990
25991 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25992 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25993 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25994 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25995 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25996 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25997
25998 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25999 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26000 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26001 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26002 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26003 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26004
26005 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26006 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26007 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26008 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26009 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26010
26011 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26012 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26013 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26014 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26015 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26016 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26017 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26018
26019 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26020 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26021 that thread.
26022
26023 @item =library-loaded,...
26024 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26025 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26026 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26027 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26028 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26029 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26030 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26031 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26032 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26033 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26034 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26035 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26036 thread groups.
26037
26038 @item =library-unloaded,...
26039 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26040 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26041 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26042 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26043 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26044 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26045 thread groups.
26046
26047 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26048 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26049 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26050 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26051 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26052
26053 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26054 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26055 initial value @var{initial}.
26056
26057 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26058 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26059 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26060 trace state variables are deleted.
26061
26062 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26063 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26064 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26065 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26066 value of trace state variable is known.
26067
26068 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26069 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26070 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26071 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26072 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26073 user.
26074
26075 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26076 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26077 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26078
26079 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26080 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26081
26082 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26083 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26084 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26085 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26086 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26087
26088 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26089 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26090 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26091 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26092 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26093 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26094
26095 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26096 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26097 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26098 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26099 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26100 executable code.
26101 @end table
26102
26103 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26104 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26105
26106 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26107 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26108 following fields:
26109
26110 @table @code
26111 @item number
26112 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26113 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26114 @samp{1.2}.
26115
26116 @item type
26117 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26118 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26119
26120 @item catch-type
26121 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26122 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26123
26124 @item disp
26125 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26126 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26127 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26128
26129 @item enabled
26130 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26131 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26132 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26133
26134 @item addr
26135 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26136 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26137 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26138 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26139 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26140
26141 @item func
26142 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26143 If not known, this field is not present.
26144
26145 @item filename
26146 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26147 If not known, this field is not present.
26148
26149 @item fullname
26150 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26151 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26152
26153 @item line
26154 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26155 If not known, this field is not present.
26156
26157 @item at
26158 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26159 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26160 by a symbol name.
26161
26162 @item pending
26163 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26164 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26165
26166 @item evaluated-by
26167 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26168 @samp{target}.
26169
26170 @item thread
26171 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26172 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26173
26174 @item task
26175 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26176 field will hold the task identifier.
26177
26178 @item cond
26179 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26180
26181 @item ignore
26182 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26183
26184 @item enable
26185 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26186
26187 @item traceframe-usage
26188 FIXME.
26189
26190 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26191 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26192
26193 @item mask
26194 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26195
26196 @item pass
26197 A tracepoint's pass count.
26198
26199 @item original-location
26200 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26201 This field is optional.
26202
26203 @item times
26204 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26205
26206 @item installed
26207 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26208 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26209 is not.
26210
26211 @item what
26212 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26213
26214 @end table
26215
26216 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26217 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26218
26219 @smallexample
26220 -> -break-insert main
26221 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26222 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26223 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26224 times="0"@}
26225 <- (gdb)
26226 @end smallexample
26227
26228 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26229 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26230
26231 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26232 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26233 fields:
26234
26235 @table @code
26236 @item level
26237 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26238 zero. This field is always present.
26239
26240 @item func
26241 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26242 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26243
26244 @item addr
26245 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26246
26247 @item file
26248 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26249 address. This field may be absent.
26250
26251 @item line
26252 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26253 may be absent.
26254
26255 @item from
26256 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26257 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26258
26259 @end table
26260
26261 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26262 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26263
26264 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26265 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26266
26267 @table @code
26268 @item id
26269 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26270 always present.
26271
26272 @item target-id
26273 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26274
26275 @item details
26276 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26277 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26278 frontend. This field is optional.
26279
26280 @item state
26281 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26282 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26283
26284 @item core
26285 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26286 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26287 @end table
26288
26289 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26290 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26291
26292 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26293 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26294 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26295 the @code{exception-name} field.
26296
26297 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26298 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26299 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26300 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26301
26302 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26303 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26304 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26305 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26306
26307 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26308 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26309
26310 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26311
26312 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26313 information of the breakpoint.
26314
26315 @smallexample
26316 -> -break-insert main
26317 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26318 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26319 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26320 times="0"@}
26321 <- (gdb)
26322 @end smallexample
26323
26324 @subheading Program Execution
26325
26326 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26327 reason that execution stopped.
26328
26329 @smallexample
26330 -> -exec-run
26331 <- ^running
26332 <- (gdb)
26333 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26334 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26335 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26336 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26337 <- (gdb)
26338 -> -exec-continue
26339 <- ^running
26340 <- (gdb)
26341 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26342 <- (gdb)
26343 @end smallexample
26344
26345 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26346
26347 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26348
26349 @smallexample
26350 -> (gdb)
26351 <- -gdb-exit
26352 <- ^exit
26353 @end smallexample
26354
26355 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26356 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26357 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26358 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26359 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26360 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26361
26362 @subheading A Bad Command
26363
26364 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26365
26366 @smallexample
26367 -> -rubbish
26368 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26369 <- (gdb)
26370 @end smallexample
26371
26372
26373 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26374 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26375 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26376
26377 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26378 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26379
26380 @subheading Motivation
26381
26382 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26383
26384 @subheading Introduction
26385
26386 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26387
26388 @subheading Commands
26389
26390 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26391
26392 @subsubheading Synopsis
26393
26394 @smallexample
26395 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26396 @end smallexample
26397
26398 @subsubheading Result
26399
26400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26401
26402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26403
26404 @subsubheading Example
26405
26406 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26407 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26408
26409
26410 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26411 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26412 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26413
26414 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26415 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26416 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26417 breakpoints.
26418
26419 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26420 @findex -break-after
26421
26422 @subsubheading Synopsis
26423
26424 @smallexample
26425 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26426 @end smallexample
26427
26428 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26429 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26430 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26431 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26432
26433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26434
26435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26436
26437 @subsubheading Example
26438
26439 @smallexample
26440 (gdb)
26441 -break-insert main
26442 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26443 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26444 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26445 times="0"@}
26446 (gdb)
26447 -break-after 1 3
26448 ~
26449 ^done
26450 (gdb)
26451 -break-list
26452 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26453 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26454 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26455 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26456 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26457 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26458 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26459 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26460 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26461 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26462 (gdb)
26463 @end smallexample
26464
26465 @ignore
26466 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26467 @findex -break-catch
26468 @end ignore
26469
26470 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26471 @findex -break-commands
26472
26473 @subsubheading Synopsis
26474
26475 @smallexample
26476 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26477 @end smallexample
26478
26479 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26480 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26481 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26482 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26483 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26484 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26485
26486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26487
26488 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26489
26490 @subsubheading Example
26491
26492 @smallexample
26493 (gdb)
26494 -break-insert main
26495 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26496 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26497 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26498 times="0"@}
26499 (gdb)
26500 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26501 ^done
26502 (gdb)
26503 @end smallexample
26504
26505 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26506 @findex -break-condition
26507
26508 @subsubheading Synopsis
26509
26510 @smallexample
26511 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26512 @end smallexample
26513
26514 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26515 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26516 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26517 command below).
26518
26519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26520
26521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26522
26523 @subsubheading Example
26524
26525 @smallexample
26526 (gdb)
26527 -break-condition 1 1
26528 ^done
26529 (gdb)
26530 -break-list
26531 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26532 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26533 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26534 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26535 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26536 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26537 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26538 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26539 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26540 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26541 (gdb)
26542 @end smallexample
26543
26544 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26545 @findex -break-delete
26546
26547 @subsubheading Synopsis
26548
26549 @smallexample
26550 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26551 @end smallexample
26552
26553 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26554 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26555
26556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26557
26558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26559
26560 @subsubheading Example
26561
26562 @smallexample
26563 (gdb)
26564 -break-delete 1
26565 ^done
26566 (gdb)
26567 -break-list
26568 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26569 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26570 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26571 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26572 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26573 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26574 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26575 body=[]@}
26576 (gdb)
26577 @end smallexample
26578
26579 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26580 @findex -break-disable
26581
26582 @subsubheading Synopsis
26583
26584 @smallexample
26585 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26586 @end smallexample
26587
26588 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26589 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26590
26591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26592
26593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26594
26595 @subsubheading Example
26596
26597 @smallexample
26598 (gdb)
26599 -break-disable 2
26600 ^done
26601 (gdb)
26602 -break-list
26603 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26604 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26605 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26606 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26607 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26608 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26609 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26610 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26611 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26612 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26613 (gdb)
26614 @end smallexample
26615
26616 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26617 @findex -break-enable
26618
26619 @subsubheading Synopsis
26620
26621 @smallexample
26622 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26623 @end smallexample
26624
26625 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26626
26627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26628
26629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26630
26631 @subsubheading Example
26632
26633 @smallexample
26634 (gdb)
26635 -break-enable 2
26636 ^done
26637 (gdb)
26638 -break-list
26639 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26640 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26641 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26642 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26643 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26644 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26645 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26646 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26647 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26648 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26649 (gdb)
26650 @end smallexample
26651
26652 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26653 @findex -break-info
26654
26655 @subsubheading Synopsis
26656
26657 @smallexample
26658 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26659 @end smallexample
26660
26661 @c REDUNDANT???
26662 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26663
26664 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26665 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26666 table.
26667
26668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26669
26670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26671
26672 @subsubheading Example
26673 N.A.
26674
26675 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26676 @findex -break-insert
26677
26678 @subsubheading Synopsis
26679
26680 @smallexample
26681 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26682 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26683 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26684 @end smallexample
26685
26686 @noindent
26687 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26688
26689 @itemize @bullet
26690 @item function
26691 @c @item +offset
26692 @c @item -offset
26693 @c @item linenum
26694 @item filename:linenum
26695 @item filename:function
26696 @item *address
26697 @end itemize
26698
26699 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26700
26701 @table @samp
26702 @item -t
26703 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26704 @item -h
26705 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26706 @item -f
26707 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26708 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26709 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26710 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26711 cannot be parsed.
26712 @item -d
26713 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26714 @item -a
26715 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26716 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26717 @item -c @var{condition}
26718 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26719 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26720 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26721 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26722 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26723 @end table
26724
26725 @subsubheading Result
26726
26727 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26728 resulting breakpoint.
26729
26730 Note: this format is open to change.
26731 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26732
26733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26734
26735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26736 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26737
26738 @subsubheading Example
26739
26740 @smallexample
26741 (gdb)
26742 -break-insert main
26743 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26744 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26745 times="0"@}
26746 (gdb)
26747 -break-insert -t foo
26748 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26749 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26750 times="0"@}
26751 (gdb)
26752 -break-list
26753 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26754 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26755 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26756 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26757 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26758 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26759 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26760 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26761 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26762 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26763 times="0"@},
26764 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26765 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26766 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26767 times="0"@}]@}
26768 (gdb)
26769 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26770 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26771 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26772 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26773 @c times="0"@}
26774 @c (gdb)
26775 @end smallexample
26776
26777 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26778 @findex -dprintf-insert
26779
26780 @subsubheading Synopsis
26781
26782 @smallexample
26783 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26784 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26785 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26786 [ @var{argument} ]
26787 @end smallexample
26788
26789 @noindent
26790 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26791
26792 @itemize @bullet
26793 @item @var{function}
26794 @c @item +offset
26795 @c @item -offset
26796 @c @item @var{linenum}
26797 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26798 @item @var{filename}:function
26799 @item *@var{address}
26800 @end itemize
26801
26802 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26803
26804 @table @samp
26805 @item -t
26806 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26807 @item -f
26808 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26809 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26810 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26811 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26812 cannot be parsed.
26813 @item -d
26814 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26815 @item -c @var{condition}
26816 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26817 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26818 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26819 to @var{ignore-count}.
26820 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26821 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26822 @end table
26823
26824 @subsubheading Result
26825
26826 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26827 resulting breakpoint.
26828
26829 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26830
26831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26832
26833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26834
26835 @subsubheading Example
26836
26837 @smallexample
26838 (gdb)
26839 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26840 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26841 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26842 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26843 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26844 original-location="foo"@}
26845 (gdb)
26846 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26847 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26848 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26849 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26850 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26851 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26852 (gdb)
26853 @end smallexample
26854
26855 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26856 @findex -break-list
26857
26858 @subsubheading Synopsis
26859
26860 @smallexample
26861 -break-list
26862 @end smallexample
26863
26864 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26865
26866 @table @samp
26867 @item Number
26868 number of the breakpoint
26869 @item Type
26870 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26871 @item Disposition
26872 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26873 or @samp{nokeep}
26874 @item Enabled
26875 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26876 @item Address
26877 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26878 @item What
26879 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26880 name, line number
26881 @item Thread-groups
26882 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26883 @item Times
26884 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26885 @end table
26886
26887 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26888 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26889
26890 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26891
26892 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26893
26894 @subsubheading Example
26895
26896 @smallexample
26897 (gdb)
26898 -break-list
26899 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26900 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26901 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26902 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26903 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26904 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26905 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26906 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26907 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26908 times="0"@},
26909 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26910 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26911 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26912 (gdb)
26913 @end smallexample
26914
26915 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26916
26917 @smallexample
26918 (gdb)
26919 -break-list
26920 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26921 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26922 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26923 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26924 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26925 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26926 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26927 body=[]@}
26928 (gdb)
26929 @end smallexample
26930
26931 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26932 @findex -break-passcount
26933
26934 @subsubheading Synopsis
26935
26936 @smallexample
26937 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26938 @end smallexample
26939
26940 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26941 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26942 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26943 command @samp{passcount}.
26944
26945 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26946 @findex -break-watch
26947
26948 @subsubheading Synopsis
26949
26950 @smallexample
26951 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26952 @end smallexample
26953
26954 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26955 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26956 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26957 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26958 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26959 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26960 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26961 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26962
26963 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26964 breakpoints inserted.
26965
26966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26967
26968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26969 @samp{rwatch}.
26970
26971 @subsubheading Example
26972
26973 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26974
26975 @smallexample
26976 (gdb)
26977 -break-watch x
26978 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26979 (gdb)
26980 -exec-continue
26981 ^running
26982 (gdb)
26983 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26984 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26985 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26986 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26987 (gdb)
26988 @end smallexample
26989
26990 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26991 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26992 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26993
26994 @smallexample
26995 (gdb)
26996 -break-watch C
26997 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26998 (gdb)
26999 -exec-continue
27000 ^running
27001 (gdb)
27002 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27003 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27004 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27005 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27006 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27007 (gdb)
27008 -exec-continue
27009 ^running
27010 (gdb)
27011 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27012 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27013 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27014 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27015 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27016 (gdb)
27017 @end smallexample
27018
27019 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27020 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27021 deleted.
27022
27023 @smallexample
27024 (gdb)
27025 -break-watch C
27026 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27027 (gdb)
27028 -break-list
27029 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27030 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27031 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27032 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27033 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27034 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27035 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27036 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27037 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27038 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27039 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27040 times="1"@},
27041 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27042 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27043 (gdb)
27044 -exec-continue
27045 ^running
27046 (gdb)
27047 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27048 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27049 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27050 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27051 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27052 (gdb)
27053 -break-list
27054 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27055 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27056 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27057 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27058 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27059 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27060 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27061 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27062 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27063 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27064 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27065 times="1"@},
27066 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27067 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27068 (gdb)
27069 -exec-continue
27070 ^running
27071 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27072 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27073 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27074 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27075 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27076 (gdb)
27077 -break-list
27078 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27079 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27080 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27081 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27082 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27083 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27084 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27085 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27086 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27087 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27088 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27089 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27090 (gdb)
27091 @end smallexample
27092
27093
27094 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27095 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27096 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27097
27098 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27099 catchpoints.
27100
27101 @menu
27102 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27103 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27104 @end menu
27105
27106 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27107 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27108
27109 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27110 @findex -catch-load
27111
27112 @subsubheading Synopsis
27113
27114 @smallexample
27115 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27116 @end smallexample
27117
27118 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27119 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27120 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27121 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27122 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27123
27124
27125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27126
27127 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27128
27129 @subsubheading Example
27130
27131 @smallexample
27132 -catch-load -t foo.so
27133 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27134 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27135 (gdb)
27136 @end smallexample
27137
27138
27139 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27140 @findex -catch-unload
27141
27142 @subsubheading Synopsis
27143
27144 @smallexample
27145 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27146 @end smallexample
27147
27148 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27149 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27150 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27151 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27152 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27153
27154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27155
27156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27157
27158 @subsubheading Example
27159
27160 @smallexample
27161 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27162 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27163 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27164 (gdb)
27165 @end smallexample
27166
27167 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27168 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27169
27170 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27171 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27172
27173 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27174 @findex -catch-assert
27175
27176 @subsubheading Synopsis
27177
27178 @smallexample
27179 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27180 @end smallexample
27181
27182 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27183
27184 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27185
27186 @table @samp
27187 @item -c @var{condition}
27188 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27189 @item -d
27190 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27191 @item -t
27192 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27193 @end table
27194
27195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27196
27197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27198
27199 @subsubheading Example
27200
27201 @smallexample
27202 -catch-assert
27203 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27204 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27205 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27206 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27207 (gdb)
27208 @end smallexample
27209
27210 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27211 @findex -catch-exception
27212
27213 @subsubheading Synopsis
27214
27215 @smallexample
27216 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27217 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27218 @end smallexample
27219
27220 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27221 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27222 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27223 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27224 catchpoints.
27225
27226 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27227
27228 @table @samp
27229 @item -c @var{condition}
27230 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27231 @item -d
27232 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27233 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27234 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27235 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27236 @item -t
27237 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27238 @item -u
27239 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27240 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27241 @end table
27242
27243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27244
27245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27246 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27247
27248 @subsubheading Example
27249
27250 @smallexample
27251 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27252 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27253 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27254 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27255 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27256 (gdb)
27257 @end smallexample
27258
27259 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27260 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27261 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27262
27263 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27264 @findex -exec-arguments
27265
27266
27267 @subsubheading Synopsis
27268
27269 @smallexample
27270 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27271 @end smallexample
27272
27273 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27274 @samp{-exec-run}.
27275
27276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27277
27278 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27279
27280 @subsubheading Example
27281
27282 @smallexample
27283 (gdb)
27284 -exec-arguments -v word
27285 ^done
27286 (gdb)
27287 @end smallexample
27288
27289
27290 @ignore
27291 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27292 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27293
27294 @subsubheading Synopsis
27295
27296 @smallexample
27297 -exec-show-arguments
27298 @end smallexample
27299
27300 Print the arguments of the program.
27301
27302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27303
27304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27305
27306 @subsubheading Example
27307 N.A.
27308 @end ignore
27309
27310
27311 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27312 @findex -environment-cd
27313
27314 @subsubheading Synopsis
27315
27316 @smallexample
27317 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27318 @end smallexample
27319
27320 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27321
27322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27323
27324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27325
27326 @subsubheading Example
27327
27328 @smallexample
27329 (gdb)
27330 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27331 ^done
27332 (gdb)
27333 @end smallexample
27334
27335
27336 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27337 @findex -environment-directory
27338
27339 @subsubheading Synopsis
27340
27341 @smallexample
27342 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27343 @end smallexample
27344
27345 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27346 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27347 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27348 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27349 occurs as normal.
27350 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27351 multiple directories in a single command
27352 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27353 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27354 If blanks are needed as
27355 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27356 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27357 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27358 character must not be used
27359 in any directory name.
27360 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27361
27362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27363
27364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27365
27366 @subsubheading Example
27367
27368 @smallexample
27369 (gdb)
27370 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27371 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27372 (gdb)
27373 -environment-directory ""
27374 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27375 (gdb)
27376 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27377 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27378 (gdb)
27379 -environment-directory -r
27380 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27381 (gdb)
27382 @end smallexample
27383
27384
27385 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27386 @findex -environment-path
27387
27388 @subsubheading Synopsis
27389
27390 @smallexample
27391 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27392 @end smallexample
27393
27394 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27395 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27396 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27397 supplied in addition to the
27398 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27399 occurs as normal.
27400 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27401 multiple directories in a single command
27402 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27403 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27404 If blanks are needed as
27405 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27406 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27407 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27408 character must not be used
27409 in any directory name.
27410 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27411
27412
27413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27414
27415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27416
27417 @subsubheading Example
27418
27419 @smallexample
27420 (gdb)
27421 -environment-path
27422 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27423 (gdb)
27424 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27425 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27426 (gdb)
27427 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27428 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27429 (gdb)
27430 @end smallexample
27431
27432
27433 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27434 @findex -environment-pwd
27435
27436 @subsubheading Synopsis
27437
27438 @smallexample
27439 -environment-pwd
27440 @end smallexample
27441
27442 Show the current working directory.
27443
27444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27445
27446 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27447
27448 @subsubheading Example
27449
27450 @smallexample
27451 (gdb)
27452 -environment-pwd
27453 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27454 (gdb)
27455 @end smallexample
27456
27457 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27458 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27459 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27460
27461
27462 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27463 @findex -thread-info
27464
27465 @subsubheading Synopsis
27466
27467 @smallexample
27468 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27469 @end smallexample
27470
27471 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27472 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27473 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27474 also reports the current thread.
27475
27476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27477
27478 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27479 about all threads.
27480
27481 @subsubheading Result
27482
27483 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27484 defined for a given thread:
27485
27486 @table @samp
27487 @item current
27488 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27489
27490 @item id
27491 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27492
27493 @item target-id
27494 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27495
27496 @item details
27497 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27498 field is optional.
27499
27500 @item name
27501 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27502 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27503 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27504 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27505 field is omitted.
27506
27507 @item frame
27508 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27509
27510 @item state
27511 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27512 values:
27513
27514 @table @code
27515 @item stopped
27516 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27517 threads.
27518
27519 @item running
27520 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27521 threads.
27522
27523 @end table
27524
27525 @item core
27526 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27527 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27528
27529 @end table
27530
27531 @subsubheading Example
27532
27533 @smallexample
27534 -thread-info
27535 ^done,threads=[
27536 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27537 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27538 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27539 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27540 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27541 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27542 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27543 state="running"@}],
27544 current-thread-id="1"
27545 (gdb)
27546 @end smallexample
27547
27548 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27549 @findex -thread-list-ids
27550
27551 @subsubheading Synopsis
27552
27553 @smallexample
27554 -thread-list-ids
27555 @end smallexample
27556
27557 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27558 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27559
27560 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27561 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27562
27563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27564
27565 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27566
27567 @subsubheading Example
27568
27569 @smallexample
27570 (gdb)
27571 -thread-list-ids
27572 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27573 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27574 (gdb)
27575 @end smallexample
27576
27577
27578 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27579 @findex -thread-select
27580
27581 @subsubheading Synopsis
27582
27583 @smallexample
27584 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27585 @end smallexample
27586
27587 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27588 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27589
27590 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27591 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27592
27593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27594
27595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27596
27597 @subsubheading Example
27598
27599 @smallexample
27600 (gdb)
27601 -exec-next
27602 ^running
27603 (gdb)
27604 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27605 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27606 (gdb)
27607 -thread-list-ids
27608 ^done,
27609 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27610 number-of-threads="3"
27611 (gdb)
27612 -thread-select 3
27613 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27614 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27615 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27616 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27617 (gdb)
27618 @end smallexample
27619
27620 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27621 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27622 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27623
27624 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27625 @findex -ada-task-info
27626
27627 @subsubheading Synopsis
27628
27629 @smallexample
27630 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27631 @end smallexample
27632
27633 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27634 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27635
27636 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27637
27638 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27639 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27640
27641 @subsubheading Result
27642
27643 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27644 defined for each Ada task:
27645
27646 @table @samp
27647 @item current
27648 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27649
27650 @item id
27651 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27652
27653 @item task-id
27654 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27655
27656 @item thread-id
27657 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27658
27659 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27660 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27661 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27662
27663 @item parent-id
27664 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27665 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27666
27667 @item priority
27668 The base priority of the task.
27669
27670 @item state
27671 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27672 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27673
27674 @item name
27675 The name of the task.
27676
27677 @end table
27678
27679 @subsubheading Example
27680
27681 @smallexample
27682 -ada-task-info
27683 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27684 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27685 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27686 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27687 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27688 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27689 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27690 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27691 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27692 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27693 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27694 (gdb)
27695 @end smallexample
27696
27697 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27698 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27699 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27700
27701 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27702 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27703 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27704 other cases.
27705
27706 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27707 @findex -exec-continue
27708
27709 @subsubheading Synopsis
27710
27711 @smallexample
27712 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27713 @end smallexample
27714
27715 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27716 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27717 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27718 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27719 @itemize @bullet
27720 @item
27721 breakpoints or watchpoints
27722 @item
27723 signals or exceptions
27724 @item
27725 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27726 @item
27727 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27728 @end itemize
27729 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27730 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27731 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27732 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27733 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27734 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27735
27736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27737
27738 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27739
27740 @subsubheading Example
27741
27742 @smallexample
27743 -exec-continue
27744 ^running
27745 (gdb)
27746 @@Hello world
27747 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27748 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27749 line="13"@}
27750 (gdb)
27751 @end smallexample
27752
27753
27754 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27755 @findex -exec-finish
27756
27757 @subsubheading Synopsis
27758
27759 @smallexample
27760 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27761 @end smallexample
27762
27763 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27764 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27765 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27766 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27767 function was called.
27768
27769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27770
27771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27772
27773 @subsubheading Example
27774
27775 Function returning @code{void}.
27776
27777 @smallexample
27778 -exec-finish
27779 ^running
27780 (gdb)
27781 @@hello from foo
27782 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27783 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27784 (gdb)
27785 @end smallexample
27786
27787 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27788 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27789 value itself.
27790
27791 @smallexample
27792 -exec-finish
27793 ^running
27794 (gdb)
27795 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27796 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27797 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27798 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27799 (gdb)
27800 @end smallexample
27801
27802
27803 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27804 @findex -exec-interrupt
27805
27806 @subsubheading Synopsis
27807
27808 @smallexample
27809 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27810 @end smallexample
27811
27812 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27813 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27814 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27815 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27816 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27817
27818 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27819 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27820 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27821 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27822
27823 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27824 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27825 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27826 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27827
27828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27829
27830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27831
27832 @subsubheading Example
27833
27834 @smallexample
27835 (gdb)
27836 111-exec-continue
27837 111^running
27838
27839 (gdb)
27840 222-exec-interrupt
27841 222^done
27842 (gdb)
27843 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27844 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27845 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27846 (gdb)
27847
27848 (gdb)
27849 -exec-interrupt
27850 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27851 (gdb)
27852 @end smallexample
27853
27854 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27855 @findex -exec-jump
27856
27857 @subsubheading Synopsis
27858
27859 @smallexample
27860 -exec-jump @var{location}
27861 @end smallexample
27862
27863 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27864 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27865 different forms of @var{location}.
27866
27867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27868
27869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27870
27871 @subsubheading Example
27872
27873 @smallexample
27874 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27875 *running,thread-id="all"
27876 ^running
27877 @end smallexample
27878
27879
27880 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27881 @findex -exec-next
27882
27883 @subsubheading Synopsis
27884
27885 @smallexample
27886 -exec-next [--reverse]
27887 @end smallexample
27888
27889 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27890 of the next source line is reached.
27891
27892 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27893 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27894 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27895 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27896 source line where the function was called.
27897
27898
27899 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27900
27901 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27902
27903 @subsubheading Example
27904
27905 @smallexample
27906 -exec-next
27907 ^running
27908 (gdb)
27909 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27910 (gdb)
27911 @end smallexample
27912
27913
27914 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27915 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27916
27917 @subsubheading Synopsis
27918
27919 @smallexample
27920 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27921 @end smallexample
27922
27923 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27924 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27925 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27926 printed as well.
27927
27928 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27929 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27930 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27931 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27932 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27933
27934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27935
27936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27937
27938 @subsubheading Example
27939
27940 @smallexample
27941 (gdb)
27942 -exec-next-instruction
27943 ^running
27944
27945 (gdb)
27946 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27947 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27948 (gdb)
27949 @end smallexample
27950
27951
27952 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27953 @findex -exec-return
27954
27955 @subsubheading Synopsis
27956
27957 @smallexample
27958 -exec-return
27959 @end smallexample
27960
27961 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27962 Displays the new current frame.
27963
27964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27965
27966 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27967
27968 @subsubheading Example
27969
27970 @smallexample
27971 (gdb)
27972 200-break-insert callee4
27973 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27974 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27975 (gdb)
27976 000-exec-run
27977 000^running
27978 (gdb)
27979 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27980 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27981 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27982 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27983 (gdb)
27984 205-break-delete
27985 205^done
27986 (gdb)
27987 111-exec-return
27988 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27989 args=[@{name="strarg",
27990 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27991 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27992 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27993 (gdb)
27994 @end smallexample
27995
27996
27997 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27998 @findex -exec-run
27999
28000 @subsubheading Synopsis
28001
28002 @smallexample
28003 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28004 @end smallexample
28005
28006 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28007 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28008 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28009 the program has exited exceptionally.
28010
28011 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28012 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28013 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28014 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28015 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28016
28017 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28018 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28019 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28020 (@pxref{Starting}).
28021
28022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28023
28024 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28025
28026 @subsubheading Examples
28027
28028 @smallexample
28029 (gdb)
28030 -break-insert main
28031 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28032 (gdb)
28033 -exec-run
28034 ^running
28035 (gdb)
28036 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28037 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28038 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28039 (gdb)
28040 @end smallexample
28041
28042 @noindent
28043 Program exited normally:
28044
28045 @smallexample
28046 (gdb)
28047 -exec-run
28048 ^running
28049 (gdb)
28050 x = 55
28051 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28052 (gdb)
28053 @end smallexample
28054
28055 @noindent
28056 Program exited exceptionally:
28057
28058 @smallexample
28059 (gdb)
28060 -exec-run
28061 ^running
28062 (gdb)
28063 x = 55
28064 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28065 (gdb)
28066 @end smallexample
28067
28068 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28069 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28070
28071 @smallexample
28072 (gdb)
28073 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28074 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28075 @end smallexample
28076
28077
28078 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28079
28080
28081 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28082 @findex -exec-step
28083
28084 @subsubheading Synopsis
28085
28086 @smallexample
28087 -exec-step [--reverse]
28088 @end smallexample
28089
28090 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28091 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28092 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28093 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28094 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28095 previously executed source line.
28096
28097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28098
28099 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28100
28101 @subsubheading Example
28102
28103 Stepping into a function:
28104
28105 @smallexample
28106 -exec-step
28107 ^running
28108 (gdb)
28109 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28110 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28111 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28112 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28113 (gdb)
28114 @end smallexample
28115
28116 Regular stepping:
28117
28118 @smallexample
28119 -exec-step
28120 ^running
28121 (gdb)
28122 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28123 (gdb)
28124 @end smallexample
28125
28126
28127 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28128 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28129
28130 @subsubheading Synopsis
28131
28132 @smallexample
28133 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28134 @end smallexample
28135
28136 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28137 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28138 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28139 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28140 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28141 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28142 as well.
28143
28144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28145
28146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28147
28148 @subsubheading Example
28149
28150 @smallexample
28151 (gdb)
28152 -exec-step-instruction
28153 ^running
28154
28155 (gdb)
28156 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28157 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28158 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28159 (gdb)
28160 -exec-step-instruction
28161 ^running
28162
28163 (gdb)
28164 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28165 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28166 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28167 (gdb)
28168 @end smallexample
28169
28170
28171 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28172 @findex -exec-until
28173
28174 @subsubheading Synopsis
28175
28176 @smallexample
28177 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28178 @end smallexample
28179
28180 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28181 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28182 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28183 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28184
28185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28186
28187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28188
28189 @subsubheading Example
28190
28191 @smallexample
28192 (gdb)
28193 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28194 ^running
28195 (gdb)
28196 x = 55
28197 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28198 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28199 (gdb)
28200 @end smallexample
28201
28202 @ignore
28203 @subheading -file-clear
28204 Is this going away????
28205 @end ignore
28206
28207 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28208 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28209 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28210
28211 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28212 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28213
28214 @smallexample
28215 -enable-frame-filters
28216 @end smallexample
28217
28218 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28219 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28220 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28221 request that this functionality be enabled.
28222
28223 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28224
28225 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28226 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28227
28228 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28229 @findex -stack-info-frame
28230
28231 @subsubheading Synopsis
28232
28233 @smallexample
28234 -stack-info-frame
28235 @end smallexample
28236
28237 Get info on the selected frame.
28238
28239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28240
28241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28242 (without arguments).
28243
28244 @subsubheading Example
28245
28246 @smallexample
28247 (gdb)
28248 -stack-info-frame
28249 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28250 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28251 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28252 (gdb)
28253 @end smallexample
28254
28255 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28256 @findex -stack-info-depth
28257
28258 @subsubheading Synopsis
28259
28260 @smallexample
28261 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28262 @end smallexample
28263
28264 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28265 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28266
28267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28268
28269 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28270
28271 @subsubheading Example
28272
28273 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28274
28275 @smallexample
28276 (gdb)
28277 -stack-info-depth
28278 ^done,depth="12"
28279 (gdb)
28280 -stack-info-depth 4
28281 ^done,depth="4"
28282 (gdb)
28283 -stack-info-depth 12
28284 ^done,depth="12"
28285 (gdb)
28286 -stack-info-depth 11
28287 ^done,depth="11"
28288 (gdb)
28289 -stack-info-depth 13
28290 ^done,depth="12"
28291 (gdb)
28292 @end smallexample
28293
28294 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28295 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28296 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28297
28298 @subsubheading Synopsis
28299
28300 @smallexample
28301 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28302 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28303 @end smallexample
28304
28305 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28306 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28307 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28308 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28309 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28310 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28311 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28312 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28313
28314 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28315 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28316 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28317 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28318 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28319 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28320
28321 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28322 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28323 are still displayed, however.
28324
28325 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28326 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28327
28328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28329
28330 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28331 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28332 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28333
28334 @subsubheading Example
28335
28336 @smallexample
28337 (gdb)
28338 -stack-list-frames
28339 ^done,
28340 stack=[
28341 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28342 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28343 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28344 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28345 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28346 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28347 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28348 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28349 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28350 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28351 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28352 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28353 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28354 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28355 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28356 (gdb)
28357 -stack-list-arguments 0
28358 ^done,
28359 stack-args=[
28360 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28361 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28362 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28363 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28364 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28365 (gdb)
28366 -stack-list-arguments 1
28367 ^done,
28368 stack-args=[
28369 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28370 frame=@{level="1",
28371 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28372 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28373 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28374 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28375 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28376 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28377 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28378 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28379 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28380 (gdb)
28381 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28382 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28383 (gdb)
28384 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28385 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28386 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28387 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28388 (gdb)
28389 @end smallexample
28390
28391 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28392
28393
28394 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28395 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28396 @findex -stack-list-frames
28397
28398 @subsubheading Synopsis
28399
28400 @smallexample
28401 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28402 @end smallexample
28403
28404 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28405 following info:
28406
28407 @table @samp
28408 @item @var{level}
28409 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28410 @item @var{addr}
28411 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28412 @item @var{func}
28413 Function name.
28414 @item @var{file}
28415 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28416 @item @var{fullname}
28417 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28418 @item @var{line}
28419 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28420 @item @var{from}
28421 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28422 if the frame's function is not known.
28423 @end table
28424
28425 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28426 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28427 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28428 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28429 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28430 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28431 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28432 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28433 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28434
28435 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28436
28437 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28438
28439 @subsubheading Example
28440
28441 Full stack backtrace:
28442
28443 @smallexample
28444 (gdb)
28445 -stack-list-frames
28446 ^done,stack=
28447 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28448 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28449 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28450 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28451 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28452 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28453 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28454 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28455 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28456 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28457 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28458 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28459 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28460 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28461 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28462 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28463 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28464 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28465 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28466 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28467 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28468 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28469 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28470 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28471 (gdb)
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28475
28476 @smallexample
28477 (gdb)
28478 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28479 ^done,stack=
28480 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28481 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28482 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28483 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28484 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28485 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28486 (gdb)
28487 @end smallexample
28488
28489 Show a single frame:
28490
28491 @smallexample
28492 (gdb)
28493 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28494 ^done,stack=
28495 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28496 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28497 (gdb)
28498 @end smallexample
28499
28500
28501 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28502 @findex -stack-list-locals
28503 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28504
28505 @subsubheading Synopsis
28506
28507 @smallexample
28508 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28509 @end smallexample
28510
28511 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28512 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28513 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28514 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28515 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28516 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28517 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28518 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28519 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28520 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28521
28522 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28523 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28524 variables are still displayed, however.
28525
28526 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28527 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28528
28529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28530
28531 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28532
28533 @subsubheading Example
28534
28535 @smallexample
28536 (gdb)
28537 -stack-list-locals 0
28538 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28539 (gdb)
28540 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28541 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28542 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28543 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28544 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28545 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28546 (gdb)
28547 @end smallexample
28548
28549 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28550 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28551 @findex -stack-list-variables
28552
28553 @subsubheading Synopsis
28554
28555 @smallexample
28556 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28557 @end smallexample
28558
28559 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28560 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28561 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28562 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28563 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28564 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28565 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28566
28567 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28568 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28569 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28570
28571 @subsubheading Example
28572
28573 @smallexample
28574 (gdb)
28575 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28576 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28577 (gdb)
28578 @end smallexample
28579
28580
28581 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28582 @findex -stack-select-frame
28583
28584 @subsubheading Synopsis
28585
28586 @smallexample
28587 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28588 @end smallexample
28589
28590 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28591 the stack.
28592
28593 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28594 option to every command.
28595
28596 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28597
28598 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28599 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28600
28601 @subsubheading Example
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 (gdb)
28605 -stack-select-frame 2
28606 ^done
28607 (gdb)
28608 @end smallexample
28609
28610 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28611 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28612 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28613
28614 @ignore
28615
28616 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28617
28618 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28619 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28620 used by @code{Insight}.
28621
28622 The two main reasons for that are:
28623
28624 @enumerate 1
28625 @item
28626 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28627
28628 @item
28629 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28630 now).
28631 @end enumerate
28632
28633 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28634 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28635 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28636 hints about their use.
28637
28638 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28639 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28640 least, the following operations:
28641
28642 @itemize @bullet
28643 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28644 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28645 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28646 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28647 @end itemize
28648
28649 @end ignore
28650
28651 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28652
28653 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28654
28655 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28656 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28657 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28658 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28659 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28660 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28661 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28662 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28663 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28664 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28665 object, or to change display format.
28666
28667 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28668 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28669 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28670 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28671 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28672 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28673 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28674 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28675 child will be created.
28676
28677 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28678 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28679 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28680 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28681 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28682
28683 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28684 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28685 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28686 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28687 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28688 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28689 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28690 variables that frontend has created.
28691
28692 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28693 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28694 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28695 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28696 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28697 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28698 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28699 implicitly updated.
28700
28701 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28702 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28703 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28704 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28705 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28706 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28707 frame. Consider this example:
28708
28709 @smallexample
28710 void do_work(...)
28711 @{
28712 struct work_state state;
28713
28714 if (...)
28715 do_work(...);
28716 @}
28717 @end smallexample
28718
28719 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28720 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28721 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28722 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28723 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28724
28725 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28726 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28727 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28728 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28729 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28730 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28731
28732 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28733 access this functionality:
28734
28735 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28736 @item @strong{Operation}
28737 @tab @strong{Description}
28738
28739 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28740 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28741 @item @code{-var-create}
28742 @tab create a variable object
28743 @item @code{-var-delete}
28744 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28745 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28746 @tab set the display format of this variable
28747 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28748 @tab show the display format of this variable
28749 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28750 @tab tells how many children this object has
28751 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28752 @tab return a list of the object's children
28753 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28754 @tab show the type of this variable object
28755 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28756 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28757 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28758 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28759 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28760 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28761 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28762 @tab get the value of this variable
28763 @item @code{-var-assign}
28764 @tab set the value of this variable
28765 @item @code{-var-update}
28766 @tab update the variable and its children
28767 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28768 @tab set frozeness attribute
28769 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28770 @tab set range of children to display on update
28771 @end multitable
28772
28773 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28774 how it can be used.
28775
28776 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28777
28778 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28779 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28780
28781 @smallexample
28782 -enable-pretty-printing
28783 @end smallexample
28784
28785 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28786 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28787 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28788 request that this functionality be enabled.
28789
28790 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28791
28792 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28793 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28794
28795 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28796 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28797
28798 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28799 @findex -var-create
28800
28801 @subsubheading Synopsis
28802
28803 @smallexample
28804 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28805 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28806 @end smallexample
28807
28808 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28809 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28810 register.
28811
28812 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28813 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28814 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28815 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28816 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28817
28818 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28819 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28820 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28821 object must be created.
28822
28823 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28824 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28825
28826 @itemize @bullet
28827 @item
28828 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28829
28830 @item
28831 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28832
28833 @item
28834 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28835 @end itemize
28836
28837 @cindex dynamic varobj
28838 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28839 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28840 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28841 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28842 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28843 compatibility for existing clients.
28844
28845 @subsubheading Result
28846
28847 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28848 are:
28849
28850 @table @samp
28851 @item name
28852 The name of the varobj.
28853
28854 @item numchild
28855 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28856 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28857 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28858
28859 @item value
28860 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28861 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28862 will not be interesting.
28863
28864 @item type
28865 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28866 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28867 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28868 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28869 @emph{declared} one.
28870
28871 @item thread-id
28872 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28873 thread's identifier.
28874
28875 @item has_more
28876 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28877 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28878
28879 @item dynamic
28880 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28881 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28882 then this attribute will not be present.
28883
28884 @item displayhint
28885 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28886 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28887 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28888 @end table
28889
28890 Typical output will look like this:
28891
28892 @smallexample
28893 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28894 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28895 @end smallexample
28896
28897
28898 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28899 @findex -var-delete
28900
28901 @subsubheading Synopsis
28902
28903 @smallexample
28904 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28905 @end smallexample
28906
28907 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28908 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28909
28910 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28911
28912
28913 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28914 @findex -var-set-format
28915
28916 @subsubheading Synopsis
28917
28918 @smallexample
28919 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28920 @end smallexample
28921
28922 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28923 @var{format-spec}.
28924
28925 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28926 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28927
28928 @smallexample
28929 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28930 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28931 @end smallexample
28932
28933 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28934 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28935 for pointers, etc.).
28936
28937 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28938 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28939
28940 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28941 @findex -var-show-format
28942
28943 @subsubheading Synopsis
28944
28945 @smallexample
28946 -var-show-format @var{name}
28947 @end smallexample
28948
28949 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28950
28951 @smallexample
28952 @var{format} @expansion{}
28953 @var{format-spec}
28954 @end smallexample
28955
28956
28957 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28958 @findex -var-info-num-children
28959
28960 @subsubheading Synopsis
28961
28962 @smallexample
28963 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28964 @end smallexample
28965
28966 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28967
28968 @smallexample
28969 numchild=@var{n}
28970 @end smallexample
28971
28972 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28973 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28974 be available.
28975
28976
28977 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28978 @findex -var-list-children
28979
28980 @subsubheading Synopsis
28981
28982 @smallexample
28983 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28984 @end smallexample
28985 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28986
28987 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28988 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28989 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28990 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28991 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28992 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28993 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28994 and unions.
28995
28996 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28997 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28998 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28999 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29000 reported.
29001
29002 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29003 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29004 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29005 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29006 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29007 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29008 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29009 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29010 the visible items.
29011
29012 For each child the following results are returned:
29013
29014 @table @var
29015
29016 @item name
29017 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29018
29019 @item exp
29020 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29021 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29022
29023 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29024 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29025
29026 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29027 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29028 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29029 type and value are not present.
29030
29031 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29032 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29033 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29034
29035 @item numchild
29036 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29037 0.
29038
29039 @item type
29040 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29041 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29042 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29043 @emph{declared} one.
29044
29045 @item value
29046 If values were requested, this is the value.
29047
29048 @item thread-id
29049 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29050 Otherwise this result is not present.
29051
29052 @item frozen
29053 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29054
29055 @item displayhint
29056 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29057 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29058 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29059
29060 @item dynamic
29061 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29062 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29063 then this attribute will not be present.
29064
29065 @end table
29066
29067 The result may have its own attributes:
29068
29069 @table @samp
29070 @item displayhint
29071 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29072 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29073 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29074
29075 @item has_more
29076 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29077 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29078 @end table
29079
29080 @subsubheading Example
29081
29082 @smallexample
29083 (gdb)
29084 -var-list-children n
29085 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29086 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29087 (gdb)
29088 -var-list-children --all-values n
29089 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29090 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29091 @end smallexample
29092
29093
29094 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29095 @findex -var-info-type
29096
29097 @subsubheading Synopsis
29098
29099 @smallexample
29100 -var-info-type @var{name}
29101 @end smallexample
29102
29103 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29104 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29105 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29106
29107 @smallexample
29108 type=@var{typename}
29109 @end smallexample
29110
29111
29112 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29113 @findex -var-info-expression
29114
29115 @subsubheading Synopsis
29116
29117 @smallexample
29118 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29119 @end smallexample
29120
29121 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29122 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29123 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29124
29125 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29126 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29127
29128 @smallexample
29129 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29130 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29131 @end smallexample
29132
29133 @noindent
29134 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29135 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29136
29137 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29138 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29139 is of limited use.
29140
29141 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29142 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29143
29144 @subsubheading Synopsis
29145
29146 @smallexample
29147 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29148 @end smallexample
29149
29150 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29151 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29152 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29153 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29154 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29155 watchpoint from a variable object.
29156
29157 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29158 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29159
29160 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29161 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29162 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29163 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29164 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29165 @smallexample
29166 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29167 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29168 @end smallexample
29169
29170 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29171 @findex -var-show-attributes
29172
29173 @subsubheading Synopsis
29174
29175 @smallexample
29176 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29177 @end smallexample
29178
29179 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29180
29181 @smallexample
29182 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29183 @end smallexample
29184
29185 @noindent
29186 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29187
29188 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29189 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29190
29191 @subsubheading Synopsis
29192
29193 @smallexample
29194 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29195 @end smallexample
29196
29197 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29198 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29199 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29200 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29201 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29202 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29203 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29204
29205 @smallexample
29206 value=@var{value}
29207 @end smallexample
29208
29209 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29210 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29211
29212 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29213 @findex -var-assign
29214
29215 @subsubheading Synopsis
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29219 @end smallexample
29220
29221 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29222 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29223 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29224 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29225
29226 @subsubheading Example
29227
29228 @smallexample
29229 (gdb)
29230 -var-assign var1 3
29231 ^done,value="3"
29232 (gdb)
29233 -var-update *
29234 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29235 (gdb)
29236 @end smallexample
29237
29238 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29239 @findex -var-update
29240
29241 @subsubheading Synopsis
29242
29243 @smallexample
29244 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29245 @end smallexample
29246
29247 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29248 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29249 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29250 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29251 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29252 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29253 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29254 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29255 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29256 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29257 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29258 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29259 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29260
29261 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29262 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29263 diagnostic.
29264
29265 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29266 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29267
29268 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29269 @samp{changelist}.
29270
29271 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29272
29273 @table @samp
29274 @item name
29275 The name of the varobj.
29276
29277 @item value
29278 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29279 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29280
29281 @item in_scope
29282 @anchor{-var-update}
29283 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29284
29285 @table @code
29286 @item "true"
29287 The variable object's current value is valid.
29288
29289 @item "false"
29290 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29291 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29292 scope.
29293
29294 @item "invalid"
29295 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29296 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29297 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29298 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29299 objects.
29300 @end table
29301
29302 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29303 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29304
29305 @item type_changed
29306 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29307 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29308 be @samp{false}.
29309
29310 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29311 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29312 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29313 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29314 unset.
29315
29316 @item new_type
29317 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29318 hold the new type.
29319
29320 @item new_num_children
29321 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29322 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29323
29324 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29325 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29326 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29327 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29328 children which may be available.
29329
29330 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29331 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29332 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29333 only happen at the end of the update range).
29334
29335 @item displayhint
29336 The display hint, if any.
29337
29338 @item has_more
29339 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29340 available outside the varobj's update range.
29341
29342 @item dynamic
29343 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29344 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29345 then this attribute will not be present.
29346
29347 @item new_children
29348 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29349 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29350 be listed in this attribute.
29351 @end table
29352
29353 @subsubheading Example
29354
29355 @smallexample
29356 (gdb)
29357 -var-assign var1 3
29358 ^done,value="3"
29359 (gdb)
29360 -var-update --all-values var1
29361 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29362 type_changed="false"@}]
29363 (gdb)
29364 @end smallexample
29365
29366 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29367 @findex -var-set-frozen
29368 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29369
29370 @subsubheading Synopsis
29371
29372 @smallexample
29373 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29374 @end smallexample
29375
29376 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29377 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29378 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29379 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29380 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29381 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29382 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29383 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29384 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29385 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29386 @code{-var-update} does.
29387
29388 @subsubheading Example
29389
29390 @smallexample
29391 (gdb)
29392 -var-set-frozen V 1
29393 ^done
29394 (gdb)
29395 @end smallexample
29396
29397 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29398 @findex -var-set-update-range
29399 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29400
29401 @subsubheading Synopsis
29402
29403 @smallexample
29404 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29405 @end smallexample
29406
29407 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29408 @code{-var-update}.
29409
29410 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29411 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29412 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29413 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29414
29415 @subsubheading Example
29416
29417 @smallexample
29418 (gdb)
29419 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29420 ^done
29421 @end smallexample
29422
29423 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29424 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29425 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29426
29427 @subsubheading Synopsis
29428
29429 @smallexample
29430 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29431 @end smallexample
29432
29433 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29434
29435 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29436 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29437
29438 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29439 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29440 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29441 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29442 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29443 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29444 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29445
29446 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29447 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29448 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29449 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29450
29451 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29452 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29453 can be used to check this.
29454
29455 @subsubheading Example
29456
29457 Resetting the visualizer:
29458
29459 @smallexample
29460 (gdb)
29461 -var-set-visualizer V None
29462 ^done
29463 @end smallexample
29464
29465 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29466
29467 @smallexample
29468 (gdb)
29469 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29470 ^done
29471 @end smallexample
29472
29473 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29474 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29475
29476 @smallexample
29477 (gdb)
29478 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29479 ^done
29480 @end smallexample
29481
29482 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29483 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29484 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29485
29486 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29487 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29488 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29489 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29490
29491 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29492 @c @subheading -data-assign
29493 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29494 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29495 @c set variable
29496 @c @subsubheading Example
29497 @c N.A.
29498
29499 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29500 @findex -data-disassemble
29501
29502 @subsubheading Synopsis
29503
29504 @smallexample
29505 -data-disassemble
29506 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29507 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29508 -- @var{mode}
29509 @end smallexample
29510
29511 @noindent
29512 Where:
29513
29514 @table @samp
29515 @item @var{start-addr}
29516 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29517 @item @var{end-addr}
29518 is the end address
29519 @item @var{filename}
29520 is the name of the file to disassemble
29521 @item @var{linenum}
29522 is the line number to disassemble around
29523 @item @var{lines}
29524 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29525 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29526 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29527 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29528 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29529 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29530 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29531 are displayed.
29532 @item @var{mode}
29533 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29534 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29535 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29536 @end table
29537
29538 @subsubheading Result
29539
29540 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29541 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29542 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29543
29544 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29545 following fields:
29546
29547 @table @code
29548 @item address
29549 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29550
29551 @item func-name
29552 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29553
29554 @item offset
29555 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29556
29557 @item inst
29558 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29559
29560 @item opcodes
29561 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29562 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29563
29564 @end table
29565
29566 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29567 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29568
29569 @table @code
29570 @item line
29571 The line number within @samp{file}.
29572
29573 @item file
29574 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29575 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29576 used.
29577
29578 @item fullname
29579 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29580 using the source file search path
29581 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29582 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29583
29584 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29585 present in the debug information.
29586
29587 @item line_asm_insn
29588 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29589 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29590 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29591 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29592 @samp{opcodes}.
29593
29594 @end table
29595
29596 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29597 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29598 adjust its format.
29599
29600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29601
29602 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29603
29604 @subsubheading Example
29605
29606 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29607
29608 @smallexample
29609 (gdb)
29610 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29611 ^done,
29612 asm_insns=[
29613 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29614 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29615 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29616 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29617 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29618 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29619 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29620 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29621 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29622 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29623 (gdb)
29624 @end smallexample
29625
29626 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29627 @code{main}.
29628
29629 @smallexample
29630 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29631 ^done,asm_insns=[
29632 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29633 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29634 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29635 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29636 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29637 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29638 [@dots{}]
29639 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29640 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29641 (gdb)
29642 @end smallexample
29643
29644 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29645
29646 @smallexample
29647 (gdb)
29648 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29649 ^done,asm_insns=[
29650 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29651 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29652 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29653 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29654 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29655 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29656 (gdb)
29657 @end smallexample
29658
29659 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29660
29661 @smallexample
29662 (gdb)
29663 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29664 ^done,asm_insns=[
29665 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29666 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29667 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29668 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29669 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29670 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29671 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29672 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29673 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29674 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29675 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29676 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29677 (gdb)
29678 @end smallexample
29679
29680
29681 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29682 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29683
29684 @subsubheading Synopsis
29685
29686 @smallexample
29687 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29688 @end smallexample
29689
29690 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29691 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29692 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29693
29694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29695
29696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29697 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29698 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29699
29700 @subsubheading Example
29701
29702 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29703 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29704 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29705 output.
29706
29707 @smallexample
29708 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29709 211^done,value="1"
29710 (gdb)
29711 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29712 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29713 (gdb)
29714 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29715 411^done,value="4"
29716 (gdb)
29717 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29718 511^done,value="4"
29719 (gdb)
29720 @end smallexample
29721
29722
29723 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29724 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29725
29726 @subsubheading Synopsis
29727
29728 @smallexample
29729 -data-list-changed-registers
29730 @end smallexample
29731
29732 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29733
29734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29735
29736 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29737 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29738
29739 @subsubheading Example
29740
29741 On a PPC MBX board:
29742
29743 @smallexample
29744 (gdb)
29745 -exec-continue
29746 ^running
29747
29748 (gdb)
29749 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29750 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29751 line="5"@}
29752 (gdb)
29753 -data-list-changed-registers
29754 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29755 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29756 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29757 (gdb)
29758 @end smallexample
29759
29760
29761 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29762 @findex -data-list-register-names
29763
29764 @subsubheading Synopsis
29765
29766 @smallexample
29767 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29768 @end smallexample
29769
29770 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29771 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29772 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29773 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29774 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29775 include empty register names.
29776
29777 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29778
29779 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29780 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29781 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29782
29783 @subsubheading Example
29784
29785 For the PPC MBX board:
29786 @smallexample
29787 (gdb)
29788 -data-list-register-names
29789 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29790 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29791 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29792 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29793 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29794 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29795 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29796 (gdb)
29797 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29798 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29799 (gdb)
29800 @end smallexample
29801
29802 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29803 @findex -data-list-register-values
29804
29805 @subsubheading Synopsis
29806
29807 @smallexample
29808 -data-list-register-values
29809 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29810 @end smallexample
29811
29812 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29813 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29814 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29815 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29816 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29817 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29818
29819 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29820
29821 @table @code
29822 @item x
29823 Hexadecimal
29824 @item o
29825 Octal
29826 @item t
29827 Binary
29828 @item d
29829 Decimal
29830 @item r
29831 Raw
29832 @item N
29833 Natural
29834 @end table
29835
29836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29837
29838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29839 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29840
29841 @subsubheading Example
29842
29843 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29844 don't appear in the actual output):
29845
29846 @smallexample
29847 (gdb)
29848 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29849 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29850 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29851 (gdb)
29852 -data-list-register-values x
29853 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29854 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29855 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29856 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29857 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29858 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29859 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29860 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29861 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29862 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29863 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29864 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29865 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29866 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29867 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29868 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29869 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29870 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29871 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29872 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29873 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29874 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29875 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29876 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29877 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29878 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29879 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29880 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29881 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29882 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29883 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29884 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29885 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29886 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29887 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29888 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29889 (gdb)
29890 @end smallexample
29891
29892
29893 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29894 @findex -data-read-memory
29895
29896 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29897
29898 @subsubheading Synopsis
29899
29900 @smallexample
29901 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29902 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29903 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29904 @end smallexample
29905
29906 @noindent
29907 where:
29908
29909 @table @samp
29910 @item @var{address}
29911 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29912 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29913 quoted using the C convention.
29914
29915 @item @var{word-format}
29916 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29917 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29918 ,Output Formats}).
29919
29920 @item @var{word-size}
29921 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29922
29923 @item @var{nr-rows}
29924 The number of rows in the output table.
29925
29926 @item @var{nr-cols}
29927 The number of columns in the output table.
29928
29929 @item @var{aschar}
29930 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29931 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29932 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29933 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29934
29935 @item @var{byte-offset}
29936 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29937 @end table
29938
29939 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29940 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29941 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29942 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29943 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29944 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29945 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29946 @samp{addr}.
29947
29948 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29949 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29950 @samp{prev-page}.
29951
29952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29953
29954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29955 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29956
29957 @subsubheading Example
29958
29959 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29960 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29961 word. Display each word in hex.
29962
29963 @smallexample
29964 (gdb)
29965 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29966 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29967 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29968 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29969 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29970 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29971 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29972 (gdb)
29973 @end smallexample
29974
29975 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29976 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29977
29978 @smallexample
29979 (gdb)
29980 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29981 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29982 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29983 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29984 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29985 (gdb)
29986 @end smallexample
29987
29988 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29989 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29990 used as the non-printable character.
29991
29992 @smallexample
29993 (gdb)
29994 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29995 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29996 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29997 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29998 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29999 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30000 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30001 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30002 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30003 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30004 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30005 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30006 (gdb)
30007 @end smallexample
30008
30009 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30010 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30011
30012 @subsubheading Synopsis
30013
30014 @smallexample
30015 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30016 @var{address} @var{count}
30017 @end smallexample
30018
30019 @noindent
30020 where:
30021
30022 @table @samp
30023 @item @var{address}
30024 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30025 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30026 quoted using the C convention.
30027
30028 @item @var{count}
30029 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
30030
30031 @item @var{byte-offset}
30032 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
30033 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
30034 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
30035 perform address arithmetics itself.
30036
30037 @end table
30038
30039 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30040 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30041 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30042 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30043 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30044 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30045
30046 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
30047 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
30048 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30049 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
30050 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30051 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30052 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30053 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30054
30055 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30056 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30057 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30058 and has the following fields:
30059
30060 @table @code
30061 @item begin
30062 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30063
30064 @item end
30065 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30066
30067 @item offset
30068 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30069 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30070
30071 @item contents
30072 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30073
30074 @end table
30075
30076
30077
30078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30079
30080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30081
30082 @subsubheading Example
30083
30084 @smallexample
30085 (gdb)
30086 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30087 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30088 end="0xbffff15e",
30089 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30090 (gdb)
30091 @end smallexample
30092
30093
30094 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30095 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30096
30097 @subsubheading Synopsis
30098
30099 @smallexample
30100 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30101 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30102 @end smallexample
30103
30104 @noindent
30105 where:
30106
30107 @table @samp
30108 @item @var{address}
30109 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30110 written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30111 quoted using the C convention.
30112
30113 @item @var{contents}
30114 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
30115
30116 @item @var{count}
30117 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
30118 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
30119 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
30120
30121 @end table
30122
30123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30124
30125 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30126
30127 @subsubheading Example
30128
30129 @smallexample
30130 (gdb)
30131 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30132 ^done
30133 (gdb)
30134 @end smallexample
30135
30136 @smallexample
30137 (gdb)
30138 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30139 ^done
30140 (gdb)
30141 @end smallexample
30142
30143 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30144 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30145 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30146
30147 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30148 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30149
30150 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30151 @findex -trace-find
30152
30153 @subsubheading Synopsis
30154
30155 @smallexample
30156 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30157 @end smallexample
30158
30159 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30160 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30161 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30162
30163 @table @samp
30164
30165 @item none
30166 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30167
30168 @item frame-number
30169 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30170 that index.
30171
30172 @item tracepoint-number
30173 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30174 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30175
30176 @item pc
30177 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30178 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30179 address.
30180
30181 @item pc-inside-range
30182 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30183 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30184 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30185
30186 @item pc-outside-range
30187 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30188 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30189 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30190
30191 @item line
30192 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30193 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30194 the specified location.
30195
30196 @end table
30197
30198 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30199 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30200
30201 @table @samp
30202 @item found
30203 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30204 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30205
30206 @item traceframe
30207 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30208 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30209
30210 @item tracepoint
30211 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30212 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30213
30214 @item frame
30215 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30216 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30217 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30218
30219 @end table
30220
30221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30222
30223 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30224
30225 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30226 @findex -trace-define-variable
30227
30228 @subsubheading Synopsis
30229
30230 @smallexample
30231 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30232 @end smallexample
30233
30234 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30235 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30236 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30237 with the @samp{$} character.
30238
30239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30240
30241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30242
30243 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30244 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30245
30246 @subsubheading Synopsis
30247
30248 @smallexample
30249 -trace-frame-collected
30250 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30251 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30252 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30253 [--memory-contents]
30254 @end smallexample
30255
30256 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30257 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30258 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30259 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30260 See the output description table below for more details.
30261
30262 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30263 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30264 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30265 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30266 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30267
30268 For instance, if the actions were
30269 @smallexample
30270 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30271 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30272 @end smallexample
30273
30274 @noindent
30275 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30276 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30277 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30278 objects would be computed expressions.
30279
30280 An example output would be:
30281
30282 @smallexample
30283 (gdb)
30284 -trace-frame-collected
30285 ^done,
30286 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30287 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30288 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30289 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30290 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30291 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30292 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30293 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30294 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30295 ...
30296 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30297 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30298 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30299 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30300 (gdb)
30301 @end smallexample
30302
30303 Where:
30304
30305 @table @code
30306 @item explicit-variables
30307 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30308 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30309 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30310 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30311 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30312 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30313 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30314 arrays, structures and unions.
30315
30316 @item computed-expressions
30317 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30318 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30319 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30320 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30321
30322 @item registers
30323 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30324 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30325 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30326 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30327 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30328
30329 @item tvars
30330 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30331 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30332 current value are returned.
30333
30334 @item memory
30335 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30336 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30337 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30338
30339 @table @code
30340 @item address
30341 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30342
30343 @item length
30344 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30345
30346 @item contents
30347 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30348 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30349
30350 @end table
30351
30352 @end table
30353
30354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30355
30356 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30357
30358 @subsubheading Example
30359
30360 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30361 @findex -trace-list-variables
30362
30363 @subsubheading Synopsis
30364
30365 @smallexample
30366 -trace-list-variables
30367 @end smallexample
30368
30369 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30370 table has the following fields:
30371
30372 @table @samp
30373 @item name
30374 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30375
30376 @item initial
30377 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30378 field is always present.
30379
30380 @item current
30381 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30382 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30383 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30384 presently running.
30385
30386 @end table
30387
30388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30389
30390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30391
30392 @subsubheading Example
30393
30394 @smallexample
30395 (gdb)
30396 -trace-list-variables
30397 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30398 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30399 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30400 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30401 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30402 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30403 (gdb)
30404 @end smallexample
30405
30406 @subheading -trace-save
30407 @findex -trace-save
30408
30409 @subsubheading Synopsis
30410
30411 @smallexample
30412 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30413 @end smallexample
30414
30415 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30416 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30417 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30418 to perform the save.
30419
30420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30421
30422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30423
30424
30425 @subheading -trace-start
30426 @findex -trace-start
30427
30428 @subsubheading Synopsis
30429
30430 @smallexample
30431 -trace-start
30432 @end smallexample
30433
30434 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30435 have any fields.
30436
30437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30438
30439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30440
30441 @subheading -trace-status
30442 @findex -trace-status
30443
30444 @subsubheading Synopsis
30445
30446 @smallexample
30447 -trace-status
30448 @end smallexample
30449
30450 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30451 the following fields:
30452
30453 @table @samp
30454
30455 @item supported
30456 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30457 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30458 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30459 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30460 started. This field is always present.
30461
30462 @item running
30463 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30464 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30465 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30466
30467 @item stop-reason
30468 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30469 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30470 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30471 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30472 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30473 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30474 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30475 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30476 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30477
30478 @item stopping-tracepoint
30479 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30480 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30481 @samp{passcount}.
30482
30483 @item frames
30484 @itemx frames-created
30485 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30486 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30487 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30488 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30489
30490 @item buffer-size
30491 @itemx buffer-free
30492 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30493 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30494
30495 @item circular
30496 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30497 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30498 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30499 and may fill up.
30500
30501 @item disconnected
30502 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30503 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30504 that the trace run will stop.
30505
30506 @item trace-file
30507 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30508 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30509
30510 @end table
30511
30512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30513
30514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30515
30516 @subheading -trace-stop
30517 @findex -trace-stop
30518
30519 @subsubheading Synopsis
30520
30521 @smallexample
30522 -trace-stop
30523 @end smallexample
30524
30525 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30526 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30527 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30528
30529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30530
30531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30532
30533
30534 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30535 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30536 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30537
30538
30539 @ignore
30540 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30541 @findex -symbol-info-address
30542
30543 @subsubheading Synopsis
30544
30545 @smallexample
30546 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30547 @end smallexample
30548
30549 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30550
30551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30552
30553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30554
30555 @subsubheading Example
30556 N.A.
30557
30558
30559 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30560 @findex -symbol-info-file
30561
30562 @subsubheading Synopsis
30563
30564 @smallexample
30565 -symbol-info-file
30566 @end smallexample
30567
30568 Show the file for the symbol.
30569
30570 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30571
30572 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30573 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30574
30575 @subsubheading Example
30576 N.A.
30577
30578
30579 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30580 @findex -symbol-info-function
30581
30582 @subsubheading Synopsis
30583
30584 @smallexample
30585 -symbol-info-function
30586 @end smallexample
30587
30588 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30589
30590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30591
30592 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30593
30594 @subsubheading Example
30595 N.A.
30596
30597
30598 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30599 @findex -symbol-info-line
30600
30601 @subsubheading Synopsis
30602
30603 @smallexample
30604 -symbol-info-line
30605 @end smallexample
30606
30607 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30608
30609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30610
30611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30612 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30613
30614 @subsubheading Example
30615 N.A.
30616
30617
30618 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30619 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30620
30621 @subsubheading Synopsis
30622
30623 @smallexample
30624 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30625 @end smallexample
30626
30627 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30628
30629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30630
30631 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30632
30633 @subsubheading Example
30634 N.A.
30635
30636
30637 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30638 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30639
30640 @subsubheading Synopsis
30641
30642 @smallexample
30643 -symbol-list-functions
30644 @end smallexample
30645
30646 List the functions in the executable.
30647
30648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30649
30650 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30651 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30652
30653 @subsubheading Example
30654 N.A.
30655 @end ignore
30656
30657
30658 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30659 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30660
30661 @subsubheading Synopsis
30662
30663 @smallexample
30664 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30665 @end smallexample
30666
30667 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30668 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30669 ascending PC order.
30670
30671 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30672
30673 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30674
30675 @subsubheading Example
30676 @smallexample
30677 (gdb)
30678 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30679 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30680 (gdb)
30681 @end smallexample
30682
30683
30684 @ignore
30685 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30686 @findex -symbol-list-types
30687
30688 @subsubheading Synopsis
30689
30690 @smallexample
30691 -symbol-list-types
30692 @end smallexample
30693
30694 List all the type names.
30695
30696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30697
30698 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30699 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30700
30701 @subsubheading Example
30702 N.A.
30703
30704
30705 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30706 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30707
30708 @subsubheading Synopsis
30709
30710 @smallexample
30711 -symbol-list-variables
30712 @end smallexample
30713
30714 List all the global and static variable names.
30715
30716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30717
30718 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30719
30720 @subsubheading Example
30721 N.A.
30722
30723
30724 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30725 @findex -symbol-locate
30726
30727 @subsubheading Synopsis
30728
30729 @smallexample
30730 -symbol-locate
30731 @end smallexample
30732
30733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30734
30735 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30736
30737 @subsubheading Example
30738 N.A.
30739
30740
30741 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30742 @findex -symbol-type
30743
30744 @subsubheading Synopsis
30745
30746 @smallexample
30747 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30748 @end smallexample
30749
30750 Show type of @var{variable}.
30751
30752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30753
30754 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30755 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30756
30757 @subsubheading Example
30758 N.A.
30759 @end ignore
30760
30761
30762 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30763 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30764 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30765
30766 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30767 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30768
30769 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30770 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30771
30772 @subsubheading Synopsis
30773
30774 @smallexample
30775 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30776 @end smallexample
30777
30778 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30779 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30780 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30781 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30782 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30783 notification.
30784
30785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30786
30787 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30788
30789 @subsubheading Example
30790
30791 @smallexample
30792 (gdb)
30793 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30794 ^done
30795 (gdb)
30796 @end smallexample
30797
30798
30799 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30800 @findex -file-exec-file
30801
30802 @subsubheading Synopsis
30803
30804 @smallexample
30805 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30806 @end smallexample
30807
30808 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30809 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30810 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30811 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30812 notification.
30813
30814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30815
30816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30817
30818 @subsubheading Example
30819
30820 @smallexample
30821 (gdb)
30822 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30823 ^done
30824 (gdb)
30825 @end smallexample
30826
30827
30828 @ignore
30829 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30830 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30831
30832 @subsubheading Synopsis
30833
30834 @smallexample
30835 -file-list-exec-sections
30836 @end smallexample
30837
30838 List the sections of the current executable file.
30839
30840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30841
30842 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30843 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30844 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30845
30846 @subsubheading Example
30847 N.A.
30848 @end ignore
30849
30850
30851 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30852 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30853
30854 @subsubheading Synopsis
30855
30856 @smallexample
30857 -file-list-exec-source-file
30858 @end smallexample
30859
30860 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30861 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30862 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30863 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30864
30865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30866
30867 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30868
30869 @subsubheading Example
30870
30871 @smallexample
30872 (gdb)
30873 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30874 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30875 (gdb)
30876 @end smallexample
30877
30878
30879 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30880 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30881
30882 @subsubheading Synopsis
30883
30884 @smallexample
30885 -file-list-exec-source-files
30886 @end smallexample
30887
30888 List the source files for the current executable.
30889
30890 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30891 name) of a source file.
30892
30893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30894
30895 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30896 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30897
30898 @subsubheading Example
30899 @smallexample
30900 (gdb)
30901 -file-list-exec-source-files
30902 ^done,files=[
30903 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30904 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30905 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30906 (gdb)
30907 @end smallexample
30908
30909 @ignore
30910 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30911 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30912
30913 @subsubheading Synopsis
30914
30915 @smallexample
30916 -file-list-shared-libraries
30917 @end smallexample
30918
30919 List the shared libraries in the program.
30920
30921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30922
30923 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30924
30925 @subsubheading Example
30926 N.A.
30927
30928
30929 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30930 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30931
30932 @subsubheading Synopsis
30933
30934 @smallexample
30935 -file-list-symbol-files
30936 @end smallexample
30937
30938 List symbol files.
30939
30940 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30941
30942 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30943
30944 @subsubheading Example
30945 N.A.
30946 @end ignore
30947
30948
30949 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30950 @findex -file-symbol-file
30951
30952 @subsubheading Synopsis
30953
30954 @smallexample
30955 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30956 @end smallexample
30957
30958 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30959 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30960 produced, except for a completion notification.
30961
30962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30963
30964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30965
30966 @subsubheading Example
30967
30968 @smallexample
30969 (gdb)
30970 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30971 ^done
30972 (gdb)
30973 @end smallexample
30974
30975 @ignore
30976 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30977 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30978 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30979
30980 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30981
30982 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30983
30984 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30985
30986 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30987
30988 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30989
30990 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30991
30992 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30993
30994 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30995
30996 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30997 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30998 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30999
31000 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31001
31002 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31003
31004 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31005
31006 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31007 @end ignore
31008
31009
31010 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31011 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31012 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31013
31014
31015 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31016 @findex -target-attach
31017
31018 @subsubheading Synopsis
31019
31020 @smallexample
31021 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31022 @end smallexample
31023
31024 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31025 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31026 group, the id previously returned by
31027 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31028
31029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31030
31031 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31032
31033 @subsubheading Example
31034 @smallexample
31035 (gdb)
31036 -target-attach 34
31037 =thread-created,id="1"
31038 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31039 ^done
31040 (gdb)
31041 @end smallexample
31042
31043 @ignore
31044 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31045 @findex -target-compare-sections
31046
31047 @subsubheading Synopsis
31048
31049 @smallexample
31050 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31051 @end smallexample
31052
31053 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31054 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31055
31056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31057
31058 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31059
31060 @subsubheading Example
31061 N.A.
31062 @end ignore
31063
31064
31065 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31066 @findex -target-detach
31067
31068 @subsubheading Synopsis
31069
31070 @smallexample
31071 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31072 @end smallexample
31073
31074 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31075 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31076 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31077
31078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31079
31080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31081
31082 @subsubheading Example
31083
31084 @smallexample
31085 (gdb)
31086 -target-detach
31087 ^done
31088 (gdb)
31089 @end smallexample
31090
31091
31092 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31093 @findex -target-disconnect
31094
31095 @subsubheading Synopsis
31096
31097 @smallexample
31098 -target-disconnect
31099 @end smallexample
31100
31101 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31102 generally not resumed.
31103
31104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31105
31106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31107
31108 @subsubheading Example
31109
31110 @smallexample
31111 (gdb)
31112 -target-disconnect
31113 ^done
31114 (gdb)
31115 @end smallexample
31116
31117
31118 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31119 @findex -target-download
31120
31121 @subsubheading Synopsis
31122
31123 @smallexample
31124 -target-download
31125 @end smallexample
31126
31127 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31128 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31129
31130 @table @samp
31131 @item section
31132 The name of the section.
31133 @item section-sent
31134 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31135 @item section-size
31136 The size of the section.
31137 @item total-sent
31138 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31139 @item total-size
31140 The size of the overall executable to download.
31141 @end table
31142
31143 @noindent
31144 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31145 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31146
31147 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31148 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31149
31150 @table @samp
31151 @item section
31152 The name of the section.
31153 @item section-size
31154 The size of the section.
31155 @item total-size
31156 The size of the overall executable to download.
31157 @end table
31158
31159 @noindent
31160 At the end, a summary is printed.
31161
31162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31163
31164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31165
31166 @subsubheading Example
31167
31168 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31169 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31170
31171 @smallexample
31172 (gdb)
31173 -target-download
31174 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31175 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31176 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31177 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31178 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31179 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31180 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31181 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31182 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31183 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31184 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31185 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31186 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31187 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31188 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31189 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31190 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31191 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31192 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31193 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31194 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31195 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31196 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31197 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31198 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31199 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31200 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31201 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31202 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31203 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31204 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31205 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31206 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31207 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31208 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31209 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31210 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31211 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31212 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31213 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31214 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31215 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31216 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31217 write-rate="429"
31218 (gdb)
31219 @end smallexample
31220
31221
31222 @ignore
31223 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31224 @findex -target-exec-status
31225
31226 @subsubheading Synopsis
31227
31228 @smallexample
31229 -target-exec-status
31230 @end smallexample
31231
31232 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31233 not, for instance).
31234
31235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31236
31237 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31238
31239 @subsubheading Example
31240 N.A.
31241
31242
31243 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31244 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31245
31246 @subsubheading Synopsis
31247
31248 @smallexample
31249 -target-list-available-targets
31250 @end smallexample
31251
31252 List the possible targets to connect to.
31253
31254 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31255
31256 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31257
31258 @subsubheading Example
31259 N.A.
31260
31261
31262 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31263 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31264
31265 @subsubheading Synopsis
31266
31267 @smallexample
31268 -target-list-current-targets
31269 @end smallexample
31270
31271 Describe the current target.
31272
31273 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31274
31275 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31276 other things).
31277
31278 @subsubheading Example
31279 N.A.
31280
31281
31282 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31283 @findex -target-list-parameters
31284
31285 @subsubheading Synopsis
31286
31287 @smallexample
31288 -target-list-parameters
31289 @end smallexample
31290
31291 @c ????
31292 @end ignore
31293
31294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31295
31296 No equivalent.
31297
31298 @subsubheading Example
31299 N.A.
31300
31301
31302 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31303 @findex -target-select
31304
31305 @subsubheading Synopsis
31306
31307 @smallexample
31308 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31309 @end smallexample
31310
31311 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31312
31313 @table @samp
31314 @item @var{type}
31315 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31316 @item @var{parameters}
31317 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31318 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31319 @end table
31320
31321 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31322 which the target program is, in the following form:
31323
31324 @smallexample
31325 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31326 args=[@var{arg list}]
31327 @end smallexample
31328
31329 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31330
31331 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31332
31333 @subsubheading Example
31334
31335 @smallexample
31336 (gdb)
31337 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31338 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31339 (gdb)
31340 @end smallexample
31341
31342 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31343 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31344 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31345
31346
31347 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31348 @findex -target-file-put
31349
31350 @subsubheading Synopsis
31351
31352 @smallexample
31353 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31354 @end smallexample
31355
31356 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31357 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31358
31359 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31360
31361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31362
31363 @subsubheading Example
31364
31365 @smallexample
31366 (gdb)
31367 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31368 ^done
31369 (gdb)
31370 @end smallexample
31371
31372
31373 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31374 @findex -target-file-get
31375
31376 @subsubheading Synopsis
31377
31378 @smallexample
31379 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31380 @end smallexample
31381
31382 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31383 on the host system.
31384
31385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31386
31387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31388
31389 @subsubheading Example
31390
31391 @smallexample
31392 (gdb)
31393 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31394 ^done
31395 (gdb)
31396 @end smallexample
31397
31398
31399 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31400 @findex -target-file-delete
31401
31402 @subsubheading Synopsis
31403
31404 @smallexample
31405 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31406 @end smallexample
31407
31408 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31409
31410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31411
31412 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31413
31414 @subsubheading Example
31415
31416 @smallexample
31417 (gdb)
31418 -target-file-delete remotefile
31419 ^done
31420 (gdb)
31421 @end smallexample
31422
31423
31424 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31425 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31426 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31427
31428 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31429 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31430
31431 @subsubheading Synopsis
31432
31433 @smallexample
31434 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31435 @end smallexample
31436
31437 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31438 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31439 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31440
31441 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31442
31443 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31444
31445 @subsubheading Result
31446
31447 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31448 defined for each exception:
31449
31450 @table @samp
31451 @item name
31452 The name of the exception.
31453
31454 @item address
31455 The address of the exception.
31456
31457 @end table
31458
31459 @subsubheading Example
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31463 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31464 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31465 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31466 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31467 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31468 @end smallexample
31469
31470 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31471
31472 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31473 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31474 Catchpoint Commands}.
31475
31476
31477 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31478 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31479 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31480
31481 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31482 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31483 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31484 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31485
31486 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31487 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31488 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31489
31490 @subsubheading Synopsis
31491
31492 @smallexample
31493 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31494 @end smallexample
31495
31496 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31497
31498 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31499 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31500 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31501 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31502 dash.
31503
31504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31505
31506 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31507
31508 @subsubheading Result
31509
31510 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31511
31512 @table @samp
31513 @item exists
31514 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31515 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31516
31517 @end table
31518
31519 @subsubheading Example
31520
31521 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31522
31523 @smallexample
31524 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31525 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31526 @end smallexample
31527
31528 @noindent
31529 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31530 to the debugger:
31531
31532 @smallexample
31533 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31534 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31535 @end smallexample
31536
31537 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31538 @findex -list-features
31539 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31540
31541 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31542 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31543 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31544 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31545 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31546 startup.
31547
31548 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31549 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31550 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31551 is given below.
31552
31553 Example output:
31554
31555 @smallexample
31556 (gdb) -list-features
31557 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31558 @end smallexample
31559
31560 The current list of features is:
31561
31562 @ftable @samp
31563 @item frozen-varobjs
31564 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31565 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31566 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31567 @item pending-breakpoints
31568 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31569 command.
31570 @item python
31571 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31572 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31573 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31574 @item thread-info
31575 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31576 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31577 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31578 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31579 @item breakpoint-notifications
31580 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31581 CLI will be announced via async records.
31582 @item ada-task-info
31583 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31584 @item language-option
31585 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31586 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31587 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31588 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31589 @item undefined-command-error-code
31590 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31591 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31592 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31593 @item exec-run-start-option
31594 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31595 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31596 @end ftable
31597
31598 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31599 @findex -list-target-features
31600
31601 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31602 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31603 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31604 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31605 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31606 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31607 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31608 Example output:
31609
31610 @smallexample
31611 (gdb) -list-target-features
31612 ^done,result=["async"]
31613 @end smallexample
31614
31615 The current list of features is:
31616
31617 @table @samp
31618 @item async
31619 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31620 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31621 while the target is running.
31622
31623 @item reverse
31624 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31625 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31626
31627 @end table
31628
31629 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31630 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31631 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31632
31633 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31634
31635 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31636 @findex -gdb-exit
31637
31638 @subsubheading Synopsis
31639
31640 @smallexample
31641 -gdb-exit
31642 @end smallexample
31643
31644 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31645
31646 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31647
31648 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31649
31650 @subsubheading Example
31651
31652 @smallexample
31653 (gdb)
31654 -gdb-exit
31655 ^exit
31656 @end smallexample
31657
31658
31659 @ignore
31660 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31661 @findex -exec-abort
31662
31663 @subsubheading Synopsis
31664
31665 @smallexample
31666 -exec-abort
31667 @end smallexample
31668
31669 Kill the inferior running program.
31670
31671 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31672
31673 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31674
31675 @subsubheading Example
31676 N.A.
31677 @end ignore
31678
31679
31680 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31681 @findex -gdb-set
31682
31683 @subsubheading Synopsis
31684
31685 @smallexample
31686 -gdb-set
31687 @end smallexample
31688
31689 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31690 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31691
31692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31693
31694 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31695
31696 @subsubheading Example
31697
31698 @smallexample
31699 (gdb)
31700 -gdb-set $foo=3
31701 ^done
31702 (gdb)
31703 @end smallexample
31704
31705
31706 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31707 @findex -gdb-show
31708
31709 @subsubheading Synopsis
31710
31711 @smallexample
31712 -gdb-show
31713 @end smallexample
31714
31715 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31716
31717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31718
31719 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31720
31721 @subsubheading Example
31722
31723 @smallexample
31724 (gdb)
31725 -gdb-show annotate
31726 ^done,value="0"
31727 (gdb)
31728 @end smallexample
31729
31730 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31731
31732
31733 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31734 @findex -gdb-version
31735
31736 @subsubheading Synopsis
31737
31738 @smallexample
31739 -gdb-version
31740 @end smallexample
31741
31742 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31743
31744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31745
31746 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31747 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31748
31749 @subsubheading Example
31750
31751 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31752 @c box in TeX.
31753 @smallexample
31754 (gdb)
31755 -gdb-version
31756 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31757 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31758 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31759 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31760 ~ certain conditions.
31761 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31762 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31763 ~ details.
31764 ~This GDB was configured as
31765 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31766 ^done
31767 (gdb)
31768 @end smallexample
31769
31770 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31771 @findex -list-thread-groups
31772
31773 @subheading Synopsis
31774
31775 @smallexample
31776 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31777 @end smallexample
31778
31779 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31780 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31781 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31782 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31783 top-level thread groups.
31784
31785 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31786 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31787 available on the target.
31788
31789 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31790 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31791 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31792 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31793 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31794 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31795 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31796 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31797
31798 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31799 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31800 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31801 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31802 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31803 @samp{threads} field.
31804
31805 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31806 the following caveats:
31807
31808 @itemize @bullet
31809 @item
31810 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31811 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31812 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31813
31814 @item
31815 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31816 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31817 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31818 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31819 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31820 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31821
31822 @end itemize
31823
31824 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31825 have the following fields:
31826
31827 @table @code
31828 @item id
31829 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31830 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31831 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31832
31833 @item type
31834 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31835 valid type.
31836
31837 @item pid
31838 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31839 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31840
31841 @item exit-code
31842 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31843 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31844 only if the process is not running.
31845
31846 @item num_children
31847 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31848 absent for an available thread group.
31849
31850 @item threads
31851 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31852 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31853 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31854
31855 @item cores
31856 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31857 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31858 such information is not available.
31859
31860 @item executable
31861 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31862 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31863 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31864
31865 @end table
31866
31867 @subheading Example
31868
31869 @smallexample
31870 @value{GDBP}
31871 -list-thread-groups
31872 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31873 -list-thread-groups 17
31874 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31875 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31876 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31877 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31878 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31879 -list-thread-groups --available
31880 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31881 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31882 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31883 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31884 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31885 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31886 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31887 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31888 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31889 @end smallexample
31890
31891 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31892 @findex -info-os
31893
31894 @subsubheading Synopsis
31895
31896 @smallexample
31897 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31898 @end smallexample
31899
31900 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31901 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31902 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31903 of data of that type.
31904
31905 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31906 system.
31907
31908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31909
31910 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31911
31912 @subsubheading Example
31913
31914 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31915 like this:
31916
31917 @smallexample
31918 @value{GDBP}
31919 -info-os
31920 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
31921 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31922 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31923 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31924 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
31925 col2="CPUs"@},
31926 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31927 col2="File descriptors"@},
31928 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31929 col2="Kernel modules"@},
31930 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31931 col2="Message queues"@},
31932 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31933 col2="Processes"@},
31934 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31935 col2="Process groups"@},
31936 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31937 col2="Semaphores"@},
31938 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31939 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31940 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31941 col2="Sockets"@},
31942 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31943 col2="Threads"@}]
31944 @value{GDBP}
31945 -info-os processes
31946 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31947 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31948 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31949 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31950 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31951 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31952 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31953 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31954 ...
31955 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31956 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31957 (gdb)
31958 @end smallexample
31959
31960 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31961 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31962 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31963 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31964 @code{info os} omits it.)
31965
31966 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31967 @findex -add-inferior
31968
31969 @subheading Synopsis
31970
31971 @smallexample
31972 -add-inferior
31973 @end smallexample
31974
31975 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31976 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31977 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31978 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31979 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31980 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31981
31982 @subheading Example
31983
31984 @smallexample
31985 @value{GDBP}
31986 -add-inferior
31987 ^done,inferior="i3"
31988 @end smallexample
31989
31990 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31991 @findex -interpreter-exec
31992
31993 @subheading Synopsis
31994
31995 @smallexample
31996 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31997 @end smallexample
31998 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31999
32000 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32001
32002 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32003
32004 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32005
32006 @subheading Example
32007
32008 @smallexample
32009 (gdb)
32010 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32011 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32012 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32013 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32014 ^done
32015 (gdb)
32016 @end smallexample
32017
32018 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32019 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32020
32021 @subheading Synopsis
32022
32023 @smallexample
32024 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32025 @end smallexample
32026
32027 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32028
32029 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32030
32031 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32032
32033 @subheading Example
32034
32035 @smallexample
32036 (gdb)
32037 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32038 ^done
32039 (gdb)
32040 @end smallexample
32041
32042 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32043 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32044
32045 @subheading Synopsis
32046
32047 @smallexample
32048 -inferior-tty-show
32049 @end smallexample
32050
32051 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32052
32053 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32054
32055 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32056
32057 @subheading Example
32058
32059 @smallexample
32060 (gdb)
32061 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32062 ^done
32063 (gdb)
32064 -inferior-tty-show
32065 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32066 (gdb)
32067 @end smallexample
32068
32069 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32070 @findex -enable-timings
32071
32072 @subheading Synopsis
32073
32074 @smallexample
32075 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32076 @end smallexample
32077
32078 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32079 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32080 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32081 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32082
32083 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32084
32085 No equivalent.
32086
32087 @subheading Example
32088
32089 @smallexample
32090 (gdb)
32091 -enable-timings
32092 ^done
32093 (gdb)
32094 -break-insert main
32095 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32096 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32097 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32098 times="0"@},
32099 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32100 (gdb)
32101 -enable-timings no
32102 ^done
32103 (gdb)
32104 -exec-run
32105 ^running
32106 (gdb)
32107 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32108 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32109 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32110 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32111 (gdb)
32112 @end smallexample
32113
32114 @node Annotations
32115 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32116
32117 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32118 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32119 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32120 relatively high level.
32121
32122 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32123 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32124
32125 @ignore
32126 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32127 @end ignore
32128
32129 @menu
32130 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32131 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32132 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32133 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32134 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32135 * Annotations for Running::
32136 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32137 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32138 @end menu
32139
32140 @node Annotations Overview
32141 @section What is an Annotation?
32142 @cindex annotations
32143
32144 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32145 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32146 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32147 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32148 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32149 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32150 cannot contain newline characters.
32151
32152 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32153 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32154 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32155 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32156 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32157 means those three characters as output.
32158
32159 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32160 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32161 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32162 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32163 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32164 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32165 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32166 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32167 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32168
32169 @table @code
32170 @kindex set annotate
32171 @item set annotate @var{level}
32172 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32173 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32174
32175 @item show annotate
32176 @kindex show annotate
32177 Show the current annotation level.
32178 @end table
32179
32180 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32181
32182 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32183
32184 @smallexample
32185 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32186 GNU gdb 6.0
32187 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32188 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32189 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32190 under certain conditions.
32191 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32192 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32193 for details.
32194 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32195
32196 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32197 (@value{GDBP})
32198 ^Z^Zprompt
32199 @kbd{quit}
32200
32201 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32202 $
32203 @end smallexample
32204
32205 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32206 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32207 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32208 output from @value{GDBN}.
32209
32210 @node Server Prefix
32211 @section The Server Prefix
32212 @cindex server prefix
32213
32214 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32215 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32216 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32217 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32218 a transparent manner.
32219
32220 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32221 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32222 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32223 @code{print} command.
32224
32225 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32226 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32227
32228 @node Prompting
32229 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32230
32231 @cindex annotations for prompts
32232 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32233 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32234 over, etc.
32235
32236 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32237 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32238 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32239 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32240 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32241 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32242 features the following annotations:
32243
32244 @smallexample
32245 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32246 ^Z^Zprompt
32247 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32248 @end smallexample
32249
32250 The input types are
32251
32252 @table @code
32253 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32254 @findex prompt annotation
32255 @findex post-prompt annotation
32256 @item prompt
32257 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32258
32259 @findex pre-commands annotation
32260 @findex commands annotation
32261 @findex post-commands annotation
32262 @item commands
32263 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32264 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32265
32266 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32267 @findex overload-choice annotation
32268 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32269 @item overload-choice
32270 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32271
32272 @findex pre-query annotation
32273 @findex query annotation
32274 @findex post-query annotation
32275 @item query
32276 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32277
32278 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32279 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32280 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32281 @item prompt-for-continue
32282 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32283 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32284 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32285 presence of annotations.
32286 @end table
32287
32288 @node Errors
32289 @section Errors
32290 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32291
32292 @findex quit annotation
32293 @smallexample
32294 ^Z^Zquit
32295 @end smallexample
32296
32297 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32298
32299 @findex error annotation
32300 @smallexample
32301 ^Z^Zerror
32302 @end smallexample
32303
32304 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32305
32306 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32307 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32308 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32309 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32310 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32311 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32312 to the top level.
32313
32314 @findex error-begin annotation
32315 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32316
32317 @smallexample
32318 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32319 @end smallexample
32320
32321 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32322 message.
32323
32324 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32325 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32326 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32327
32328 @node Invalidation
32329 @section Invalidation Notices
32330
32331 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32332 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32333 changed.
32334
32335 @table @code
32336 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32337 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32338
32339 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32340 have changed.
32341
32342 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32343 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32344
32345 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32346 deleted a breakpoint.
32347 @end table
32348
32349 @node Annotations for Running
32350 @section Running the Program
32351 @cindex annotations for running programs
32352
32353 @findex starting annotation
32354 @findex stopping annotation
32355 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32356 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32357
32358 @smallexample
32359 ^Z^Zstarting
32360 @end smallexample
32361
32362 is output. When the program stops,
32363
32364 @smallexample
32365 ^Z^Zstopped
32366 @end smallexample
32367
32368 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32369 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32370
32371 @table @code
32372 @findex exited annotation
32373 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32374 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32375 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32376
32377 @findex signalled annotation
32378 @findex signal-name annotation
32379 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32380 @findex signal-string annotation
32381 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32382 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32383 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32384 annotation continues:
32385
32386 @smallexample
32387 @var{intro-text}
32388 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32389 @var{name}
32390 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32391 @var{middle-text}
32392 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32393 @var{string}
32394 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32395 @var{end-text}
32396 @end smallexample
32397
32398 @noindent
32399 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32400 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32401 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32402 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32403 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32404
32405 @findex signal annotation
32406 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32407 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32408 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32409 terminated with it.
32410
32411 @findex breakpoint annotation
32412 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32413 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32414
32415 @findex watchpoint annotation
32416 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32417 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32418 @end table
32419
32420 @node Source Annotations
32421 @section Displaying Source
32422 @cindex annotations for source display
32423
32424 @findex source annotation
32425 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32426
32427 @smallexample
32428 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32429 @end smallexample
32430
32431 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32432 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32433 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32434 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32435 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32436 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32437 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32438 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32439 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32440 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32441 depend on the language).
32442
32443 @node JIT Interface
32444 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32445 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32446 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32447
32448 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32449 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32450 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32451 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32452
32453 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32454 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32455 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32456 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32457 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32458 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32459
32460 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32461 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32462 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32463 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32464 LLVM JIT.
32465
32466 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32467 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32468 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32469 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32470 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32471 out about additional code.
32472
32473 @menu
32474 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32475 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32476 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32477 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32478 @end menu
32479
32480 @node Declarations
32481 @section JIT Declarations
32482
32483 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32484 implement the interface:
32485
32486 @smallexample
32487 typedef enum
32488 @{
32489 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32490 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32491 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32492 @} jit_actions_t;
32493
32494 struct jit_code_entry
32495 @{
32496 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32497 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32498 const char *symfile_addr;
32499 uint64_t symfile_size;
32500 @};
32501
32502 struct jit_descriptor
32503 @{
32504 uint32_t version;
32505 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32506 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32507 uint32_t action_flag;
32508 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32509 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32510 @};
32511
32512 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32513 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32514
32515 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32516 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32517 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32518 @end smallexample
32519
32520 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32521 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32522 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32523
32524 @node Registering Code
32525 @section Registering Code
32526
32527 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32528
32529 @itemize @bullet
32530 @item
32531 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32532 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32533
32534 @item
32535 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32536 file.
32537
32538 @item
32539 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32540
32541 @item
32542 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32543
32544 @item
32545 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32546 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32547 @end itemize
32548
32549 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32550 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32551 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32552 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32553
32554 @node Unregistering Code
32555 @section Unregistering Code
32556
32557 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32558
32559 @itemize @bullet
32560 @item
32561 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32562
32563 @item
32564 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32565
32566 @item
32567 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32568 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32569 @end itemize
32570
32571 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32572 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32573
32574 @node Custom Debug Info
32575 @section Custom Debug Info
32576 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32577 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32578
32579 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32580 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32581 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32582 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32583 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32584 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32585 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32586 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32587 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32588
32589 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32590 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32591 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32592 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32593 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32594 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32595 compiler.
32596
32597 @menu
32598 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32599 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32600 @end menu
32601
32602 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32603 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32604 @kindex jit-reader-load
32605 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32606
32607 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32608 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32609
32610 @table @code
32611 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32612 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32613 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32614 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32615 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32616 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32617 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32618
32619 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32620 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32621 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32622 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32623 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32624
32625 @item jit-reader-unload
32626 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32627
32628 @end table
32629
32630 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32631 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32632 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32633
32634 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32635 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32636
32637 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32638 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32639 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32640 the system include directory.
32641
32642 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32643 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32644 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32645
32646 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32647 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32648
32649 @findex gdb_init_reader
32650 @smallexample
32651 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32652 @end smallexample
32653
32654 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32655
32656 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32657 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32658 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32659 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32660 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32661 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32662
32663 @smallexample
32664 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32665 @{
32666 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32667 int reader_version;
32668
32669 /* For use by the reader. */
32670 void *priv_data;
32671
32672 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32673 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32674 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32675 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32676 @};
32677 @end smallexample
32678
32679 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32680 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32681
32682 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32683 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32684 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32685 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32686 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32687 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32688 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32689 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32690 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32691 target's address space.
32692
32693 @node In-Process Agent
32694 @chapter In-Process Agent
32695 @cindex debugging agent
32696 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32697 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32698 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32699 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32700 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32701 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32702 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32703 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32704 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32705 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32706 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32707 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32708 behavior without interrupting it.
32709
32710 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32711 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32712 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32713 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32714 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32715 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32716 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32717 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32718 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32719
32720 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32721 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32722 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32723 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32724
32725 @anchor{Control Agent}
32726 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32727 debugging with the following commands:
32728
32729 @table @code
32730 @kindex set agent on
32731 @item set agent on
32732 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32733 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32734 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32735 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32736 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32737 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32738
32739 @kindex set agent off
32740 @item set agent off
32741 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32742 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32743
32744 @kindex show agent
32745 @item show agent
32746 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32747 the in-process agent.
32748 @end table
32749
32750 @menu
32751 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32752 @end menu
32753
32754 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32755 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32756 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32757
32758 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32759 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32760 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32761 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32762 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32763 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32764 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32765 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32766 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32767
32768 @menu
32769 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32770 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32771 @end menu
32772
32773 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32774 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32775 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32776
32777 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32778 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32779
32780 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32781 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32782 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32783 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32784
32785 @enumerate
32786 @item
32787 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32788 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32789 @item
32790 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32791 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32792 the other one.
32793 @end enumerate
32794
32795 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32796
32797 @enumerate
32798 @item
32799 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32800 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32801 @anchor{agent expression object}
32802 @item
32803 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32804 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32805 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32806 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32807 @item
32808 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32809 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32810
32811 @end enumerate
32812
32813 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32814 object:
32815
32816 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32817 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32818 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32819 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32820 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32821 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32822 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32823 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32824 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32825 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32826 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32827 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32828 memory address for collecting.
32829 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32830 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32831 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32832 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32833 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32834 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32835 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32836 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32837 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32838 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32839 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32840 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32841 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32842 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32843 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32844 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32845 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32846 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32847 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32848 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32849 @ref{agent expression object}
32850 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32851 @ref{agent expression object}
32852 @item actions @tab variable
32853 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32854 @end multitable
32855
32856 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32857 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32858 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32859
32860 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32861 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32862
32863 @table @samp
32864
32865 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32866 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32867 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32868 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32869 in IPA finally.
32870
32871 Replies:
32872 @table @samp
32873 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32874 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32875 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32876 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32877 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32878 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32879 @item E @var{NN}
32880 for an error
32881
32882 @end table
32883
32884 @item close
32885 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32886 is about to kill inferiors.
32887
32888 @item qTfSTM
32889 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32890 @item qTsSTM
32891 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32892 @item qTSTMat
32893 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32894 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32895 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32896
32897 Replies:
32898 @table @samp
32899 @item E @var{NN}
32900 for an error
32901 @end table
32902 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32903 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32904 @end table
32905
32906 @node GDB Bugs
32907 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32908 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32909 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32910
32911 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32912
32913 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32914 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32915 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32916 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32917
32918 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32919 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32920
32921 @menu
32922 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32923 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32924 @end menu
32925
32926 @node Bug Criteria
32927 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32928 @cindex bug criteria
32929
32930 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32931
32932 @itemize @bullet
32933 @cindex fatal signal
32934 @cindex debugger crash
32935 @cindex crash of debugger
32936 @item
32937 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32938 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32939
32940 @cindex error on valid input
32941 @item
32942 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32943 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32944 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32945
32946 @cindex invalid input
32947 @item
32948 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32949 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32950 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32951 for traditional practice''.
32952
32953 @item
32954 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32955 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32956 @end itemize
32957
32958 @node Bug Reporting
32959 @section How to Report Bugs
32960 @cindex bug reports
32961 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32962
32963 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32964 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32965 contact that organization first.
32966
32967 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32968 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32969 distribution.
32970 @c should add a web page ref...
32971
32972 @ifset BUGURL
32973 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32974 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32975 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32976 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32977 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32978 be used.
32979
32980 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32981 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32982 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32983 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32984
32985 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32986 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32987 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32988 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32989 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32990 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32991 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32992 bug reports to the mailing list.
32993 @end ifset
32994 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32995 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32996 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32997 @end ifclear
32998 @end ifset
32999
33000 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33001 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33002 fact or leave it out, state it!
33003
33004 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33005 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33006 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33007 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33008 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33009 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33010 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33011 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33012 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33013
33014 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33015 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33016 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33017 self-contained.
33018
33019 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33020 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33021 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33022 bugs properly.
33023
33024 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33025
33026 @itemize @bullet
33027 @item
33028 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33029 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33030 version}.
33031
33032 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33033 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33034
33035 @item
33036 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33037 version number.
33038
33039 @item
33040 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33041 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33042 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33043 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33044
33045 @item
33046 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33047 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33048
33049 @item
33050 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33051 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33052 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33053 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33054 those compilers.
33055
33056 @item
33057 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33058 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33059 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33060 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33061
33062 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33063 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33064
33065 @item
33066 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33067 reproduce the bug.
33068
33069 @item
33070 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33071 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33072
33073 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33074 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33075 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33076 a chance to make a mistake.
33077
33078 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33079 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33080 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33081 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33082 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33083 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33084 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33085 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33086
33087 @pindex script
33088 @cindex recording a session script
33089 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33090 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33091 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33092 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33093
33094 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33095 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33096
33097 @item
33098 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33099 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33100 it by context, not by line number.
33101
33102 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33103 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33104
33105 @end itemize
33106
33107 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33108
33109 @itemize @bullet
33110 @item
33111 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33112
33113 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33114 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33115 changes will not affect it.
33116
33117 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33118 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33119 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33120 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33121
33122 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33123 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33124 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33125 less time, and so on.
33126
33127 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33128 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33129
33130 @item
33131 A patch for the bug.
33132
33133 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33134 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33135 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33136 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33137
33138 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33139 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33140 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33141 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33142
33143 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33144 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33145 help us to understand.
33146
33147 @item
33148 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33149
33150 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33151 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33152 @end itemize
33153
33154 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33155 @c and consists of the two following files:
33156 @c rluser.texi
33157 @c hsuser.texi
33158 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33159 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33160 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33161 @include rluser.texi
33162 @include hsuser.texi
33163 @end ifclear
33164
33165 @node In Memoriam
33166 @appendix In Memoriam
33167
33168 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33169 contributors:
33170
33171 @table @code
33172 @item Fred Fish
33173 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33174 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33175 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33176
33177 @item Michael Snyder
33178 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33179 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33180 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33181 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33182 @end table
33183
33184 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33185 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33186
33187 @node Formatting Documentation
33188 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33189
33190 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33191 @cindex reference card
33192 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33193 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33194 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33195 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33196 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33197 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33198
33199 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33200 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33201
33202 @smallexample
33203 make refcard.dvi
33204 @end smallexample
33205
33206 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33207 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33208 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33209 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33210 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33211
33212 @cindex documentation
33213
33214 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33215 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33216 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33217 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33218 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33219 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33220
33221 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33222 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33223 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33224 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33225 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33226 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33227 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33228 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33229
33230 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33231 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33232 @code{makeinfo}.
33233
33234 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33235 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33236 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33237
33238 @smallexample
33239 cd gdb
33240 make gdb.info
33241 @end smallexample
33242
33243 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33244 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33245 Texinfo definitions file.
33246
33247 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33248 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33249 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33250 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33251 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33252 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33253 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33254
33255 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33256 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33257 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33258 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33259 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33260 directory.
33261
33262 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33263 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33264 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33265 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33266
33267 @smallexample
33268 make gdb.dvi
33269 @end smallexample
33270
33271 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33272
33273 @node Installing GDB
33274 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33275 @cindex installation
33276
33277 @menu
33278 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33279 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33280 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33281 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33282 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33283 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33284 @end menu
33285
33286 @node Requirements
33287 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33288 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33289
33290 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33291 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33292
33293 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33294 @table @asis
33295 @item ISO C90 compiler
33296 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33297 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33298
33299 @end table
33300
33301 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33302 @table @asis
33303 @item Expat
33304 @anchor{Expat}
33305 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33306 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33307 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33308 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33309 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33310 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33311
33312 Expat is used for:
33313
33314 @itemize @bullet
33315 @item
33316 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33317 @item
33318 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33319 @item
33320 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33321 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33322 @item
33323 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33324 @item
33325 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33326 @item
33327 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33328 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33329 @end itemize
33330
33331 @item zlib
33332 @cindex compressed debug sections
33333 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33334 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33335 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33336 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33337 information in such binaries.
33338
33339 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33340 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33341 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33342
33343 @item iconv
33344 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33345 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33346 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33347 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33348
33349 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33350 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33351 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33352 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33353
33354 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33355 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33356 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33357
33358 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33359 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33360 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33361 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33362 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33363 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33364 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33365 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33366 @end table
33367
33368 @node Running Configure
33369 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33370 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33371 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33372 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33373 build the @code{gdb} program.
33374 @iftex
33375 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33376 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33377 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33378 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33379 @end iftex
33380
33381 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33382 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33383 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33384
33385 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33386 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33387
33388 @table @code
33389 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33390 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33391
33392 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33393 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33394
33395 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33396 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33397
33398 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33399 @sc{gnu} include files
33400
33401 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33402 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33403
33404 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33405 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33406
33407 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33408 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33409
33410 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33411 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33412
33413 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33414 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33415 @end table
33416
33417 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33418 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33419 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33420
33421 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33422 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33423 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33424 argument.
33425
33426 For example:
33427
33428 @smallexample
33429 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33430 ./configure @var{host}
33431 make
33432 @end smallexample
33433
33434 @noindent
33435 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33436 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33437 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33438 correct value by examining your system.)
33439
33440 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33441 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33442 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33443 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33444
33445 @need 750
33446 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33447 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33448 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33449
33450 @smallexample
33451 sh configure @var{host}
33452 @end smallexample
33453
33454 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33455 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33456 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33457 @file{configure}
33458 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33459 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33460
33461 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33462 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33463 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33464 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33465 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33466 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33467 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33468 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33469 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33470
33471 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33472 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33473 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33474 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33475 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33476
33477 @node Separate Objdir
33478 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33479
33480 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33481 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33482 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33483 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33484 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33485 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33486 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33487 program specified there.
33488
33489 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33490 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33491 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33492 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33493 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33494 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33495
33496 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33497 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33498
33499 @smallexample
33500 @group
33501 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33502 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33503 cd ../gdb-sun4
33504 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33505 make
33506 @end group
33507 @end smallexample
33508
33509 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33510 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33511 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33512 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33513 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33514 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33515
33516 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33517 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33518 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33519 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33520 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33521
33522 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33523 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33524 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33525 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33526 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33527 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33528
33529 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33530 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33531 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33532
33533 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33534 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33535 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33536 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33537 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33538
33539 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33540 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33541 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33542 with each other.
33543
33544 @node Config Names
33545 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33546
33547 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33548 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33549 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33550 of information in the following pattern:
33551
33552 @smallexample
33553 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33554 @end smallexample
33555
33556 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33557 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33558 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33559
33560 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33561 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33562 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33563 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33564 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33565 abbreviations---for example:
33566
33567 @smallexample
33568 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33569 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33570 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33571 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33572 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33573 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33574 % sh config.sub sun4
33575 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33576 % sh config.sub sun3
33577 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33578 % sh config.sub i986v
33579 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33580 @end smallexample
33581
33582 @noindent
33583 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33584 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33585
33586 @node Configure Options
33587 @section @file{configure} Options
33588
33589 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33590 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33591 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33592 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33593
33594 @smallexample
33595 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33596 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33597 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33598 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33599 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33600 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33601 @var{host}
33602 @end smallexample
33603
33604 @noindent
33605 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33606 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33607 @samp{--}.
33608
33609 @table @code
33610 @item --help
33611 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33612
33613 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33614 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33615 @file{@var{dir}}.
33616
33617 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33618 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33619 @file{@var{dir}}.
33620
33621 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33622 @need 2000
33623 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33624 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33625 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33626 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33627 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33628 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33629 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33630 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33631 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33632 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33633 @var{dirname}.
33634
33635 @item --norecursion
33636 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33637 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33638
33639 @item --target=@var{target}
33640 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33641 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33642 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33643
33644 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33645
33646 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33647 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33648
33649 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33650 @end table
33651
33652 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33653 needed for special purposes only.
33654
33655 @node System-wide configuration
33656 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33657 @cindex system-wide init file
33658
33659 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33660 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33661 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33662
33663 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33664
33665 @table @code
33666 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33667 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33668 @var{file}.
33669 @end table
33670
33671 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33672 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33673
33674 @itemize @bullet
33675 @item
33676 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33677 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33678 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33679 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33680 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33681 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33682
33683 @item
33684 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33685 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33686 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33687 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33688 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33689 @end itemize
33690
33691 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33692 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33693 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33694 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33695 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33696 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33697 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33698 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33699 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33700 reread.
33701
33702 @menu
33703 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33704 @end menu
33705
33706 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33707 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33708 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33709
33710 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33711 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33712 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33713 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33714 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33715 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33716
33717 The following scripts are currently available:
33718 @itemize @bullet
33719
33720 @item @file{elinos.py}
33721 @pindex elinos.py
33722 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33723 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33724 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33725 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33726 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33727 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33728
33729 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33730 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33731 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33732 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33733 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33734 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33735
33736 @end itemize
33737
33738 @node Maintenance Commands
33739 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33740 @cindex maintenance commands
33741 @cindex internal commands
33742
33743 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33744 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33745 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33746 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33747 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33748
33749 @table @code
33750 @kindex maint agent
33751 @kindex maint agent-eval
33752 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33753 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33754 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33755 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33756 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33757 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33758 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33759 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33760 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33761 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33762 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33763 addition and return the sum.
33764 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33765 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33766
33767 @kindex maint agent-printf
33768 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33769 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33770 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33771 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33772 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33773
33774 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33775 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33776 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33777 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33778 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33779 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33780 is shown:
33781
33782 @table @code
33783 @item breakpoint
33784 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33785
33786 @item watchpoint
33787 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33788
33789 @item longjmp
33790 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33791 @code{longjmp} calls.
33792
33793 @item longjmp resume
33794 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33795
33796 @item until
33797 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33798
33799 @item finish
33800 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33801
33802 @item shlib events
33803 Shared library events.
33804
33805 @end table
33806
33807 @kindex maint info bfds
33808 @item maint info bfds
33809 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33810 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33811
33812 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33813 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33814 @cindex displaced stepping support
33815 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33816 @item set displaced-stepping
33817 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33818 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33819 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33820 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33821 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33822 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33823
33824 @table @code
33825 @item set displaced-stepping on
33826 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33827 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33828
33829 @item set displaced-stepping off
33830 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33831 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33832
33833 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33834 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33835 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33836 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33837 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33838 @end table
33839
33840 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33841 @item maint check-psymtabs
33842 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33843 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33844
33845 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33846 @item maint check-symtabs
33847 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33848
33849 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33850 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33851 Expand symbol tables.
33852 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33853 names matching @var{regexp}.
33854
33855 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33856 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33857 @cindex demangler crashes
33858 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33859 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33860 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33861 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33862 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33863 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33864 option to terminate the current session.
33865
33866 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33867 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33868 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33869
33870 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33871 @item maint cplus namespace
33872 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33873
33874 @kindex maint deprecate
33875 @kindex maint undeprecate
33876 @cindex deprecated commands
33877 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33878 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33879 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33880 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33881 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33882 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33883 the replacement as part of the warning.
33884
33885 @kindex maint dump-me
33886 @item maint dump-me
33887 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33888 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33889 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33890 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33891
33892 @kindex maint internal-error
33893 @kindex maint internal-warning
33894 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33895 @cindex demangler crashes
33896 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33897 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33898 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33899
33900 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33901 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33902 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
33903 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33904 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33905 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33906 @value{GDBN} session.
33907
33908 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33909 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33910
33911 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33912
33913 @smallexample
33914 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33915 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33916 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33917 debugging may prove unreliable.
33918 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33919 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33920 (@value{GDBP})
33921 @end smallexample
33922
33923 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33924 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33925 @cindex demangler crashes
33926
33927 @kindex maint set internal-error
33928 @kindex maint show internal-error
33929 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33930 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33931 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33932 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33933 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33934 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33935 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33936 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33937 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33938 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33939 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33940 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33941 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33942 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33943 described in the table below.
33944
33945 @table @samp
33946 @item quit
33947 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33948 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33949
33950 @item corefile
33951 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33952 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33953 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33954 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33955 disabled.
33956 @end table
33957
33958 @kindex maint packet
33959 @item maint packet @var{text}
33960 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33961 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33962 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33963 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33964 checksum.
33965
33966 @kindex maint print architecture
33967 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33968 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33969 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33970
33971 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33972 @item maint print c-tdesc
33973 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33974 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33975 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33976
33977 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33978 @item maint print dummy-frames
33979 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33980
33981 @smallexample
33982 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33983 @dots{}
33984 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33985 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33986 58 return (a + b);
33987 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33988 @dots{}
33989 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33990 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33991 (@value{GDBP})
33992 @end smallexample
33993
33994 Takes an optional file parameter.
33995
33996 @kindex maint print registers
33997 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33998 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33999 @kindex maint print register-groups
34000 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34001 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34002 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34003 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34004 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34005 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34006 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34007
34008 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34009 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34010 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34011 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34012 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34013 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34014 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34015 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34016
34017 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34018 write the information.
34019
34020 @kindex maint print reggroups
34021 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34022 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34023 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34024 information.
34025
34026 The register groups info looks like this:
34027
34028 @smallexample
34029 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34030 Group Type
34031 general user
34032 float user
34033 all user
34034 vector user
34035 system user
34036 save internal
34037 restore internal
34038 @end smallexample
34039
34040 @kindex flushregs
34041 @item flushregs
34042 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34043
34044 @kindex maint print objfiles
34045 @cindex info for known object files
34046 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34047 Print a dump of all known object files.
34048 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34049 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34050 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34051
34052 @kindex maint print user-registers
34053 @cindex user registers
34054 @item maint print user-registers
34055 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34056 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34057 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34058 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34059 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34060 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34061 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34062
34063 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34064 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34065 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34066 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34067 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34068 matching @var{regexp}.
34069 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34070 and the full path if known.
34071 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34072
34073 @kindex maint print statistics
34074 @cindex bcache statistics
34075 @item maint print statistics
34076 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34077 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34078 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34079 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34080 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34081 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34082 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34083 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34084 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34085 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34086 lengths.
34087
34088 @kindex maint print target-stack
34089 @cindex target stack description
34090 @item maint print target-stack
34091 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34092 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34093 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34094 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34095 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34096 address.
34097
34098 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34099 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34100
34101 @kindex maint print type
34102 @cindex type chain of a data type
34103 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34104 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34105 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34106 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34107 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34108 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34109
34110 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34111 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34112 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34113 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34114 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34115 information.
34116
34117 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34118 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34119 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34120 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34121 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34122 always see the disassembly form.
34123
34124 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34125
34126 @smallexample
34127 (gdb) info addr argc
34128 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34129 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34130 @end smallexample
34131
34132 For more information on these expressions, see
34133 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34134
34135 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34136 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34137 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34138 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34139 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
34140
34141 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
34142 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34143 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
34144 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34145 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34146 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34147 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34148 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34149 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34150
34151 @kindex maint set profile
34152 @kindex maint show profile
34153 @cindex profiling GDB
34154 @item maint set profile
34155 @itemx maint show profile
34156 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34157
34158 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34159 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34160 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34161 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34162 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34163 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34164 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34165
34166 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34167 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34168
34169 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34170 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34171 @cindex hardware debug registers
34172 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34173 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34174 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34175 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34176 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34177 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34178 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34179
34180 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34181 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34182 @item maint set show-all-tib
34183 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34184 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34185 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34186 command.
34187
34188 @kindex maint set target-async
34189 @kindex maint show target-async
34190 @item maint set target-async
34191 @itemx maint show target-async
34192 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34193 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34194 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34195 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34196
34197 @kindex maint set per-command
34198 @kindex maint show per-command
34199 @item maint set per-command
34200 @itemx maint show per-command
34201 @cindex resources used by commands
34202
34203 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34204 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34205
34206 @table @code
34207 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34208 @itemx maint show per-command space
34209 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34210 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34211 took, following the command's own output.
34212 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34213 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34214
34215 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34216 @itemx maint show per-command time
34217 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34218 for each command.
34219 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34220 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34221 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34222 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34223 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34224 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34225 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34226 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34227 spent by the program been debugged.
34228 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34229 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34230
34231 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34232 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34233 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34234 for each command.
34235 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34236
34237 @enumerate a
34238 @item
34239 number of symbol tables
34240 @item
34241 number of primary symbol tables
34242 @item
34243 number of blocks in the blockvector
34244 @end enumerate
34245 @end table
34246
34247 @kindex maint space
34248 @cindex memory used by commands
34249 @item maint space @var{value}
34250 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34251 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34252
34253 @kindex maint time
34254 @cindex time of command execution
34255 @item maint time @var{value}
34256 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34257 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34258
34259 @kindex maint translate-address
34260 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34261 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34262 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34263 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34264 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34265 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34266 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34267
34268 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34269 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34270 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34271
34272 @end table
34273
34274 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34275 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34276
34277 @table @code
34278 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34279 @kindex set watchdog
34280 @cindex watchdog timer
34281 @cindex timeout for commands
34282 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34283 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34284 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34285
34286 @item show watchdog
34287 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34288 @end table
34289
34290 @node Remote Protocol
34291 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34292
34293 @menu
34294 * Overview::
34295 * Packets::
34296 * Stop Reply Packets::
34297 * General Query Packets::
34298 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34299 * Tracepoint Packets::
34300 * Host I/O Packets::
34301 * Interrupts::
34302 * Notification Packets::
34303 * Remote Non-Stop::
34304 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34305 * Examples::
34306 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34307 * Library List Format::
34308 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34309 * Memory Map Format::
34310 * Thread List Format::
34311 * Traceframe Info Format::
34312 * Branch Trace Format::
34313 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34314 @end menu
34315
34316 @node Overview
34317 @section Overview
34318
34319 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34320 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34321 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34322 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34323
34324 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34325 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34326
34327 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34328 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34329 @cindex remote serial protocol
34330 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34331 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34332 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34333 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34334 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34335
34336 @smallexample
34337 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34338 @end smallexample
34339 @noindent
34340
34341 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34342 @noindent
34343 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34344 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34345 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34346
34347 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34348 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34349
34350 @smallexample
34351 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34352 @end smallexample
34353
34354 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34355 @noindent
34356 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34357 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34358 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34359
34360 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34361 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34362 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34363 retransmission):
34364
34365 @smallexample
34366 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34367 <- @code{+}
34368 @end smallexample
34369 @noindent
34370
34371 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34372 once a connection is established.
34373 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34374
34375 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34376 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34377 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34378 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34379 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34380 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34381 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34382
34383 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34384 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34385 exceptions).
34386
34387 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34388 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34389 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34390 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34391
34392 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34393 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34394 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34395
34396 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34397 @anchor{Binary Data}
34398 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34399 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34400 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34401 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34402 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34403 binary data.
34404
34405 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34406 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34407 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34408 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34409 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34410 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34411 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34412 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34413 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34414 (described next).
34415
34416 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34417 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34418 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34419 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34420 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34421 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34422 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34423 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34424 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34425 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34426 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34427 3}} more times.
34428
34429 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34430 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34431 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34432 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34433 @samp{0*"00}.
34434
34435 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34436 error number. That number is not well defined.
34437
34438 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34439 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34440 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34441 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34442 on that response.
34443
34444 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34445 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34446 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34447 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34448 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34449 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34450
34451 @node Packets
34452 @section Packets
34453
34454 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34455 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34456 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34457 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34458
34459 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34460 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34461 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34462 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34463 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34464 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34465 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34466 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34467 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34468 @var{baz}.
34469
34470 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34471 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34472 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34473 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34474 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34475 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34476 pick any thread.
34477
34478 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34479 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34480 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34481 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34482 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34483 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34484 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34485 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34486 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34487 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34488 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34489 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34490 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34491
34492 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34493 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34494 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34495 more information.
34496
34497 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34498 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34499
34500 Here are the packet descriptions.
34501
34502 @table @samp
34503
34504 @item !
34505 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34506 @anchor{extended mode}
34507 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34508 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34509 debugged.
34510
34511 Reply:
34512 @table @samp
34513 @item OK
34514 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34515 @end table
34516
34517 @item ?
34518 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34519 @anchor{? packet}
34520 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34521 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34522 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34523
34524 Reply:
34525 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34526
34527 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34528 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34529 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34530 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34531 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34532
34533 Reply:
34534 @table @samp
34535 @item OK
34536 The arguments were set.
34537 @item E @var{NN}
34538 An error occurred.
34539 @end table
34540
34541 @item b @var{baud}
34542 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34543 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34544 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34545
34546 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34547 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34548 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34549
34550 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34551 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34552 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34553 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34554 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34555
34556 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34557 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34558 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34559 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34560
34561 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34562 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34563
34564 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34565 @anchor{bc}
34566 @item bc
34567 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34568 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34569
34570 Reply:
34571 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34572
34573 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34574 @anchor{bs}
34575 @item bs
34576 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34577 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34578
34579 Reply:
34580 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34581
34582 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34583 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34584 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34585 is omitted, resume at current address.
34586
34587 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34588 packet}.
34589
34590 Reply:
34591 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34592
34593 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34594 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34595 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34596 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34597
34598 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34599 packet}.
34600
34601 Reply:
34602 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34603
34604 @item d
34605 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34606 Toggle debug flag.
34607
34608 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34609 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34610
34611 @item D
34612 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34613 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34614 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34615 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34616 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34617
34618 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34619 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34620 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34621 big-endian hex string.
34622
34623 Reply:
34624 @table @samp
34625 @item OK
34626 for success
34627 @item E @var{NN}
34628 for an error
34629 @end table
34630
34631 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34632 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34633 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34634 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34635 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34636
34637 @item g
34638 @anchor{read registers packet}
34639 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34640 Read general registers.
34641
34642 Reply:
34643 @table @samp
34644 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34645 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34646 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34647 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34648 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34649 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34650 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34651
34652 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34653 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34654 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34655 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34656 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34657 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34658 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34659 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34660
34661 @smallexample
34662 -> @code{g}
34663 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34664 @end smallexample
34665
34666 @item E @var{NN}
34667 for an error.
34668 @end table
34669
34670 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34671 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34672 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34673 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34674
34675 Reply:
34676 @table @samp
34677 @item OK
34678 for success
34679 @item E @var{NN}
34680 for an error
34681 @end table
34682
34683 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34684 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34685 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34686 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34687 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34688 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34689 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34690 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34691 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34692
34693 Reply:
34694 @table @samp
34695 @item OK
34696 for success
34697 @item E @var{NN}
34698 for an error
34699 @end table
34700
34701 @c FIXME: JTC:
34702 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34703 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34704 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34705 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34706 @c described. For example:
34707 @c
34708 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34709 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34710 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34711 @c
34712 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34713 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34714 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34715
34716 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34717 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34718 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34719 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34720 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34721 step starting at that address.
34722
34723 @item I
34724 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34725 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34726 step packet}.
34727
34728 @item k
34729 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34730 Kill request.
34731
34732 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34733
34734 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34735 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34736
34737 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34738
34739 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34740 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34741 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34742
34743 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34744 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34745 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34746
34747 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34748 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34749 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34750 (@pxref{? packet}).
34751
34752 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34753 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34754 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34755 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34756
34757 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34758 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34759 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34760 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34761 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34762 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34763 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34764 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34765
34766 Reply:
34767 @table @samp
34768 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34769 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34770 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34771 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34772 @item E @var{NN}
34773 @var{NN} is errno
34774 @end table
34775
34776 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34777 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34778 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34779 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34780 hexadecimal number.
34781
34782 Reply:
34783 @table @samp
34784 @item OK
34785 for success
34786 @item E @var{NN}
34787 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34788 written).
34789 @end table
34790
34791 @item p @var{n}
34792 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34793 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34794 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34795 register value is encoded.
34796
34797 Reply:
34798 @table @samp
34799 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34800 the register's value
34801 @item E @var{NN}
34802 for an error
34803 @item @w{}
34804 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34805 @end table
34806
34807 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34808 @anchor{write register packet}
34809 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34810 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34811 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34812 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34813
34814 Reply:
34815 @table @samp
34816 @item OK
34817 for success
34818 @item E @var{NN}
34819 for an error
34820 @end table
34821
34822 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34823 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34824 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34825 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34826 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34827 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34828
34829 @item r
34830 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34831 Reset the entire system.
34832
34833 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34834
34835 @item R @var{XX}
34836 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34837 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34838 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34839
34840 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34841
34842 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34843 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34844 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34845 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34846
34847 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34848 packet}.
34849
34850 Reply:
34851 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34852
34853 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34854 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34855 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34856 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34857 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34858
34859 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34860 packet}.
34861
34862 Reply:
34863 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34864
34865 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34866 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34867 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34868 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34869 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34870
34871 @item T @var{thread-id}
34872 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34873 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34874
34875 Reply:
34876 @table @samp
34877 @item OK
34878 thread is still alive
34879 @item E @var{NN}
34880 thread is dead
34881 @end table
34882
34883 @item v
34884 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34885 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34886
34887 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34888 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34889 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34890 The process ID is a
34891 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34892 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34893 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34894
34895 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34896 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34897 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34898 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34899 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34900 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34901 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34902 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34903
34904 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34905
34906 Reply:
34907 @table @samp
34908 @item E @var{nn}
34909 for an error
34910 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34911 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34912 @item OK
34913 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34914 @end table
34915
34916 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34917 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34918 @anchor{vCont packet}
34919 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34920 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34921 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34922 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34923 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34924 Specifying multiple
34925 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34926 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34927
34928 Currently supported actions are:
34929
34930 @table @samp
34931 @item c
34932 Continue.
34933 @item C @var{sig}
34934 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34935 @item s
34936 Step.
34937 @item S @var{sig}
34938 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34939 @item t
34940 Stop.
34941 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34942 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34943 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34944 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34945 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34946 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34947
34948 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34949 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34950 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34951 jumps to @var{start}).
34952
34953 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34954 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34955 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34956
34957 @end table
34958
34959 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34960 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34961 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34962
34963 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34964 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34965 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34966 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34967 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34968 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34969 as an implementation detail.
34970
34971 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34972 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34973 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34974 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34975 @var{thread-id}.
34976
34977 Reply:
34978 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34979
34980 @item vCont?
34981 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34982 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34983
34984 Reply:
34985 @table @samp
34986 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34987 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34988 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34989 @item @w{}
34990 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34991 @end table
34992
34993 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34994 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34995 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34996 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34997
34998 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34999 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35000 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35001 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35002 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35003 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35004 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35005 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35006 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35007 packet is received.
35008
35009 Reply:
35010 @table @samp
35011 @item OK
35012 for success
35013 @item E @var{NN}
35014 for an error
35015 @end table
35016
35017 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35018 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35019 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35020 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35021 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35022 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35023 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35024 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35025 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35026 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35027 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35028 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35029
35030
35031 Reply:
35032 @table @samp
35033 @item OK
35034 for success
35035 @item E.memtype
35036 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35037 @item E @var{NN}
35038 for an error
35039 @end table
35040
35041 @item vFlashDone
35042 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35043 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35044 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35045 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35046 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35047 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35048 request is completed.
35049
35050 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35051 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35052 @anchor{vKill packet}
35053 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35054 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35055 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35056 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35057
35058 Reply:
35059 @table @samp
35060 @item E @var{nn}
35061 for an error
35062 @item OK
35063 for success
35064 @end table
35065
35066 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35067 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35068 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35069 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35070 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35071 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35072 state.
35073
35074 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35075
35076 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35077
35078 Reply:
35079 @table @samp
35080 @item E @var{nn}
35081 for an error
35082 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35083 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35084 @end table
35085
35086 @item vStopped
35087 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35088 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35089
35090 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35091 @anchor{X packet}
35092 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35093 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35094 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
35095 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35096
35097 Reply:
35098 @table @samp
35099 @item OK
35100 for success
35101 @item E @var{NN}
35102 for an error
35103 @end table
35104
35105 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35106 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35107 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35108 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35109 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35110 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35111 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35112
35113 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35114 separately.
35115
35116 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35117 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35118 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35119 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35120 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35121 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35122
35123 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35124 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35125 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35126 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35127 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35128 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35129
35130 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35131 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35132 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35133 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35134 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35135 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35136 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35137 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35138 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35139 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35140
35141 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35142 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35143
35144 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35145 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35146
35147 @table @samp
35148
35149 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35150 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35151 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35152
35153 @end table
35154
35155 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35156 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35157 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35158 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35159 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35160 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35161 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35162
35163 @table @samp
35164
35165 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35166 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35167 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35168
35169 @end table
35170
35171 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35172
35173 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35174 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35175 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35176 target, is not defined.}
35177
35178 Reply:
35179 @table @samp
35180 @item OK
35181 success
35182 @item @w{}
35183 not supported
35184 @item E @var{NN}
35185 for an error
35186 @end table
35187
35188 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35189 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35190 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35191 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35192 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35193 address @var{addr}.
35194
35195 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35196 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35197 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35198
35199 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35200 movement.}
35201
35202 Reply:
35203 @table @samp
35204 @item OK
35205 success
35206 @item @w{}
35207 not supported
35208 @item E @var{NN}
35209 for an error
35210 @end table
35211
35212 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35213 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35214 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35215 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35216 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35217 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35218
35219 Reply:
35220 @table @samp
35221 @item OK
35222 success
35223 @item @w{}
35224 not supported
35225 @item E @var{NN}
35226 for an error
35227 @end table
35228
35229 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35230 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35231 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35232 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35233 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35234 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35235
35236 Reply:
35237 @table @samp
35238 @item OK
35239 success
35240 @item @w{}
35241 not supported
35242 @item E @var{NN}
35243 for an error
35244 @end table
35245
35246 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35247 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35248 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35249 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35250 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35251 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35252
35253 Reply:
35254 @table @samp
35255 @item OK
35256 success
35257 @item @w{}
35258 not supported
35259 @item E @var{NN}
35260 for an error
35261 @end table
35262
35263 @end table
35264
35265 @node Stop Reply Packets
35266 @section Stop Reply Packets
35267 @cindex stop reply packets
35268
35269 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35270 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35271 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35272 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35273 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35274 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35275 @value{GDBN} source code.
35276
35277 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35278 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35279 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35280 components.
35281
35282 @table @samp
35283
35284 @item S @var{AA}
35285 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35286 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35287 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35288
35289 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35290 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35291 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35292 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35293 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35294 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35295 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35296 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35297
35298 @itemize @bullet
35299 @item
35300 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35301 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35302 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35303 two-digit hex number.
35304
35305 @item
35306 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35307 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35308
35309 @item
35310 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35311 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35312
35313 @item
35314 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35315 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35316 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35317 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35318
35319 @item
35320 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35321 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35322 future.
35323 @end itemize
35324
35325 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35326
35327 @table @samp
35328 @item watch
35329 @itemx rwatch
35330 @itemx awatch
35331 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35332 hex.
35333
35334 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35335 @item library
35336 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35337 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35338 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35339
35340 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35341 @item replaylog
35342 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35343 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35344 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35345 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35346 for more information.
35347
35348 @item swbreak
35349 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35350 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35351 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35352 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35353 part must be left empty.
35354
35355 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35356 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35357 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35358 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35359 address.
35360
35361 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35362 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35363 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35364 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35365 indicating support.
35366
35367 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35368
35369 @item hwbreak
35370 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35371 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35372
35373 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35374 apply.
35375 @end table
35376
35377 @item W @var{AA}
35378 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35379 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35380 applicable to certain targets.
35381
35382 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35383 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35384 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35385 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35386
35387 @item X @var{AA}
35388 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35389 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35390
35391 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35392 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35393 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35394 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35395
35396 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35397 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35398 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35399 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35400 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35401
35402 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35403 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35404 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35405 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35406 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35407 system calls.
35408
35409 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35410 this very system call.
35411
35412 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35413 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35414 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35415 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35416 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35417 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35418
35419 @end table
35420
35421 @node General Query Packets
35422 @section General Query Packets
35423 @cindex remote query requests
35424
35425 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35426 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35427 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35428 sending information to and from the stub.
35429
35430 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35431 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35432 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35433 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35434 conventions:
35435
35436 @itemize @bullet
35437 @item
35438 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35439 @item
35440 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35441 letter.
35442 @item
35443 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35444 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35445 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35446 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35447 @end itemize
35448
35449 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35450 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35451 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35452 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35453 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35454 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35455 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35456 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35457 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35458 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35459 packet.}.
35460
35461 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35462 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35463 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35464 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35465 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35466
35467 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35468
35469 @table @samp
35470
35471 @item QAgent:1
35472 @itemx QAgent:0
35473 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35474 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35475
35476 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35477 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35478 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35479 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35480 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35481 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35482 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35483 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35484 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35485 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35486 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35487
35488 @item qC
35489 @cindex current thread, remote request
35490 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35491 Return the current thread ID.
35492
35493 Reply:
35494 @table @samp
35495 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35496 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35497 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35498 @item @r{(anything else)}
35499 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35500 @end table
35501
35502 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35503 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35504 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35505 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35506 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35507 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35508 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35509 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35510
35511 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35512 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35513 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35514 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35515 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35516 detect trailing zeros.
35517
35518 Reply:
35519 @table @samp
35520 @item E @var{NN}
35521 An error (such as memory fault)
35522 @item C @var{crc32}
35523 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35524 @end table
35525
35526 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35527 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35528 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35529 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35530 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35531 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35532 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35533 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35534 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35535 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35536 randomization.
35537
35538 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35539
35540 Reply:
35541 @table @samp
35542 @item OK
35543 The request succeeded.
35544
35545 @item E @var{nn}
35546 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35547
35548 @item @w{}
35549 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35550 by the stub.
35551 @end table
35552
35553 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35554 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35555 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35556 address space randomization.
35557
35558 @item qfThreadInfo
35559 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35560 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35561 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35562 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35563 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35564 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35565 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35566 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35567 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35568 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35569
35570 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35571
35572 Reply:
35573 @table @samp
35574 @item m @var{thread-id}
35575 A single thread ID
35576 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35577 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35578 @item l
35579 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35580 @end table
35581
35582 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35583 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35584 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35585 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35586 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35587 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35588 fields.
35589
35590 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35591 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35592 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35593 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35594 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35595
35596 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35597 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35598 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35599 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35600 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35601
35602 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35603 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35604
35605 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35606 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35607 information associated with the variable.)
35608
35609 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35610 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35611 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35612 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35613 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35614 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35615
35616 Reply:
35617 @table @samp
35618 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35619 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35620 local storage requested.
35621
35622 @item E @var{nn}
35623 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35624
35625 @item @w{}
35626 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35627 @end table
35628
35629 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35630 @cindex get thread information block address
35631 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35632 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35633
35634 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35635
35636 Reply:
35637 @table @samp
35638 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35639 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35640 thread information block.
35641
35642 @item E @var{nn}
35643 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35644 address could not be retrieved.
35645
35646 @item @w{}
35647 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35648 @end table
35649
35650 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35651 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35652 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35653 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35654 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35655 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35656 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35657
35658 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35659
35660 Reply:
35661 @table @samp
35662 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35663 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35664 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35665 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35666 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35667 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35668 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35669 @end table
35670
35671 @item qOffsets
35672 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35673 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35674 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35675 image.
35676
35677 Reply:
35678 @table @samp
35679 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35680 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35681 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35682 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35683 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35684 segments by the supplied offsets.
35685
35686 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35687 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35688 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35689
35690 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35691 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35692 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35693 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35694 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35695 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35696 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35697 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35698 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35699 @end table
35700
35701 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35702 @cindex thread information, remote request
35703 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35704 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35705 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35706 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35707
35708 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35709 (see below).
35710
35711 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35712
35713 @item QNonStop:1
35714 @itemx QNonStop:0
35715 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35716 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35717 @anchor{QNonStop}
35718 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35719 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35720
35721 Reply:
35722 @table @samp
35723 @item OK
35724 The request succeeded.
35725
35726 @item E @var{nn}
35727 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35728
35729 @item @w{}
35730 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35731 the stub.
35732 @end table
35733
35734 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35735 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35736 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35737 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35738
35739 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35740 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35741 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35742 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35743 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35744 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35745 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35746 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35747 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35748 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35749 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35750 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35751 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35752
35753 Reply:
35754 @table @samp
35755 @item OK
35756 The request succeeded.
35757
35758 @item E @var{nn}
35759 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35760
35761 @item @w{}
35762 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35763 the stub.
35764 @end table
35765
35766 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35767 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35768 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35769 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35770
35771 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35772 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35773 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35774 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35775 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35776 Others should be silently discarded.
35777
35778 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35779 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35780 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35781 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35782 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35783 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35784 signals.
35785
35786 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35787 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35788
35789 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35790 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35791 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35792 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35793 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35794
35795 Reply:
35796 @table @samp
35797 @item OK
35798 The request succeeded.
35799
35800 @item E @var{nn}
35801 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35802
35803 @item @w{}
35804 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35805 by the stub.
35806 @end table
35807
35808 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35809 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35810 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35811 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35812
35813 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35814 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35815 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35816 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35817 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35818 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35819 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35820 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35821 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35822
35823 Reply:
35824 @table @samp
35825 @item OK
35826 A command response with no output.
35827 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35828 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35829 @item E @var{NN}
35830 Indicate a badly formed request.
35831 @item @w{}
35832 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35833 @end table
35834
35835 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35836 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35837 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35838 packets.)
35839
35840 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35841 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35842 @ifnotinfo
35843 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35844 @end ifnotinfo
35845 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35846 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35847 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35848 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35849 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35850
35851 Reply:
35852 @table @samp
35853 @item 0
35854 The pattern was not found.
35855 @item 1,address
35856 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35857 @item E @var{NN}
35858 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35859 @item @w{}
35860 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35861 @end table
35862
35863 @item QStartNoAckMode
35864 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35865 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35866 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35867 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35868
35869 Reply:
35870 @table @samp
35871 @item OK
35872 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35873 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35874 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35875 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35876 @item @w{}
35877 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35878 @end table
35879
35880 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35881 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35882 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35883 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35884 @anchor{qSupported}
35885 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35886 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35887 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35888 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35889 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35890 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35891 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35892 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35893 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35894 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35895 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35896 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35897 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35898 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35899
35900 Reply:
35901 @table @samp
35902 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35903 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35904 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35905 possible forms).
35906 @item @w{}
35907 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35908 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35909 @end table
35910
35911 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35912 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35913 are:
35914
35915 @table @samp
35916 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35917 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35918 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35919 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35920 @item @var{name}+
35921 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35922 need an associated value.
35923 @item @var{name}-
35924 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35925 @item @var{name}?
35926 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35927 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35928 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35929 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35930 @end table
35931
35932 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35933 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35934 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35935 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35936 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35937
35938 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35939 are defined:
35940
35941 @table @samp
35942 @item multiprocess
35943 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35944 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35945 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35946 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35947 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35948
35949 @item xmlRegisters
35950 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35951 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35952 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35953 description.
35954
35955 @item qRelocInsn
35956 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35957 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35958 instruction reply packet}).
35959
35960 @item swbreak
35961 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
35962 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
35963
35964 @item hwbreak
35965 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
35966 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
35967 @end table
35968
35969 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35970 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35971 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35972 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35973 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35974 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35975 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35976 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35977 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35978 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35979 all the features it supports.
35980
35981 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35982 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35983
35984 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35985 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35986 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35987 form response.
35988
35989 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35990 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35991 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35992 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35993
35994 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35995 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35996 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35997 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35998 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35999
36000 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36001
36002 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36003 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36004 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36005 @item Feature Name
36006 @tab Value Required
36007 @tab Default
36008 @tab Probe Allowed
36009
36010 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36011 @tab Yes
36012 @tab @samp{-}
36013 @tab No
36014
36015 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36016 @tab No
36017 @tab @samp{-}
36018 @tab Yes
36019
36020 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36021 @tab No
36022 @tab @samp{-}
36023 @tab Yes
36024
36025 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36026 @tab No
36027 @tab @samp{-}
36028 @tab Yes
36029
36030 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36031 @tab No
36032 @tab @samp{-}
36033 @tab Yes
36034
36035 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36036 @tab No
36037 @tab @samp{-}
36038 @tab Yes
36039
36040 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36041 @tab No
36042 @tab @samp{-}
36043 @tab Yes
36044
36045 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36046 @tab No
36047 @tab @samp{-}
36048 @tab Yes
36049
36050 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36051 @tab No
36052 @tab @samp{-}
36053 @tab No
36054
36055 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36056 @tab No
36057 @tab @samp{-}
36058 @tab Yes
36059
36060 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36061 @tab No
36062 @tab @samp{-}
36063 @tab Yes
36064
36065 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36066 @tab No
36067 @tab @samp{-}
36068 @tab Yes
36069
36070 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36071 @tab No
36072 @tab @samp{-}
36073 @tab Yes
36074
36075 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36076 @tab No
36077 @tab @samp{-}
36078 @tab Yes
36079
36080 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36081 @tab No
36082 @tab @samp{-}
36083 @tab Yes
36084
36085 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36086 @tab No
36087 @tab @samp{-}
36088 @tab Yes
36089
36090 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36091 @tab No
36092 @tab @samp{-}
36093 @tab Yes
36094
36095 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36096 @tab No
36097 @tab @samp{-}
36098 @tab Yes
36099
36100 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36101 @tab No
36102 @tab @samp{-}
36103 @tab Yes
36104
36105 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36106 @tab Yes
36107 @tab @samp{-}
36108 @tab Yes
36109
36110 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36111 @tab Yes
36112 @tab @samp{-}
36113 @tab Yes
36114
36115 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36116 @tab Yes
36117 @tab @samp{-}
36118 @tab Yes
36119
36120 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36121 @tab No
36122 @tab @samp{-}
36123 @tab Yes
36124
36125 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36126 @tab No
36127 @tab @samp{-}
36128 @tab Yes
36129
36130 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36131 @tab No
36132 @tab @samp{-}
36133 @tab Yes
36134
36135 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36136 @tab No
36137 @tab @samp{-}
36138 @tab No
36139
36140 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36141 @tab No
36142 @tab @samp{-}
36143 @tab No
36144
36145 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36146 @tab No
36147 @tab @samp{-}
36148 @tab No
36149
36150 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36151 @tab No
36152 @tab @samp{-}
36153 @tab No
36154
36155 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36156 @tab No
36157 @tab @samp{-}
36158 @tab No
36159
36160 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36161 @tab No
36162 @tab @samp{-}
36163 @tab No
36164
36165 @item @samp{QAgent}
36166 @tab No
36167 @tab @samp{-}
36168 @tab No
36169
36170 @item @samp{QAllow}
36171 @tab No
36172 @tab @samp{-}
36173 @tab No
36174
36175 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36176 @tab No
36177 @tab @samp{-}
36178 @tab No
36179
36180 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36181 @tab No
36182 @tab @samp{-}
36183 @tab No
36184
36185 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36186 @tab No
36187 @tab @samp{-}
36188 @tab No
36189
36190 @item @samp{tracenz}
36191 @tab No
36192 @tab @samp{-}
36193 @tab No
36194
36195 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36196 @tab No
36197 @tab @samp{-}
36198 @tab No
36199
36200 @item @samp{swbreak}
36201 @tab No
36202 @tab @samp{-}
36203 @tab No
36204
36205 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36206 @tab No
36207 @tab @samp{-}
36208 @tab No
36209
36210 @end multitable
36211
36212 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36213
36214 @table @samp
36215 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36216 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36217 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36218 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36219 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36220 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36221 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36222 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36223 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36224 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36225
36226 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36227 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36228 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36229
36230 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36231 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36232 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36233
36234 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36235 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36236 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36237
36238 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36239 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36240 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36241
36242 @item qXfer:features:read
36243 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36244 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36245
36246 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36247 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36248 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36249
36250 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36251 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36252 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36253
36254 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36255 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36256 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36257 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36258
36259 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36260 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36261 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36262
36263 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36264 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36265 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36266
36267 @item qXfer:spu:read
36268 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36269 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36270
36271 @item qXfer:spu:write
36272 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36273 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36274
36275 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36276 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36277 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36278
36279 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36280 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36281 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36282
36283 @item qXfer:threads:read
36284 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36285 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36286
36287 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36288 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36289 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36290
36291 @item qXfer:uib:read
36292 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36293 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36294
36295 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36296 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36297 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36298
36299 @item QNonStop
36300 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36301 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36302
36303 @item QPassSignals
36304 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36305 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36306
36307 @item QStartNoAckMode
36308 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36309 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36310
36311 @item multiprocess
36312 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36313 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36314 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36315 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36316 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36317 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36318 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36319 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36320 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36321 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36322 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36323
36324 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36325 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36326 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36327
36328 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36329 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36330 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36331 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36332
36333 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36334 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36335 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36336
36337 @item ReverseContinue
36338 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36339 (@pxref{bc}).
36340
36341 @item ReverseStep
36342 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36343 (@pxref{bs}).
36344
36345 @item TracepointSource
36346 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36347 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36348
36349 @item QAgent
36350 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36351
36352 @item QAllow
36353 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36354
36355 @item QDisableRandomization
36356 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36357
36358 @item StaticTracepoint
36359 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36360 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36361
36362 @item InstallInTrace
36363 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36364 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36365
36366 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36367 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36368 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36369 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36370
36371 @item QTBuffer:size
36372 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36373 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36374
36375 @item tracenz
36376 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36377 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36378 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36379
36380 @item BreakpointCommands
36381 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36382 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36383 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36384
36385 @item Qbtrace:off
36386 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36387
36388 @item Qbtrace:bts
36389 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36390
36391 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36392 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36393
36394 @item swbreak
36395 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36396 breakpoints.
36397
36398 @item hwbreak
36399 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36400 breakpoints.
36401
36402 @end table
36403
36404 @item qSymbol::
36405 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36406 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36407 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36408 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36409
36410 Reply:
36411 @table @samp
36412 @item OK
36413 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36414 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36415 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36416 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36417 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36418 below.
36419 @end table
36420
36421 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36422 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36423
36424 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36425 target has previously requested.
36426
36427 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36428 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36429 will be empty.
36430
36431 Reply:
36432 @table @samp
36433 @item OK
36434 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36435 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36436 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36437 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36438 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36439 @end table
36440
36441 @item qTBuffer
36442 @itemx QTBuffer
36443 @itemx QTDisconnected
36444 @itemx QTDP
36445 @itemx QTDPsrc
36446 @itemx QTDV
36447 @itemx qTfP
36448 @itemx qTfV
36449 @itemx QTFrame
36450 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36451
36452 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36453
36454 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36455 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36456 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36457 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36458 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36459 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36460 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36461 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36462 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36463 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36464 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36465
36466 Reply:
36467 @table @samp
36468 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36469 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36470 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36471 the thread's attributes.
36472 @end table
36473
36474 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36475 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36476 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36477 packets.)
36478
36479 @item QTNotes
36480 @itemx qTP
36481 @itemx QTSave
36482 @itemx qTsP
36483 @itemx qTsV
36484 @itemx QTStart
36485 @itemx QTStop
36486 @itemx QTEnable
36487 @itemx QTDisable
36488 @itemx QTinit
36489 @itemx QTro
36490 @itemx qTStatus
36491 @itemx qTV
36492 @itemx qTfSTM
36493 @itemx qTsSTM
36494 @itemx qTSTMat
36495 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36496
36497 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36498 @cindex read special object, remote request
36499 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36500 @anchor{qXfer read}
36501 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36502 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36503 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36504 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36505 additional details about what data to access.
36506
36507 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36508 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36509 formats, listed below.
36510
36511 @table @samp
36512 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36513 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36514 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36515 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36516
36517 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36518 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36519
36520 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36521 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36522
36523 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36524 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36525 packet may have one of the following values:
36526
36527 @table @code
36528 @item all
36529 Returns all available branch trace.
36530
36531 @item new
36532 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36533 the last read request.
36534
36535 @item delta
36536 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36537 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36538 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36539 used to stitch traces together.
36540
36541 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36542 @end table
36543
36544 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36545 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36546
36547 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36548 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36549
36550 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36551 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36552
36553 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36554 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36555
36556 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36557 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
36558 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
36559 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
36560 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
36561 number.
36562
36563 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36564 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36565
36566 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36567 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36568 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36569 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36570 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36571
36572 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36573 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36574
36575 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36576 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36577 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36578 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36579 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36580
36581 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36582 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36583 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36584
36585 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36586 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36587
36588 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36589 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36590 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36591 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36592 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36593 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36594 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36595 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36596
36597 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36598 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36599
36600 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36601 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36602
36603 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36604 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36605 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36606 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36607
36608 @table @code
36609 @item start=@var{address}
36610 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36611 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36612 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36613 chosen as the starting point.
36614
36615 @item prev=@var{address}
36616 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36617 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36618 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36619 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36620 exists prior to the starting point.
36621
36622 @end table
36623
36624 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36625 ignored.
36626
36627 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36628 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36629 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36630 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36631 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36632
36633 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36634 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36635
36636 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36637 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36638
36639 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36640 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36641 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
36642 Action Lists}.
36643
36644 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36645 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36646 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36647
36648 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36649 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
36650 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36651 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36652 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36653
36654 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36655 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36656 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36657
36658 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36659 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36660 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36661 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36662 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36663 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36664 in that context to be accessed.
36665
36666 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36667 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36668 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36669
36670 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36671 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
36672 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
36673 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36674 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36675
36676 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36677 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36678
36679 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36680 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
36681
36682 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
36683 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
36684 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36685
36686 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36687 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36688
36689 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36690 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
36691
36692 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
36693 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
36694
36695 This packet is not probed by default.
36696
36697 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36698 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
36699 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
36700 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
36701 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
36702
36703 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36704 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36705
36706 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36707 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
36708 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
36709 @xref{Operating System Information}.
36710
36711 @end table
36712
36713 Reply:
36714 @table @samp
36715 @item m @var{data}
36716 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
36717 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
36718 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
36719 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
36720 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
36721 request.
36722
36723 @item l @var{data}
36724 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36725 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36726 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36727
36728 @item l
36729 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36730 There is no more data to be read.
36731
36732 @item E00
36733 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36734
36735 @item E @var{nn}
36736 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36737 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36738
36739 @item @w{}
36740 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36741 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36742 @end table
36743
36744 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36745 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36746 @anchor{qXfer write}
36747 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36748 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36749 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36750 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36751 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36752 to access.
36753
36754 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36755 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36756 formats, listed below.
36757
36758 @table @samp
36759 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36760 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36761 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36762 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36763 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36764
36765 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36766 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36767 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36768
36769 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36770 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36771 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36772 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36773 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36774 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36775 in that context to be accessed.
36776
36777 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36778 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36779 @end table
36780
36781 Reply:
36782 @table @samp
36783 @item @var{nn}
36784 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36785 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36786
36787 @item E00
36788 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36789
36790 @item E @var{nn}
36791 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36792 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36793
36794 @item @w{}
36795 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36796 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36797 @end table
36798
36799 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36800 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36801 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36802 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36803 must respond with an empty packet.
36804
36805 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36806 @cindex query attached, remote request
36807 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36808 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36809 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36810 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36811 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36812 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36813 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36814
36815 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36816 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36817 the @code{quit} command.
36818
36819 Reply:
36820 @table @samp
36821 @item 1
36822 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36823 @item 0
36824 The remote server created a new process.
36825 @item E @var{NN}
36826 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36827 @end table
36828
36829 @item Qbtrace:bts
36830 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36831
36832 Reply:
36833 @table @samp
36834 @item OK
36835 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36836 @item E.errtext
36837 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36838 @end table
36839
36840 @item Qbtrace:off
36841 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36842
36843 Reply:
36844 @table @samp
36845 @item OK
36846 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36847 @item E.errtext
36848 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36849 @end table
36850
36851 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
36852 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
36853 btrace recording method in bts format.
36854
36855 Reply:
36856 @table @samp
36857 @item OK
36858 The ring buffer size has been set.
36859 @item E.errtext
36860 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36861 @end table
36862
36863 @end table
36864
36865 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36866 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36867
36868 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36869 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36870 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36871
36872 @menu
36873 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36874 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36875 @end menu
36876
36877 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36878 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36879
36880 @menu
36881 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36882 @end menu
36883
36884 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36885 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36886 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36887
36888 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36889
36890 @table @r
36891
36892 @item 2
36893 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36894
36895 @item 3
36896 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36897
36898 @item 4
36899 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36900
36901 @end table
36902
36903 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36904 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36905
36906 @menu
36907 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36908 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36909 @end menu
36910
36911 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36912 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36913 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36914
36915 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36916 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36917 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36918 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36919 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36920 most-significant -- least-significant.
36921
36922 @table @r
36923
36924 @item MIPS32
36925 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36926 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36927 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36928
36929 @item MIPS64
36930 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36931 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36932 as @code{MIPS32}.
36933
36934 @end table
36935
36936 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36937 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36938 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36939
36940 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36941
36942 @table @r
36943
36944 @item 2
36945 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36946
36947 @item 3
36948 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36949
36950 @item 4
36951 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36952
36953 @item 5
36954 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36955
36956 @end table
36957
36958 @node Tracepoint Packets
36959 @section Tracepoint Packets
36960 @cindex tracepoint packets
36961 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36962
36963 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36964 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36965
36966 @table @samp
36967
36968 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36969 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36970 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36971 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36972 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36973 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36974 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36975 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36976 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36977 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36978 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36979 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36980 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36981 actions.
36982
36983 Replies:
36984 @table @samp
36985 @item OK
36986 The packet was understood and carried out.
36987 @item qRelocInsn
36988 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36989 @item @w{}
36990 The packet was not recognized.
36991 @end table
36992
36993 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36994 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36995 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36996 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36997 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36998 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36999 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37000
37001 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37002 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37003 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37004 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37005 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37006 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37007 tracepoint actions.
37008
37009 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37010 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37011 following forms:
37012
37013 @table @samp
37014
37015 @item R @var{mask}
37016 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37017 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37018 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37019 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37020 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37021
37022 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37023 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37024 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37025 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37026 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37027 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37028 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37029
37030 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37031 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37032 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37033 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37034 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37035 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37036 packet).
37037
37038 @end table
37039
37040 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37041 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37042 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37043 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37044 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37045 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37046 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37047 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37048
37049 Replies:
37050 @table @samp
37051 @item OK
37052 The packet was understood and carried out.
37053 @item qRelocInsn
37054 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37055 @item @w{}
37056 The packet was not recognized.
37057 @end table
37058
37059 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37060 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37061 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37062 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37063 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37064 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37065 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37066 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37067
37068 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37069 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37070 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37071 fit in a single packet.
37072 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37073 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37074
37075 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37076 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37077 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37078 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37079
37080 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37081 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37082 query packets.
37083
37084 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37085 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37086 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37087 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37088 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37089 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37090 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37091 be found.
37092
37093 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37094 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37095 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37096 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37097 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37098 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37099 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37100 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37101 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37102 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37103 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37104 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37105 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37106 variable.
37107
37108 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37109 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37110 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37111 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37112 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37113
37114 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37115 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37116 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37117 one of the following forms:
37118
37119 @table @samp
37120 @item F @var{f}
37121 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37122 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37123 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37124
37125 @item T @var{t}
37126 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37127 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37128
37129 @end table
37130
37131 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37132 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37133 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37134 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37135
37136 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37137 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37138 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37139 is a hexadecimal number.
37140
37141 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37142 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37143 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37144 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37145 numbers.
37146
37147 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37148 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37149 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37150
37151 @item qTMinFTPILen
37152 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37153 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37154 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37155 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37156 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37157 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37158 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37159 arrange for that.
37160
37161 Replies:
37162
37163 @table @samp
37164 @item 0
37165 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37166 @item @var{length}
37167 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37168 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37169 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37170 regardless of size.
37171 @item E
37172 An error has occurred.
37173 @item @w{}
37174 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37175 @end table
37176
37177 @item QTStart
37178 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37179 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37180 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37181 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37182 instruction reply packet}).
37183
37184 @item QTStop
37185 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37186 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37187
37188 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37189 @anchor{QTEnable}
37190 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37191 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37192 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37193 of data from it will resume.
37194
37195 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37196 @anchor{QTDisable}
37197 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37198 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37199 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37200 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37201
37202 @item QTinit
37203 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37204 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37205
37206 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37207 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37208 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37209 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37210 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37211
37212 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37213 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37214 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37215 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37216
37217 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37218 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37219 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37220 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37221 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37222 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37223
37224 @item qTStatus
37225 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37226 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37227
37228 The reply has the form:
37229
37230 @table @samp
37231
37232 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37233 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37234 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37235 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37236
37237 @end table
37238
37239 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37240 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37241
37242 @table @samp
37243
37244 @item tnotrun:0
37245 No trace has been run yet.
37246
37247 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37248 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37249 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37250 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37251 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37252
37253 @item tfull:0
37254 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37255
37256 @item tdisconnected:0
37257 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37258
37259 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37260 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37261
37262 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37263 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37264 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37265 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37266 is hex encoded.
37267
37268 @item tunknown:0
37269 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37270
37271 @end table
37272
37273 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37274 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37275 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37276 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37277 trace.
37278
37279 @table @samp
37280
37281 @item tframes:@var{n}
37282 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37283
37284 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37285 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37286 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37287
37288 @item tsize:@var{n}
37289 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37290
37291 @item tfree:@var{n}
37292 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37293
37294 @item circular:@var{n}
37295 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37296 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37297 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37298 and may fill up.
37299
37300 @item disconn:@var{n}
37301 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37302 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37303 that the trace run will stop.
37304
37305 @end table
37306
37307 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37308 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37309 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37310 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37311 address @var{addr}.
37312
37313 Replies:
37314 @table @samp
37315 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37316 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37317 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37318 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37319 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37320
37321 @end table
37322
37323 @item qTV:@var{var}
37324 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37325 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37326 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37327
37328 Replies:
37329 @table @samp
37330 @item V@var{value}
37331 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37332 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37333 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37334 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37335 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37336 program is running.
37337
37338 @item U
37339 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37340 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37341 was not collected.
37342 @end table
37343
37344 @item qTfP
37345 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37346 @itemx qTsP
37347 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37348 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37349 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37350 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37351 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37352 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37353
37354 @item qTfV
37355 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37356 @itemx qTsV
37357 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37358 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37359 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37360 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37361 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37362 trace state variables.
37363
37364 @item qTfSTM
37365 @itemx qTsSTM
37366 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37367 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37368 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37369 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37370 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37371 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37372 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37373 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37374
37375 Reply:
37376 @table @samp
37377 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37378 A single marker
37379 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37380 a comma-separated list of markers
37381 @item l
37382 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37383 @item E @var{nn}
37384 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37385 @item @w{}
37386 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37387 stub.
37388 @end table
37389
37390 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37391 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37392
37393 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37394 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37395 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37396 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37397 @dfn{last}).
37398
37399 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37400 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37401 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37402 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37403 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37404 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37405 tracepoint markers.
37406
37407 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37408 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37409 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37410 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37411 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37412 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37413
37414 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37415 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37416 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37417 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37418 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37419 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37420 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37421 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37422 available.
37423
37424 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37425 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37426 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37427
37428 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37429 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37430 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37431 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37432 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37433 use whatever size it prefers.
37434
37435 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37436 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37437 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37438 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37439 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37440
37441 @end table
37442
37443 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37444 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37445 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37446 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37447 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37448 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37449 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37450 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37451 it had executed in the original location.
37452
37453 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37454 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37455 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37456 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37457 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37458 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37459 format of the request is:
37460
37461 @table @samp
37462 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37463
37464 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37465 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37466 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37467 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37468 memory starting at @var{to}.
37469 @end table
37470
37471 Replies:
37472 @table @samp
37473 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37474 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37475 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37476 @item E @var{NN}
37477 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37478 relocating the instruction.
37479 @end table
37480
37481 @node Host I/O Packets
37482 @section Host I/O Packets
37483 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37484 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37485
37486 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37487 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37488 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37489 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37490 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37491 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37492 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37493 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37494 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37495 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37496
37497 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37498 its arguments. They have this format:
37499
37500 @table @samp
37501
37502 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37503 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37504 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37505 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37506 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37507 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37508 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37509 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37510 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37511
37512 @end table
37513
37514 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37515
37516 @table @samp
37517
37518 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37519 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37520 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37521 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37522 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37523 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37524 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37525 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37526 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37527 @var{attachment}.
37528
37529 @item @w{}
37530 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37531
37532 @end table
37533
37534 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37535
37536 @table @samp
37537 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37538 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37539 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37540 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37541 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37542 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37543 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37544
37545 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37546 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37547 -1 if an error occurs.
37548
37549 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37550 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37551 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37552 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37553 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37554 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37555 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37556 @var{count} was zero.
37557
37558 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37559 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37560 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37561 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37562 some characters were escaped.
37563
37564 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37565 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37566 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37567 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37568 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37569 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37570 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37571 error occurred.
37572
37573 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
37574 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
37575 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
37576 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
37577 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
37578 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
37579
37580 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37581 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37582 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37583
37584 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37585 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37586 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37587
37588 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37589 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37590 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37591 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37592 some characters were escaped.
37593
37594 @end table
37595
37596 @node Interrupts
37597 @section Interrupts
37598 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37599
37600 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
37601 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
37602 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
37603 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37604
37605 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
37606 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
37607 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
37608 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
37609 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
37610
37611 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
37612 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
37613 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
37614 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
37615 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
37616 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
37617 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
37618 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
37619
37620 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
37621 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
37622 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
37623
37624 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
37625 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
37626 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
37627 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
37628 currently-executing threads and processes.
37629 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
37630 running program, it should send one of the stop
37631 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
37632 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
37633 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
37634 Interrupts received while the
37635 program is stopped are discarded.
37636
37637 @node Notification Packets
37638 @section Notification Packets
37639 @cindex notification packets
37640 @cindex packets, notification
37641
37642 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
37643 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
37644 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
37645 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
37646 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
37647 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
37648 is not a problem.
37649
37650 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
37651 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
37652 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
37653 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
37654 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
37655 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
37656 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
37657
37658 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
37659 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
37660
37661 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
37662 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
37663 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
37664 not they understand it.
37665
37666 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
37667 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
37668 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
37669 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
37670 recipients.
37671
37672 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
37673 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
37674 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
37675 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
37676 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
37677
37678 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
37679 @table @samp
37680 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
37681 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
37682 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
37683 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
37684 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
37685 @item @var{ack}
37686 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
37687 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
37688 @end table
37689
37690 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
37691 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
37692
37693 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
37694 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
37695 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
37696 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
37697 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
37698 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
37699 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
37700 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
37701 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
37702 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
37703
37704 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
37705 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
37706 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
37707 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
37708 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
37709 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
37710
37711 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
37712 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
37713 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
37714 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
37715 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
37716
37717 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
37718 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
37719 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
37720 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
37721 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
37722 normally.
37723
37724 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
37725 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
37726 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
37727 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
37728 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
37729 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
37730 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
37731 the process shall be repeated.
37732
37733 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
37734 following example:
37735 @smallexample
37736 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
37737 @code{...}
37738 -> @code{vStopped}
37739 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
37740 -> @code{vStopped}
37741 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
37742 -> @code{vStopped}
37743 <- @code{OK}
37744 @end smallexample
37745
37746 The following notifications are defined:
37747 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37748
37749 @item Notification
37750 @tab Ack
37751 @tab Event
37752 @tab Description
37753
37754 @item Stop
37755 @tab vStopped
37756 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37757 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37758 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37759 @value{GDBN}.
37760 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37761
37762 @end multitable
37763
37764 @node Remote Non-Stop
37765 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37766
37767 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37768 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37769 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37770 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37771
37772 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37773 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37774 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37775 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37776 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37777 probe the target state after a mode change.
37778
37779 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37780 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37781 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37782 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37783 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37784 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37785 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37786 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37787 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37788 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37789 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37790
37791 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37792 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37793 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37794 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37795 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37796 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37797 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37798 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37799 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37800 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37801 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37802 @samp{OK}.
37803
37804 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
37805 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
37806 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
37807 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
37808 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
37809 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
37810 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
37811 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
37812 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
37813 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
37814 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
37815 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
37816 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
37817
37818 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37819 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37820
37821 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37822 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37823 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37824 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37825 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37826 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37827 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37828
37829 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37830 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37831 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37832 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37833 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37834
37835 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37836 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37837 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37838 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37839
37840 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37841 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37842 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37843 @pxref{qSupported}.
37844 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37845 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37846 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37847 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37848 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37849 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37850 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37851
37852 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37853 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37854 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37855 connection.
37856 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37857 new connection is established,
37858 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37859 for the current connection, once disabled.
37860
37861 @node Examples
37862 @section Examples
37863
37864 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37865 does not get any direct output:
37866
37867 @smallexample
37868 -> @code{R00}
37869 <- @code{+}
37870 @emph{target restarts}
37871 -> @code{?}
37872 <- @code{+}
37873 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37874 -> @code{+}
37875 @end smallexample
37876
37877 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37878
37879 @smallexample
37880 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37881 <- @code{+}
37882 -> @code{s}
37883 <- @code{+}
37884 @emph{time passes}
37885 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37886 -> @code{+}
37887 -> @code{g}
37888 <- @code{+}
37889 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37890 -> @code{+}
37891 @end smallexample
37892
37893 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37894 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37895 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37896
37897 @menu
37898 * File-I/O Overview::
37899 * Protocol Basics::
37900 * The F Request Packet::
37901 * The F Reply Packet::
37902 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37903 * Console I/O::
37904 * List of Supported Calls::
37905 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37906 * Constants::
37907 * File-I/O Examples::
37908 @end menu
37909
37910 @node File-I/O Overview
37911 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37912 @cindex file-i/o overview
37913
37914 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37915 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37916 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37917 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37918 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37919 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37920
37921 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37922 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37923 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37924 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37925 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37926
37927 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37928 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37929 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37930 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37931 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37932 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37933 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37934
37935 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37936 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37937 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37938 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37939 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37940
37941 @smallexample
37942 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37943 <- target requests 'system call X'
37944 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37945 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37946 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37947 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37948 @end smallexample
37949
37950 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37951 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37952 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37953 system are not supported by this protocol.
37954
37955 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37956
37957 @node Protocol Basics
37958 @subsection Protocol Basics
37959 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37960
37961 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37962 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37963 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37964 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37965 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37966 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37967 to call the appropriate host system call:
37968
37969 @itemize @bullet
37970 @item
37971 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37972
37973 @item
37974 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37975 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37976 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37977 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37978
37979 @end itemize
37980
37981 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37982
37983 @itemize @bullet
37984 @item
37985 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37986 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37987 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37988 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37989 packet.
37990
37991 @item
37992 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37993 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37994
37995 @item
37996 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37997
37998 @item
37999 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38000
38001 @item
38002 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38003 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38004 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38005 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38006 packet.
38007
38008 @end itemize
38009
38010 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38011 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38012
38013 @itemize @bullet
38014 @item
38015 Return value.
38016
38017 @item
38018 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38019
38020 @item
38021 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38022
38023 @end itemize
38024
38025 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38026 the latest continue or step action.
38027
38028 @node The F Request Packet
38029 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38030 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38031 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38032
38033 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38034
38035 @table @samp
38036 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38037
38038 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38039 This is just the name of the function.
38040
38041 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38042 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38043 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38044 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38045 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38046 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38047 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38048
38049 @end table
38050
38051
38052
38053 @node The F Reply Packet
38054 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38055 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38056 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38057
38058 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38059
38060 @table @samp
38061
38062 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38063
38064 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38065
38066 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38067 representation.
38068 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38069
38070 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38071 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38072 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38073
38074 @smallexample
38075 F0,0,C
38076 @end smallexample
38077
38078 @noindent
38079 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38080
38081 @smallexample
38082 F-1,4,C
38083 @end smallexample
38084
38085 @noindent
38086 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38087
38088 @end table
38089
38090
38091 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38092 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38093 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38094
38095 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38096 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38097 the target should behave as if it had
38098 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38099 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38100 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38101 packet.
38102
38103 It's important for the target to know in which
38104 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38105
38106 @itemize @bullet
38107 @item
38108 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38109
38110 @item
38111 The system call on the host has been finished.
38112
38113 @end itemize
38114
38115 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38116 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38117 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38118 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38119 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38120 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38121
38122 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38123 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38124 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38125 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38126 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38127 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38128 or the full action has been completed.
38129
38130 @node Console I/O
38131 @subsection Console I/O
38132 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38133
38134 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38135 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38136 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38137 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38138 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38139 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38140 conditions is met:
38141
38142 @itemize @bullet
38143 @item
38144 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38145 @code{read}
38146 system call is treated as finished.
38147
38148 @item
38149 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38150 newline.
38151
38152 @item
38153 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38154 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38155
38156 @end itemize
38157
38158 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38159 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38160 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38161 is stopped at the user's request.
38162
38163
38164 @node List of Supported Calls
38165 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38166 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38167
38168 @menu
38169 * open::
38170 * close::
38171 * read::
38172 * write::
38173 * lseek::
38174 * rename::
38175 * unlink::
38176 * stat/fstat::
38177 * gettimeofday::
38178 * isatty::
38179 * system::
38180 @end menu
38181
38182 @node open
38183 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38184 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38185
38186 @table @asis
38187 @item Synopsis:
38188 @smallexample
38189 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38190 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38191 @end smallexample
38192
38193 @item Request:
38194 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38195
38196 @noindent
38197 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38198
38199 @table @code
38200 @item O_CREAT
38201 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38202 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38203 are concerned.
38204
38205 @item O_EXCL
38206 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38207 an error and open() fails.
38208
38209 @item O_TRUNC
38210 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38211 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38212 truncated to zero length.
38213
38214 @item O_APPEND
38215 The file is opened in append mode.
38216
38217 @item O_RDONLY
38218 The file is opened for reading only.
38219
38220 @item O_WRONLY
38221 The file is opened for writing only.
38222
38223 @item O_RDWR
38224 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38225 @end table
38226
38227 @noindent
38228 Other bits are silently ignored.
38229
38230
38231 @noindent
38232 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38233
38234 @table @code
38235 @item S_IRUSR
38236 User has read permission.
38237
38238 @item S_IWUSR
38239 User has write permission.
38240
38241 @item S_IRGRP
38242 Group has read permission.
38243
38244 @item S_IWGRP
38245 Group has write permission.
38246
38247 @item S_IROTH
38248 Others have read permission.
38249
38250 @item S_IWOTH
38251 Others have write permission.
38252 @end table
38253
38254 @noindent
38255 Other bits are silently ignored.
38256
38257
38258 @item Return value:
38259 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38260 occurred.
38261
38262 @item Errors:
38263
38264 @table @code
38265 @item EEXIST
38266 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38267
38268 @item EISDIR
38269 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38270
38271 @item EACCES
38272 The requested access is not allowed.
38273
38274 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38275 @var{pathname} was too long.
38276
38277 @item ENOENT
38278 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38279
38280 @item ENODEV
38281 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38282
38283 @item EROFS
38284 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38285 write access was requested.
38286
38287 @item EFAULT
38288 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38289
38290 @item ENOSPC
38291 No space on device to create the file.
38292
38293 @item EMFILE
38294 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38295
38296 @item ENFILE
38297 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38298 has been reached.
38299
38300 @item EINTR
38301 The call was interrupted by the user.
38302 @end table
38303
38304 @end table
38305
38306 @node close
38307 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38308 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38309
38310 @table @asis
38311 @item Synopsis:
38312 @smallexample
38313 int close(int fd);
38314 @end smallexample
38315
38316 @item Request:
38317 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38318
38319 @item Return value:
38320 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38321
38322 @item Errors:
38323
38324 @table @code
38325 @item EBADF
38326 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38327
38328 @item EINTR
38329 The call was interrupted by the user.
38330 @end table
38331
38332 @end table
38333
38334 @node read
38335 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38336 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38337
38338 @table @asis
38339 @item Synopsis:
38340 @smallexample
38341 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38342 @end smallexample
38343
38344 @item Request:
38345 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38346
38347 @item Return value:
38348 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38349 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38350 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38351
38352 @item Errors:
38353
38354 @table @code
38355 @item EBADF
38356 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38357 reading.
38358
38359 @item EFAULT
38360 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38361
38362 @item EINTR
38363 The call was interrupted by the user.
38364 @end table
38365
38366 @end table
38367
38368 @node write
38369 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38370 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38371
38372 @table @asis
38373 @item Synopsis:
38374 @smallexample
38375 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38376 @end smallexample
38377
38378 @item Request:
38379 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38380
38381 @item Return value:
38382 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38383 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38384 is returned.
38385
38386 @item Errors:
38387
38388 @table @code
38389 @item EBADF
38390 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38391 writing.
38392
38393 @item EFAULT
38394 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38395
38396 @item EFBIG
38397 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38398 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38399
38400 @item ENOSPC
38401 No space on device to write the data.
38402
38403 @item EINTR
38404 The call was interrupted by the user.
38405 @end table
38406
38407 @end table
38408
38409 @node lseek
38410 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38411 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38412
38413 @table @asis
38414 @item Synopsis:
38415 @smallexample
38416 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38417 @end smallexample
38418
38419 @item Request:
38420 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38421
38422 @var{flag} is one of:
38423
38424 @table @code
38425 @item SEEK_SET
38426 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38427
38428 @item SEEK_CUR
38429 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38430 bytes.
38431
38432 @item SEEK_END
38433 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38434 bytes.
38435 @end table
38436
38437 @item Return value:
38438 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38439 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38440 value of -1 is returned.
38441
38442 @item Errors:
38443
38444 @table @code
38445 @item EBADF
38446 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38447
38448 @item ESPIPE
38449 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38450
38451 @item EINVAL
38452 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38453
38454 @item EINTR
38455 The call was interrupted by the user.
38456 @end table
38457
38458 @end table
38459
38460 @node rename
38461 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38462 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38463
38464 @table @asis
38465 @item Synopsis:
38466 @smallexample
38467 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38468 @end smallexample
38469
38470 @item Request:
38471 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38472
38473 @item Return value:
38474 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38475
38476 @item Errors:
38477
38478 @table @code
38479 @item EISDIR
38480 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38481 directory.
38482
38483 @item EEXIST
38484 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38485
38486 @item EBUSY
38487 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38488 process.
38489
38490 @item EINVAL
38491 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38492 of itself.
38493
38494 @item ENOTDIR
38495 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38496 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38497 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38498
38499 @item EFAULT
38500 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38501
38502 @item EACCES
38503 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38504
38505 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38506
38507 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38508
38509 @item ENOENT
38510 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38511
38512 @item EROFS
38513 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38514
38515 @item ENOSPC
38516 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38517 directory entry.
38518
38519 @item EINTR
38520 The call was interrupted by the user.
38521 @end table
38522
38523 @end table
38524
38525 @node unlink
38526 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38527 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38528
38529 @table @asis
38530 @item Synopsis:
38531 @smallexample
38532 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38533 @end smallexample
38534
38535 @item Request:
38536 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38537
38538 @item Return value:
38539 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38540
38541 @item Errors:
38542
38543 @table @code
38544 @item EACCES
38545 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38546
38547 @item EPERM
38548 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38549
38550 @item EBUSY
38551 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38552 being used by another process.
38553
38554 @item EFAULT
38555 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38556
38557 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38558 @var{pathname} was too long.
38559
38560 @item ENOENT
38561 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38562
38563 @item ENOTDIR
38564 A component of the path is not a directory.
38565
38566 @item EROFS
38567 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38568
38569 @item EINTR
38570 The call was interrupted by the user.
38571 @end table
38572
38573 @end table
38574
38575 @node stat/fstat
38576 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38577 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38578 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38579
38580 @table @asis
38581 @item Synopsis:
38582 @smallexample
38583 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38584 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38585 @end smallexample
38586
38587 @item Request:
38588 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38589 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38590
38591 @item Return value:
38592 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38593
38594 @item Errors:
38595
38596 @table @code
38597 @item EBADF
38598 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38599
38600 @item ENOENT
38601 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38602 path is an empty string.
38603
38604 @item ENOTDIR
38605 A component of the path is not a directory.
38606
38607 @item EFAULT
38608 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38609
38610 @item EACCES
38611 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38612
38613 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38614 @var{pathname} was too long.
38615
38616 @item EINTR
38617 The call was interrupted by the user.
38618 @end table
38619
38620 @end table
38621
38622 @node gettimeofday
38623 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
38624 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
38625
38626 @table @asis
38627 @item Synopsis:
38628 @smallexample
38629 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
38630 @end smallexample
38631
38632 @item Request:
38633 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
38634
38635 @item Return value:
38636 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
38637
38638 @item Errors:
38639
38640 @table @code
38641 @item EINVAL
38642 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
38643
38644 @item EFAULT
38645 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38646 @end table
38647
38648 @end table
38649
38650 @node isatty
38651 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
38652 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
38653
38654 @table @asis
38655 @item Synopsis:
38656 @smallexample
38657 int isatty(int fd);
38658 @end smallexample
38659
38660 @item Request:
38661 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
38662
38663 @item Return value:
38664 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
38665
38666 @item Errors:
38667
38668 @table @code
38669 @item EINTR
38670 The call was interrupted by the user.
38671 @end table
38672
38673 @end table
38674
38675 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
38676 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
38677 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
38678 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
38679 needed.
38680
38681
38682 @node system
38683 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
38684 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
38685
38686 @table @asis
38687 @item Synopsis:
38688 @smallexample
38689 int system(const char *command);
38690 @end smallexample
38691
38692 @item Request:
38693 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
38694
38695 @item Return value:
38696 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
38697 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
38698 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
38699 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
38700 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
38701 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
38702 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
38703
38704 @item Errors:
38705
38706 @table @code
38707 @item EINTR
38708 The call was interrupted by the user.
38709 @end table
38710
38711 @end table
38712
38713 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
38714 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
38715 the host is simplified before it's returned
38716 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
38717 is discarded, and the return value consists
38718 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
38719
38720 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
38721 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
38722 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
38723
38724 @table @code
38725 @item set remote system-call-allowed
38726 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
38727 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
38728 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
38729
38730 @item show remote system-call-allowed
38731 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
38732 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
38733 protocol.
38734 @end table
38735
38736 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38737 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38738 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38739
38740 @menu
38741 * Integral Datatypes::
38742 * Pointer Values::
38743 * Memory Transfer::
38744 * struct stat::
38745 * struct timeval::
38746 @end menu
38747
38748 @node Integral Datatypes
38749 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
38750 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38751
38752 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
38753 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
38754 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
38755
38756 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
38757 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
38758
38759 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
38760
38761 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38762 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38763
38764 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38765
38766 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38767 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38768 byte order.
38769
38770 @node Pointer Values
38771 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38772 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38773
38774 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38775 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38776 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38777 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38778
38779 @smallexample
38780 @code{1aaf/12}
38781 @end smallexample
38782
38783 @noindent
38784 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38785 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38786 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38787 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38788
38789 @smallexample
38790 @code{123456/d}
38791 @end smallexample
38792
38793 @node Memory Transfer
38794 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38795 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38796
38797 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38798 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38799 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38800 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38801 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38802 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38803 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38804
38805
38806 @node struct stat
38807 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38808 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38809
38810 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38811 is defined as follows:
38812
38813 @smallexample
38814 struct stat @{
38815 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38816 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38817 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38818 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38819 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38820 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38821 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38822 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38823 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38824 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38825 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38826 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38827 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38828 @};
38829 @end smallexample
38830
38831 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38832 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38833 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38834
38835 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38836 range of values.
38837
38838 @table @code
38839
38840 @item st_dev
38841 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38842
38843 @item st_ino
38844 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38845
38846 @item st_mode
38847 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38848 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38849
38850 @item st_uid
38851 @itemx st_gid
38852 @itemx st_rdev
38853 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38854
38855 @item st_atime
38856 @itemx st_mtime
38857 @itemx st_ctime
38858 These values have a host and file system dependent
38859 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38860 support exact timing values.
38861 @end table
38862
38863 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38864 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38865 continuing.
38866
38867 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38868 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38869 get truncated on the target.
38870
38871 @node struct timeval
38872 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38873 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38874
38875 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38876 is defined as follows:
38877
38878 @smallexample
38879 struct timeval @{
38880 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38881 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38882 @};
38883 @end smallexample
38884
38885 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38886 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38887 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38888
38889 @node Constants
38890 @subsection Constants
38891 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38892
38893 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38894 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38895 values before and after the call as needed.
38896
38897 @menu
38898 * Open Flags::
38899 * mode_t Values::
38900 * Errno Values::
38901 * Lseek Flags::
38902 * Limits::
38903 @end menu
38904
38905 @node Open Flags
38906 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38907 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38908
38909 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38910
38911 @smallexample
38912 O_RDONLY 0x0
38913 O_WRONLY 0x1
38914 O_RDWR 0x2
38915 O_APPEND 0x8
38916 O_CREAT 0x200
38917 O_TRUNC 0x400
38918 O_EXCL 0x800
38919 @end smallexample
38920
38921 @node mode_t Values
38922 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38923 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38924
38925 All values are given in octal representation.
38926
38927 @smallexample
38928 S_IFREG 0100000
38929 S_IFDIR 040000
38930 S_IRUSR 0400
38931 S_IWUSR 0200
38932 S_IXUSR 0100
38933 S_IRGRP 040
38934 S_IWGRP 020
38935 S_IXGRP 010
38936 S_IROTH 04
38937 S_IWOTH 02
38938 S_IXOTH 01
38939 @end smallexample
38940
38941 @node Errno Values
38942 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38943 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38944
38945 All values are given in decimal representation.
38946
38947 @smallexample
38948 EPERM 1
38949 ENOENT 2
38950 EINTR 4
38951 EBADF 9
38952 EACCES 13
38953 EFAULT 14
38954 EBUSY 16
38955 EEXIST 17
38956 ENODEV 19
38957 ENOTDIR 20
38958 EISDIR 21
38959 EINVAL 22
38960 ENFILE 23
38961 EMFILE 24
38962 EFBIG 27
38963 ENOSPC 28
38964 ESPIPE 29
38965 EROFS 30
38966 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38967 EUNKNOWN 9999
38968 @end smallexample
38969
38970 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38971 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38972
38973 @node Lseek Flags
38974 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38975 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38976
38977 @smallexample
38978 SEEK_SET 0
38979 SEEK_CUR 1
38980 SEEK_END 2
38981 @end smallexample
38982
38983 @node Limits
38984 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38985 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38986
38987 All values are given in decimal representation.
38988
38989 @smallexample
38990 INT_MIN -2147483648
38991 INT_MAX 2147483647
38992 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38993 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38994 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38995 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38996 @end smallexample
38997
38998 @node File-I/O Examples
38999 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39000 @cindex file-i/o examples
39001
39002 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39003 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39004
39005 @smallexample
39006 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39007 @emph{request memory read from target}
39008 -> @code{m1234,6}
39009 <- XXXXXX
39010 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39011 -> @code{F6}
39012 @end smallexample
39013
39014 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39015 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39016
39017 @smallexample
39018 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39019 @emph{request memory write to target}
39020 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39021 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39022 -> @code{F6}
39023 @end smallexample
39024
39025 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39026 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39027
39028 @smallexample
39029 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39030 -> @code{F-1,9}
39031 @end smallexample
39032
39033 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39034 host is called:
39035
39036 @smallexample
39037 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39038 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39039 <- @code{T02}
39040 @end smallexample
39041
39042 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39043 host is called:
39044
39045 @smallexample
39046 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39047 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39048 <- @code{T02}
39049 @end smallexample
39050
39051 @node Library List Format
39052 @section Library List Format
39053 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39054
39055 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39056 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39057 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39058 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39059 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39060 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39061 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39062 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39063 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39064 are loaded.
39065
39066 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39067 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39068 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39069 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39070
39071 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39072 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39073 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39074 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39075 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39076 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39077
39078 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39079 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39080
39081 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39082 offset, looks like this:
39083
39084 @smallexample
39085 <library-list>
39086 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39087 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39088 </library>
39089 </library-list>
39090 @end smallexample
39091
39092 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39093 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39094
39095 @smallexample
39096 <library-list>
39097 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39098 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39099 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39100 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39101 </library>
39102 </library-list>
39103 @end smallexample
39104
39105 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39106
39107 @smallexample
39108 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39109 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39110 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39111 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39112 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39113 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39114 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39115 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39116 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39117 @end smallexample
39118
39119 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39120 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39121 section for each library.
39122
39123 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39124 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39125 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39126
39127 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39128 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39129 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39130 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39131
39132 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39133 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39134 target, the following parameters are reported:
39135
39136 @itemize @minus
39137 @item
39138 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39139 @code{struct link_map}.
39140 @item
39141 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39142 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39143 @item
39144 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39145 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39146 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39147 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39148 @item
39149 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39150 @end itemize
39151
39152 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39153 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39154 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39155
39156 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39157 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39158
39159 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39160 looks like this:
39161
39162 @smallexample
39163 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39164 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39165 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39166 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39167 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39168 </library-list-svr>
39169 @end smallexample
39170
39171 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39172
39173 @smallexample
39174 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39175 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39176 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39177 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39178 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39179 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39180 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39181 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39182 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39183 @end smallexample
39184
39185 @node Memory Map Format
39186 @section Memory Map Format
39187 @cindex memory map format
39188
39189 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39190 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39191 memory map.
39192
39193 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39194 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39195 lists memory regions.
39196
39197 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39198 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39199
39200 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39201
39202 @smallexample
39203 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39204 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39205 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39206 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39207 <memory-map>
39208 region...
39209 </memory-map>
39210 @end smallexample
39211
39212 Each region can be either:
39213
39214 @itemize
39215
39216 @item
39217 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39218 bytes from there:
39219
39220 @smallexample
39221 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39222 @end smallexample
39223
39224
39225 @item
39226 A region of read-only memory:
39227
39228 @smallexample
39229 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39230 @end smallexample
39231
39232
39233 @item
39234 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39235 bytes in length:
39236
39237 @smallexample
39238 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39239 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39240 </memory>
39241 @end smallexample
39242
39243 @end itemize
39244
39245 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39246 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39247 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39248
39249 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39250
39251 @smallexample
39252 <!-- ................................................... -->
39253 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39254 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39255 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39256 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39257 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39258 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39259 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39260 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39261 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39262 and its type, or device. -->
39263 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39264 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39265 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39266 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39267 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39268 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39269 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39270 @end smallexample
39271
39272 @node Thread List Format
39273 @section Thread List Format
39274 @cindex thread list format
39275
39276 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39277 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39278 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39279 the following structure:
39280
39281 @smallexample
39282 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39283 <threads>
39284 <thread id="id" core="0">
39285 ... description ...
39286 </thread>
39287 </threads>
39288 @end smallexample
39289
39290 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39291 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39292 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39293 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39294 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39295
39296 @node Traceframe Info Format
39297 @section Traceframe Info Format
39298 @cindex traceframe info format
39299
39300 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39301 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39302 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39303 collected in a traceframe.
39304
39305 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39306 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39307
39308 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39309 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39310
39311 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39312
39313 @smallexample
39314 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39315 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39316 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39317 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39318 <traceframe-info>
39319 block...
39320 </traceframe-info>
39321 @end smallexample
39322
39323 Each traceframe block can be either:
39324
39325 @itemize
39326
39327 @item
39328 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39329 @var{length} bytes from there:
39330
39331 @smallexample
39332 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39333 @end smallexample
39334
39335 @item
39336 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39337 collected:
39338
39339 @smallexample
39340 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39341 @end smallexample
39342
39343 @end itemize
39344
39345 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39346
39347 @smallexample
39348 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39349 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39350
39351 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39352 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39353 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39354 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39355 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39356 @end smallexample
39357
39358 @node Branch Trace Format
39359 @section Branch Trace Format
39360 @cindex branch trace format
39361
39362 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39363 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39364 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39365 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39366
39367 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39368 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39369
39370 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39371 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39372
39373 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39374
39375 @smallexample
39376 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39377 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39378 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39379 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39380 <btrace>
39381 block...
39382 </btrace>
39383 @end smallexample
39384
39385 @itemize
39386
39387 @item
39388 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39389 and ending at @var{end}:
39390
39391 @smallexample
39392 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39393 @end smallexample
39394
39395 @end itemize
39396
39397 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39398
39399 @smallexample
39400 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
39401 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39402
39403 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39404 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39405 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39406 @end smallexample
39407
39408 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39409 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39410 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39411
39412 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39413 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39414 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39415
39416 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39417 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39418
39419 @table @code
39420 @item bts
39421 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39422 @table @code
39423 @item size
39424 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39425 @end table
39426 @end table
39427
39428 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39429 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39430
39431 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39432
39433 @smallexample
39434 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?)>
39435 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39436
39437 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39438 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39439 @end smallexample
39440
39441 @include agentexpr.texi
39442
39443 @node Target Descriptions
39444 @appendix Target Descriptions
39445 @cindex target descriptions
39446
39447 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39448 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39449 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39450 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39451 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39452 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39453 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39454
39455 @itemize @bullet
39456 @item
39457 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39458 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39459 @item
39460 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39461 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39462 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39463 @item
39464 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39465 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39466 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39467 @end itemize
39468
39469 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39470 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39471 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39472 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39473 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39474
39475 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39476 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39477
39478 @menu
39479 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39480 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39481 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39482 descriptions.
39483 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39484 @end menu
39485
39486 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39487 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39488
39489 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39490 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39491 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39492 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39493 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39494 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39495 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39496 Format}.
39497
39498 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39499 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39500 specify a file are:
39501
39502 @table @code
39503 @cindex set tdesc filename
39504 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39505 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39506
39507 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39508 @item unset tdesc filename
39509 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39510 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39511
39512 @cindex show tdesc filename
39513 @item show tdesc filename
39514 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39515 @end table
39516
39517
39518 @node Target Description Format
39519 @section Target Description Format
39520 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39521
39522 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39523 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39524 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39525 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39526 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39527 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39528 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39529
39530 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39531 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39532 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39533 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39534 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39535
39536 Here is a simple target description:
39537
39538 @smallexample
39539 <target version="1.0">
39540 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39541 </target>
39542 @end smallexample
39543
39544 @noindent
39545 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39546 the x86-64 architecture.
39547
39548 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39549 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39550 are explained further below.
39551
39552 @smallexample
39553 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39554 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39555 <target version="1.0">
39556 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39557 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39558 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39559 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39560 </target>
39561 @end smallexample
39562
39563 @noindent
39564 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39565 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39566 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39567 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39568 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39569 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39570 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39571 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39572 the version mismatch.
39573
39574 @subsection Inclusion
39575 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39576 @cindex XInclude
39577 @ifnotinfo
39578 @cindex <xi:include>
39579 @end ifnotinfo
39580
39581 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39582 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39583 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39584 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39585 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39586
39587 @smallexample
39588 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39589 @end smallexample
39590
39591 @noindent
39592 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39593 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39594 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39595 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39596 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39597 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39598 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39599 original description.
39600
39601 @subsection Architecture
39602 @cindex <architecture>
39603
39604 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
39605
39606 @smallexample
39607 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
39608 @end smallexample
39609
39610 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39611 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39612
39613 @subsection OS ABI
39614 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
39615
39616 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39617 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39618
39619 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
39620
39621 @smallexample
39622 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
39623 @end smallexample
39624
39625 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
39626 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
39627
39628 @subsection Compatible Architecture
39629 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
39630
39631 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39632 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39633
39634 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
39635
39636 @smallexample
39637 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
39638 @end smallexample
39639
39640 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39641 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39642
39643 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
39644 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
39645 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
39646 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
39647 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
39648 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
39649 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
39650
39651 @smallexample
39652 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
39653 <compatible>spu</compatible>
39654 @end smallexample
39655
39656 @subsection Features
39657 @cindex <feature>
39658
39659 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
39660 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
39661 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
39662 has this form:
39663
39664 @smallexample
39665 <feature name="@var{name}">
39666 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
39667 @var{reg}@dots{}
39668 </feature>
39669 @end smallexample
39670
39671 @noindent
39672 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
39673 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
39674 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
39675 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
39676
39677 @subsection Types
39678
39679 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
39680 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
39681 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
39682 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
39683 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
39684
39685 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
39686 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
39687 Types must be defined before they are used.
39688
39689 @cindex <vector>
39690 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
39691 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
39692 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
39693 @var{count}:
39694
39695 @smallexample
39696 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
39697 @end smallexample
39698
39699 @cindex <union>
39700 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
39701 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
39702 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
39703 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
39704
39705 @smallexample
39706 <union id="@var{id}">
39707 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39708 @dots{}
39709 </union>
39710 @end smallexample
39711
39712 @cindex <struct>
39713 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
39714 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
39715 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
39716 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
39717 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
39718 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
39719 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
39720 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
39721
39722 @smallexample
39723 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39724 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39725 @dots{}
39726 </struct>
39727 @end smallexample
39728
39729 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
39730 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
39731
39732 @smallexample
39733 <struct id="@var{id}">
39734 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39735 @dots{}
39736 </struct>
39737 @end smallexample
39738
39739 @cindex <flags>
39740 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
39741 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
39742 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
39743 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
39744 are supported.
39745
39746 @smallexample
39747 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39748 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39749 @dots{}
39750 </flags>
39751 @end smallexample
39752
39753 @subsection Registers
39754 @cindex <reg>
39755
39756 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
39757
39758 @smallexample
39759 <reg name="@var{name}"
39760 bitsize="@var{size}"
39761 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
39762 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
39763 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
39764 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
39765 @end smallexample
39766
39767 @noindent
39768 The components are as follows:
39769
39770 @table @var
39771
39772 @item name
39773 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
39774
39775 @item bitsize
39776 The register's size, in bits.
39777
39778 @item regnum
39779 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
39780 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
39781 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
39782 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
39783 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
39784 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
39785 in order of increasing register number.
39786
39787 @item save-restore
39788 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
39789 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
39790 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
39791 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
39792 ABI.
39793
39794 @item type
39795 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39796 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39797 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39798 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39799 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39800 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39801
39802 @item group
39803 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39804 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39805 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39806 in @code{info registers}.
39807
39808 @end table
39809
39810 @node Predefined Target Types
39811 @section Predefined Target Types
39812 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39813
39814 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39815 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39816 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39817 types. The currently supported types are:
39818
39819 @table @code
39820
39821 @item int8
39822 @itemx int16
39823 @itemx int32
39824 @itemx int64
39825 @itemx int128
39826 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39827
39828 @item uint8
39829 @itemx uint16
39830 @itemx uint32
39831 @itemx uint64
39832 @itemx uint128
39833 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39834
39835 @item code_ptr
39836 @itemx data_ptr
39837 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39838 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39839 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39840 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39841 may be marked as data pointers.
39842
39843 @item ieee_single
39844 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39845
39846 @item ieee_double
39847 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39848
39849 @item arm_fpa_ext
39850 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39851
39852 @item i387_ext
39853 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39854
39855 @item i386_eflags
39856 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39857
39858 @item i386_mxcsr
39859 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39860
39861 @end table
39862
39863 @node Standard Target Features
39864 @section Standard Target Features
39865 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39866
39867 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39868 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39869 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39870 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39871 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39872 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39873 can recognize them.
39874
39875 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39876 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39877 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39878 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39879 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39880 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39881 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39882 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39883
39884 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39885 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39886 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39887
39888 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39889 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39890 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39891 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39892
39893 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39894 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39895 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39896
39897 @menu
39898 * AArch64 Features::
39899 * ARM Features::
39900 * i386 Features::
39901 * MicroBlaze Features::
39902 * MIPS Features::
39903 * M68K Features::
39904 * Nios II Features::
39905 * PowerPC Features::
39906 * S/390 and System z Features::
39907 * TIC6x Features::
39908 @end menu
39909
39910
39911 @node AArch64 Features
39912 @subsection AArch64 Features
39913 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39914
39915 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39916 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39917 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39918
39919 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39920 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39921 and @samp{fpcr}.
39922
39923 @node ARM Features
39924 @subsection ARM Features
39925 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39926
39927 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39928 ARM targets.
39929 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39930 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39931
39932 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39933 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39934 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39935 and @samp{xpsr}.
39936
39937 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39938 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39939
39940 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39941 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39942 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39943 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39944
39945 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39946 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39947 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39948 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39949 halves of the double-precision registers.
39950
39951 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39952 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39953 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39954 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39955 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39956 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39957
39958 @node i386 Features
39959 @subsection i386 Features
39960 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39961
39962 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39963 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39964
39965 @itemize @minus
39966 @item
39967 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39968 @item
39969 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39970 @item
39971 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39972 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39973 @item
39974 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39975 @item
39976 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39977 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39978 @end itemize
39979
39980 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39981
39982 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39983 describe registers:
39984
39985 @itemize @minus
39986 @item
39987 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39988 @item
39989 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39990 @item
39991 @samp{mxcsr}
39992 @end itemize
39993
39994 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39995 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39996 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39997
39998 @itemize @minus
39999 @item
40000 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40001 @item
40002 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40003 @end itemize
40004
40005 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
40006 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40007
40008 @itemize @minus
40009 @item
40010 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40011 @item
40012 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40013 @end itemize
40014
40015 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40016 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40017
40018 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40019 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40020 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40021
40022 @itemize @minus
40023 @item
40024 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40025 @end itemize
40026
40027 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40028
40029 @itemize @minus
40030 @item
40031 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40032 @end itemize
40033
40034 It should
40035 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40036
40037 @itemize @minus
40038 @item
40039 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40040 @item
40041 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40042 @end itemize
40043
40044 It should
40045 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40046
40047 @itemize @minus
40048 @item
40049 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40050 @end itemize
40051
40052 @node MicroBlaze Features
40053 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40054 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40055
40056 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40057 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40058 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40059 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40060 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40061
40062 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40063 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40064
40065 @node MIPS Features
40066 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40067 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40068
40069 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40070 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40071 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40072 on the target.
40073
40074 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40075 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40076 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40077
40078 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40079 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40080 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40081 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40082
40083 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40084 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40085 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40086 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40087
40088 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40089 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40090 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40091
40092 @node M68K Features
40093 @subsection M68K Features
40094 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40095
40096 @table @code
40097 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40098 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40099 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40100 One of those features must be always present.
40101 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40102 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40103 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40104 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40105
40106 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40107 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40108 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40109 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40110 @end table
40111
40112 @node Nios II Features
40113 @subsection Nios II Features
40114 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40115
40116 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40117 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40118 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40119 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40120 @samp{mpuacc}).
40121
40122 @node PowerPC Features
40123 @subsection PowerPC Features
40124 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40125
40126 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40127 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40128 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40129 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40130
40131 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40132 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40133
40134 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40135 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40136 and @samp{vrsave}.
40137
40138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40139 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40140 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40141 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40142 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40143 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40144
40145 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40146 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40147 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40148 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40149 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40150 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40151 user.
40152
40153 @node S/390 and System z Features
40154 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40155 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40156 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40157
40158 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40159 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40160 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40161 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40162 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40163 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40164 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40165 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40166 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40167
40168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40169 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40170 @samp{fpc}.
40171
40172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40173 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40174
40175 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40176 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40177 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40178 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40179 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40180 32-bit wide.
40181
40182 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40183 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40184 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40185
40186 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40187 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40188 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40189 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40190 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40191 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40192 @samp{v31}.
40193
40194 @node TIC6x Features
40195 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40196 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40197 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40199 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40200 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40201
40202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40203 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40204 through @samp{B31}.
40205
40206 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40207 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40208
40209 @node Operating System Information
40210 @appendix Operating System Information
40211 @cindex operating system information
40212
40213 @menu
40214 * Process list::
40215 @end menu
40216
40217 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40218 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40219 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40220 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40221 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40222 on a different aspect of target.
40223
40224 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40225 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40226 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40227 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40228
40229 @node Process list
40230 @appendixsection Process list
40231 @cindex operating system information, process list
40232
40233 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40234 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40235 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40236 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40237
40238 An example document is:
40239
40240 @smallexample
40241 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40242 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40243 <osdata type="processes">
40244 <item>
40245 <column name="pid">1</column>
40246 <column name="user">root</column>
40247 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40248 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40249 </item>
40250 </osdata>
40251 @end smallexample
40252
40253 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40254 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40255 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40256 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40257 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40258 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40259 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40260
40261 @node Trace File Format
40262 @appendix Trace File Format
40263 @cindex trace file format
40264
40265 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40266 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40267
40268 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40269 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40270 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40271 in the future.
40272
40273 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40274 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40275 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40276 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40277 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40278 of this section.
40279
40280 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40281
40282 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40283 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40284 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40285 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40286 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40287 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40288 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40289 endianness.
40290
40291 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40292
40293 @table @code
40294 @item R @var{bytes}
40295 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40296 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40297 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40298 hexadecimal encoding.
40299
40300 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40301 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40302 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40303 @var{length} bytes.
40304
40305 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40306 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40307 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40308
40309 @end table
40310
40311 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40312 of blocks.
40313
40314 @node Index Section Format
40315 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40316 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40317 @cindex index section format
40318
40319 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40320 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40321 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40322 description.
40323
40324 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40325 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40326 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40327 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40328 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40329 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40330
40331 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40332
40333 @enumerate
40334 @item
40335 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40336 unless otherwise noted:
40337
40338 @enumerate
40339 @item
40340 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40341 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40342 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40343 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40344 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40345 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40346 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40347
40348 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40349 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40350 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40351 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40352
40353 @item
40354 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40355
40356 @item
40357 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40358 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40359 to the next offset.
40360
40361 @item
40362 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40363
40364 @item
40365 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40366
40367 @item
40368 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40369 @end enumerate
40370
40371 @item
40372 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40373 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40374 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40375 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40376 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40377 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40378 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40379 CU indices.
40380
40381 @item
40382 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40383 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40384 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40385 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40386
40387 @item
40388 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40389 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40390
40391 @enumerate
40392 @item
40393 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40394
40395 @item
40396 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40397 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40398
40399 @item
40400 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40401 @end enumerate
40402
40403 @item
40404 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40405 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40406
40407 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40408 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40409 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40410 constant pool.
40411
40412 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40413 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40414 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40415
40416 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40417 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40418 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40419 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40420 index version:
40421
40422 @table @asis
40423 @item Version 4
40424 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40425
40426 @item Versions 5 to 7
40427 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40428 @end table
40429
40430 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40431
40432 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40433 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40434 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40435 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40436 collision.
40437
40438 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40439 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40440 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40441 the code.
40442
40443 @item
40444 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40445 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40446 strings.
40447
40448 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40449 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40450 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40451 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40452 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40453 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40454
40455 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40456 @end enumerate
40457
40458 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40459 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40460 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40461
40462 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40463 (bit 0 = LSB):
40464
40465 @table @asis
40466
40467 @item Bits 0-23
40468 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40469 @item Bits 24-27
40470 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40471 @item Bits 28-30
40472 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40473
40474 @table @asis
40475 @item 0
40476 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40477 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40478 with previous versions of the index.
40479 @item 1
40480 The symbol is a type.
40481 @item 2
40482 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40483 @item 3
40484 The symbol is a function.
40485 @item 4
40486 Any other kind of symbol.
40487 @item 5,6,7
40488 These values are reserved.
40489 @end table
40490
40491 @item Bit 31
40492 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40493
40494 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40495 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40496 @value{GDBN} sources.
40497
40498 @end table
40499
40500 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40501 global/static attributes in the index.
40502
40503 @smallexample
40504 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40505 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40506 switch (die->tag)
40507 @{
40508 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40509 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40510 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40511 kind = TYPE;
40512 is_static = 1;
40513 break;
40514 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40515 kind = VARIABLE;
40516 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40517 break;
40518 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40519 kind = FUNCTION;
40520 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40521 break;
40522 case DW_TAG_constant:
40523 kind = VARIABLE;
40524 is_static = ! is_external;
40525 break;
40526 case DW_TAG_variable:
40527 kind = VARIABLE;
40528 is_static = ! is_external;
40529 break;
40530 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40531 kind = TYPE;
40532 is_static = 0;
40533 break;
40534 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40535 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40536 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40537 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40538 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40539 kind = TYPE;
40540 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40541 break;
40542 default:
40543 assert (0);
40544 @}
40545 @end smallexample
40546
40547 @node Man Pages
40548 @appendix Manual pages
40549 @cindex Man pages
40550
40551 @menu
40552 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40553 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40554 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40555 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40556 @end menu
40557
40558 @node gdb man
40559 @heading gdb man
40560
40561 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40562
40563 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40564 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40565 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40566 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40567 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40568 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40569 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40570 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40571 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40572 @c man end
40573
40574 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40575 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40576 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40577 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40578
40579 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40580 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40581
40582 @itemize @bullet
40583 @item
40584 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
40585
40586 @item
40587 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
40588
40589 @item
40590 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
40591
40592 @item
40593 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
40594 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
40595 @end itemize
40596
40597 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
40598 Modula-2.
40599
40600 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
40601 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
40602 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
40603 by using the command @code{help}.
40604
40605 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
40606 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
40607 executable program as the argument:
40608
40609 @smallexample
40610 gdb program
40611 @end smallexample
40612
40613 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
40614
40615 @smallexample
40616 gdb program core
40617 @end smallexample
40618
40619 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
40620 to debug a running process:
40621
40622 @smallexample
40623 gdb program 1234
40624 gdb -p 1234
40625 @end smallexample
40626
40627 @noindent
40628 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
40629 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
40630 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
40631
40632 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
40633
40634 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
40635 @table @env
40636 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
40637 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
40638
40639 @item run [@var{arglist}]
40640 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
40641
40642 @item bt
40643 Backtrace: display the program stack.
40644
40645 @item print @var{expr}
40646 Display the value of an expression.
40647
40648 @item c
40649 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
40650
40651 @item next
40652 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
40653 function calls in the line.
40654
40655 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40656 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
40657
40658 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40659 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
40660
40661 @item step
40662 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
40663 function calls in the line.
40664
40665 @item help [@var{name}]
40666 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
40667 about using @value{GDBN}.
40668
40669 @item quit
40670 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
40671 @end table
40672
40673 @ifset man
40674 For full details on @value{GDBN},
40675 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40676 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
40677 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
40678 @end ifset
40679 @c man end
40680
40681 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
40682 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
40683 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
40684 encountered with no
40685 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
40686 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
40687 Many options have
40688 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
40689 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
40690 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
40691 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
40692 more usual convention.)
40693
40694 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
40695 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
40696 option is used.
40697
40698 @table @env
40699 @item -help
40700 @itemx -h
40701 List all options, with brief explanations.
40702
40703 @item -symbols=@var{file}
40704 @itemx -s @var{file}
40705 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
40706
40707 @item -write
40708 Enable writing into executable and core files.
40709
40710 @item -exec=@var{file}
40711 @itemx -e @var{file}
40712 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
40713 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
40714 dump.
40715
40716 @item -se=@var{file}
40717 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
40718 file.
40719
40720 @item -core=@var{file}
40721 @itemx -c @var{file}
40722 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
40723
40724 @item -command=@var{file}
40725 @itemx -x @var{file}
40726 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
40727
40728 @item -ex @var{command}
40729 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
40730
40731 @item -directory=@var{directory}
40732 @itemx -d @var{directory}
40733 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
40734
40735 @item -nh
40736 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
40737
40738 @item -nx
40739 @itemx -n
40740 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
40741
40742 @item -quiet
40743 @itemx -q
40744 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
40745 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
40746
40747 @item -batch
40748 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
40749 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
40750 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
40751 commands in the command files.
40752
40753 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
40754 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
40755 more useful, the message
40756
40757 @smallexample
40758 Program exited normally.
40759 @end smallexample
40760
40761 @noindent
40762 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
40763 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
40764
40765 @item -cd=@var{directory}
40766 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
40767 instead of the current directory.
40768
40769 @item -fullname
40770 @itemx -f
40771 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
40772 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
40773 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
40774 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
40775 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
40776 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
40777 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
40778 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
40779
40780 @item -b @var{bps}
40781 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
40782 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
40783
40784 @item -tty=@var{device}
40785 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
40786 @end table
40787 @c man end
40788
40789 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
40790 @ifset man
40791 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40792 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40793 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40794
40795 @smallexample
40796 info gdb
40797 @end smallexample
40798
40799 @noindent
40800 should give you access to the complete manual.
40801
40802 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40803 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40804 @end ifset
40805 @c man end
40806
40807 @node gdbserver man
40808 @heading gdbserver man
40809
40810 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
40811 @format
40812 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
40813 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40814
40815 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40816
40817 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40818 @c man end
40819 @end format
40820
40821 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40822 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40823 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40824
40825 @ifclear man
40826 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40827 @end ifclear
40828 @ifset man
40829 Usage (server (target) side):
40830 @end ifset
40831
40832 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40833 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40834 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40835 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40836
40837 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40838 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40839 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40840
40841 @smallexample
40842 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40843 @end smallexample
40844
40845 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40846
40847 @smallexample
40848 @ifset man
40849 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40850 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40851 @end ifset
40852 @ifclear man
40853 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40854 @end ifclear
40855 @end smallexample
40856
40857 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40858 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40859 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40860
40861 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40862
40863 @smallexample
40864 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40865 @end smallexample
40866
40867 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40868 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40869 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40870 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40871 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40872 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40873 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40874 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40875 print an error message and exit.
40876
40877 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40878 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40879
40880 @smallexample
40881 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40882 @end smallexample
40883
40884 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40885 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40886
40887 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40888 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40889 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40890 the program you want to debug.
40891
40892 @smallexample
40893 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40894 @end smallexample
40895
40896 @ifclear man
40897 @subheading Usage (host side)
40898 @end ifclear
40899 @ifset man
40900 Usage (host side):
40901 @end ifset
40902
40903 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40904 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40905 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40906 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40907 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40908 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40909 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40910 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40911 descriptor. For example:
40912
40913 @smallexample
40914 @ifset man
40915 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40916 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40917 @end ifset
40918 @ifclear man
40919 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40920 @end ifclear
40921 @end smallexample
40922
40923 @noindent
40924 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40925
40926 @smallexample
40927 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40928 @end smallexample
40929
40930 @noindent
40931 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40932 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40933 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40934 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40935 `Connection refused'.
40936
40937 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40938 described in
40939 @ifset man
40940 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40941 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40942 @end ifset
40943 @ifclear man
40944 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40945 @end ifclear
40946 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40947
40948 @smallexample
40949 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40950 @end smallexample
40951
40952 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40953 case.
40954 @c man end
40955
40956 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40957 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40958
40959 @itemize @bullet
40960
40961 @item
40962 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40963
40964 @smallexample
40965 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40966 @end smallexample
40967
40968 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40969 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40970 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40971 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40972 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40973 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40974 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40975
40976 @item
40977 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40978 program:
40979
40980 @smallexample
40981 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40982 @end smallexample
40983
40984 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40985 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40986 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40987 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40988
40989 @item
40990 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40991
40992 @smallexample
40993 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40994 @end smallexample
40995
40996 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40997 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40998 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40999 debug several processes in the same session.
41000 @end itemize
41001
41002 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41003
41004 @table @env
41005
41006 @item --help
41007 List all options, with brief explanations.
41008
41009 @item --version
41010 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41011
41012 @item --attach
41013 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41014
41015 @smallexample
41016 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41017 @end smallexample
41018
41019 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41020 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41021
41022 @item --multi
41023 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41024 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41025 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41026 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41027
41028 @smallexample
41029 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41030 @end smallexample
41031
41032 @item --debug
41033 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41034 process.
41035 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41036 the developers.
41037
41038 @item --remote-debug
41039 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41040 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41041 the developers.
41042
41043 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41044 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41045 of debugging output.
41046 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41047
41048 @item --wrapper
41049 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41050 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41051 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41052 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41053
41054 @item --once
41055 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41056 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41057 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41058 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41059
41060 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41061
41062 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41063 @c QDisableRandomization.
41064
41065 @end table
41066 @c man end
41067
41068 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41069 @ifset man
41070 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41071 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41072 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41073
41074 @smallexample
41075 info gdb
41076 @end smallexample
41077
41078 should give you access to the complete manual.
41079
41080 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41081 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41082 @end ifset
41083 @c man end
41084
41085 @node gcore man
41086 @heading gcore
41087
41088 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41089
41090 @format
41091 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41092 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41093 @c man end
41094 @end format
41095
41096 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41097 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41098 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41099 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41100 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41101 running without any change.
41102 @c man end
41103
41104 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41105 @table @env
41106 @item -o @var{filename}
41107 The optional argument
41108 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41109 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41110 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41111 @end table
41112 @c man end
41113
41114 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41115 @ifset man
41116 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41117 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41118 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41119
41120 @smallexample
41121 info gdb
41122 @end smallexample
41123
41124 @noindent
41125 should give you access to the complete manual.
41126
41127 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41128 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41129 @end ifset
41130 @c man end
41131
41132 @node gdbinit man
41133 @heading gdbinit
41134
41135 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41136
41137 @format
41138 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41139 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41140 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41141 @end ifset
41142
41143 ~/.gdbinit
41144
41145 ./.gdbinit
41146 @c man end
41147 @end format
41148
41149 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41150 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41151 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41152 described in
41153 @ifset man
41154 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41155 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41156 @end ifset
41157 @ifclear man
41158 @ref{Sequences}.
41159 @end ifclear
41160
41161 Please read more in
41162 @ifset man
41163 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41164 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41165 @end ifset
41166 @ifclear man
41167 @ref{Startup}.
41168 @end ifclear
41169
41170 @table @env
41171 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41172 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41173 @end ifset
41174 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41175 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41176 @end ifclear
41177 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41178 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41179 See more in
41180 @ifset man
41181 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41182 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41183 @end ifset
41184 @ifclear man
41185 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41186 @end ifclear
41187
41188 @item ~/.gdbinit
41189 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41190 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41191
41192 @item ./.gdbinit
41193 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41194 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41195 See more in
41196 @ifset man
41197 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41198 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41199 @end ifset
41200 @ifclear man
41201 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41202 @end ifclear
41203 @end table
41204 @c man end
41205
41206 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41207 @ifset man
41208 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41209
41210 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41211 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41212 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41213
41214 @smallexample
41215 info gdb
41216 @end smallexample
41217
41218 should give you access to the complete manual.
41219
41220 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41221 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41222 @end ifset
41223 @c man end
41224
41225 @include gpl.texi
41226
41227 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41228 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41229 @include fdl.texi
41230
41231 @node Concept Index
41232 @unnumbered Concept Index
41233
41234 @printindex cp
41235
41236 @node Command and Variable Index
41237 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41238
41239 @printindex fn
41240
41241 @tex
41242 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41243 % meantime:
41244 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41245 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41246 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41247 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41248 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41249 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41250 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41251 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41252 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41253 \page\colophon
41254 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41255 @end tex
41256
41257 @bye